266 42 362MB
English Pages 248 Year 2017
London Art Worlds
LONDON ART WORLDS LONDON ART WORLDS LONDON ART WORLDS LONDON ART WORLDS LONDON ART WORLDS LONDON ART WORLDS LONDON ART WORLDS LONDON ART WORLDS LONDON ART WORLDS LONDON ART WORLDS LONDON ART WORLDS LONDON ART WORLDS LONDON ART WORLDS LONDON ART WORLDS
Mobile, Contingent, and Ephemeral Networks, 1960–1980
Edited by Jo Applin, Catherine Spencer, and Amy Tobin The Pennsylvania State University Press, University Park, Pennsylvania
Supported by a Publications Grant from the Paul Mellon Centre for Studies in British Art. Library of Congress Cataloging-inPublication Data Names: Applin, Jo, editor. | Spencer, Catherine, 1985– , editor. | Tobin, Amy, 1989– , editor. Title: London art worlds : mobile, contingent, and ephemeral networks, 1960–1980 / edited by Jo Applin, Catherine Spencer, and Amy Tobin. Other titles: Refiguring modernism. Description: University Park, Pennsylvania : The Pennsylvania State University Press, [2018] | Series: Refiguring modernism | Includes bibliographical references and index. Summary: “Examines the rich networks of international artists and art practices that emerged in and around London during the 1960s and 1970s. Discusses diverse practices, movements, and spaces, from painting, sculpture, and film to performance, conceptual, and land art”—Provided by publisher. Identifiers: LCCN 2017009261 | ISBN 9780271078533 (cloth : alk. paper) Subjects: LCSH: Art—England—London. | Art, Modern—20th century. | Artists—England—London. Classification: LCC N6770 .L6495 2018 | DDC 709.421—dc23 LC record available at https://lccn.loc. gov/2017009261
Copyright © 2018 The Pennsylvania State University All rights reserved Printed in China Published by The Pennsylvania State University Press, University Park, PA 16802-1003 The Pennsylvania State University Press is a member of the Association of American University Presses. It is the policy of The Pennsylvania State University Press to use acid-free paper. Publications on uncoated stock satisfy the minimum requirements of American National Standard for Information Sciences—Permanence of Paper for Printed Library Material, ansi z39.48–1992.
Typeset by Regina Starace Printed and bound by Asia Pacific Offset Composed in Whitney and Futura Printed on Chen Ming FSC matt Bound in JHT
List of Illustrations vii Acknowledgments xi
Introduction
6. Taking the Trouble to Sound It:
Jo Applin, Catherine Spencer,
Mediating Conflict in the Work of Rita
and Amy Tobin 1
Donagh Catherine Spencer 115
1. Everything Was Connected: Kinetic
7. Circulations and Cooperations: Art,
Art and Internationalism at Signals
Feminism, and Film in 1960s and 1970s
London, 1964–66
London
Isobel Whitelegg 21
Lucy Reynolds 133
2. A Porous Entity: The Centre for
8. Project sigma: An Interpersonal
Behavioural Art at Gallery House,
Logbook
1972–73
Andrew Wilson 151
Antony Hudek 39
3. Mapping the City: Felipe Ehrenberg in
9. The Artist as a Speaker-Performer: The London Art School in the
London, 1968–71
1960s–70s
Carmen Juliá 55
Elena Crippa 169
4. Restoring Some Period Color to Roelof
10. File Under COUM: Art on Trial in
Louw’s Pyramid of Oranges (1967)
Genesis P-Orridge’s Mail Action
Joy Sleeman 77
Dominic Johnson 183
5. Collectivity, Temporality, and Festival Culture in John Dugger’s Quasi-Architecture, 1970–74 Courtney J. Martin 95
Bibliography 201 List of Contributors 213 Index 216
Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents Contents
Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations Illustrations
I.1
Front cover of the International Times, February 9–23, 1973. Cover design and photograph by George Snow. Photo courtesy of the International Times Archive and George Snow. 2
I.2
Rose Finn-Kelcey, Here Is a Gale Warning, 1971. Black bunting and silver tissue, 670 × 900 cm. Originally shown as part of Art Spectrum, survey exhibition of London Artists, Alexandra Palace, London. Photo courtesy the Estate of Rose Finn-Kelcey. 6
I.3
Cecilia Vicuña, Libro Tul Rojo, from 12 Books for the Chilean Resistance, 1973–74. Purchased in 2014 by the Tate Americas Foundation courtesy of the Latin American Acquisition Committee. © Cecilia Vicuña. Photo courtesy England & Co., London. 11
I.4
John Dugger, Chile Vencera Banner in Trafalgar Square, 1974. © John Dugger. Photo courtesy of Banner Arts Archive. 16
I.5
John Dugger, The Great Martial Arts Banner (Wu Shu Kwan), 1976. Dyed-canvas, sewn strip banner with soft rigging (seen here installed at the Flaxman Sports Centre, Lambeth, London). © John Dugger. Photo courtesy of Banner Arts Archive. 17
1.1 Front cover, Signalz: Newsbulletin of the Centre for Advanced Creative Study, June 1964 (facsimile edition published by Iniva, 1995). Photo courtesy of the Stuart Hall Library, Iniva (Institute of International Visual Arts), London. 23
1.2 Photograph taken during the installation of the exhibition A Quarter of a Century of the Beautiful Art of Alejandro Otero: 1940–1965, Signals London, January 20–March 19, 1966. Photo © Clay Perry, courtesy of England & Co. Gallery, London. 27 1.3 Photograph taken during the installation of the exhibition A Quarter of a Century of the Beautiful Art of Alejandro Otero: 1940–1965, Signals London, January 20–March 19, 1966. Photo © Clay Perry, courtesy of England & Co. Gallery, London. 28 1.4 Invitation card for the exhibition Soundings Three, Signals London, August 25–September 24, 1966. Photo courtesy of Isobel Whitelegg. 30 1.5 Catalogue for the exhibition Venezuela, Midland Group Gallery, Nottingham, May 27–June 24, 1972. Photo courtesy of Inspire—Nottinghamshire Archives. 35 2.1 Stephen Willats, West London Super Girls outside the Centre for Behavioural Art, London, 1973. Photo courtesy of Stephen Willats. 45 2.2 Stephen Willats, The Artist as an Instigator of Changes in Social Cognition and Behaviour, Centre for Behavioural Art, London, 1973. Photo courtesy of Stephen Willats. 46 2.3a Stephen Willats, Survey of Distance Models of Art, Images sheet 1, Centre for Behavioural Art, London, 1973. Photo courtesy of Stephen Willats. 49
2.3b Stephen Willats, Survey of Distance Models of Art, Images sheet 2, Centre for Behavioural Art, London, 1973. Photo courtesy of Stephen Willats. 49 3.1 Felipe Ehrenberg, A Stroll in July, or One Thursday Afternoon, or Half Day in London, or (The) Afternoon, or . . . Topology of Sculpture, 1970. Photo: Fondo Felipe Ehrenberg, Centro de Documentación Arkheia, Museo Universitario Arte Contemporáneo, UNAM. Courtesy of Felipe Ehrenberg. 59 3.2 Felipe Ehrenberg, A Stroll in July, or One Thursday Afternoon, or Half Day in London, or (The) Afternoon, or . . . Topology of Sculpture, 1970. Photo: Fondo Felipe Ehrenberg, Centro de Documentación Arkheia, Museo Universitario Arte Contemporáneo, UNAM. Courtesy of Felipe Ehrenberg. 60 3.3 Felipe Ehrenberg, A Stroll in July, or One Thursday Afternoon, or Half Day in London, or (The) Afternoon, or . . . Topology of Sculpture, 1970. Photo: Fondo Felipe Ehrenberg, Centro de Documentación Arkheia, Museo Universitario Arte Contemporáneo, UNAM. Courtesy of Felipe Ehrenberg. 60 3.4 Felipe Ehrenberg, Tube-O-Nauts’ Travels, a Voyage Under London, 1970. Photo: Rodolfo “Laus” Alcaraz. Courtesy of Felipe Ehrenberg. 62 3.5 Felipe Ehrenberg, Tube-O-Nauts’ Travels, a Voyage Under London, 1970. Photo: Rodolfo “Laus” Alcaraz. Courtesy of Felipe Ehrenberg. 63 3.6 A Date with Fate at the Tate, or Tate Bait, 1970 (from left to right, Stuart Brisley, Felipe Ehrenberg, Sigi Krauss, and John Plant). Photo: Philippe Mora. Courtesy of Felipe Ehrenberg. 64 3.7 Polygonal Workshop, Garbage Walk, 1970. Photo: Fondo Felipe Ehrenberg, Centro de Documentación Arkheia, Museo Universitario Arte Contemporáneo, UNAM. Courtesy of Felipe Ehrenberg. 68 3.8 Polygonal Workshop, Garbage Walk, 1970. Photo: Fondo Felipe Ehrenberg, Centro de Documentación Arkheia, Museo Universitario Arte Contemporáneo, UNAM. Courtesy of Felipe Ehrenberg. 69 4.1 Roelof Louw, Soul City (Pyramid of Oranges), 1967. Tate Gallery, London, presented by Tate Patrons 2013, T13881. Installation shot from the Tate Britain exhibition
viii Illustrations
Conceptual Art in Britain, 1964–1979, 2016. © Roelof Louw. Photo © Tate, London, 2016. 78 4.2 Arts Lab, London, membership form and proposal by Roelof Louw, 1967. Collection of Biddy Peppin. 79 4.3 Roelof Louw, sculpture for the Arts Laboratory, October 1967, from Studio International 177, no. 907 (January 1969): 35. © Roelof Louw. 80 4.4 Roelof Louw, Holland Park, 1967. © Roelof Louw. Courtesy of Richard Saltoun Gallery. 82 4.5 Roelof Louw, Square 4 (Red / Light Green), ca. 1969. © Roelof Louw. Photo © Tate, London, 2016. 84 5.1 John Dugger, Pavilion Dugger (a.k.a. People’s Participation Pavilion), 1972. Installation at the exhibition documenta 5: Befragung der Realität—Bildwelten heute, Museum Fridericianum, Kassel, Germany, 1972. © John Dugger. Photo courtesy of Banner Arts Archive. 96 5.2 John Dugger, Biomass Installation, 1971. Shown at the exhibition Pioneers of Part-Art, Museum of Modern Art, Oxford. © John Dugger. Photo courtesy of Banner Arts Archive. 100 5.3 John Dugger and Lorenz Dombois, architectural plan for Pavilion Dugger (a.k.a. People’s Participation Pavilion), 1972. Installation at the exhibition documenta 5: Befragung der Realität—Bildwelten heute, Museum Fridericianum, Kassel, Germany, 1972. © John Dugger. Photo courtesy of Banner Arts Archive. 105 5.4 Graham Stevens, Inflatable, 1972, atop the People’s Participation Pavilion. Installation at the exhibition documenta 5: Befragung der Realität—Bildwelten heute, Museum Fridericianum, Kassel, Germany, 1972. Photo courtesy of Graham Stevens. 106 5.5 Arts Festival for Democracy in Chile, Royal College of Art, London, 1974. © John Dugger. Photo courtesy of Banner Arts Archive. 110 6.1 Rita Donagh, Evening Papers (Ulster 1972–74), 1973–74. Oil, pencil, and collage on canvas, 140 × 200 cm. British Council Collection. © Rita Donagh. 116 6.2 Rita Donagh, Reflection on Three Weeks in May 1970, 1971. Oil and graphite on canvas, 152.4 × 152.4 cm. © Rita Donagh. Photo © Tate, London, 2016. 118
6.3 Rita Donagh, “taking the trouble to sound it,” 1970. Oil, pencil, and colored pencil on hardboard, 91 × 122 cm. Arts Council Collection, Southbank Centre, London. © Rita Donagh. 121
8.4 Project sigma—Public Relations—List of People Interested, sigma portfolio 17 (London: project sigma, December 1964). Photo: Andrew Wilson. Reproduced courtesy of the Estate of Alexander Trocchi. 159
6.4 Rita Donagh, Bloodstains, 1971. Pencil, gouache, and collage on paper, 51 × 76.5 cm. Private collection. 123
8.5 Jeff Nuttall, ed., My Own Mag 15 (April 1966), showing list of addresses. Photo: Andrew Wilson. Reproduced courtesy of Jill Richards. 160
7.1 Cinema Rising, “Directory of U.K. Independent Film-makers,” 1972. Courtesy of British Artists Film & Video Study Collection at Central Saint Martins. 135 7.2 Sally Potter, The Building, New Arts Lab, 1969. Photo: Sally Potter © Adventure Pictures Ltd. 138 7.3 Sally Potter, Annabel Nicolson, and Barbara Schwartz (now Ess) at the London Filmmakers’ Co-operative ca. 1970. Photo courtesy of LUX, London. 141 7.4 Reel Time film performance by Annabel Nicolson, North East London Polytechnic, 1973. Photo courtesy of Annabel Nicolson and LUX, London. 143 8.1 “Hands Off Alexander Trocchi,” declaration signed by Guy Debord, Jacqueline de Jong, and Asger Jorn, October 7, 1960. Photo: Andrew Wilson. Reproduced courtesy of the Debord Estate / Alice Becker-Ho. Rights reserved. 154 8.2 “Resolution Concerning the Imprisonment of Alexander Trocchi,” published in Internationale situationniste 5 (December 1960). Photo: Andrew Wilson. Reproduced courtesy of the Debord Estate / Alice Becker-Ho. Rights reserved. 154 8.3 Project sigma—Public Relations—List of People Interested, sigma portfolio 17 (London: project sigma, December 1964). Photo: Andrew Wilson. Reproduced courtesy of the Estate of Alexander Trocchi. 158
ix Illustrations
8.6 Jeff Nuttall, ed., My Own Mag 15 (April 1966), showing list of addresses. Photo: Andrew Wilson. Reproduced courtesy of Jill Richards. 160 10.1 COUM Transmissions, Omissions (Kleiinie Spielinie), Kiel, West Germany, June 1975. © BREYER P-ORRIDGE. Courtesy the artist and Invisible Exports, New York. 186 10.2 Genesis P-Orridge, untitled postcard (front), 1975. Mimeograph of collage on postcard as reproduced in the publication G.P.O. v. G.P-O.: A Chronicle of Mail Art on Trial. © BREYER P-ORRIDGE. Courtesy the artist and Invisible Exports, New York. 189 10.3 Genesis P-Orridge, untitled postcard (back), 1975. Mimeograph of collage on postcard as reproduced in the publication G.P.O. v. G.P-O.: A Chronicle of Mail Art on Trial. © BREYER P-ORRIDGE. Courtesy the artist and Invisible Exports, New York. 189 10.4 Photo taken in foyer of the Highbury Corner Magistrates’ Court, London, April 5, 1976. Left to right: Richard Cork, Colin Naylor, Genesis P-Orridge, David Offenbach, Pauline Smith, Peter (Sleazy) Christopherson. Mimeograph of photograph as reproduced in the publication G.P.O. v. G.P-O.: A Chronicle of Mail Art on Trial. © BREYER P-ORRIDGE. Courtesy the artist and Invisible Exports, New York. Photo: Barbara Reise. 193
Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments Acknowledgments
This book would not have been possible without the
go as well to our wonderful editors Ellie Goodman and
kind generosity of many individuals and organizations,
Jonathan P. Eburne for their support and wise coun-
for which we are very grateful indeed. The genesis of
sel. Many thanks also to Hannah Hebert for expertly
London Art Worlds: Mobile, Contingent, and Ephemeral
shepherding the book into production. Siona Wilson and
Networks, 1960–1980 was a conference at the University
another anonymous reader provided invaluable feedback
of York in 2013 funded by the Paul Mellon Centre for
and advice for which we remain very grateful.
Studies in British Art, together with support from the
British Art Research School and the Centre for Modern
chapters, both London in particular and the United
Studies at the University of York.
Kingdom in general were considered places of refuge
and tolerance that could hold space for and give space
In particular we thank James Boaden, Guy Brett,
For many of the artists discussed in the following
Genesis BREYER P-ORRIDGE, Sally Child, Andree Cooke
to a diverse international group of political and cre-
and the Estate of Rose Finn-Kelcey, Rita Donagh, John
ative voices. That very diversity is now being placed
Dugger, Felipe Ehrenberg, Jane England, Barbara Ess, Hilary
under increasing threat, as a politics of retrenchment
Floe, the International Times Archive, the Leverhulme Trust,
continues to dominate the political landscape and
Roelof Louw, LUX, Nigel Mckernaghan, Mike Manzi at
the movement of people around the world. With its
Adventure Pictures, Sally Potter, Annabel Nicolson, George
emphasis on the contingent and precarious, on the
Snow, Lisa Tickner, Sarah Victoria Turner, and the UCL
international networks of solidarity and relation that
Slade School of Fine Art.
the sixties and seventies produced, and on the critiques
of imperialism, patriarchy, racism, and neocolonialism
We thank our contributors for their scholarship,
intellectual rigor, and continuing enthusiasm for this proj-
mounted by many of the artists who appear in its pages,
ect. Without their hard work and good cheer our editorial
London Art Worlds feels especially prescient and politi-
task would have been far less pleasurable. Thanks must
cally pertinent.
Introduction Jo Applin, Catherine Spencer, and Amy Tobin
In a 1970 article entitled “Artists in Revolt,” published in
of counterculture, communication, irreverence, and
the Times, the writer and curator Guy Brett summed up
internationalism that began to emerge in this era.2 Its
the negative response among artists and critics to the
pages featured original and often provocative artwork,
controversially conservative exhibition British Sculpture
including cartoons and photo collages, combined with
out of the Sixties at the Institute of Contemporary Arts
commentary on contemporary political events. One cover
(ICA) in London: “It seems to me that if there is any
from 1973, for example, designed by the photographer
justification at all for a backward look at British art of the
George Snow, features a pixelated version of the iconic
sixties, it should at least be to explode the official line, not
International Times logo, depicting the silent-film actress
repeat it.” Taking up Brett’s challenge nearly fifty years
Theda Bara, above a photograph of the Bogside area in
on, one place we might look to see this “official line”
Derry (Londonderry), a flash point for the violence that
being “exploded”—and to get a sense of the compet-
erupted in Northern Ireland in the late 1960s (fig. I.1).
ing social and political countercultural assays made by
The walls of one house are daubed with the words “You
artists, writers, activists, and commentators outside the
are now entering Free Derry,” demarcating a nationalist
officially and institutionally recognized art scene during
republican zone that for several years existed outside
the 1960s and into the 1970s—is the London-based
official state and police control, forming a vivid rejec-
International Times newspaper, launched in 1966. Initially
tion of a coherent “British” identity. The headline above,
known by the zeitgeisty sobriquet “The Longhair Times,”
“Bloody Sunday: Ireland Twelve Months On,” registers the
the International Times encapsulates the intersection
continued reverberations of a particularly violent incident
1
Fig. I.1 Front cover of the International Times, February 9–23, 1973. Cover design and photograph by George Snow.
activities of the Independent Group, which ran between 1952 and 1955 at the ICA, together with artists including Eduardo Paolozzi and Richard Hamilton. The activities of group members continued during the 1960s, becoming part of the burgeoning Pop movement and its contribution to, and absorption of, mass-mediatized culture. As Lisa Tickner has argued, Pop artists did not just use the images and icons of vernacular forms of entertainment in their works but were themselves submerged in a new and dynamic field of value that was economic, cultural, and symbolic: “artists steeped in consumer culture in turn inspired it. . . . Signs and motifs are contagious, spreading from hand to hand, sloughing or absorbing earlier referents, sliding into irony and fashion.”5 An example of this is seen in the collision of Brutalist ruin and candy color in Eduardo Paolozzi’s series As Is When (1964–65), which merges high and low culture together with imagined future technologies and obsolete kitsch, on the single plane of a screen-printed surface. Pauline Boty’s semiabstract canvases, meanwhile, pair painterly shape and color with images of celebrity culture, fusing together one and the other without hierarchy or value judgment. during the so-called troubles, when the British army shot
Seen from this perspective, works by artists like Paolozzi
dead thirteen civilians. As a forum for both the collec-
and Boty are less about taking from the world outside
tion and dissemination of information about festivals,
than entering into a new, vital cultural stream of dialogue
performances, artworks, commentary, community action,
between art and its surrounding environment.
and politics, the International Times was part of a dynamic
visual and conceptual field, from which many artists drew
very different from the more familiar Pop works associ-
inspiration and in which they actively participated.3
ated with the early 1960s. Indeed, the London art world
of the 1960s has typically been considered either in terms
The fluidity of references caught in the pages of
The practices uncovered by this book, however, are
the International Times expanded on the “long front of
of a hermetic history with its own internal currents and
culture,” influentially identified by the critic Lawrence
lineages or, conversely, as an art scene indebted to its
Alloway in 1959. Alloway had been a participant in the
international, and specifically American, peers, against
4
2 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
whom the work of London-based artists and practices
the establishment of alternative publications, to public
has often been pitched as somewhat provincial. While
protests and new pedagogical models in London’s art
this book does not intend to ignore the very real differ-
schools. Often these activities occurred outside of, or
ences and particularities of the London art world that
in tension with, established institutions and venues for
were frequently, and significantly, tied to the specificities
art and its display. The London art world was no longer
of place, time, and circumstance, it does seek to loosen
contained within the familiar galleries of London’s
that world’s boundaries in important ways. Even in the
West End and major national institutions, nor was it
case of Pop art produced in Britain, for example, many
tied to a specific medium or “movement.” Rather, new
works figured their own complex economic, social,
and constantly shifting networks and transient sites of
and political relationship with the fantasy of postwar
collaboration, exhibition, and action emerged. Groups
consumerism and popular culture in ways that were
of international artists, many from Latin America and
wholly distinct from American Pop, while simultaneously
recently decolonized countries, mobilized politically in
engaging with an increasingly globalized mass media and
the capital around issues relating to gender, sexuality,
a wider Cold War imaginary. Proceeding from this per-
feminism, and democracy. London Art Worlds traces
spective, London Art Worlds examines the extraordinarily
the many informal, impromptu, and experimental
rich and underexplored networks of international artists
relationships that exist alongside and fragment more
and art practices that emerged in and around Britain’s
established institutional histories of British art in this
capital during the 1960s and 1970s, although these dates
period. The chapters address the diversity of practices,
7
are necessarily porous by several years at either end.
movements, and spaces across the sixties and sev-
In particular, this volume seeks to link the activities of
enties, from painting, sculpture, and film through to
artists across these two decades, in contrast with much
performance and conceptual works. Feminism, activ-
of the literature on art in Britain during this period, which
ism, and the rising internationalism and politicization
treats the 1960s and 1970s as separate moments with
of the art scene are also foregrounded for their radical
very different casts of characters and almost opposing
challenge and reformulation of the “art world” as it had
socioeconomic contexts. By bringing together the two
previously been understood. Under these pressures,
decades, we want to make new connections across a
and as a result of a new emphasis on process, collabo-
broader field of cultural production—to invoke the work
ration, and exchange, the “art world” was transformed
of the sociologist Pierre Bourdieu—and to suture some
into “art worlds.” This shift in terminology encompasses
of the divisions fissuring the way in which this field has
the interactions and participation of myriad artists,
been mapped to date.
and the contingent artworks that circulated as a result,
on national and international scales. We envisage this
6
8
9
The 1960s and 1970s witnessed an explosion of
new media, attitudes, and approaches to making and
period as one of multiple and overlapping spheres,
thinking about art, from the rise of cybernetics, through
rather than a coherent system.
3 Introduction
Activity in London needs to be approached as
London during this period, but also because it undeniably
part of a wider range of burgeoning endeavors in sites
and inevitably formed an important site for many artists,
and venues throughout Britain during the 1960s and
whether the city was a permanent residence or a staging
1970s. Ikon in Birmingham (founded in 1964), the
post.12 Even when they were reacting against it—such as
Museum of Modern Art, Oxford (1966, now Modern
when the Mexican artist Felipe Ehrenberg moved from
Art Oxford), the Fruitmarket in Edinburgh (1974), Side
London to Devon to establish the Beau Geste Press, as
in Newcastle (1977), and Site Gallery in Sheffield (1978),
Carmen Juliá shows in her contribution to this book—
among many others, formed points of activity across
London remained a significant psychical and conceptual
the United Kingdom. To take one example, the Richard
site to be navigated and negotiated, rejected as well as
Demarco Gallery in Edinburgh acted as a point of
embraced.13 When the Brazilian artist Hélio Oiticica trav-
contact between artists working in the United Kingdom
eled to London for his exhibition at the Whitechapel Art
and those in Soviet Bloc countries. Through a series
Gallery in 1969, he also visited the University of Sussex
of physical exchanges, artists could visit partners in
in the south of England, where he worked collaboratively
different countries and political systems, until inter-
with students to create a series of “Nest-Cells,” provi-
ventions by Soviet states excluded Western visitors,
sional spaces that individuals could inhabit with found
while the Edinburgh Festival provided a platform for
materials.14 The impact of this work in Sussex can be dis-
artists like Allan Kaprow, Joseph Beuys, Tadeusz Kantor,
cerned in his later constructions in New York, underlining
Marina Abramović, and Carolee Schneemann. Adrian
that London was not the only environment that proved
Henri, a painter and member of the “Liverpool poets”
important for Oiticica during his time in England. The
during the 1960s, notes in 1974 that while the London
essays collected here offer fresh understandings of work
art world “has tended to promote safe, easily saleable
produced by a range of practitioners passing through the
commodities,” outside of the city, “for financial and
capital, allowing us to complicate rather than confirm the
social reasons, it has been more possible for small,
binaries of center and periphery.
self-sustaining groups of artists to create multi-media
works in a localized context. There is a strong provincial
Oiticica emerged from the experience of geographic
tradition of contact with avant-garde groups in other
movement and interchange, while emphasis on that
countries: in Edinburgh, Cardiff and Newcastle it is pos-
mobility was often conditioned by the processes of
sible, via letters, little magazines and exchange visits,
emigration and forced relocation. Such displacements
to relate to an international movement and be free from
encompass the experience of political exile, together
fashionable London attitudes.”
with more local evictions and the growing squatters’
movement.15 The “internationalism” of the 1960s and
10
11
This book, however, remains focused on the capital,
The activities of artists such as Ehrenberg and
not only because extensive work remains to be done on
1970s, forged as it was during decades of decolonization
recuperating the alternative practices that effloresced in
and the arrival in Britain of diaspora artists from newly
4 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
independent countries, and exemplified by initiatives
central, and northern England, as well as Scotland,
such as the Caribbean Artists Movement (1966–72),
Wales, and Ulster (Northern Ireland)—divisions that
differs significantly from the current globalization in
reflected the nationalist and colonial geographies that
the art world. Such difference resulted in works and
underlay and punctuated this period of British history.
practices reflecting unique understandings of mobility
Art Spectrum London was the largest exhibition, filling
that anticipated, but were distinct from, contemporary
the Great Hall of Alexandra Palace with 115 contrib-
concerns. This is by no means to suggest that the pres-
utors. Many works included in the show manifested
ent volume aligns “internationalism” with an automatic
the dynamics of mobility, contingency, and ephemer-
assumption of fluid and easy exchange. As writers and
ality invoked by our subtitle. From Rose Finn-Kelcey’s
artists such as Rasheed Araeen have pointed out, the
flag, flying above the palace and emblazoned with the
discourse of internationalism has often been infused
words “here is a gale warning” (fig. I.2), to Gustav
16
17
with imperialist dynamics. Many of the contributors
Metzger’s environment of newsprint, radio, and televi-
to this volume approach art in Britain from a distinctly
sion Mass-Media-Today, the exhibition showcased the
transnational perspective, building on postcolonialism’s
experimental and political outlook of a diverse group
embrace of hybridity, investment in cosmopolitanism,
of artists working in relatively close quarters.19 Yet it
and movement beyond the model of the nation-state as
was not just the works on display that were significant:
a demarcation of identity. This position offers a valuable
the London show also came to act as a vibrant meeting
alternative to the imperialist inflections of “internation-
place. Despite receiving sponsorship from the then Arts
alism.” Yet we preserve the latter term here, precisely in
Council of Great Britain, the exhibition at Alexandra
order to retain a sense of the problematic unevenness
Palace was not affiliated with any one institution. This
with which it was imbued during the 1960s and 1970s
site, popularly known as the “people’s palace,” allowed
and because an acutely critical awareness of such
artists to express their discontent with the current art
imbalances directly informed many of the practices
world and its systems, which would have been harder
considered in the following essays.
to do in the context of an institutional exhibition or
18
at an official meeting of the Arts Council.20 Margaret Harrison, whose work was not included in the show, Alternative Sites and New Alignments
nonetheless cited Art Spectrum London as a key factor in the formation of the Artists’ Union during 1972: “this
The kinds of changes and disruptions encompassed
was the first time for many years that artists in London
by the chapters in this book are exemplified by the Art
had been brought together in a large exhibition. It led to
Spectrum exhibitions of 1971. Art Spectrum was a large
the discovery of shared problems concerning minimal
and sprawling initiative consisting of seven exhibi-
survival and the inevitably divisive effect of competition
tions surveying contemporary art in London, southern,
for limited funds, with women artists in a particularly
5 Introduction
Fig. I.2 Rose Finn-Kelcey, Here Is a Gale Warning, 1971. Black bunting and silver tissue, 670 × 900 cm. Originally shown as part of Art Spectrum, survey exhibition of London Artists, Alexandra Palace, London.
forced numerous London galleries to close. This loss of potential commercial support was matched by the emergence of new art practices—such as performance—which both national and private funding bodies struggled to keep abreast of.23
Art Spectrum London was, then, an important cata-
lyst for the formation of alternative networks that built upon and reacted to the events of the 1960s, complicating established institutional histories of this period. As the opening passage from its catalogue states: “The London art community is more fragmented than is generally thought. . . . London does not have an artistic quarter, nor even generally recognised meeting places for artists. . . . The ‘art world,’ has no real existence. vulnerable position . . . culminating in an open meeting
There is a real dissatisfaction now with the notion of
at the Camden Studios at which working parties were
the art ‘scene’—a word much used in the days of Pop.
formed.” Unlike the unruly group meetings and dispa-
. . . The present art situation . . . is that a large number
rate political aims of its New York–based counterpart,
of people are making art with only a limited outlet for it,
the Art Workers’ Coalition, the Artists’ Union sought
with a meagre chance of making a living out of it, and
Trade Union Congress ratification. The artists of the
with no common centre.”24 Here we find articulated with
union did not merely associate with the figure of the
particular force the emergence of the “art worlds” con-
industrial worker as members of the coalition did; they
sidered by this book, as well as their often-precarious
acknowledged the differences between their working
nature. During the 1970s in particular, the art-world
conditions and those of waged labor, particularly the
system that had propelled many young artists to
precariousness of working without a fixed or perma-
celebrity in the 1960s faltered, and newly politicized
nent contract. As such they sought to align work in the
and diverse groups set about testing and protesting its
visual arts with that of musicians, actors, and designers.
limits. Spaces such as John Kasmin’s Mayfair gallery
Issues covered by the Artists’ Union included the fair
had cultivated transatlantic contact between artists
remuneration of artists, the resale right, and changes in
often working in large-scale abstraction such as David
art-school education, which had resulted in the loss of
Hockney, Morris Louis, and Kenneth Noland. As Tickner
part-time jobs providing artists with an income as well
has argued, the Kasmin Gallery became an important
as time to make their work. Union policy also responded
site for artistic interaction in the late 1960s, before it
to the economic downturn of the late 1960s that had
was forced to close in 1972 due to the financial strain of
21
22
6 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
keeping a Mayfair gallery space.25 As well as suffering
gave artists access to international publications and
from the economic downturn of the 1970s, these kinds
magazines but also acted on many occasions as an
of gallery spaces became increasingly problematic for
alternative arts venue in its own right, including during
artists who sought to challenge what they saw as the
the 1966 Destruction in Art Symposium.28 Artist-run
market-driven power structures dominating artistic
organizations like Acme, which opened in 1971, and
production and reception.
Space, founded in 1968—along with entities like Arts
Instead, a variety of alternative spaces started to
Lab (which ran between 1967 and 1969) and 2B Butler’s
facilitate, both consciously and inadvertently, collab-
Wharf, which began in 1975—incorporated studios and
oration between artists living in and traveling through
exhibition areas that fostered interaction, exchange, and
the capital. These incorporated existing institutions,
multimedia experimentation, in addition to supporting
including art schools and universities, as well as newly
artists practically.29 A number of collaborative projects
established sites born out of collaboration.26 Galleries
also emerged around shared investments, including the
like Signals, founded in 1964 by Paul Keeler and the
pedagogical experiments by students at the Hornsey
artist David Medalla, exemplified this approach. Signals,
College of Art, the London Filmmakers’ Co-operative—
discussed in this volume by Isobel Whitelegg, was
the focus of Lucy Reynolds’s chapter—the women’s
instrumental in giving many Latin American artists,
postal-art event Feministo, and the Hackney Flashers
including Mira Schendel and Sergio de Camargo, solo
photography collective.30 Initiatives like the Exploding
shows in the United Kingdom. As Whitelegg has written
Galaxy and Alexander Trocchi’s project sigma, dis-
elsewhere, Signals fostered “an openness; an interest
cussed by here Andrew Wilson, meanwhile, functioned
in artistic praxis as a collaborative phenomenon not
to connect disparate individuals and groups in loose
bounded by ideological, formal or geographical lines.”27
national and international alignments.31 At the same
Although Signals only lasted two years, until 1966,
time, alternative spaces including clubs, cabarets, and
the receptivity and collaboration it encouraged fueled
squats fostered the exploration of identity and the cre-
other initiatives. These included the Indica gallery and
ation of new interdisciplinary art forms as well as activist
bookstore and Gallery House. The latter, opened in 1970
organizing; in 1974, for example, the South London Gay
by the German émigré Sigi Krauss, provided a venue for
Community Centre began as a squat in the Brixton area
the highly experimental work of artists including Stuart
of South London, becoming a focal point for political and
Brisley, Marc Camille Chaimowicz, and Gustav Metzger.
cultural activities.32
That Gallery House features in several of the chapters in
London Art Worlds attests to its importance in this period.
nated with the spirit manifested in Harald Szeemann’s
Other significant points of contact included Gallery One,
1969 exhibition Live in your Head: When Attitudes
Art Meeting Place, and Bob Cobbing’s Better Books
Become Form: Works—Concepts—Processes—Situations—
bookstore on the Charing Cross Road, which not only
Information, which transferred from the Kunsthalle
7 Introduction
The works produced at these sites and spaces reso-
Bern to the ICA not long before British Sculpture out of
large institutions, many of the artists discussed in this
the Sixties but offered a dramatically different take on
book were peripatetic, and the work they created was
sculptural production. In the catalogue essay he wrote
correspondingly impermanent and transient. In lieu of
for the London iteration, Charles Harrison observed
fixed spaces that dictated stylistic affiliations, artists
that “virtually all the artists represented would appear
began to form, beyond the established coordinates of
to share a dissatisfaction with the status of artwork
the institutional art world, peer-group collaborations
as a particular object in a finite state, and a rejection
that emphasized the process as much as the product
of the notion of form as a specific and other identity
of making. We invoke the term “network” to respond
to be imposed upon material.” It was precisely the
to this diffusion of practices, which is illuminated by
existence of these new “attitudes” that would in part
the work of sociologist Manuel Castells, whose early
incite Brett’s critique of British Sculpture out of the Sixties
theorization of social movements argued for the impor-
in his “Artists in Revolt” article. The earlier generation
tance of the network for collective mobilization against
of sculptors in Britain had worked in a predominantly
corporate ownership of the sites of power. In The City
modernist language of abstraction and form that, by
and the Grassroots, of 1983, he suggests that mobilization
1970, was considered to stand for an institutionalized
must occur locally before building up increasingly larger
establishment and private discourse shared by only a
networks of resistance.35 Castells’s work points to the
few artists and that was ripe for challenge. For figures
political nature of many of the practices considered
like Bruce McLean, this involved a shift toward photo-
in this book. By circumventing and cutting across the
graphing provisional outdoor “sculptural” interventions,
spaces and rhythms of the commercial and institutional
and performance pieces lampooning the work of Henry
art worlds, artworks that foregrounded political issues
Moore and other establishment figures.34 Mapping the
connected to constructions of gender, sexuality, race,
marginal and liminal sites of the London art worlds in
and nationality became increasingly visible. Many
the 1960s and 1970s thus enables us to “explode” the
artists renegotiated their local environments and forged
received line of exhibition histories, the production of
new channels of connection, nationally and internation-
works, and conceptualizations of artistic practice.
ally, to form alternative networks of artistic production
33
and display. Networked Artists and Politicized Practices
Castells has since readdressed the revolution-
ary potential of the network to analyze the changing relationship of the subject to technology. As technology
Art Spectrum London’s effect of gathering artists
becomes more personalized and mobile, communi-
together exemplifies another key term in our title:
cation via the network is unfixed from local sites and
“network.” In contrast to an art scene articulated by
bound up in a system of flows. He argues that in the
clear spatial markers, like commercial galleries and
information age modern life is better described by the
8 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
metaphor of the network than that of the machine.36
child, a refugee on the Kindertransport. He became rad-
Although the period under discussion here precedes
icalized through time spent with an anarchist commune
public use of the Internet, Castells’s metaphor has
in Bristol and his association with the British Campaign
important ramifications for artists who were using
for Nuclear Disarmament after the first march on the
newly available and affordable technologies in their
Automatic Weapons Establishment at Aldermaston in
work and for the flux in artistic exchange occurring
1958.40 Rejecting the formalist training he had received
across the ostensibly firm but in reality often perme-
under David Bomberg at Borough Polytechnic (now
able Iron Curtain of Cold War discontent, notably with
London South Bank University), Metzger actively
artists in Poland and the former Yugoslavia. It also
launched himself into the orbit of international artists
allows us to complicate the “network” and “system”
in London while intervening in the social structures
analogies so influentially used by critics such as
that conditioned its culture. Metzger’s distribution of
Lawrence Alloway and Jack Burnham during the 1960s
his Auto-Destructive Art manifestos in the late 1950s
and 1970s.37 Building on the idea of the network as vital
and early 1960s, together with actions such as his 1961
for the communal challenge to corporate incursions
South Bank Demonstration, merged performance with an
into the shared public space of the city fabric, we might
activist mentality that treated the established art world,
conceive of the artistic networks that spanned London
and in particular the art market, as complicit in wider
and beyond during the 1960s and 1970s as a series of
geopolitical and environmental failures. This would
“contact zones,” which the linguist and literary scholar
culminate in the three-year Art Strike that Metzger
Mary Louise Pratt has defined as “social spaces where
undertook between 1977 and 1980. Such actions,
cultures meet, clash, and grapple with each other, often
though, were not restricted to the art world. Throughout
in contexts of highly asymmetrical relations of power,
the 1970s numerous searing attacks, protests, and
such as colonialism, slavery, or their aftermaths as they
general strikes across the public sector took place in
are lived out in many parts of the world today.”
response to the failing economy under Harold Wilson’s
In October 1970, for instance, Gustav Metzger,
and James Callaghan’s Labour governments between
Stuart Brisley, Felipe Ehrenberg, Sigi Krauss, and others
1974 and 1979, plunging Britain into a state of political
staged a demonstration at the Tate Gallery in London
and social turmoil. The infamous “Winter of Discontent”
under the auspices of the newly founded International
in 1978–79 saw a major strike by dustmen that resulted
Coalition for the Liquidation of Art, an event explored
in high piles of rotting refuse in the nation’s streets and
by Carmen Juliá in her chapter.39 The message was
public spaces, fostering a resurgence of support for
clear: the London art scene was polluted and in need
the Conservative Party and eventually the election of
of cleansing. This protest aesthetic had been central to
Margaret Thatcher as prime minister in 1979.41 During
Metzger’s anti-artworks since the early 1960s. German
the late 1960s tensions in Northern Ireland had also
by birth, Metzger had arrived in London in 1939 as a
reached a crisis point; in 1969 Wilson sent British troops
38
9 Introduction
into Belfast and Derry, and throughout the 1970s and
of Polaroid film stock, its directional arrows intended to
1980s Britain was marked by clashes within its own
help the photographer load the camera (fig. I.3). This
geographic boundaries. These conflicts were both
collection of materials, salvaged from discarded and
destabilizing and productive: the U.S. artist Carolee
overlooked detritus, expresses the difficulty of seeing
Schneemann has recalled that her “years in the 1960s
clearly in a foreign city, at a distance from political and
and 1970s in London were a time in which the city’s
emotional investments abroad. The ephemeral items
traditional social and class structures were in a state of
become markers of Vicuña’s enforced presence during
dissolution. Resistance to the Vietnam War activated
a time of political upheaval; her work remains atten-
many radical, creative Americans to come to the UK
tive to the mechanisms of oppression, both racial and
and participate in the vitality of the music, drugs, and
gendered, that structure networks and systems. The
rock and roll. . . . The shifts in social structures were
latter is signaled in Libro Tul Rojo through the combina-
unique and volatile.” These “unique and volatile”
tion of tulle, a material often used for bridal veils, with
shifts—social, political, and physical—prompted a vast
the romanticized nineteenth-century-style image of
range of experimental and activist work.
the woman in the garden. Libro Tul Rojo registers the
vulnerability of the exiled and misplaced subject while
42
The practice of the Chilean artist Cecilia Vicuña is
a case in point. Vicuña traveled to London to study at
using ephemerality and fragility to comment on both the
the Slade School of Fine Art between 1972 and 1975; in
difficulty of making works in adverse conditions and the
1973 a military coup d’état by General Augusto Pinochet
political potential of ephemerality as a formal strategy,
toppled the democratically elected Chilean government
resulting in easily movable artworks that simultaneously
of Salvador Allende and ushered in decades of brutal
act like anchors or totems for the artist.
dictatorship, preventing her return. During her years
of exile in London, Vicuña created A Journal of Objects
as books, coupled with her overarching identification of
for the Chilean Resistance 1973–4 (1973–74), comprising
this project as a “journal of objects,” indicates that these
twenty-six items that fall into two distinct bodies of
items are intended to pass from hand to hand, transmit-
works: Precarious Objects (or Precarios) and 12 Books for
ting ideas and information as they go. Even if physically
the Chilean Resistance. The Precarios and the 12 Books for
untenable in any given specific instance, collaborative
the Chilean Resistance consist of small collaged scraps
and activist links could still be explored in the exchange
of found materials configured to narrate personal and
of similarly ephemeral material—both image and
political events. In one of the component works of the
text—through mail and publication systems, paralleling
12 Books for the Chilean Resistance entitled Libro Tul Rojo
and sometimes intersecting with similar interactions
(Red tulle book), Vicuña layered a sheer snippet of
between artists in Europe and the United States that
red mesh tulle fabric over an illustrated fragment of a
extended back to the 1960s. Indeed, infrastructures
woman in a garden, which is stitched to an end section
such as the mail service, together with personal and
10 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
Vicuña’s presentation of her small collaged items
Fig. I.3 Cecilia Vicuña, Libro Tul Rojo, from 12 Books for the Chilean Resistance, 1973–74. Purchased in 2014 by the Tate Americas Foundation courtesy of the Latin American Acquisition Committee. © Cecilia Vicuña.
more ad hoc circulation lists built up by artists, cura-
and Latin American art of the 1960s. Whitelegg seeks to
tors, and critics, often converged, as in ventures like
nuance the historical reception of this enterprise, regis-
Ehrenberg’s Beau Geste Press or Genesis P‑Orridge’s
tering the “tensions, divergences, and disconnections”
infiltration of the postal system, which Dominic
that inflected its interlinked understandings of kineticism
Johnson discusses in his chapter. The Beau Geste Press
and internationalism. Rather than view Signals as a pro-
published artists’ books by practitioners including
genitor in the history of global art, Whitelegg points to
Schneemann and Vicuña, forming a correlative to the
the temporal and geographic specificity of its position in
traveling Fluxshoe exhibition, which Ehrenberg was also
1960s London, recuperating the more local connections
involved in, together with David Mayor. As Whitelegg
that existed alongside its links with Latin America.
discusses in her chapter, Signals, while serving as a gal-
lery, also produced a periodical, its Newsbulletin, which
founded by the artist Stephen Willats, explored by
collated information from an interdisciplinary range of
Antony Hudek in chapter 2, functioned as an exhibition
writers and artists. Although inevitably specialist to a
space but also, and perhaps more importantly, as a
certain extent, the printing-press venture is indicative
meeting point for scientists and artists interested in
of widespread artistic interest in the relative geographic
how cybernetics, sociology, engineering, philosophy,
freedom enabled by communications media, and in
and pedagogy could be used to rethink the social
creating more accessible, reproducible works that could
fabric of everyday life. The uniqueness of this interdis-
be purchased cheaply.
ciplinary venture, Hudek proposes, precludes any easy
43
Like Signals, the Centre for Behavioural Art (CBA),
fit with more established narratives of North American conceptual art. Indeed, Hudek describes how Willats London Art Worlds
was concerned with “transforming the means of artistic and discursive production from object focused and
While our aim is not simply to put forward a series of
author driven to socially engaged and networked”—an
“alternatives” to the mainstream under the assumption
aim that speaks to the interests of many practitioners
they were de facto “better,” the kinds of networks, new
in this volume. Through recent reassessments of
relationships, and alliances that began to appear in 1960s
collaboration and collectivity, the importance of
and 1970s London have to date been somewhat margin-
group work for artists in London can be reconsidered
alized, to the benefit of their better-known counterparts.
afresh.44
By tracing a broader and more flexible network of
affiliations and collaborations, it is possible to establish
ceptual works that Felipe Ehrenberg developed as
a wider and less familiar set of coordinates. In chapter
he moved between London and Devon, after he left
1 Isobel Whitelegg reflects on the way Signals and its
Mexico in 1968 due to the violent political oppression
Newsbulletin have been written into accounts of British
in the country. Juliá shows how Ehrenberg’s works
12 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
In chapter 3 Carmen Juliá investigates the con-
actively reflect on the artist’s experience of mobil-
beyond the immediate terrain of London in order to
ity, together with the exclusions that prevented his
study John Dugger’s People’s Participation Pavilion at
entrance into official institutions of British art, exem-
Harald Szeemann’s documenta 5 in Kassel during 1972,
plified by his protest on the threshold of Tate in 1970 as
linking Dugger’s aims for his Pavilion with both his
part of the “International Coalition for the Liquidation
exhibitions in England and the work of contemporar-
of Art” event. Ehrenberg’s opposition to the establish-
ies, including David Medalla, Lygia Clark, and Cecilia
ment and the mainstream, which led to his embrace
Vicuña. Martin traces how, with Medalla and Vicuña,
of the street as a site for artistic activity, vividly
Dugger went on to form Artists for Democracy in
demonstrates how artists during the 1960s and 1970s
1974: Brett, who was also a member, described this as
challenged and protested the structures of London’s
“a London-based group committed to giving cultural
art worlds, while also engaging with them. Ehrenberg’s
and material support to liberation movements world-
Beau Geste Press and Signals’ links with kineticism, not
wide” demonstrating the need to consider the role that
to mention Keeler and Medalla’s use of the Newsbulletin
anti-imperialism has played in formations of mobility
to communicate their gallery’s activities, find a parallel
and exchange.45 Martin’s use of the term “festival
in the distribution systems that Willats carefully
culture” to conceptualize the production of Dugger and
nurtured for the dissemination of his magazine Control,
his associates powerfully conveys the combination of
elaborating a shared vision of the artist as a networked
ephemerality and provocation that characterized much
and socially engaged figure.
collaborative artistic production in this period.
International exchange between artists, as well as
The legacies of empire and imperialism were
the resulting movement of artworks through maga-
directly addressed by artists including Araeen, Dugger,
zines, news bulletins, films, and exhibitions, similarly
Ehrenberg, and Medalla and are inextricable from many
informs the essays by Joy Sleeman, Courtney J. Martin,
of the structures, circulations, and networks discussed
and Lucy Reynolds. In chapter 4 Sleeman argues
throughout this book. In chapter 6 Catherine Spencer
that the South African artist Roelof Louw’s sculptural
considers how the abstract paintings produced by the
practice offers new ways to think about the kinds of
artist Rita Donagh during the 1970s constitute a highly
artistic and cultural flows “in to” but also “out of”
charged locus for considering the long-term resonances
London. Sleeman intricately maps the physical sites
of British imperialism. Donagh’s work registers the con-
of Louw’s ephemeral sculptural production across
flict in Northern Ireland after its resurgence in the late
the capital and through contemporary publications,
1960s, but in a way that acknowledges the distances
notably the art press, such as Studio International, but
and elisions that on the British mainland fractured the
also considers the different temporal sites that his work
understanding of the multifaceted political situation.
Pyramid of Oranges (1967) has come to occupy through
Like many other artists considered in this book, Donagh
re-creation. In chapter 5 Martin shifts the book’s focus
responded to the increasing connectivity provided by
13 Introduction
mass-media technologies, but also questioned the
mechanisms embedded within it. This can be con-
effects of mediatization on the viewing subject.
nected back to the emergence of the Artists’ Union and
the need to guard against the potentially exploitative
Spencer also touches on Donagh’s complex rela-
tionship with the women’s liberation movement during
aspects of artistic mobility.
the 1970s, which, together with Reynolds’s discussion
in chapter 7, signals the many different positions carved
Andrew Wilson, Elena Crippa, and Dominic Johnson,
out by women artists during the 1970s. Reynolds shows
explore how artists operated both with and against
how distribution networks were particularly important
established social and political structures, rang-
for many feminist-influenced artists, who sought to
ing from university pedagogy to the Royal Mail. In
bypass and expose the hidden oppressions of the art
chapter 8 Wilson looks to an alternative example of
world and forge new sites for creation, display, and
countercultural identity construction, dependent on
exchange. Reynolds considers how women filmmakers
relationships both geographically and disciplinarily
such as Sally Potter, Barbara Schwartz (also known as
disparate. This essay focuses on the milieu Alexander
Barbara Ess), and Annabel Nicolson engaged in nascent
Trocchi negotiated across Europe and America
feminist activity as they concomitantly contributed to
through project sigma, an organization structured
the London Filmmakers’ Co-operative, investigating
as a crisscrossing network—or, as Trocchi described
how—and even whether—they were able to recon-
it, a “spontaneous university”—in the early 1960s. In
cile these two increasingly divergent affiliations. By
chapter 9 Crippa comparably examines the relation-
looking at their early performances and film screen-
ship between art and pedagogy in her account of the
ings and considering the impact of visiting American
artist as “speaker-performer” in the 1960s and 1970s,
artists to the co-op during the 1960s, such as Carolee
although from perspectives that were much more
Schneemann and Carla Liss, Reynolds intimates how
closely aligned with traditional institutions. Crippa
these changing organizational allegiances fostered work
elucidates how ephemeral and potentially radical art
in new media as well as collaborations at the point of
forms such as performance took root in the interstices
production and display. New distribution routes for
of existing institutions while exploiting infrastructural
artworks—including film, magazines, mail, and book
volatility to create new modes of expression such as
publication—altered the temporal and physical coordi-
the performance-lecture as well as challenging fixed
nates of artworks, allowing them to be experienced in
disciplinary boundaries like theater and art. These
multiple places simultaneously while facilitating new
challenges extended from the development of broader
ways and institutions through which the public could
audiences to the making of politically and socially
access them. In bringing these vehicles to light, this
concerned art and the testing of the structures of art
book is interested in the role played by infrastructure,
education. The volume closes with Dominic Johnson’s
registering its enabling properties but also the control
analysis of Genesis P-Orridge’s provocative 1976 Mail
14 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
The final three essays in London Art Worlds, by
Action in chapter 10. Johnson considers the artist’s for-
photograph express solidarity not only with those in
mation of subcultural identity through their mail objects
Chile who resisted Pinochet’s coup but also with work-
as well as their brush with civil law, state bureaucracy,
ers and trade unions from London and across Britain.46
and the tabloid press after P-Orridge was prosecuted
Dugger would continue to explore the banner form
for sending explicit material through the mail. The com-
throughout the 1970s, embarking on ambitious projects
plexity of the relationship that P-Orridge established
such as his Great Martial Arts Banner of 1976 (fig. I.5),
with the existing infrastructures of both the mail and
the design for which was based on the positions that
the legal system—using them to circulate and publicize
make up the black-belt sequence in Kung Fu. Dugger
work and moreover to galvanize a tightly knit body of
envisaged this cross-cultural work as inherently par-
supporters—illustrates the simultaneous existence of
ticipatory and social, in the sense that it drew on the
antipathy and affinity between institutions and counter-
mural tradition but also, due to the movements covering
cultural interventions that recurs throughout London Art
its surface, prompted mental and even bodily engage-
Worlds.
ment on the part of the viewer. Dugger’s banners, like
Finn-Kelcey’s flags, are emblematic of the dynamics of
Together, these essays aim to position London
as a coordinate of artistic activity on an international
mobility, contingency, and ephemerality. As the critic
map in order to complicate notions of nationalism and
Su Braden observed in relation to works like Here Is a
existing definitions of British art as a secure category or
Gale Warning at Art Spectrum London, “flags of every
obvious description. We are interested, for example, in
kind have to be frequently renewed as they soon fade or
how artists commandeered national institutional spaces
become rotted by the elements. Rose Finn-Kelcey’s flags
and worked with or reflected upon particular social and
are not about possession in any sense. The object will
political contexts of the city, intervening in the urban
not last and the image, as it moves, is concealed and
fabric of the metropolis. In September 1974, for example,
re-emerges—is unrepeatable.”47
in connection with the Artists for Democracy initia-
tive, Dugger hung his giant Chile Vencera Banner along
and Dugger’s “guerrilla art banners” resonate with
one flank of the base for Nelson’s column in Trafalgar
Ehrenberg’s anger at institutional racism and exclusion,
Square during a large-scale public protest organized
women filmmakers’ covert negotiation of distinctly
by the Chile Solidarity Campaign. A photograph from
gendered film collectives, and P-Orridge’s assault on
the event shows its component strips unfurling gently
the mail and legal systems. Throughout, this volume
in the breeze above a series of banners belonging to
analyzes how artists collaborated with the city, as well
trade unions (fig. I.4). Dugger has described the Chile
as with the specific social and cultural milieus that
Vencera Banner as a “guerrilla art banner,” sewn together
London engendered. In an evocative phrase, Hudek
from individual strips of cloth, which could be rigged
describes Willats’s CBA as “simultaneously an embed-
up quickly and easily; its form and positioning in the
ded and a foreign body,” a duality that can be applied to
15 Introduction
The impulses encapsulated by Finn-Kelcey’s flags
Fig. I.4 John Dugger, Chile Vencera Banner in Trafalgar Square, 1974. © John Dugger.
Fig. I.5 John Dugger, The Great Martial Arts Banner (Wu Shu Kwan), 1976. Dyedcanvas, sewn strip banner with soft rigging (seen here installed at the Flaxman Sports Centre, Lambeth, London). © John Dugger.
the conceptual and political situations of many artists,
multiple practices. We want neither to fetishize London
works, and temporary organizations in the essays
nor to situate it as a center defined by provincial mar-
collected here. The histories in London Art Worlds are
gins. Rather, by emphasizing what Brett has dubbed the
very much in the process of being told, as demon-
“complex currents of artistic activity” during this period,
strated by the fact that many of the essays draw on new
this volume offers a new set of parameters through
archival material and primary sources, underscoring
which to think about a range of artists and artistic prac-
the importance of rethinking art histories of Britain in
tices that flowed within, around, and from London’s art
the 1960s and 1970s. Through the models of mobility,
worlds in the sixties and seventies.48
contingency, and ephemerality, we hope to gain a fresh sense of the fluidity and richness of artistic production during these decades, as well as the specific politics of
17 Introduction
Notes
1. Brett, “Artists in Revolt.” The American curator Gene Baro selected the art for the exhibition, which included works by Anthony Caro, Phillip King, and William Turnbull. Some artists, such as Eduardo Paolozzi, had refused to take part in the show. In another review the sculptor Bruce McLean argued that Baro had failed to reflect adequately the work that was being produced in Britain, offering instead a stultified rehashing of the “New Generation” sculpture that had emerged under Caro’s influence at the St. Martin’s School of Art in the mid-1960s. See McLean, “Not Even Crimble Crumble.” 2. For a visual history of the counterculture, see Grunenberg, Summer of Love: Art of the Psychedelic Era. See also the accompanying volume Grunenberg and Harris, The Summer of Love: Psychedelic Art, Social Crisis, and Counterculture in the 1960s. 3. Andrew Wilson notes that fundraisers for the International Times often constituted countercultural “happenings” in their own right, intimating that the magazine actively contributed to the milieu it documented. Wilson, “Towards an Index for Everything,” 54. 4. See Alloway, “Long Front of Culture.” 5. Tickner, “‘Export Britain,’” 411. 6. Although Alloway argued that British Pop enthusiastically embraced American consumer culture, he also stressed that it “developed as an aesthetic proposal made in opposition to established opinion” specific to the U.K. context. Alloway identified Richard Hamilton in particular as manifesting an “activist” stance. Alloway, “Development of British Pop,” 66 and 40. For an analysis of Hamilton’s engagement with the British sociopolitical context in his Pop works of the 1960s, see A. Wilson, Richard Hamilton: Swingeing London 67 (f). Other artists affiliated with Pop whose work has activist connotations include Colin Self: see Tufnell, “Colin Self and the Bomb.” 7. Significant precedents include Parker and Pollock, Framing Feminism; Walker, Left Shift; and Mulholland, Cultural Devolution. Important critical interventions include Battista, Renegotiating the Body; Johnson, Critical Live Art; and S. Wilson, Art Labor, Sex Politics. 8. For an example of a study concentrating solely on the 1960s, see Mellor, Sixties Art Scene in London. While Mellor’s exhibition remains an important source, we also hope that the current volume takes into consideration Brett’s critique that it did not fully consider the role played by artists from Latin America, Africa, and Asia in the London art scene of the 1960s, or the impact of postcolonialism, presenting “an almost entirely British, white phenomenon, whereas the vitality of the period was certainly due to its cosmopolitan and multiracial character.” Brett, “Life Strategies,” 200. Brett has consistently written “across” these decades, and his work is of central importance to this book. See in particular Brett, “Tissues of Thought.”
18 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
9. Bourdieu approaches cultural production as a “field” in which individual works exist relationally. This field consists of multiple intersecting factors, including “information about institutions—e.g. academies, journals, magazines, galleries, publishers, etc.—and about persons, their relationships, liaisons and quarrels, information about the ideas and problems which are ‘in the air’ and circulate orally in gossip and rumour.” Bourdieu, “Field of Cultural Production,” 32. 10. Demarco played an important role in organizing many of these performances. For the development of performance art in other parts of Britain, such as Wales, see Roms and Edwards, “Towards a Prehistory of Live Art in the UK.” 11. Henri, Environments and Happenings, 112. 12. A comparable methodological approach can be found in Cherix, In and Out of Amsterdam. The exhibition catalogued in this volume traced how a range of conceptual artists passed through the city of Amsterdam during the 1960s and early 1970s, creating artworks and establishing new connections as they did so. 13. For a description of the press’s activities, see Conwell, “Beau Geste Press.” 14. For Oiticica’s time in London, see Brett and Figueiredo, Oiticica in London. 15. For an account of the squatters’ movement in London, see Craddock, “Squatters: Tolmers United.” 16. For the impact of decolonization on art and visual culture in Britain, see the essays collected in Faulkner and Ramamurthy, Visual Culture and Decolonisation in Britain. The importance of spaces such as the New Vision Centre in London for artists from formerly colonized countries and the Commonwealth during the 1950s and 1960s is conveyed by Margaret Garlake in New Vision 56–66, while writers such as Dorothy Rowe, Kobena Mercer, and Leon Wainwright have explored the work of artists such as Frank Bowling and Aubrey Williams through a postcolonial lens. See Rowe, “Nonsynchronous Cartographies”; Mercer, “Black Atlantic Abstraction”; and Wainwright, “Varieties of Belatedness and Provincialism.” 17. A number of commentators have identified social and political factors that mark the advent of globalization’s hypermobility, including the fall of the Berlin Wall in 1989 and the emergence of digital technologies. For an overview of these debates in relation to the definition of “contemporary” art, see the responses to the “Questionnaire on ‘The Contemporary,’” October 130 (Fall 2009): 3–124, particularly Alexander Alberro, 55–60. On mobility and globalization, see Papastergiadis, Turbulence of Migration. At the same time, other critics and curators have noted that globalizing tendences were indeed a characteristic of art practices in the 1960s: see, for example, Camnitzer, Farver, and Weiss, Global Conceptualism.
18. Araeen stated in no uncertain terms in his Black Manifesto, written between 1975 and 1976 and originally published in 1978, that the “present ‘internationalism’ of Western art is no more than a function of Western politico-economic power and the imposition of its values on other people. Therefore, in an international context, it would be more appropriate to call it imperialist art.” Araeen, “Preliminary Notes for a Black Manifesto,” 83. For the history of the Black Arts Movement in the late 1970s and 1980s, see Bailey, Baucom, and Boyce, Shades of Black, and Chambers, Black Artists in British Art. 19. Entries 41 and 90 for Rose Finn-Kelcey and Gustav Metzger, Art Spectrum London, n.p. 20. Prior to Art Spectrum artists Conrad Atkinson and Charles Gosford met with the arts council a number of times on the subject of its support of artists outside the commercial system. The relative failure of these discussions no doubt supported the debates at and after Art Spectrum London. 21. M. Harrison, “Notes on Feminist Art in Britain, 1970–77,” 213. 22. For an account of the parallel situation in the United States, see Bryan-Wilson, Art Workers. 23. See Saunders, “Freaks’ Roll Call.” 24. Introduction to Art Spectrum London, n.p. 25. See Tickner, “The Kasmin Gallery.” 26. See Anderson and Tobin, “Collaboration is Not an Alternative.” 27. Whitelegg, “Signals Echoes Traces,” 89. 28. For an account of events at the store see Nuttall, Bomb Culture, 157. 29. See Harvey and Yiakoumaki, Supporting Artists. 30. For more on Feministo: A Postal Art Event, see Tobin, “I’ll Show You Mine, If You Show Me Yours.” For the history of the “Hornsey Uprising” of 1968, which responded to changes in the art-school curriculum and prompted students to design their own proposals for education programs in protest, see Tickner, Hornsey 1968. The interrelation of radicalism and pedagogy was also explored in a 2013 exhibition at Flat Time House, formerly the home of John Latham and subsequently an archive/gallery space, entitled The Mental Furniture Industry. 31. See Drower, “Exploding Galaxy,” and Drower, 99 Balls Pond Road. 32. For the importance of club spaces and cabaret culture for feminist and queer performance, see Butt, “Common Turn in Performance,” particularly 53–59. See also Cross, “Gays: Revolting Queers.”
19 Introduction
33. C. Harrison, “Against Precedents,” 195. 34. For these shifts, see Applin, “When Attitudes Became Formless.” See also Applin, “There’s a Sculpture on my Shoulder,” and Peabody, Anglo-American Exchange in Postwar Sculpture. 35. See Castells, The City and the Grassroots. 36. See Castells, Network Society. See also Larsen, Networks. 37. Alloway used the word “network” to describe the art world in his 1972 essay “Network: The Art World Described as a System.” For Alloway’s use of the term, see Martin, “Art World, Network, and Other Alloway Keywords.” For Jack Burnham’s body of writing, see Burnham, Dissolve into Comprehension. 38. Pratt, “Arts of the Contact Zone,” 34. 39. An excerpted transcript of Ehrenberg’s action during this event was published in Studio International. See Ehrenberg, “Date with Fate at Tate.” 40. For an overview of Metzger’s increasing politicization, see O’Brien and Larner, Gustav Metzger: Decades, 1959–2009, and Cole, Gustav Metzger: Retrospectives. 41. See Beckett, When the Lights Went Out; Turner, Crisis? What Crisis? Britain in the 1970s; and Proll, Goodbye to London. 42. Schneemann, “Foreword: Live Art Performance Art Body Art,” 2. 43. Simon Anderson situates Fluxshoe within the context of international Fluxus activities in a way that complements the aims of this volume. See Anderson, “Fluxus, Fluxion, Fluxshoe.” 44. Although instances of collaboration and collectivity in Britain in the 1960s and 1970s remain underresearched, Grant Kester’s discussions of collaboration and collectivity in Conversation Pieces: Community and Communication in Modern Art and The One and The Many: Contemporary Collaborative Art in a Global Context, together with Blake Stimson and Gregory Sholette’s edited collection Collectivism After Modernism: The Art of Social Imagination After 1945, trace important developments across disparate geographies in the twentieth and twenty-first centuries. In this respect, see also Claire Bishop’s chapter on the London-based Artist Placement Group for a discussion of British art of the 1970s in relation to recent debates about participation. Bishop, “Incidental People: APG and Community Arts.” 45. Brett, introduction to Carnival of Perception, 17. 46. John Dugger, e-mail correspondence with the authors, June 16, 2016. 47. Braden, “Sky Signs,” 30. 48. Brett, introduction to Carnival of Perception, 16.
Everything Was Connected Kinetic Art and Internationalism at Signals London, 1964–66 Isobel Whitelegg
Everything was connected. The title of this essay rests
by immigrant and exile artists within Britain should
on a recollection. The phrase was the answer to a
be better acknowledged. Such factors have drawn
question asked of one of Signals’ founding members.
Signals into loose relation with the postcolonial, the
For what reason were a poem, a scientific image, and
global, and the transnational—that “primary marker” of
a reproduction of a work of art placed together on one
contemporaneity.3
page of Signals’ Newsbulletin? “At that time,” came the
answer, “we believed that everything was connected.”
America specifically and the global more broadly, speak
to the interests of the present and the recent past. The
1
Since the early 1990s the collectively conceived
Signals’ accumulated associations, with Latin
and cooperated gallery Signals London (1964–66) has
role that it played in the development and definition
attracted renewed attention for reasons related to its
of kinetic art, however, has been more subtly articu-
international perspective. It is now widely recognized
lated. For those involved with Signals, “kinetic” was a
for playing a decisive role in the British reception
provisional and mutable term, tempered by tentative
of Latin American art, by lending early support to
alternatives, such as “elemental,” “perceptual,” and
now-celebrated artists and by extending its reach
“environmental.” Without downplaying the relevance
toward previously unacknowledged artistic centers,
of Signals’ embrace of the migrant-artist and the Latin
such as Caracas and Rio de Janeiro. At the same time,
American milieu, in this chapter I pay attention to
those involved in organizing Signals’ exhibitions and
an interrelation between the specific parameters of
editing its Newsbulletin argued that the role played
Signals’ internationalism and the centrality of kinetic
2
1. 1. 1. 1. 1. 1. 1. 1. 1. 1.
art to its activities. So doing, I draw attention to certain
Times) was a de facto fifth. In November 1964 CACS,
connections that Signals made, notably with English
renamed Signals London, moved into a four-storey
and North American kinetic art, which are more often
property on Wigmore Street in London’s West End that
not emphasized in revisions of its history. I also aim to
was owned by Keeler’s father, Charles. For the two years
ground Signals’ interconnectedness within a specific
that Signals existed, this large “showroom” was the
place and time: in London and at the very crux between
venue for nine comprehensive one-person exhibitions.
postwar attitudes and the dawning of new aesthetic
and geopolitical perspectives. In so doing, I show that
collective exhibitions, which assembled work by artists
Signals’ initially optimistic emphasis on untroubled
of varying generations, nationalities, and tendencies.
pan-Western connections was put under pressure, by
Emerging in titled series, these acted as laboratories for
both international political upheavals and contrasting
the reconciliation of individual formal emphases and the
perspectives on the value of scientific and technological
development of a thesis on the meaning and historical
innovation. Under such conditions, Signals’ definition of
significance of kinetic art. The first of the Soundings
the kinetic, however flexible, is revealed to be one that
series (Soundings One, January–February 1964) was
also necessarily involved tensions, divergences, and
organized by Keeler for the Ashmolean Museum in
disconnections.
Oxford and predated the existence of both CACS and
Signals itself. Following a series of Pilot CACS shows
The name Signals (at first spelled with a z, Signalz)
Solo shows were complemented by a series of
was borrowed from the title of a series of works by the
at Medalla and Paul Keeler’s Kensington apartment,
artist Takis and came into circulation in August 1964 as
Soundings Two took place at Signals’ West End prem-
the title of the inaugural news bulletin of an indepen-
ises, approximately halfway through its lifetime, in July
dent and recently founded entity named the Centre for
1965. This exhibition brought works by contemporary
Advanced Creative Study (CACS). With its first imprint,
artists of different ages and nationalities together with
CACS announced an aspiration to be a forum for “all
those of an earlier avant-garde including Josef Albers,
those who believe passionately in the co-relation of the
Marcel Duchamp, Naum Gabo, Kazimir Malevich, Piet
arts and Art’s imaginative integration with technology,
Mondrian, Henry Moore, and Ben Nicholson.
science, architecture and our entire environment” (fig.
1.1). CACS operated at first from a private address—
cal development of kinetic art similar to that of the
the home of artist David Medalla and Paul Keeler, a
movement’s seminal exhibition, Le Mouvement, while
graduate of the Central School of Speech and Drama
being both larger in scale and more complex in range.
turned collector and exhibition organizer. With Keeler
Organized by Denise René and Victor Vasarely at
and Medalla, the artists Marcello Salvadori and Gustav
René’s Paris gallery in April 1955, Le Mouvement featured
Metzger were CACS’s founding members. The writer
eight international and cross-generational artists: Jean
and curator Guy Brett (at that time art critic on the
Tinguely, Yaacov Agam, Pol Bury, Alexander Calder,
4
22 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
Soundings Two took an approach to the histori-
Fig. 1.1 Front cover, Signalz: Newsbulletin of the Centre for Advanced Creative Study, June 1964 (facsimile edition published by Iniva, 1995).
Marcel Duchamp, Robert Jacobsen, Jesús Rafael Soto, and Vasarely himself. With Soundings Two, Signals distinguished itself from its predecessors by using the exhibition as a vehicle to assert a British-internationalist genealogy. The exhibition was dedicated to Circle: International Survey of Contemporary Art, and Keeler emphasized the contribution that had been made to British art by exiles from elsewhere in Europe.5 In an interview reprinted in the exhibition’s invitation card, he commented that “British art missed a great opportunity when artists like Moholy-Nagy, Gabo, Schwitters, Mondrian and Calder came to live in this country.”6
Collective exhibitions were also used as a means
to approach the somewhat vexed designation “kinetic” art. An editorial statement in the June–July 1965 Signals Newsbulletin argued that this word should be understood to encompass the “increasing sum of multiple creative endeavours.”7 In time, “invisible,” rather than “kinetic,” evolved as a recurrent term for describing collective exploration. A projected survey exhibition, entitled Towards the Invisible, proposed that individual works, contemporary and historical, should be composed into constellations of interest, including “energy, dematerialization and growth, light and color, and the animation and total involvement of space.”8 The exhibition was never realized in the ambitious form that was imagined, but a series of three small “pilot” versions took place between June and October 1966.
the End of the World,” she departs from a discussion of
Pamela M. Lee’s Chronophobia: On Time in the Art of
Tinguely’s eponymous 1962 work in order to approach
the 1960s (2004) is one of the few art-historical studies
kinetic art as a tendency that used movement in order
to situate the kinetic tendencies that emerged from the
to “make literal” a postwar apprehension of time as
late 1950s to mid-1960s in relation to the wider devel-
volatility and impermanence. Artists who were associ-
opment of Western art. In a chapter entitled “Study for
ated with what Lee terms “the Signals group” play a key
23 Everything Was Connected
role in her argument. For Lee, they offer a set of “global
both the “loose community of artists and critics” that
propositions around movement, invisibility, and energy”
she describes and also, set within its Wigmore Street
and form a counterpoint to Tinguely’s self-destructing
premises, a sporadically successful commercial gallery,
machines.
headquarters, and gathering place.13
9
Lee identifies “conflictedness” as a characteris-
When employing Signals as a collective noun, it
tic inherent to kinetic art, a peculiar combination of
is often impossible even to identify exactly to whom
“regressiveness and forward motion,” which confuses
one is referring. Its self-published Newsbulletin assem-
any clear identification of aesthetic, political, and social
bled a common voice from a polyphony of self-penned
ambitions. Such “conflictedness” can also be observed
and reprinted texts. These documented and expanded
in the split between how kinetic art may be perceived
upon Signals’ program of exhibitions and at the same
10
now (optimistic, nostalgic, entertaining—and irrele-
time attempted to resolve and articulate its founding
vant) and the radicalism that it exuded in its own time.
members’ different stakes in the aesthetic-imaginative
Artists and ideas associated with Signals support Lee’s
potential of new developments in technology and
position in divesting kinetic art of any lingering air of
science. As Lee notes, this attraction moved gradually
contemporary irrelevance. Lee’s discussion of Signals
toward a particular concern with the perceptual implica-
takes the work of Lygia Clark (featured in both solo and
tions of new models, materials, and machines—from
group exhibitions at the gallery) as its recurring motif. In
the unseen energies of quantum physics to the new
teasing out the means by which kinetic artists con-
revelations offered by microscopic visualization.
veyed the principle of movement, from the actual to the
virtual, the “limp Mobius strip” that serves as a prop for
and artistic imagery was characteristic of the Signals
Clark’s 1966 work Dialogue of Hands is used to illustrate
Newsbulletin’s layout. This approach to design was the
kinetic art’s capacity to “crystallize the phenomenal
individual signature of its editor Medalla but reflected
11
experience of viewing art as material and embodied.”
12
The creation of visual analogies between scientific
a collective standpoint and appealed to a contempo-
In Lee’s argument, Signals’ global character (which
rary imaginary, one that bridged art and science in a
Clark is seen to embody as a Brazilian artist) also marks
search for “dynamic structures underlying the visi-
and distinguishes its contribution to kinetic art.
ble world.”14 The Newsbulletin appeared at intervals
between August 1964 and March 1966, each of its six
To single out Clark as illustrative of Signals’
approach to kinetic art, however, is to remove the
editions taking the flexible form of a folded broadsheet.
gallery’s share of the conflictedness that Lee iden-
Collectively, these now form a partial record of Signals’
tifies as inherent to that movement. In line with her
activities and networks. They also reveal unrealized
wider definition of kinetic art, Signals too is an object
plans. Present-tracking and future-projecting tenses
of art-historical study that evades stable identifica-
are collapsed within its pages. Projects and proposals
tion of aesthetic and social ambitions. Signals was
seem to have been put into print urgently, without
24 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
hesitation; many were later modified, some may have
Camargo, Jesus Rafael Soto, and Takis. Born in Brazil,
been realized, others were certainly not in fact carried
Venezuela, and Greece respectively, each became the
out at all. This indiscriminancy creates numerous points
subject of an individual Signals exhibition.
of departure for possible, counterfactual narratives;
the Newsbulletin’s announced but unrealized plans give
Takis, Signals presented solo exhibitions of the work of
grounds for speculation upon what may have been
founder-artist Marcello Salvadori and that of Gerhard
Signals’ future.
von Graevenitz, a Paris-based member, alongside Soto,
of the influential Zero group. Soto’s and Camargo’s
Substantial records did not survive the unantici-
As well as those dedicated to Camargo, Soto, and
pated closure of Signals’ premises in October 1966. In
extra-European connections exerted influence on its
the absence of the semblance of historical certainty
other one-person shows—of work by Brazilian artists
offered by sets of administrative files, cuttings, and cor-
Clark (May–July 1965) and Mira Schendel (September–
respondence, the Newsbulletin now acts as an archival
October 1966) and Venezuelan artists Carlos Cruz-Diez
surrogate. Aspects of its content seem to anticipate
(September–October 1965) and Alejandro Otero
the need to keep track of history. Medalla’s Stop Press
(January–March 1966). Of the nine solo shows realized
notes, for example, map the chain of connections that
in its short lifetime, a total of six were devoted to artists
brought artists to his attention, with personal names
from Brazil and Venezuela. Via the gallery’s collective
picked out in bold text: “Lygia Clark introduced Hélio
exhibitions, as well as its printed Newsbulletin pages, the
Oiticica’s work to Paul Keeler. Mira Schendel’s work
work of many other Latin American artists, including
was introduced to Keeler by Sergio de Camargo. David
Matthias Goeritz (Mexico) and Hélio Oiticica (Brazil),
Medalla introduced to Keeler the work of Takis, Soto
appeared in London for the first time.
and Pol Bury and Chillada. Camargo also introduced to
Keeler the work of Alberto Guzman, Alejandro Otero,
with European currents of kinetic art. Supported by
Lygia Clark, Rossini Perez and Milton Dacosta.”
René in Paris, by the mid-1960s they had become more
Medalla arrived in London from the Philippines, via
familiar to a wider London gallery scene. Camargo too
Paris, in 1960 and met Brett and Keeler in the same year.
was then a long-term resident of Paris. Although not yet
The three formed a tight-knit collaborative core among
so enmeshed within kinetic art’s circuits and centers,
Signals’ founder-members. Their subsequent visits to
he had been represented at collective exhibitions in
Paris plugged Signals into a circuit of experimental art,
the French capital and achieved greater recognition in
connecting groups such as Zero in Düsseldorf, Gruppo
Europe after being awarded the International Sculpture
T in Milan, and Nul in Amsterdam to spaces including
Prize at the iii Biennale de Paris in 1963.
the Galerie Denise René and Galerie Iris Clert in Paris
and the New Vision Centre in London. Their clos-
exhibited, Camargo shares with Soto and Cruz-Diez
est Paris-based collaborators were artists Sergio de
the distinction of having entered Tate’s permanent
15
16
25 Everything Was Connected
Both Soto and Cruz-Diez were actively engaged
Among the Latin American artists that Signals
collections via a sale brokered by Keeler. The fact that
exhibited as part of both the Brazilian pavilion at the
its solo exhibitions resulted in prominent museum
1960 Venice Biennial and the exhibition Concrete Art—50
acquisitions indicates a level of influence exceeding
Years of Development, organized by Max Bill at Helmhaus
that of any informal artist-led enterprise. Such influence
Zürich the same year. Her solo exhibition at Signals
attests to the effect of the unprecedented focus that
and its accompanying Newsbulletin foregrounded the
Signals was able to afford individual artists within its
participatory emphasis and the use of ephemeral media
substantially scaled spaces. Significant too is the fact
that characterized her later career and now underpins
that among Signals’ patrons was the art historian Sir
her place in a newly internationalized genealogy of
John Rothenstein, who had recently retired from a long
contemporary art. Otero’s one-person show similarly
tenure as the director of London’s Tate Gallery, between
presented a comprehensive picture of his work that was
1938 and 1964, during which time he had renovated
considerably more complex than the abstract and more
the museum’s acquisition policies by prioritizing
obviously “kinetic” work that elsewhere aligned him
twentieth-century British art, European modernism, and
with his Venezuelan compatriots Soto and Cruz-Diez
North American abstract painting. One can imagine
(figs. 1.2 and 1.3). Among the three it was perhaps
that the work of Soto, Cruz-Diez, and Camargo, with its
the radical sparseness of Mira Schendel’s Monotipias
already-earned European pedigree, made a persuasive
that presented the greatest conceptual challenge to
case for acquisition by a modernizing museum in the
preexisting definitions of kinetic art. Works that were
early stages of self-internationalization.
unknown or unanticipated at the time of the foundation
of the Centre for Advanced Creative Study therefore
Signals’ own engagement with Latin American art
reached beyond the work of artists represented within
allowed Signals to shape and establish a distinctive
existing European circuits at the time of the gallery’s
reading of kinetic art. Clark, Otero, and Schendel alike
operation. The decision to feature solo exhibitions
nudged Signals’ collective perspective away from
of work by Lygia Clark, Alejandro Otero, and Mira
positivist associations with science and technology and
Schendel demonstrates its collective exercise of risk
toward the nuanced possibilities offered by an explora-
and instinct. Signals created the conditions for the first
tion of “the invisible.”
detailed English-language considerations of the signif-
icance of these artists. Conversely, the works by Clark,
names among Signals’ roster of solo shows was, in
Otero, and Schendel that were exhibited at the gallery
no small part, the consequence of personal links to
pushed against existing definitions of kinetic art. As
Camargo and Soto. But within the postwar British
Lee discerns, the work of Clark in particular served to
context, these two countries had also established
emphasize its participatory and perceptual dimensions.
a more popular repute as modernizing New World
nations. Wider enthusiasm had previously been in
By the time of her solo exhibition at Signals,
Clark had departed from the concretist work that was
26 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
The early dominance of Brazilian and Venezuelan
evidence across diverse sites of reception, from a 1954
Fig. 1.2 Photograph taken during the installation of the exhibition A Quarter of a Century of the Beautiful Art of Alejandro Otero: 1940–1965, Signals London, January 20–March 19, 1966. The most recent series in this retrospective were the dyed newspaper collages and white monochrome assemblages seen here.
Pathé newsreel breathlessly describing Caracas as
Venezuela’s “Utopia City” to the exhibition of pho-
revealed to a British public by both the wonders of
tographs and a model of Brasilia that was mounted
modern microscopy and by the construction of new
at the ICA in 1958. Although integrated within an
model cities in faraway places. Both of these facets
urbane artistic scene, Signals too found its way into this
of the postwar popular imaginary found their way
popular imagination. Medalla reported the presence
onto the pages of the Signals Newsbulletin. Its second
of numerous “students, doctors, nurses, technologists
issue, dated September 1964, included an article by
and scientists” at CACS’s early Pilot shows, and its
Rothenstein on the Caracas University City, an article
exhibitions were featured on films made for both tele-
on Brazilian architecture by Henrique E. Mindlin, and a
vision and cinema broadcast, and reviewed by the New
brief report on the construction of four new museums in
Scientist magazine, which had been founded in 1956.
Mexico City. With resemblances to a modernizing and
17
18
27 Everything Was Connected
By the mid-sixties, new worlds had thus been
Fig. 1.3 Photograph taken during the installation of the exhibition A Quarter of a Century of the Beautiful Art of Alejandro Otero: 1940–1965, Signals London, January 20–March 19, 1966.
increasingly affluent postwar Britain, this was a Latin
sociopolitical present that these same countries were
America in boom, participating in the construction of
experiencing by the mid-1960s.
a future informed by scientific and industrial develop-
ment, furnished by innovative and sociable architectural
assembled in relation to selective points of focus, and
constructions and benefiting from a cultural infra-
Latin America has consistently been the point around
structure geared up for internationalization. In thus
which this process pivots. Signals’ legacy as a pioneer-
characterizing the Latin countries of the Americas, the
ing center for the reception of Latin American art finds
September 1964 pages also reflect a certain anach-
its coherent proof in Medalla’s and Brett’s continuing
ronism, one generated in the gap between a delayed
commitment to artists and critics working within that
and enduring perception of countries such as Brazil
region. Signals also offers a British legacy, one that
and Venezuela as New World allies and the unstable
has been adopted as a genealogical base for the more
28 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
Fragments of Signals’ history have been repeatedly
belated embrace of Brazilian artists Oiticica, Schendel,
of Lee and others, who see its approach to kinetic art as
and Clark by the museological and academic main-
conditioned by a perception of “the art world as increas-
stream. As noted, it can be argued that an encounter
ingly global in character.”19 Lee situates the critical mass
with artists from Brazil, in particular, allowed the gallery
of the kinetic tendency in Europe and believes Signals’
to forge a distinctive understanding of kinetic art. Its
network went further, breaking out in order to connect
geographical bias—toward Brazil, Venezuela, and Latin
to artists working in Latin American nations while at
America more widely—may have been sustained had
the same time evading the reach of the United States.
the gallery survived. Its international perspective, how-
The European-centered kinetic tendency may indeed
ever, may also have been rebalanced.
be cast as a counterpoint to the “seeming hegemony
of the New York art world.”20 It is important to note,
This counterfactual narrative is suggested by a
change in the scope of Signals’ annual Soundings exhibi-
however, that expansiveness for Signals did not imply a
tion. With its third and final edition (August–September
collective aversion to more obvious, or closer to hand,
1966) Soundings moved toward a nationally specific
geographical locations. A difference, perhaps, is that
approach. Organized by Medalla, Soundings Three focused
the gallery did not explicitly prioritize North American
exclusively on “facets of abstract art in Great Britain now”
art and artists. As discussed above, it is also import-
and featured twenty-one artists based in various cities
ant to note that Signals’ decision to prioritize, instead,
(fig. 1.4). The final January–March 1966 Newsbulletin
Latin America did not entirely run against the grain of
meanwhile announced plans in motion for a further
its time; it was in part facilitated by the embrace of the
two Soundings exhibitions, focusing on North America
region in the postwar imaginary.
(1967) and Canada (1968). The host of future solo shows
announced on the invitation card for Soundings Three also
Brett has often stated an aversion to British art’s 1960s
indicates a differently balanced international path. These
“love affair” with the “toughness” of North American
included projected exhibitions of the work of four British
art.21 This does not, however, imply outright rejec-
artists—Peter Joseph, Kenneth Martin, Mary Martin,
tion of individual artists, including those—such as
and John Wells—as well as solo shows by Hélio Oiticica
Ellsworth Kelly, Jackson Pollock, Morris Louis, and
and Hercules Barsotti (Brazil); Alberto Guzman (Peru);
Clyfford Still—associated with Abstract Expressionism
Narciso Debourg (Venezuela); Edgar Negret (Colombia);
and located in New York. Indeed, to exercise prejudice
two Paris-based members of Groupe de Recherche d’Art
toward even the most hegemonic of artistic centers (or
Visuel, or GRAV (François Morellet and Julio le Parc);
movements) would seem to contradict Signals’ pre-
and the three Milan-based artists Li-Yuan Chia, Gianni
vailing endorsement of interconnectedness. Its most
Colombo, and Antonio Calderara.
ambitious unrealized group show, Towards the Invisible,
aspired to offer a new reading of Western art by recon-
Signals’ statements of future intent allow for an
understanding of its expansiveness different from that
29 Everything Was Connected
In retrospective interviews and conversations,
necting the three territories of Western Europe, Latin
Fig. 1.4 Invitation card for the exhibition Soundings Three, Signals London, August 25–September 24, 1966.
and North America through the lens of the kinetic. The
exhibition hoped to recruit both Postimpressionist and
America rarely enters narratives of Signals’ history.
Abstract Expressionist artists to the task of demon-
From the project’s earliest stages, however, Keeler had
strating that “the apparent diversities of modern art”
made regular studio visits to artists in New York as well
were “in reality—i.e. on the level of the imagination”—
as Paris.25 As a result, the artist Willoughby Sharp, who
united by “one great theme: the search for dynamic
organized a series of influential kinetically inflected
structures underlying the visible world.” Towards the
exhibitions across the United States between 1966 and
Invisible intended to include Seurat and Cézanne as
1969, became an important early connection. New
its earliest historical references, with Latin Americans
York–based art historian Dore Ashton, together with
including Camargo, Clark, and Soto entering, as part
philanthropist Caresse Crosby, served among Signals’
of a widened postwar world, alongside figures such as
U.S. patrons. Like its relationship with Europe and Latin
Yves Klein and Jackson Pollock. This, then, was a proj-
America, Signals’ projected focus on the United States
ect that reimagined a Western world in which different
and Canada was not arbitrary but rather an intended
regions, old and new, North and South, played equal
amplification of existing personal relationships.
and reciprocal roles.
was in fact quite consistent with Signals’ numerous
22
Signals thus did not delimit an “increasingly global”
An engagement with both North and South
To exhibit kinetic artists working in North America
art world by permitting entry to new centers such as
unrealized plans. The first issue of the Newsbulletin
Caracas, São Paulo, and Rio de Janeiro while neglect-
announces a third CACS Pilot Show, one to be
ing established or predictable places. Rather, it sought
co-organized by Sharp as “a trans-atlantic exhibition of
productively to diminish the exaggerated importance
kinetic art: London-Paris-New York.”26 Other significant
granted to certain centers over others, while possibly
U.S. connections emerged through the distribution of
also acting to locate peripheral practices within hege-
the Newsbulletin to individuals with mutual interests.
monic nations. Rather than deepen an apparent “split
This process returned a January 1966 letter of support
between American artists and non-Americans working
from György Kepes, then professor of visual design at
in a kinetic idiom,” Signals may have deployed its force
the Massachusetts Institute of Technology and eventual
as a European-networked, London-based center in order
founder, in 1967, of MIT’s Center for Advanced Visual
to present an alternative picture of U.S.-sited artistic
Studies (CAVS). Evidence of sympathy and connection
practice, one that did not focus exclusively on New
between Signals’ perspective and that of both Kepes
York–based movements.23 As such, Signals’ post-1966
and Sharp emerged in the years following the gal-
plans to showcase the work of U.S. and Canadian kinetic
lery’s closure. The work of both Medalla and Salvadori
artists may have acted to rejoin and reinforce the “rel-
featured in Sharp’s 1968–69 exhibition Air Art (which
atively scattered number of individuals” involved with
toured to venues in Pennsylvania, Illinois, California,
that tendency across the North American continent.
New Hampshire, and Alberta); in 1968 Takis was among
31 Everything Was Connected
24
the first artists appointed by Kepes as a CAVS fellow (a
Newsbulletin both to make note of the London-based
position also held by Otero in 1972–73).
artists, such as John Latham and Stephen Willats, who
adopted Signals as a gathering place and to report the
Signals’ final and British-focused show in the
Soundings series, meanwhile, indicates how the
activity of kinetic artists working in Britain’s “provinces.”
gallery worked to rejoin and reinforce the equally
Its three artist-members were all born in countries other
scattered field of British kinetic art. The constitu-
than the United Kingdom, each embodying and activat-
ency of Soundings Three reflects the operation of an
ing Keeler’s call for British art to recognize the continual
intra-British expansiveness, developing parallel to the
contribution made to it by migrant artists. As noted
widening of Signals’ international reach. Creating a
above, Signals also connected to and made visible the
United Kingdom–wide survey, the exhibition featured
work of artists and groups working within other British
established London-based artists, such as Mary Martin,
cities, establishing a relationship that in turn exerted
alongside members of the Manchester-based “group g,”
continued influence on the activity of regionally located
the Nottingham-based Midland Group, and individual
centers, most notably Nottingham’s Midland Group
artists based in Cardiff, Bristol, Edinburgh, and Leeds.
Gallery. And as a large London gallery, Signals was in a
27
As one of Signals’ final exhibitions, Soundings
position not only to gather in Britain’s artistic provinces
Three did not benefit from the publication of a related
but also to support the work of figures who had already
Newsbulletin edition, a coordination that had previously
been recognized in the capital. Standing out among
acted as a means of documenting, expanding upon,
Tate’s present-day Mary Martin holdings, for example,
and disseminating recently realized shows. As such, a
is the museum-scale wall relief Inversions, which was
detailed consideration of this exhibition is missing from
created as a new commission for Soundings Three.
the historical record that the Newsbulletins now offer. As
with its U.S. connections, Signals’ relationship to British
imaginary, bridging new art and new science, Medalla’s
art and artists is often overlooked or understated. Lee
collage-like Newsbulletin pages are also suggestive of
has argued that its members found the British milieu to
connections not made. One obvious but unexplored
be “parochial,” presenting itself “as a kind of reaction
link is with Richard Hamilton’s 1951 ICA exhibition
formation to activities in New York.” Certainly a U.S.
Growth and Form, a project that also underscored the
bias was evident in the exhibition programs and acqui-
perceptual possibilities offered by creating visual
sition policies of prominent London-based institutions
connections between diverse photographic sources.
at the time. This “parochialism,” however, could not be
Without denying the importance of its international
resolved simply by displacing Signals’ focus to Paris or
links, it is important also to ground Signals’ interest in
seeking out novelties from Rio.
the aesthetic and imaginative potential of new develop-
ments in technology and science within the day-to-day
28
Signals instead made inroads into the British
artistic milieu on different fronts. Medalla used the
32 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
If taken as an expression of a contemporary
of its postwar London context. London granted the
gallery a curious and receptive local public for the work
destructive and dehumanizing threat rather than an
that it displayed, one to whom the cultural production
imaginative promise. Salvadori, meanwhile, argued
of Latin American nations was not entirely unfamiliar.
consistently for collaboration between artist and
Recalling Signals’ local context also serves to reconnect
scientist, for an understanding of how the work of one
it to closer-by peers and precedents. Writing in 1988,
might be understood as analogous to the other, and for
Medalla listed the U.S.-focused Robert Fraser Gallery
the formation of conditions for the two to work together
alongside Gallery One and the New Vision Centre
in order to realize works—imaginative or functional—
as among his favorite haunts; he also expressed his
that might even “allow man complete control of his
admiration for the Whitechapel Gallery (“a flagship for
environment.”30
new developments in British and American Art”) and
recalled participating in seminars at the ICA, which
the founding of CACS to the gallery’s 1966 closure,
were “presided over by Sir Herbert Read and Sir Ronald
Salvadori’s perspective on the relation between art,
Penrose, veteran campaigners for Modern Art.”29
science, and technology remained resolute. In 1966,
with backing from poet and philanthropist Erica Marx,
In searching out Signals’ most far-reaching and
Over the course of Signals’ activities, from
groundbreaking international connections, it is the
he started an initiative of his own, the Centre for
relationships closest to home that reemerge now as the
Advanced Study of Science in Art, or CASSA. This new
more overlooked. And always hidden in plainest sight
center operated across a collection of laboratories
are the other two among Signals founder-members:
well equipped to allow artists, scientists, technolo-
Gustav Metzger and Marcello Salvadori. Although
gists, and architects to realize collaborative projects.
always named, each remains a silent outlier to existing
It was thus closer in character to U.S.-sited projects
perspectives on Signals’ history. For both Metzger and
whose approach is often starkly contrasted with that
Salvadori, Signals served more as point of departure than
of Signals, such as Billy Klüver’s Experiments in Art
collaborative nexus. While both were involved from the
and Technology (EAT, founded 1967) in New York and
beginning, each found more suitable grounds elsewhere
Kepes’s CAVS at MIT (1967).
for the development of his individual concerns.
pected death, in 1969, and the extent of its activities
Within a forum for art’s “imaginative integration
CASSA’s own life was cut short by Marx’s unex-
with technology, science, architecture and our entire
remains somewhat obscure. Insight into CASSA’s scope,
environment,” Metzger and Salvadori might also be
however, is offered by the records of a 1968 exhibition at
placed at contrasting extremes. Metzger embodied a
the Museum of Modern Art, Oxford (now Modern Art
strident resistance to any “messianic” belief in the pur-
Oxford). Entitled CASSA: Fundamental Research at the
suit of technological progress: for him, post-Newtonian
Centre for Advanced Study of Science in Art, this exhi-
science was not a new poetics of interrelation; it was
bition presented projects and statements by a group
the atom bomb. Science and technology offered a
of ten artists and architects spanning Europe, Japan,
33 Everything Was Connected
and the United States (Renzo Piano, Wolfgang Döring,
Kenji Ekuan, Joe Tilson, Friedrich St. Florian, Erica Marx,
what transpired to be the final issue of the Signals
Nizzou Associati, Heinz Mack, William Katavolos,
Newsbulletin announced an extensive trip to North
Raimund J. Abraham).
America by Takis, Keeler, and Soto. This March 1966
visit took in Soto’s solo exhibition at the Koots Gallery,
The vast difference separating Metzger’s and
A Stop Press column on the second page of
Salvadori’s perspectives appears to have resulted in
New York, as well as Directions in Kinetic Sculpture, a
mutual disinterest rather than direct confrontation. The
University of California, Berkeley, exhibition featuring
different poles that they represent also remain apart
Takis. It was also intended as a preparatory research trip
from the reading of kinetic art collectively developed by
for the gallery’s upcoming shows of U.S. and Canadian
Brett, Keeler, and Medalla in concert with collaborators
art and as an opportunity to visit “American friends and
in Europe and Latin America. Metzger and Salvadori are
supporters,” including Kelly, Duchamp, Ashton, and
thus indicative of Signals’ surplus and outlying “conflict-
Crosby. This assertion of U.S.-sited support was rein-
edness,” one that existed at the margins of more pacific
forced by the appearance of Kepes’s 1966 “Letter from
explorations of movement, invisibility, and energy. It is
Massachusetts,” published in a neighboring column.
necessary to admit this conflict within Signals’ bounds,
however, if only to account for the gallery’s ending—the
friends counterbalanced its view of the U.S. govern-
circumstances of which suggest an increased orienta-
ment’s foreign policy—an opinion that had, by then, been
tion toward the activist, and more pessimistic, pole that
quite explicitly stated. In July 1965 the predominantly
Metzger represents.
optimistic and largely apolitical tone of the Newsbulletin
had been interrupted by the publication of two texts
Salvadori’s commitment to the positive potential of
Signals’ embrace of individual North American
collaboration between art and science meanwhile finds
critical of U.S. involvement in Vietnam: a transcript of
its extensions elsewhere. In a 1967 document he intro-
historian Lewis Mumford’s “Ceremonial Address to the
duces CASSA, cautioning against any “wariness” toward
American Academy of Arts & Letters” and a letter from
science and technology’s infiltration of everyday life and
Robert Lowell to President Lyndon Johnson declining an
arguing for the need for artists to keep pace with the
invitation to dinner at the White House.
“new language of analogy” that was offered by close col-
laboration. The subtle mark of defensiveness emerging
Medalla’s decision to publish these two texts, the
through his text was echoed more loudly in parallel U.S.
withdrawal of Charles Keeler’s support, and Signals’
contexts. Kepes, for example, came under increasing
abrupt 1966 closure—has been both affirmed and
pressure to defend the similarly interdisciplinary position
refuted.32 It may be argued, however, that the seeds
of CAVS, situated as it was within MIT—an institute
of Signals’ ending were indeed cultivated by a chang-
that also housed “special labs” devoted to scientific and
ing sociopolitical climate, one to which resistance to
technological research for militaristic ends.
the U.S. war with Vietnam was a significant catalyst.
31
34 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
A causal relationship between three events—
Fig. 1.5 Catalogue for the exhibition Venezuela, Midland Group Gallery, Nottingham, May 27–June 24, 1972.
A project that began life as a “Centre for Advanced Creative Study” had already been subject to gradual reorientation; the postwar reemergence of technologically fueled military violence added greater velocity to that process. A change in the perception of Latin America too, as actual place rather than as imagined territory, also played a role in shifting the sociopolitical perspectives of Signals’ members. In late 1965 Brett and Keeler went to Brazil for the first time, meeting both Oiticica and Schendel and visiting the viii Bienal Internacional de São Paulo. For Brett, this was the first of many further trips to both Brazil and other Latin American countries. Before this, Medalla too had
enthusiasm for the Caracas University City as a model
expressed a growing interest in the social context that
for collaboration between artist and architect remains,
informed the participatory nature of Oiticica’s work. It
but it has been tempered by time: “The introduction
was in conveying a received report of the first per-
to the catalogue seems to suggest that Venezuelan
formance of Oiticica’s Parangolé, at Rio’s Museum of
painters can regard themselves as a kind of charmed
Modern Art (an event that saw Oiticica’s collaborators,
race above the mundane affairs and difficulties of their
black members of the Mangueira samba school, ejected
country. This can hardly have been the spirit at the time
by museum staff), that Medalla first spoke of a “social
of the building program in the Caracas of the 1950s,
art” gaining specific relevance in Brazil.
even if that monumental scheme did have monumental
failures in the sphere of housing.”33
A changed perspective became increasingly evident
in the years following Signal’s closure. Reviewing an exhi-
bition of Venezuelan art at the Midland Group Gallery in
Medalla’s perceptions of Latin America was demon-
1972, Brett observes that none of the artists involved live
strated in 1974, when both were involved in the founding
in Venezuela, where “few options are held out for visual
of Artists for Democracy, an organization that placed
artists beyond producing works for a rich elite who are
postcoup Chile at the center of its activity. Within
not interested in experiment” (fig. 1.5). He also notes
Signals’ lifetime, however, the dawning activism that
that Soto has by now “over-produced and exploited his
would later more strongly characterize their attitude
original idea to the point of draining it of interest” and
toward Latin America was directed not toward the
that overall the show betrays “a certain feeling of com-
pernicious character of foreign investment in nations
placency about the area of visual sensibility that is being
such as Brazil and oil-rich Venezuela. Rather, the closely
cultivated, a tasteful acquiescence.” Brett’s continued
spaced brackets of Signals’ lifetime seem to contain
35 Everything Was Connected
The most conclusive change in both Brett’s and
a moment in which it seemed that the production of
with Latin America. This region’s artistic production was
Western Europe, the United States, and Latin America
at first apprehended, from London, as the emanation of
could be imaginatively connected, and unproblemati-
a brave new world. Through the later work of Brett and
cally so. The expanding territory of the kinetic formed
Medalla, a certain disillusionment generated changed
an imaginative corollary to the scientific and industrial
perspectives and far-reaching legacies. A turn away
advancements that also filled the columns of Signals’
from optimism, and the end of Signals, may be viewed
Newsbulletin. The violent implications of foreign policies
as the conclusive resolution of a collective stake in
stemming from the Cold War were not fully felt, and
kinetic art. The perspectives of other founder-members
political upheavals in Latin America were not immedi-
and outlying collaborators, however, indicate how this
ately intuited. Its imagining of a world in which different
stake continued to evolve along paths that both forked
regions of the West, old and new, North and South,
and converged. Both CACS and Signals had captured
might play equal roles, supported by an imaginative
ideas in the air that were regrouped later, elsewhere—
connection between new art and new science, was not
and not unchanged—by different centers, from
yet explicitly concerned by realpolitik—shaped not by a
Salvadori’s CASSA and Kepes’s CAVS to Willoughby
postcolonial consciousness provoked by a decolonizing
Sharp’s exhibitions and the Midland Group’s 1968–69
British Empire, but rather by the effort to maintain an
Mutation Phenomena shows.
untroubled sense of connection and possibility, up until
its necessary breaking point.
Signals used its position as a European-networked,
London-based center in order to develop a perspective
With the provocation and collaboration of the
In this chapter I have aimed to reconsider how
artists whose work it made visible, Signals London
on kinetic art that would reflect that movement’s inter-
cultivated a distinctive reading of kinetic art. This was
nationally dispersed character. Present-day interests
one eventually able to accommodate Clark’s ephemeral
have created a particular focus on Signals’ engagement
propositions and Oiticica’s socio-spatial interventions
with certain international centers such as Caracas,
alongside Otero’s stark white-on-white overpainted
São Paulo, and Rio de Janeiro, while downplaying
assemblages and Schendel’s use of transparency as
the significance of its connections to others, such as
a subtle means to activate two-dimensional surfaces.
New York, and to the North American continent more
Signals’ stake in kinetic art may appear distinctive solely
broadly. This approach mirrors Signals’ own refusal to
by virtue of its unique connection to artists from Latin
prioritize North American art explicitly but often fails
America. Here, however, I have sought to initiate further
to consider whether that strategy remains necessary or
connections and to reinstate relationships that lie closer
valid. Signals also rejoined tendencies within British and
to home.
across North American art and used new international
discoveries as a basis for proposing different readings
To restore such connections reinscribes the “con-
flictedness” within the narrative of Signals’ relationship
36 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
of canonical movements. In the wake of a repeated, and
now rather repetitive, focus on Signals’ foundational role
important legacies, including its capacity to locate and
in the international reception of Latin American art, it
regroup dispersed but connected practices within hege-
seems timely to strategically prioritize its other equally
monic nations.
Notes
1. Guy Brett in conversation with the author. 2. See, for example, Whitelegg, “Signals Echoes Traces,” and Barson, “Mira Schendel, Signals London, and the Language of Movement,” in Barson and Palhares, Mira Schendel. 3. Osborne, Anywhere or Not at All, 27. 4. Signalz: Newsbulletin of the Centre for Advanced Creative Study 1, no. 1 (1964): 1. 5. Circle: International Survey of Constructive Art was a 1937 publication edited by Naum Gabo, Ben Nicholson, and architect Leslie Martin. It was conceived in Hampstead, where Nicholson and others lived alongside émigré artists, designers, and architects from across Europe, and included works and writings by leading international constructivist architects and artists. 6. Paul Keeler quoted in M. G. McNay, “Laboratory of the Invisible,” Guardian (Manchester), April 15, 1965. Reprinted within the invitation card for Soundings Two, Signals London, July 22–September 22, 1965. 7. Signals: Newsbulletin of Signals London 1, no. 5 (December 1964– January 1965): 12. 8. John Gardiner, “Stop Press,” Signals: Newsbulletin of Signals London 1, no. 6 (February–March 1965): 12. 9. Lee, Chronophobia, 92. 10. Ibid., 93. 11. Ibid., 93–94 . 12. Ibid., 95. 13. Ibid., 125. 14. Gardiner, “Stop Press,” 12. 15. David Medalla, “Stop Press,” Signals: Newsbulletin of Signals London 1, no. 8 (June–July 1965): 2. 16. Signals’ expansive definition of kinetic art reflects the output of artists associated with these interconnected groups, whose nonfigurative work deployed techniques such as the monochrome, seriality, artificial light, and mechanical and virtual motion. Zero was founded in Düsseldorf in 1957 by Heinz Mack and Otto Piene, who were joined by Günther Uecker in 1961; the three used the group’s publication, Zero (1957–67), alongside temporary exhibitions to cultivate a collaborative network across various Western European cities. Members included Arman, Jean Tinguely, Yves Klein, Almir Mavignier, Jesús Rafael Soto, and Luis Tomasello in Paris; Lucio Fontana and Piero Manzoni in
37 Everything Was Connected
Milan; Antoni Tàpies in Barcelona; and Arnulf Rainer in Vienna. Zero’s activities overlapped with those of the Amsterdam-based Nul group (founded in 1961 by Jan Schoonhoven, Armando, Jan Henderikse, Henk Peeters, and Herman de Vries) and the Milan-based Gruppo T. Formed when four artists (Giovanni Anceschi, Davide Boriani, Gianni Colombo, Gabriele Devecchi) met at the Accademia di Brera in Milan, Gruppo T participated in the activities of the Azimut gallery and its review, Azimuth, founded in 1959 by Enrico Castellani and Manzoni. Castellani and Manzoni were featured in an exhibition at the New Vision Centre in 1960, and this London gallery also organized a Zero survey in 1964. See Hillings, Birnbaum, and Derom, Zero: Countdown to Tomorrow, and Huizing and Visser, nul = 0. 17. The exhibition Brasilia: Photographs and a Model of the New Capital of Brazil (June 11–28, 1958) took place at the ICA while Brasilia was under construction, before its official founding, in April 1960. 18. “Attendance,” Signalz: Newsbulletin of the Centre for Advanced Creative Study 1, no. 1 (1964): 1. 19. Lee, Chronophobia, 125. 20. Ibid., 95. 21. Ibid., 130. 22. Gardiner, “Stop Press,” 12. 23. Lee, Chronophobia, 96. 24. Ibid., 95. 25. Medalla, “Paris—London: Memories of the Sixties,” 16. 26. “Small Festivals,” Signalz: Newsbulletin of the Centre for Advanced Creative Study 1, no. 1 (1964): 3. 27. The Midland Group of Artists was established in Nottingham in 1943; begun as a membership-based organization for local artists, its gallery was by the early 1960s also operating as an internationally engaged forum for progressive and experimental visual art. Between January 1968 and January 1970, artist-member Michael Granger organized a series of four “Mutation Phenomena” exhibitions; the first featured Salvadori and Soto, and the series aimed to trace the development of a “concept language” from within visual language. In 1968 the Midland Group organized an unprecedented exhibition of contemporary Latin American art, Six Latin American Countries: Argentina, Brazil, Chile, Mexico, Uruguay, Venezuela, which included the work of Oiticica, Clark, and Cruz-Diez, among others. In 1972 the gallery
featured an exhibition of modern and contemporary Venezuelan art simply entitled Venezuela. See Neate, “Provinciality and the Art World,” 275. 28. Lee, Chronophobia, 130. 29. Medalla, “Paris—London: Memories of the Sixties,” 14.
38 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
30. Salvadori, “Fundamental Research,” 308. 31. Ibid. 32. See Drower, 99 Balls Pond Road, 8–9. 33. Brett, “Venezuelan Artists.”
2. 2. 2. 2. 2. 2. 2. 2. 2. 2.
A Porous Entity The Centre for Behavioural Art at Gallery House, 1972–73 Antony Hudek
For more than fifty years the London-based artist
project titled Control, a magazine he started in 1965
Stephen Willats has investigated the socially condi-
and continues to edit to this day.1 Because of Control’s
tioned ways in which artists and audiences interact
“meta-” quality, its identity and authorship have fluc-
with and through the artwork. The terms under which
tuated. The first three issues (1965, 1966, and 1967)
he has carried out this investigation have changed over
appeared anonymously; and while Willats’s editorship
the decades, from phenomenological, cybernetic, and
was clearly identified as of the fourth issue (1968),
behaviorist in the late 1950s and 1960s to community
the magazine’s status within his work has remained
based and socially engaged from the mid-1970s onward.
purposefully open. Willats has acted as both editor and
This has led to a difficulty in categorizing Willats’s work
contributing author, a dual role granting him a flexible
of the early 1970s, as it seems both connected and dis-
distance between each issue’s content and his own
cordant with that of other artists—such as Hans Haacke
work and allowing for a shared sense of authorship over
and Art & Language—most readily associated with
content without undermining either the editor’s or the
systems theory and conceptual art at that time.
other contributors’ autonomy.
Like much conceptual art, Willats’s practice may
A related project, as frequently overlooked as
be considered a metapractice, in that it focuses not on a
Control, is the Centre for Behavioural Art (CBA), an
subject deemed external to art but on the contexts and
organization Willats ran from May 1972 to March 1973
modes of art’s reception. Willats has recorded observa-
at Gallery House in Exhibition Road, South Kensington.2
tions on this meta-self-reflexivity in a too little-known
A space for documentation of members’ projects
and for regular guest lectures and seminars, the CBA
“Genuine Conceptualism” in Europe.6 While “demate-
acted as a “point of reference, or communication,
rialization” affected the move from object to ideas and
between artists and scientists working within the area
language, it did little to alter the ways in which art was
of [behavioural social sciences],” and as a place to
produced, discussed, sold, and collected, as Lippard
discuss “art practices that intervened directly in the
later remarked. The CBA, on the other hand, defied the
social fabric of society—practices that would transform
very structures of art making, distribution, and recep-
people’s perception of themselves and their social
tion, by fostering new modes of exchanges between
relationships.” Like Control, the CBA could be seen as a
national and international artists, scientists, and partic-
metaproject, involving other artists in a collective exer-
ipating audiences. The networks fostered by the CBA,
cise of knowledge production and sharing against the
although relatively short-lived, deserve to be acknowl-
“one-way authoritative networks that have dominated
edged as potent alternatives to the more mainstream
society for so long.” The CBA folded theory—in this
relations between conceptual artists, museums, dealers,
case cybernetic, behaviorist, and learning theories—into
and collectors, which have come to define conceptual
practice, creating a self-reflexive device aimed at trans-
and neo-avant-garde art in the United Kingdom at
forming the means of artistic and discursive production
the turn of the 1970s. The CBA itself warrants closer
from object focused and author driven to socially
scrutiny as a highly successful and prescient project,
engaged and networked.
anticipating “new institutionalism” and the spate of
artist-run initiatives and dialogical practices that situate
3
4
5
But the CBA was not simply a means for Willats to
import theoretical constructs borrowed from cyber-
themselves outside of the museum and gallery circuit.7
netics, engineering, philosophy, learning and teaching
theory into art. As opposed to this “outside-in” model,
was a product of happenstance, but the center was
Willats intended the CBA to be “inside-out,” bringing
hardly spontaneous.8 For years Willats had toyed with
art into communication with other social formations,
the idea of opening a multipurpose and transdisci-
from sociology to urbanism. As I discuss below, the
plinary venue that would serve as a space for meetings
early 1970s in the United Kingdom marked a shift
and displays as well as an “information bank.”9 In the
toward a more international awareness of contem-
early 1960s, before launching Control magazine, he had
porary art, and in particular of conceptual art derived
already attempted “to establish a research centre that
largely from North American models. In this context the
brought together scientists, philosophers, art theo-
CBA provides a compelling case for a pioneering form
rists and artists (mainly constructivists) to explore the
of social conceptual art that owed little, if anything,
foundation of a new art practice that could break out of
to the “dematerialized” practices theorized and sup-
the 1950s straightjacket and embrace the new ethos.”10
ported by such influential curators as Lucy Lippard and
Control fulfilled this function, reflecting, in Willats’s
Seth Siegelaub and to what Lynda Morris has termed
words, “the growth of what can be loosely called the
40 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
The CBA’s appearance at Gallery House in 1972
Behavioural Social Sciences (Behavioural Psychology,
Sociology, Cybernetics, etc.).” But while Control “[went]
a center for radical art in London, and indeed the
some way towards providing this,” there was “inevi-
United Kingdom. Rosetta Brooks, assistant director
tably a limit to its functions, and as a result . . . it was
and exhibition organizer, was instrumental in develop-
thought opportune to add to the resource level in this
ing new curatorial frameworks to accommodate the
area by establishing the Centre for Behavioural Art.”
artists’ often radical proposals, including her ambitious
The magazine would prove much more sustainable than
three-part exhibition A Survey of the Avant-Garde in
the center, but between 1972 and 1973 they operated in
Britain (August 18–October 15, 1972), long-term artists’
tandem: issue six (1971) included papers from artists
residencies (including Willats’s CBA), and the Gallery
who would become involved in Willats’s Cognition
House Press, which published Willats’s Artist as an
Control project (1972–73); issue seven (1973) featured
Instigator of Changes in Social Cognition and Behaviour
writings by artists connected to the CBA, including
(1973). At the time of her appointment, Brooks was
Kevin Lole, John Stezaker, as well as Willats.
a young undergraduate from Newcastle enrolled in
the English Department of University College London,
11
12
The CBA’s goal of expanding and diversifying the
Krauss was not alone in making Gallery House
production and reception of art was greatly facilitated
where she met the artist John Stezaker, whom she later
by its host institution, Gallery House, a nonprofit exhibi-
married. The apartment they shared in Paddington, not
tion space as ephemeral and unique as the center itself.
far from Willats’s studio, became a meeting ground for
Gallery House occupied an entire townhouse belonging
many of the artists who showed at Gallery House.15
to the German government’s cultural center in London,
the German Institute (now Goethe-Institut), which was
House, the latter had opened with three concurrent
located next door on Exhibition Road. Sigi Krauss, the
exhibitions, entitled 3 Life Situations, each occupying an
Gallery’s director, appointed by the German cultural
entire floor of the townhouse. Stuart Brisley took over
attaché in London, had operated a frame shop and
the ground floor, sitting in a wheelchair for two weeks
experimental art gallery in Covent Garden between 1969
in a “kind of filthy prison cell” visible to the public only
and 1971, exhibiting many of the artists whose work
through a letterbox slot.16 On the first floor Marc Camille
would later appear at Gallery House.13 Between March
Chaimowicz installed his immersive Celebration? Realife,
1972 and July 1973 the Gallery hosted a large number of
where visitors would encounter what appeared to
exhibitions, installations, performances, concerts, and
be the remnants of a party, with colored lights and a
other events by young British artists, as well as interna-
disco ball strewn on the floor.17 Finally, Gustav Metzger
tional practitioners (many of them German, but not all,
produced not a show but a series of participatory situ-
who had never shown in the United Kingdom), under
ations across Gallery House’s third floor. These ranged
the principle “never close, never charge admission, and
from a “media” room, where visitors were invited to
never censor artists.”
cut up newspapers and record themselves on tape, to
41 A Porous Entity
14
Two months before the CBA appeared at Gallery
documentation of his then unrealized Stockholm June:
Eventstructure Research Group, comprising another
A Project for Stockholm 1–15 June 1972, involving 120 cars
APG affiliate, Jeffrey Shaw, and Theo Botschuijver.21 The
releasing their exhaust fumes in a gigantic transparent
collaboration resulted in an APG-related project initi-
plastic container.
ated by Latham entitled Big Breather, a large-scale (and
ill-fated) model of a marine pump, first installed in front
Although the three artists were members of the
Artists’ Union—founded in London the same year
of Gallery House in November 1972.22
as Gallery House—and two of the three (Brisley and
Chaimowicz) had shown at the Sigi Krauss Gallery, their
nistic projects OHO Context and the CBA is a further
installations had little in common. This heterogeneity
testament to Gallery House’s inclusive exhibition policy.
would become a hallmark of Gallery House, as evi-
Latham’s project remained relatively hermetic, couched
denced in the second set of exhibitions, which opened in
in the artist’s typically dense language—“The art-work
May 1972. On the ground and first floors an In Between
proposed in this case is a long-term structural event in
Show featured works by Tony Rothon, Lesly Hamilton,
time”—with little room for public engagement.23 By con-
and Carlyle Reedy, while on the top floor two projects
trast, Willats’s CBA declared itself open and collective
were granted long-term residency, John Latham’s OHO
from the outset. The organization published a mission
(or OI-IO) Context and Willats’s Centre for Art and the
statement in Gallery House’s Newsheet, asserting: “The
Behavioural Sciences, as it was first called. Although the
Centre for Art and Behavioural Sciences has, as its
last two projects adopted a durational format, and both
fundamental concern, the furtherance of the growing
Latham and Willats shared an interest in the sciences,
interests in establishing relationships between Art
the similarities stop there. Willats’s CBA took the form
and the Behavioural Sciences,” thereby addressing, as
of a cross-disciplinary think tank, grafting together the
Willats put it, a “lack of any kind of facility for commu-
pedagogical freedom of Roy Ascott’s Groundcourse
nication/interaction between artists/scientists [who]
at Ealing College of Art and the scientific creativity
are engaged in it, and the growing number of purely
of Gordon Pask’s System Research Ltd. Latham’s
interested people.”24
OHO Context, on the other hand, could be seen as
a self-initiated work placement loosely based on the
nonetheless welcomed anyone ready to contribute to its
principles he had set forth in the Artist Placement
activities.25 An agenda for a CBA meeting on February 8,
Group (APG), in which artists were placed as remuner-
1973, invites members to “contribute to a research proj-
ated consultants in industry and government, often for
ect based on the cited issues [relationships between
months at a time. OHO Context was first established
the audience, the art work, and the artist], representing
as a collaboration between Latham and Andrew Dipper
their own concerns. The diverse nature of interests that
(who would go on an APG placement of his own in
members of the Centre have, if illustrated in their contri-
1974); the two would be joined as of January 1973 by
bution, would add to the construction of a significant
18
19
20
42 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
The proximity of the two in many ways antago-
Officially a members-only association, the CBA
statement that would be useful to artists generally, and
Thing Co. Ltd. insofar as the CBA was a genuine plat-
would help to define the area of work the Centre is con-
form for debate, not an institutional front for the artist’s
cerned with.” The CBA’s open-membership policy is
activities. And unlike Christine Kozlov and Joseph
further confirmed by letters written to Willats by artists
Kosuth’s Museum of Normal Art in New York and Tom
and researchers asking for permission to take part in the
Marioni’s Museum of Conceptual Art in San Francisco,
center’s activities—letters to which Willats invariably
the CBA was not principally intended as a space for
responded positively. For example, the self-taught and
displaying art, however immaterial.32
self-employed artist Howard O’Connor wrote to Willats
on October 12, 1972, offering to participate in any aspect
allowed Willats some measure of visibility from the
of the center; on October 18 Willats invited him to help
periphery of London’s art worlds in the mid-1960s,
paint a room at the center; by March 1973 O’Connor was
one could posit that the CBA afforded Willats the
exhibiting at the CBA, had given a presentation there,
kind of exposure no other institution would grant him
and had contributed to the seventh issue of Control
in the early 1970s.33 The increasing visibility of con-
magazine. The center’s mailing list contained close
ceptual art in the United Kingdom in the late 1960s
to fifty names, and one could assume, based on the
and early 1970s—less in public institutions than in
surviving membership forms, that approximately half
progressive commercial galleries like Lisson (1967),
were dues-paying, at a cost of £1 per year. Institutions
Nigel Greenwood (1970–92), and Jack Wendler (1971–
could also become members: the Library of the Nova
74)—made it possible for non-object-based art to be
Scotia College of Art and Design (NSCAD) and the
more widely seen and discussed. For example, Art &
Birmingham Public Libraries both requested to be part
Language began exhibiting at the Lisson in 1973, and
of the CBA.29 The center’s talks themselves attracted
Stezaker with Nigel Greenwood in 1972. But this growing
approximately ten people on average—an honorable
acceptance of conceptual practices remained largely
26
27
28
number given the specialism of the topics discussed.
30
As one of the major centers for conceptual-art
Just as one could argue that Control magazine
confined to process- and language-based art, not the behaviorist and social conceptual art that Willats was
teaching and publishing from the late 1960s to the late
pursuing. With the notable exception of the Museum of
1970s, with strong ties to both European and North
Modern Art Oxford, which hosted the artist’s first major
American (primarily East Coast) conceptual artists, it
exhibition, in 1968, and would continue to support his
seems logical that NSCAD would have taken an interest
work through the 1970s, British museums and galleries
in Willats’s CBA and, presumably, Control magazine.31
generally ignored Willats’s work.
At the same time, this interest is surprising, given that
the CBA was significantly dissimilar to most North
primarily as a means of self-promotion would be to miss
American artist-initiated conceptual institutions. For
its significance as an art project able to function both
instance, it differed from Iain and Ingrid Baxter’s N.E.
at the level of operational practice and as a conceptual
43 A Porous Entity
Nonetheless, suggesting that the CBA served
model.34 While the CBA was on the upper floor of
methodology and results.36 In the critical first phase of
Gallery House, Brooks also repeatedly included Willats’s
the West London project, the three women Willats called
work in the gallery’s exhibition program, suggesting that
the Super Girls were tasked with conducting door-to-
the artist was not solely reliant on the CBA for visibility.
door interviews in four different parts of West London
Rather, Willats’s adroit use of both Gallery House and
representing different social classes, from working to
the CBA allowed him to observe the neo-avant-garde
upper middle.37 Not unusually for the time and con-
art world from without and act upon it from within.
text, the allocation of roles in the West London project
Equally, one could argue that the CBA successfully
bespeaks a gendered division of labor whereby the
operated simultaneously inside the art world, as an
male artist-coordinator could enlist female partners and
artwork within Gallery House, and outside, as a distinct
fellow artists as assistants—in this case, Rosetta Brooks,
and collective entity involving as many art-world as
the artist Shelagh Cluett, and Willats’s then partner
non-art-world audiences. To borrow Grant Kester’s
Felicity Oliver—who also helped administer the CBA’s
description of dialogical practices: “in this act of spatial
activities (fig. 2.1).
dislocation the fixity of the works’ status as art is called
into question and subject to renegotiation in the rapport
it was divided into two parts. In the first, the partic-
between the artist and participants.”
ipants were made aware of their perception of their
35
One of Willats’s most important social projects
Once the participants in the project were selected,
existing social environment, through completion of
to come out of the CBA was the West London Social
task-based questionnaires compiled in the West London
Resource Project (1972–73), along with the similarly
Manual. In the second, the participants were prompted
structured but more modestly scaled Oxford Insight
to “remodel their environment in a way they felt that
Development Project (1972). “The multidisciplinary
they determined themselves,” this time by completing
discussions at the Centre were influential in shaping the
the West London Re-Modelling Book.38 After each of the
structure” of the West London project, Willats remem-
two phases, the anonymous returns were posted on
bers, “and a number of its contributors became Project
public register boards located in libraries near the four
Operators out in West London so they could experience
project areas, allowing participants to compare their
the methodologies of the work first hand.” Like the
own responses with those of the other three groups.
CBA itself, the West London project was aimed at two
audiences: “the primary one was the people living in
reached its primary audience, namely, non-art-world
suburban areas where it was considered most people in
groups living in the suburbs, the project would not have
society live, and for whom the machinations of the ‘art
been complete without engaging secondary, art-world
world’ were distant and unfathomable”; the second-
audiences. It achieved this mainly through the CBA,
ary one was “other artists,” whose practices would
where documentation from the West London project was
be affected by observing the West London project’s
shown and where Willats gave several lectures on the
44 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
While the West London project successfully
Fig. 2.1 Stephen Willats, West London Super Girls outside the Centre for Behavioural Art, London, 1973.
project. The West London project also featured in two
communities.40 Cognition Control involved students and
exhibitions at Gallery House: the first part of A Survey of
staff from Hornsey College of Art and Trent Polytechnic
the Avant-Garde in Britain (1972) and, six months later,
in Nottingham, where Willats had taught from 1968 to
The Artist as an Instigator of Changes in Social Cognition
1972, as well as artists from the Cheshire, Leicester, and
and Behaviour (1973), which Willats intended as “an
Loughborough schools of art. Although Cognition Control
externalisation of the Centre for Behavioural Art’s dis-
manifested itself in two exhibitions—at the Midland
cussions and research” (fig. 2.2).39
Group Gallery in Nottingham (January–February 1972)
and the Museum of Modern Art Oxford (October–
Alongside the West London Social Resource Project
and Survey of Distance Models of Art, discussed below,
November 1972)—its primary characteristic was that
Cognition Control was Willats’s third CBA-related
it took place throughout the city, disrupting its inhab-
project and the one that most directly attempted
itants’ daily life by staging durational interventions
to ground art practices within specific contexts and
that would invite audience members to adopt different
45 A Porous Entity
Fig. 2.2 Stephen Willats, The Artist as an Instigator of Changes in Social Cognition and Behaviour. Centre for Behavioural Art, London, 1973.
societal models.41 The first iteration of Cognition Control
minds as to just how decisions made on their behalf
was the most ambitious, aiming “to examine, test and
are in fact made.”43 Sanger was an active participant
perhaps affect the behaviour of certain aspects of the
in the CBA’s and Gallery House’s programs. A year
local community. This [was] to be done by actually
before taking part in Cognition Control, he founded the
going out into Nottingham, on foot, in mobile trailers,
short-lived art-theory journal Frameworks, which was
through supermarkets, via advertising and over Radio
based at Gallery House and included essays by Stezaker
Nottingham, leaving the Gallery to undertake back-
and Lole, among others.44 In this context Sanger’s Signs,
ground documentation and process reporting.”42
Grips, and Words can be read as a sly comment on con-
ceptual art’s struggle to substitute visual information
Among the projects in Nottingham’s Cognition
Control was Colston Sanger’s Signs, Grips, and Words,
with language, as well as an astute analysis of the com-
which considered the coded languages used by
municational challenge facing the CBA, which aimed
Freemasons in the city to “instil a doubt in people’s
to generate art projects that adapted to the language
46 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
of non-art-world “primary” audiences while couching
and cacophonous atmosphere of Gallery House, Willats
these projects in a sophisticated theoretical language
was able to create a sustainable environment conducive
indebted to behavioral science. The Freemasons could
to the exchange and generation of knowledge at the
easily stand in for “secondary” art-world audiences,
intersection of a number of art worlds that, within a few
who similarly rely on a coded and exclusive language of
years, would harden into more autonomous camps.
signs, grips, and words.
provided by the CBA stood in contrast to the progres-
Besides his contribution to Sanger’s Frameworks
The platform for exchanges between art worlds
sive streamlining of conceptual art in British public
and a presentation at the CBA, Lole displayed documentation of his work at the center and contributed an
institutions between 1969 and 1972. One can identify
essay on behaviorism to the seventh issue of Control.
with some precision the moment when conceptual art
Before coming to London to study at the Slade, Lole had
in the United Kingdom became associated with linguis-
been a student at Lanchester Polytechnic in Coventry.
tic and analytic art dominated by Art & Language—for
In July 1971, along with fellow Lanchester students Philip
instance, in the work shown in the annual Survey exhibi-
Pilkington and David Rushton, Lole founded and edited
tions at the Camden Arts Centre in 1969 and 1970. The
the journal Analytical Art, which ran for two issues. The
1969 edition of the exhibition, curated by Peter Carey,
three were studying under Michael Baldwin and Terry
included four artists—Timothy Drever, Ed Herring, Peter
Atkinson (cofounders of Art & Language with David
Joseph, and David Parsons—whose work responded
Bainbridge and Harold Hurrell), who also contributed to
to the specific sites where they appeared, either in or
the first issue of Analytical Art.
outside the gallery.48 A year later, Survey 70, conceived
by Carey but organized by Charles Harrison, marked
45
46
These exchanges between conceptual-art mag-
azines in 1971 and 1972 reveal not only the influence
the sudden rise of Art & Language and related artists,
of Art & Language and its magazine, Art-Language
with the inclusion of Terry Atkinson, David Bainbridge,
(launched in 1969 and merged with Analytical Art after
Michael Baldwin, Harold Hurrell, and Joseph Kosuth,
the latter’s second issue), but also the dialogues taking
along with Keith Arnatt, Victor Burgin, and Ed Herring.49
place between conceptual artists such as Lole, Sanger,
and Stezaker and behavioral-cybernetic artists such
the Hayward Gallery, that a major public institution in
as Willats—a dialogue informed and sustained by the
London first organized an exhibition of conceptual art.50
CBA. As already noted, Sanger, as founding editor of
Though slightly more pluralistic than Survey 70—with
Frameworks, took part in Willats’s Cognition Control and
the inclusion, for example, of Barry Flanagan and Gilbert
had lectured at Gallery House. Stezaker could boast a
& George—The New Art still reinforced the dominance
similar network of CBA-related ties, from publishing in
of analytical conceptual art.51 At exactly the same time,
Control and Frameworks to lecturing at Gallery House.47
Rosetta Brooks’s Survey of the Avant-Garde in Britain at
These overlaps suggest that within the heterogeneous
Gallery House did everything it could to diversify the
47 A Porous Entity
It was only in 1972, with The New Art exhibition at
range of conceptual art, by supporting not only Burgin,
larger transnational movement of conceptual practice,
Herring, and Stezaker but also Latham and Willats.
from which it stood apart.
As Nicholas Philip James puts it: in contrast to the
Hayward’s “general atmosphere of sanctified detach-
lineages different from those of its U.S. counterpart.
ment,” the events at Gallery House “were marked by
While the latter responded to clearly defined move-
a more ragged and sporadic quality of presentation.”
ments such as Minimalism and Postminimalism, which
Referring specifically to A Survey of the Avant-Garde
in turn responded to Clement Greenberg’s formalism,
in Britain, James describes the “sense of rivalry [that]
it was Ludwig Wittgenstein and analytic philosophy
spurred the organizers of the alternative survey,
that grounded Art & Language’s interest in linguis-
which openly challenged the criteria of the Hayward
tics and logic, while other forces gave rise to different
exhibition.”
non-object-based art practices in the United Kingdom.
For Willats, it was cybernetics and behaviorism that led
52
53
In an article entitled “The New Art,” published in
Conceptualism in the United Kingdom had to claim
the October 1972 issue of Studio International, Brooks
him from his phenomenology-inspired manifestos of the
reviews both the Hayward exhibition and her own
late 1950s to his “homeostat” drawings of the late 1960s.
Survey of Avant-Garde in Britain. She discusses the two
Thus, when Benjamin Buchloh, in his influential essay
exhibitions together under a set of common tropes,
“Conceptual Art, 1962–1969: From the Aesthetic of
namely, “the end of the avant-garde,” “a recent inter-
Administration to the Critique of Institutions,” narrates
est in time and temporal succession,” and an overall
a progression from phenomenological perception to a
“attempt to ascribe to art works a more direct meaning
linguistic understanding of the institutional frameworks
or function.” By comparing the Hayward exhibition
that condition perception, he adopts a U.S.-centric
with her own at Gallery House in the most respected
historicist genealogy that only partially maps onto
British contemporary-art journal at the time, Brooks
postwar art in the United Kingdom.56 By his own admis-
attempts to legitimize her curatorial work at the edges
sion Willats had no connection with or even firsthand
of London’s official art world. But her article also glosses
knowledge of Art & Language at the time of the CBA.57
over the qualities that made Gallery House, and particu-
Furthermore, when Willats was asked at the time by
larly the CBA, different from what was quickly becoming
David Briers if he was aware of Hans Haacke’s partici-
an internationally recognizable form of conceptual art.
patory ballot-box pieces—one of the examples Buchloh
It erases, for example, Art & Language’s early efforts to
invokes when defining conceptual art as institutional
steer away from behaviorism and cybernetics, and the
critique—he answered in the negative.58
group’s differences with Stezaker, who in his interview
in The New Art catalogue makes his differences with Art
Visitors’ Profiles (1969–73) operates very differently from
& Language explicit. More problematic still, Brooks’s
Survey of Distance Models of Art, a project Willats real-
article insinuates that Willats’s work fell in step with a
ized with Lole in early 1973 (fig. 2.3a and 2.3b). Whereas
54
55
48 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
Despite their resemblance, a work such as Haacke’s
Fig. 2.3a Stephen Willats, Survey of Distance Models of Art. Images sheet 1. Centre for Behavioural Art, London, 1973.
Fig. 2.3b Stephen Willats, Survey of Distance Models of Art. Images sheet 2. Centre for Behavioural Art, London, 1973.
Haacke’s piece was confined to the art institution where
conclusion of their surveys across both sites was that
the poll was taken, Willats and Lole’s survey was aimed
people, no matter how distant from the “art world,”
at demographics unlikely to frequent museums of
possessed “a model of art that was important to them.”
modern and contemporary art, namely, housing estates
However, this model categorized art for the most part as
in Coventry and West London. And while Haacke’s
decoration, “reflecting, or reinforcing what was already
questions sought to remind visitors of the contempo-
the intended function or sensibility for that domestic
rary social and political context in which their viewing
space, not as a means of communicating something in
took place, Willats and Lole took pains to understand
its own right, and certainly . . . not valued as a means of
the immediate contexts of those they surveyed, asking
communicating the artist’s intentions.”59
people to complete illustrated questionnaires about
their perceptions of art in their domestic settings. The
Art,” Brooks stepped back from her assimilation of
49 A Porous Entity
Several months after her article “The New
Willats’s and Stezaker’s work to the linguistic con-
already proposed “that a behaviourist framework can be
ceptual art of Art & Language. In this follow-up piece
constructed from which to examine, not only the inter-
Brooks makes a strong case for considering Willats’s
nal relations of modern art, but its social implications.”65
cybernetics-derived work as distinct. She notes that
at first Willats was “widely misinterpreted as being
ceptualism in the face of a widespread linguistic turn
a kinetic artist in the heyday of kinetic art” but had
evidenced in exhibitions like The New Art, it also sought to
been conflated more recently with the conceptualists,
uphold a more complex and socially oriented version of
whereas in fact, “unlike his contemporaries,” he “is
cybernetics than was presented at Cybernetic Serendipity
concerned not only with the conceptual framework of
and later promoted by the Computer Arts Society.66
art activity, but also with the social framework.”60 By
Willats was not a member of the society but was well
bringing up the confusion that often subsumed Willats’s
aware of its activities, in particular through George
light-and-movement objects from the mid-1960s under
Mallen, one of the society’s cofounders, who had assisted
kineticism, Brooks points to the kinetic-cybernetic
Pask in his contribution to Cybernetic Serendipity.67 In
tradition with which Willats’s work intersected but to
1971 Willats invited Mallen to participate in his Man from
which it was certainly not reducible. The person most
the Twenty-first Century project in Nottingham and to
responsible for promoting cybernetics, as embodied
contribute a text to the sixth issue of Control magazine.68
by machines, was Jasia Reichardt, who, as assis-
In 1972 Mallen not only took part in the CBA’s Thursday
tant director of the ICA, curated the well-known and
evening lecture series but also presented documentation
popular exhibition Cybernetic Serendipity in 1968. “The
of the project at the Oxford version of Cognition Control
main theme of the Cybernetic Serendipity exhibition,”
later that year.69 Finally, it was Mallen who facilitated
Reichardt explains in an article in the November 1968
the society’s support of Willats’s Edinburgh Social Model
issue of Studio International, “was the demonstration
Construction Project in 1973.70
of machine-aided creative processes.”62 Willats held a
very different view of cybernetics and was not included
London project, the Edinburgh Social Model project was
in the exhibition. In the same November 1968 issue
realized after the CBA’s closure. Under pressure from
of Studio International, Willats wrote in an article that
the German government, Gallery House shut down in
what mattered to him was the “controlled triggering of
July 1973, following a large-scale exhibition of German
creative behaviour within an area of randomness [and]
artists that turned into an anarchic occupation of the
the subsequent directions of behaviour within the area
building.71 Perhaps sensing Gallery House’s imminent
being self-determined by the receiver (viewer).” This
demise, Willats began announcing the CBA’s reloca-
view of behaviorism puts, in the words of Roy Ascott,
tion as of March 1973, at one point suggesting that the
“software over hardware.” In 1968 Ascott, who like
ICA might be receptive to housing it.72 However, by
Willats was absent from Cybernetic Serendipity, had
the middle of May 1973 the CBA’s activities officially
61
63
64
50 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
Just as the CBA foregrounded a more social con-
Though strongly related to the CBA and the West
ceased, forcing Willats to return dues to its members.73
hand, London’s art worlds in 1972–73 and, on the other,
The CBA’s last event, a “discussion on art and its social
socially engaged artistic projects by Willats and others
function,” took place at Willats’s studio in Paddington,
in places such as Nottingham, West London, Oxford,
presumably because no other space could be found. It
and Edinburgh. After the CBA’s closure Willats left
was an appropriate topic for the concluding chapter of
behind concerns for the art world as such, producing
the CBA, which saw the shift in Willats’s practice from
context-dependent projects that engaged directly with
one that was predominantly cybernetic to one that was
the audience’s behavioral patterns. As he wrote about
more behaviorist, and finally social. In an interview from
the Edinburgh Project, “this amounted to a fundamental
2002, Willats reflected on the center’s name, saying,
difference in the methodologies of the project and those
“We called it ‘behavioural art,’ but perhaps a better
traditionally and currently associated with art practice,
term would be ‘Centre for Society Art.’” “Society Art”
for instead of it consisting of an artist’s encoding of its
should not be taken to mean “sociological,” as Willats
concerns, it provided tools for the audience to encode
was careful to point out soon after the CBA’s closure:
its concerns themselves.”77 Gallery House provided the
“I think some sociologists might be interested in some
CBA with an ideal location: both within the most pro-
of the processes [developed at the CBA], because they
gressive art gallery in London and yet on the sidelines
should be thinking about them themselves, but the
of institutional art worlds of the period. Simultaneously
project itself is not sociology, and it’s not remedial in the
an embedded and a foreign body, the CBA managed to
way that social work is . . . [rather] it’s concerned with
create new dynamics between individuals who, after the
people remodelling their mental notions of their social
center dissolved, found themselves going their separate
environment, which also in a sense restructures their
ways and into the social.78
74
75
relationship with other people.”76
The CBA, one could argue, acted as a kind of
black box, a site of interaction between, on the one
Notes The author would like to thank Kevin Lole, Colston Sanger, John Stezaker, and Stephanie Willats for so generously giving their time and sharing their reminiscences, and especially Stephen Willats for the many conversations and access to his archive. 1. See Hudek, “Meta-Magazine: Control, 1965–68.” 2. Andrew Wilson is one of the few to have stressed the importance of the CBA, both for Willats and histories of the 1970s in Britain. See A. Wilson, “Audience Is the Rationale,” 43, 45. 3. Stephen Willats, “Editorial,” Control 7 (1973), 1. The CBA’s discursive program included talks by George Mallen, head of System
51 A Porous Entity
Simulation Ltd. and research fellow at the Royal College of Art, London (“Ecogame”); the mathematician and game theorist Robert Bell (“How to Keep a Secret”); Jerry Brieske, from the Biological Computer Laboratory at the University of Illinois; Chris Evans from the United Kingdom’s National Physical Laboratory; Slade postgraduate researcher Kevin Lole (“The Artist and his Behaviourality”); Trent Polytechnic lecturer Ross Longhurst (“Happenings and some Recent Trends in Sociology”); as well as artists Don Mason, Howard O’Connor, John Stezaker (“Two Instances of Institutional Determinacy in Art”) and Willats (“The
Use of Interactive Learning Systems by the Artist” and “Social Environment Modelling”). 4. Willats, introduction to The Artist as an Instigator of Changes, 11. This page number refers to a reprint of Willats’s original stapled black-and-white A4 publication, distributed by Gallery House Press—a name standing in for Rosetta Brooks herself, who typed out Willats’s manuscript. 5. Willats, “Clothing as Artwork,” 5. 6. Morris’s “genuine” conceptualism includes artists such as Art & Language, Gilbert & George, Jan Dibbets, and Marcel Broodthaers. See Morris, Genuine Conceptualism. Tellingly, Willats does not appear in Lucy Lippard’s otherwise exhaustive Six Years: The Dematerialization of the Art Object from 1966 to 1972. 7. See Ekeberg, “Institutional Experiments Between Aesthetics and Activism.” Grant Kester specifically identifies Willats as an influence on dialogical practices of the 1990s and 2000s. Kester, Conversation Pieces, 91–97. 8. “It Came by Accident Like Everything Does” (Stephen Willats in conversation with Emily Pethick), n.p. 9. Willats, “Centre for Behavioural Art.” 10. Willats in J. Wood, United Enemies, 33. Willats ultimately credits his father’s occupation as librarian as one of the earliest inspirations for the CBA. Willats, conversation with the author, February 21, 2015. 11. Willats, “Editorial,” Control 7 (1973), 1. 12. The project is often titled Cognition and Control or Cognition & Control. In what follows I adopt Willats’s most recent usage, Cognition Control. 13. See Walker, Left Shift, 70–71. Stuart Brisley, Marc Camille Chaimowicz, and John Dugger are among the artists who first exhibited at Krauss’s gallery before showing at Gallery House. 14. On the origins of Gallery House, see the interview with Krauss in There Was an Opening, n.p. John Stezaker remembers that Gallery House, reporting to the German Institute (now Goethe-Institut), was mandated to exhibit German artists. The budgets for U.K. and German artists were separate, and for the latter depended on the support of German galleries and institutions. Stezaker, conversation with the author, March 26, 2015. 15. Stezaker, conversation with the author, March 26, 2015. 16. Walker, Left Shift, 72. 17. Newsheet 1, Gallery House (March 1973), n.p. For a fuller description of Celebration? Realife, see Holert, Marc Camille Chaimowicz: Celebration? Realife. 18. See A. Wilson, “Art:Politics / Theory:Practice,” 135; “Artists’ Union,” 192; and James, Interviews-Artists, 76. 19. The Groundcourse and Pask are connected: in 1962 Ascott invited Pask to give a lecture as part of the course, which had a lasting impact on Willats, then a student at Ealing. Between 1963 and 1964 Willats worked at System Research Ltd. as a weekend assistant. See Mason, Computer in the Art Room, 60, and A. Wilson, “Audience Is the Rationale,” 31. See also Glew, “Transmitting Art Triggers,” 20, and Mallen, “Bridging Computing,” 192.
52 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
20. On the basic tenets of APG, see Hudek and Sainsbury, “APG Approach.” 21. On Dipper’s placement with Esso, see Hudek and Sainsbury, Individual and the Organisation, 22; “Gallery House London,” unpublished document, Stephen Willats Archive, Rye; and Hudek, “Staging Dissonance,” 322. 22. After the collapse of the first Big Breather at Gallery House, Latham installed another version several months later in the courtyard of Imperial College, not far from Gallery House. 23. Newsheet 2, Gallery House (May 1972), n.p. 24. Ibid. 25. Glew, “Transmitting Art Triggers,” 34 n. 45. 26. “Centre for Behavioural Art: Research Group meeting at 7pm Thur 8th Feb at Gallery House,” typed and annotated document, Stephen Willats Archive, Rye. 27. See the correspondence between O’Connor and Willats in the Stephen Willats Archive, Rye. 28. See the two-page typed and annotated list in the Stephen Willats Archive, Rye. 29. The forms for both libraries are in the Stephen Willats Archive, Rye. 30. See the letter from Stephen Willats to Ross Longhurst, July 19, 1972, revealing that George Mallen’s lecture attracted thirteen people, “three up on the one before,” in the Stephen Willats Archive, Rye. 31. See Kennedy, Last Art College. 32. On the Museum of Normal Art, see Morris and Bonin, Materializing Six Years, 119–21; on the Museum of Conceptual Art, see Marioni, Beer, Art, and Philosophy. 33. Hudek, “Meta-Magazine: Control, 1965–68,” 39. 34. In one instance Willats is introduced as “Steve Willats of the Centre for Behavioural Art,” indicating at least some renown attached to his function as CBA director. See Art and Artists 8, no. 5 (August 1973): 5. 35. Kester, Conversation Pieces, xv. 36. Willats, West London Social Resource Project Public Monitor, n.p. 37. Willats, “West London Social Resource Project,” 25. “The Super Girls,” writes Willats, “were especially important at the participant-gathering stage, completing more successful interviews than male teams by about 50%.” Willats, The Artist as an Instigator, 44. 38. Brooks, Survey of the Avant-Garde in Britain, 1:4. 39. Ibid., 3–7. See also Willats, introduction to The Artist as an Instigator, 11. In addition to the West London project, The Artist as an Instigator exhibition included material related to its smaller version in Oxford, the Oxford Insight Development Project (1972), and the interactive installation Visual Meta Language Simulation, first shown at the Midland Group Gallery in Nottingham in January 1972 as part of Cognition Control. 40. Wilson writes that “Cognition Control Project [was] set up in 1972 as an aspect of Willats’ Centre for Behavioural Art,” which is
not exact, as the Cognition Control at the Midland Group Gallery predated the CBA by several months. See A. Wilson, “Audience Is the Rationale,” 43; also Willats, Cognition Control, n.p. Through Sigi Krauss’s connections to the organizational committee of the Munich Olympics in 1972, Willats developed a project for the Olympics entitled Social Resource Project for Munich Olympics. In the end the committee decided not to support it, since it strayed too far from their desire to have artists “draw, paint, build sculptures or objects in front of the public so that the audience could watch the development of a work of art from the beginning to the end.” Frieder Weber, the committee’s artistic adviser, to Stephen Willats, June 19, 1972, Stephen Willats Archive, Rye. 41. Willats, Cognition Control, n.p; see also Mason, Computer in the Art Room, 76. 42. Press release for Cognition & Control, Midland Group Gallery, Nottingham, January 15–February 5, 1972, Stephen Willats Archive, Rye. The six projects in Nottingham were Mick Burrows’s radio project Mass Media People; Stroud Cornock and Ernest Edmonds’s interactive touring artwork Mind Rover; Jan Kopinski and Andy McKay’s game Minformation Is Coming; David Martin and Jack Shotbolt’s Behavioural Treasure Hunt; Willats’s Social Resource Project for Tennis Clubs and Visual Meta Language Simulator; and Colston Sanger’s Signs, Grips, and Words (see Mason, Computer in the Art Room, 159–60, and Willats, “Cognition and Advertising,” 288–89). Contributors to Cognition Control at Oxford included David Bugden, Don Mason, George Mallen, Colston Sanger, and Stephen Willats. 43. Undated typed manuscript, Stephen Willats Archive, Rye. 44. In the second of the magazine’s two issues, Sanger is listed as editor, and Michael Baldwin and John Stezaker as contributing editors. 45. “Art and Its Behaviourism,” Control 7 (1973), 3–5. For a mention of Lole’s presentation of material at the CBA, see his letter to Stephen Willats, December 17, 1972, Stephen Willats Archive, Rye. 46. Pilkington and Rushton had previously founded and edited the magazine Statements, also based at Lanchester Polytechnic. Kevin Lole, telephone conversation with the author, March 5, 2015. 47. Author’s telephone conversations with Kevin Lole, March 5, 2015; Colston Sanger, March 7 and 21, 2015; and Stezaker, March 26, 2015. 48. See Carey, Survey 69: New Space. 49. See C. Harrison, Idea Structures. Ed Herring, the only artist to have survived the shift from environmental to linguistic conceptual art in the Survey shows, was one of the more progressive artists on the faculty of East Ham Collage of Art and Technology, where he taught, among others, Colston Sanger. 50. “The New Art exhibition . . . was when the ephemeral and the transient aspects of English Conceptual art . . . were officially recognized and arguably recuperated.” W. Wood, “Still You Ask
53 A Porous Entity
for More,” 66–67. See also Sleeman, “The New Art, Hayward Gallery, London, 1972.” 51. See The New Art. 52. Burgin, Herring, and Stezaker were all included in the second of the three-part exhibition A Survey of the Avant-Garde in Britain (1972). 53. James, Scenes from The Gallery, 9. 54. Brooks, “The New Art,” 153. 55. See Bihari’s critique of behaviorism: “Marshall McLuhan and the Behavioral Sciences.” On the subject of Art & Language and cybernetics, see Shanken, “Art in the Information Age,” 436 in particular, and Mason, Computer in the Room, 141–47. See also The New Art, 111–14. 56. See Buchloh, “Conceptual Art, 1962–1969.” 57. Conversation with the author, March 22, 2015. 58. Briers, “David Briers Interviews Steve Willats,” 21. 59. Willats, Artwork as Social Model, 3D, 8B. 60. Brooks, “Behavioural Art,” 28. Brooks similarly seeks to differentiate Art & Language and Stezaker in “Problem Solving and Question Begging.” 61. It must be noted that Willats himself agreed to be included in kinetic-art exhibitions (such as Electric Theatre at the ICA, March 18–April 18, 1971) and publications (such as the special issue of Studio International, February 1967), as a means of being seen. Willats, conversation with the author, March 22, 2015. 62. Reichardt, “‘Cybernetic Serendipity,’” 176. See also Reichardt, Cybernetics, Art, and Ideas, 11–17. 63. Willats, “‘Stephen Willats: Visual Automatics and Visual Transmitters.’” For a description of these mid-1960s behaviorist works by Willats, see Mellor, Sixties Art Scene in London, 186. 64. Ascott, “Behaviourables and Futuribles,” n.p. 65. Ascott, “Cybernetic Stance,” 106. 66. For a discussion of Cybernetic Serendipity as uncritical, see Mason, Computer in the Art Room, 106–7. The official birth of what would become the Computer Arts Society took place on August 7, 1968, at the International Federation for Information Processing Congress in Edinburgh. See Ford, “Technological Kindergarten,” 168. 67. Mallen, “Bridging Computing,” 192. 68. Mason, Computer in the Art Room, 75–76. 69. For a review of the Oxford Cognition Control, see Conway Lloyd Morgan’s, “Cognition and Control Project.” 70. Following a methodology similar to that of the West London project, the Edinburgh Social Model project was meant to enable participants “to construct a self-articulated, coherent model of their relationship to [the] conventions” that govern “person to person interaction within different social contexts or situations.” Willats, “Edinburgh Project.” See also Irish, “Performance of Information Flows,” 462. 71. See the catalogue for the final exhibition at Gallery House, Some 260 Miles from Here; see also Krauss, There Was an Opening.
72. See Willats to “Alan,” March 17, 1973, Stephen Willats Archive, Rye. The end of the CBA must nonetheless have come relatively rapidly, since a letter from Willats to “Earling” [?] dated March 8, 1973 (Stephen Willats Archive, Rye), informs the recipient that a display of his or her papers will remain on view for at least a month. 73. See Willats to Graham Pullen, May 13, 1973, Stephen Willats Archive, Rye. 74. The “Discussion on Art and Its Social Function” was held on Thursday, May 17, 2:00 p.m. A recording of the exchange, which included Victor Burgin, Kevin Lole, Peter Smith, Nick Waterlow, and Willats, is in the Tate Archive, London. 75. Willats, Cognition Control, n.p. 76. Briers, “David Briers Interviews Steve Willats,” 23. 77. Willats, “Edinburgh Project.” Many years later the artist would phrase the shift in this way: “Instead of me going to a place with a kind of manifesto, a kind of model of what I want to do,
54 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
I start from zero and allow the work to informally develop its own framework through my connections and relationships with people.” Willats quoted in “In Conversation: A Conversation Between Michael Stanley and Stephen Willats, March 2007,” in Dean and Stanley, Stephen Willats: Person to Person, People to People, 14. 78. Shortly after publishing a special dossier entitled “Art Theory and Practice” in Studio International (December 1973), Sanger enrolled in the M.A. program of the Courtauld Institute of Art (Sanger, conversations with the author, March 7 and 21, 2015). In 1974, after his postgraduate studies at the Slade, Lole moved to Birmingham, where he ended up staying until 1980 (Lole, telephone conversation with the author, March 5, 2015). For Stezaker, the years of Gallery House marked a moment of exploration and drift, which would begin to resolve themselves only after 1975 (Stezaker, conversation with the author, March 26, 2015).
3. 3. 3. 3. 3. 3. 3. 3. 3. 3.
Mapping the City Felipe Ehrenberg in London, 1968–71 Carmen Juliá
A Disobedient Artist In the summer of 1968 a series of student protests
Mexico’s long-ruling state-party regime Partido
were fiercely repressed by the government of Mexican
Revolucionario Institucional (PRI). However, with the
President Gustavo Díaz Ordaz. A section of the army
Summer Olympic Games approaching, President Díaz
irrupted into two of the major universities in Mexico
Ordaz was determined to keep the protests under
City, the Instituto Politécnico Nacional and the
control. Thus, on the evening of October 2, ten days
Universidad Nacional Autónoma de México. Several
before the opening of the games, government troops
students were arrested, leading to even greater protests
were ordered to fire upon a crowd of unarmed students,
and to the organization of a network of university- and
workers, professors, intellectuals, and passersby that
high-school-student strike committees. Their demands
had gathered in the Plaza de las Tres Culturas in the
included the abolition of penal codes permitting the
neighborhood of Tlatelolco. The massacre marked
arrest of anyone attending a meeting of three or more
the end of the student movement. Over the following
people, improvement of working conditions, access
months, state repression escalated, and several hundred
to education, democratization of the mass media, the
people were imprisoned, forced underground, or exiled.1
end of governmental violence, freedom for political
prisoners, and accountability and punishment of public
then wife the artist and architect Martha Hellion (b.
officials responsible for the repression. The students
1937) fled the country and moved to England, where
soon gained the support of broader sectors of the
they remained until 1974. “The atmosphere was so
population, from workers to intellectuals, challenging
repressive by the end of the year,” Ehrenberg has
In November, Felipe Ehrenberg (b. 1943) and his
recalled, “Martha and I saw no other alternative than
figure who found his own connections by affinity and by
to say goodbye to our families. . . . we got on a plane
instigating collaborations and groupings, most notably
to England together with our two children.” Much of
on his return to Mexico when he became a leading
the organized student opposition had been articulated
figure within the Grupos movement.
through the production of posters, pamphlets, banners,
and flyers, which were distributed thanks to the printing
iment with new formats such as plastics, neon,
facilities found in universities and art schools. Ehrenberg
three-dimensionality, sound and body language, and
and Hellion took part in the student uprising with the
in 1967 he gave his first lecture-performance entitled
production of weekly bulletins that gathered information
Why I Paint What I Paint while standing at the top of a
on recent events. These were translated to different
ladder in La Pérgola gallery. He also took part in some
languages (French, Italian, English, and German) and dis-
of the most controversial exhibitions held in Mexico
tributed to international newspapers. They were part of
City: Confrontación 66 (1966), organized by the Grupo
an organized clandestine group (célula) working against
Ruptura—a group of artists whose only common denomi-
the strong control exercised by the government over the
nator was to differ from the official style of the Escuela
mass media. When the rebellion broke out, the use of
Mexicana de Pintura—and the i Salón Independiente
facilities such as mimeographs or photocopiers became
(1968), an artists’ initiative established in opposition to
high risk, and anyone caught using them was in danger
the control exercised by the state over art institutions and
of imprisonment. It was at this point that Ehrenberg and
to the exclusion of artists experimenting with nontradi-
Hellion decided to leave Mexico. “At the time,” he has
tional media.6 “Painful as that departure may have been,”
recalled, “I only spoke Spanish and English. My wife and I
he has recalled, “leaving home was probably easier for
decided we’d try our luck in England.” They were granted
me than for many other[s]. . . . I had been feeling gradu-
permission to stay in the country under “attenuating
ally more constrained by a very stifling and incestuous
circumstances” and for about two years had to report to
art scene, one which wouldn’t tolerate anybody ‘arting’
the police every week.
differently than the way things were being ‘arted.’ I was
already a disobedient artist and my incipient unortho-
2
3
4
Trained as a painter and a printmaker under “the
By the late 1960s Ehrenberg had begun to exper-
apprentice system,” in a printing shop run by a group of
doxy required an urgent change of scene.”7
émigré Catalan anarcho-syndicalists, Ehrenberg learned
from artists such as Mathias Goeritz, the muralist
direction of Ehrenberg’s work. First in London and later
José Chávez Morado, and the experimental sculptor
in Devon, he engaged in a series of activities such as the
Feliciano Béjar, as well as from his mother’s “marvelous
production of a number of conceptually based works
collections of what people call folk art.” The fact that he
exploring art and its contexts, Fluxus Happenings and
did not attend art school meant that he was to remain
performances, and the search for alternative means
outside generational groupings, always an independent
of distribution through the creation of independent
5
56 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
The experience of exile in England changed the
publishing and mail-art networks. “My production during
number of artists coming from different countries,
those six years,” he has noted, “consisted mainly of test
many of whom established themselves in the capital
flights, a giant collection of blueprints for what was to
for longer or shorter periods, evolving a dynamism that
come years later. . . . None of the work I produced in
found its driving force in “the interface between artistic
Europe dealt even remotely with the quality of a finished
innovation and transnationalism.”13 Between 1966 and
object; it was all about ideas.” Instigating what he
1976 the presence of artists coming to London from
referred to as “a rebellion against the art establishment
different countries in Latin America was quite remark-
scene [and] all those moulds that impose their specula-
able. The capital was host to artists as diverse as Diego
tive limitations on the producers and consumers of art,”
Barboza, David Lamelas, Leopoldo Maler, Hélio Oiticica,
Ehrenberg’s activities in England must be understood in
and Cecilia Vicuña, who came to London under very dif-
opposition to the establishment, the mainstream, and
ferent circumstances. They contributed to the hybridity
the institution, a resistance characterized by the loss of
of a decentralized and diversified local art scene that, as
stability that accompanies the experience of exile, which
Ehrenberg has recalled, “was generous, hospitable, and
translated into the improvised nature of his work.
curious,” thus enabling them to continue to experiment
In contrast to Mexico City, London appeared as
with their work.14 Institutions like Camden Arts Centre,
“the most exciting, stimulating and democratic place.”10
Whitechapel Art Gallery, and the ICA held exhibitions
The city was perceived as a place for experimenta-
of many of these artists, while alternative venues such
tion, traditional media were increasingly subjected
as the New Drury Lane Arts Lab, Sigi Krauss Gallery,
to critical analysis, and modernism appeared to have
and the Art Meeting Place became places to experi-
finally exhausted itself. According to Guy Brett, there
ment and exchange ideas.15 Community festivals such
were “exhibitions charged with energy which were
as Camden Arts Festival and the Festival of Life held at
memorable for the freedom they gave the artists to
Alexandra Park opened their works to collaboration and
experiment.” John A. Walker has described the turn
served to connect with local communities.16
of the decade as a “period of expanded materials/
media: instead of pigment and clay, many artists began
work. For example, after the tragic events in Chile of
to employ banners, bodily waste, books, concepts/
September 1973, Vicuña’s work became more politi-
language, flags, film, mixed media installations, mirrors,
cized.17 She was one of the founding members of Artists
patchwork, performance, photocopies, photography,
for Democracy, and most of her work during that time
photomontage, posters, the postal system, sound and
was a direct attack on Pinochet’s coup d’état. Oiticica
video.” “Dazzled by the swirl of new ideas,” Ehrenberg
experienced a period of transition, from works that
soon found himself on the fringes of an incipient art
were centered on openness and participation to more
scene constituted outside official circuits and, according
obscure work such as Nitro Benzol & Black Linoleum
to Brett, shaped by the movements of an increasing
(1969), a script for an unrealized cinema experiment
8
9
11
12
57 Mapping the City
In turn, the city had different effects on their
in which the artist instructs the audience to sniff
who had died, suffered imprisonment, or been exiled
nitrobenzol, recline on cushions covered with black
after the massacre of Tlatelolco.19
linoleum, and surrender themselves to the experience of free experiment while watching the film. In contrast, Barboza’s time in London provided an opportunity to
The City as the Stage for Art
experiment with a more performative approach to art, and influenced by Oiticica’s Whitechapel Experiment,
“Within a few months after arriving in England—
he embarked on a series of experiences or collective
wham-o!—homesickness hit me,” Ehrenberg has noted,
public actions that included the participation of pass-
and he recollects “gagging over the rat race for gallery
ersby. In addition, surveys dedicated to art from Latin
recognition, [finding] it very difficult to pick up what
America, such as From Figuration Art to Systems Art
seemed a chaos of loose threads. Soon though, some
in Argentina, organized by Jorge Glusberg at Camden
semblance of order gradually became visible.”20 The
Arts Centre in 1971 in collaboration with the Centro de
precariousness inflicted by his condition as an immi-
Arte y Comunicación in Buenos Aires, and Art Systems
grant, together with the dissatisfaction he found in
in Latin America, held at the ICA in 1974, introduced to
the boundaries imposed by the establishment and the
London audiences the latest developments in art from
traditional definitions of art and its contexts, made him
Argentina.
reassess his condition as an artist. In an attempt to
evolve new means of expression that challenged the
In 1971 Ehrenberg began to record the influx of
artists passing through London, publishing the maga-
traditional relationship between artist, work, and spec-
zine Documento Trimestral (or DT: Delirium Tremens, as
tator, he took to the street as an alternative location for
he referred to it), a platform to distribute the works of
his work, engaging in a series of activities driven by an
Latin American authors or artists living in or passing
increasing rejection of the object, favoring ephemeral
through England. The intention behind such an initiative
acts, and using his body as a portable tool—the only
was to build up a network of exchange between those
one he had left.
who, coming from different parts of the continent, “find
themselves in the very same geographic spot united
in which he found himself, the city emerged as a site
by the simple—mysterious—fact of being contempo-
of negotiation upon which to recode and rebuild his
In the process of understanding the new context
raneous to each other.” This was the first document
condition as an artist. “Instead of a studio space,” he
published by the Beau Geste Press, using a secondhand
has written, “anything can become the studio, a friend’s
Gestetner duplicator that Ehrenberg purchased shortly
house, a refugee camp, the streets of the unknown city
after his arrival in London. The fact that these machines
. . . instead of art tools and materials, any tool, any mate-
were banned in Mexico moved him to acquire one. He
rial.”21 Accordingly, Ehrenberg’s works in London are
regarded this “kind gesture” as a homage to all those
inextricably linked to the fabric of the city: to its streets
18
58 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
Fig. 3.1 Felipe Ehrenberg, A Stroll in July, or One Thursday Afternoon, or Half Day in London, or (The) Afternoon, or . . . Topology of Sculpture, 1970.
and passersby, to its infrastructures and institutions, to
the internal feelings and thoughts of the artist as well
its social reality, and, more importantly, to the artist’s
as the external aspects of his experience during the
experience of all of them.
walk. His notes read, for example: “Mementos (Hyde
Park 16:45) Mnemonic, Memory, Time”; “Time only is
In the afternoon of July 30, 1970, Ehrenberg left his
basement flat in Islington and went for a stroll. For six
memory and memory is what makes time (stoned)”; and
consecutive hours he walked through the city, “follow-
“Physical fatigue = My feet hurt” (fig. 3.2). The postcards
ing chance.” Later he documented the walk on a map,
give evidence of the action: “Its existence,” he wrote,
tracing with a red ballpoint pen the route he had taken
“was certified by the British Post Office in the form of
(fig. 3.1). During the walk, he methodically mailed to
five postcards posted at various points along the walk”
himself a series of postcards that incorporated found
(fig. 3.3).22
objects and debris he encountered along the way,
together with drawings and annotations that recorded
or One Thursday Afternoon, or Half Day in London, or (The)
59 Mapping the City
The work appeared under the title of A Stroll in July,
Fig. 3.2 Felipe Ehrenberg, A Stroll in July, or One Thursday Afternoon, or Half Day in London, or (The) Afternoon, or . . . Topology of Sculpture, 1970.
Fig. 3.3 Felipe Ehrenberg, A Stroll in July, or One Thursday Afternoon, or Half Day in London, or (The) Afternoon, or . . . Topology of Sculpture, 1970.
Afternoon, or . . . Topology of Sculpture (1970) and through
the artist’s experience of a time and a place and on his
it, Ehrenberg introduced a new notion of the sculptural
capacity to record this experience through postcards,
work as the documentation of both the physical move-
objects, ideas, and associations that would assist him
ment of the body and its emotional response to the
in remembering it. Ultimately, the work was a form of
environment. “If the definition of a sculpture,” he wrote,
self-documentation that acted in two different direc-
“is accepted to be the focusing of physical action/
tions: on the one hand, it indicated a direct engagement
movement by a mental/creative effort resulting in a
with the understanding of the new surroundings from
form, a walk is a sculpture.” The walk could be repeated
the position of a marginal figure, the foreigner, and on
by anyone accepting this definition; the route could be
the other hand, it was coupled with a desire to surpass
the same he had taken or a different one. However, as
the strictures imposed by modernist categories and
the artist stated, “the main bulk of the work, being of a
to broaden traditional attitudes toward the very same,
mnemonic nature, is subjective and thus not relevant to
primarily in the context of expanding definitions in the
this report.” Therefore, the work’s main focus was on
field of sculpture.
23
60 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
A few months later, on October 8, 1970, Ehrenberg,
works lacked the critical attitude that lay behind the
accompanied by a fellow Mexican, photographer
Situationists’ immersions in the city. The impetus
and theater artist Rodolfo “Laus” Alcaraz, embarked
behind them rose from his condition as a migrant and
on a nearly eighteen-hour journey on the London
the necessity to get to know his surroundings through
Underground, from the time it opened until it closed.
the physical inspection of the city and the behaviors of
Tube-O-Nauts’ Travels, a Voyage Under London (1970)
the individuals he confronted on the way. As Lucy R.
encompasses a great variety of documentation, from
Lippard has observed, a true sense of place is a virtual
underground maps, travel schedules, graphs, and photo-
immersion, rooted in live experience, political commit-
graphs to audio recordings of newspaper headlines read
ment, and a topographical familiarity.25 “Even if one’s
by other passengers, details of activities, and physical
history there is short,” Lippard writes, “a place can
and psychological changes undergone by the artists (fig.
still be felt as an extension of the body, especially the
3.4). The work adopts the shape of sociological research,
walking body, passing through and becoming part of
denoting an obsession with theoretical methodologies
the landscape.”26 This can be understood as a survival
to document the impact of the environment on the emo-
technique whereby visual and sensory experiences are
tions and behaviors of the individual, whether the artist
gathered in works that become the means to satisfy
or the passerby he confronts (fig. 3.5).
the artist’s need to find a sense of locality or belonging
within the newly found environment.
Cuauhtémoc Medina has observed some similar-
ities between Ehrenberg’s walks and the Situationists’ dérives—where chance is the guiding principle across the urban fabric—as well as with the work of Vito
The One-Eyed Look at Art
Acconci, Stanley Brouwn, and Richard Long.24 Indeed, the adoption of the walk as an art form in the mid-1960s
Ehrenberg considers artists to be a vital part of the com-
challenged modes of engagement with the experi-
munity. Inspired by an older generation including Diego
ences of daily-life spaces by scrutinizing the accepted
Rivera, José Clemente Orozco, David Alfaro Siqueiros,
definition of sculpture. The inclusion of a durational
Frida Kahlo, and Dr. Atl, all of whom he has described as
dimension in the work meant that the artist experience
“intensely political animals,” Ehrenberg defined artists
became the means to depict time and space. For the
as “the spokespeople of society.”27 “They’re not a part
viewer, this experience can only exist through the art-
of society’s superstructure,” he has noted, “[they’re]
ist’s recollection and therefore as projected imagination.
infrastructure,” and he maintains that art, and in par-
ticular modern Mexican art, is “especially committed
Ehrenberg’s walks shared some of the conceptual
strategies of his contemporaries such as annotation,
to cultivating our links to the whole of society.”28 The
the use of maps, and the fulfillment of a self-imposed
tradition of mural painting considered artists as active
activity within a series of parameters. However, his
participants in social change, for which the artwork
61 Mapping the City
Fig. 3.4 Felipe Ehrenberg, Tube-O-Nauts’ Travels, a Voyage Under London, 1970.
Fig. 3.5 Felipe Ehrenberg, Tube-O-Nauts’ Travels, a Voyage Under London, 1970.
served as a model and a catalyst. The conviction that art activity could actually influence people’s behavior and prompt a change in society led Ehrenberg to engage in a series of actions both to challenge the nature of the artwork and to alter the actual contexts within which the work operated.29
During 1970 he attended the printmaking class
run by the Portuguese artist Bartolomeu dos Santos at the Slade School of Art. Although he never enrolled, he was allowed to use the printing facilities. At the Slade he met Stuart Brisley, then a student adviser and tutor. Through Brisley he learned about the International Coalition for the Liquidation of Art, “a small cadre of dedicated revolutionary artists from Britain, America and other countries,” founded in Amsterdam toward the end of the summer of 1970.30 A network that moved away from a specific concern with making objects, the coalition’s main claim was to destroy all art in order to start a regeneration of the system of production and distribution. Underlined with an ecological concern in part inspired by the success of Earth Day, the coalition denounced an overproduction of art objects that were “polluting the world.”31 Art, they asserted, had been taken to “the end of the road. It is a static thing. The final result (and we really mean final) of creativity today is art pollution.” Accordingly, artists were summoned to
could be interpreted as a continuation of the Festival
“liquidate the art world by demonstrating at museums,
of Auto-Destructive Art and the three-day Destruction
galleries, and auction houses until they closed their
in Art symposium held at the Africa Centre in 1966,
doors. The artist must liquidate the art world by shut-
which created a series of “participation-situations” and,
ting down everything from art magazines to art councils
through artists, writers, psychologists, sociologists, and
because they were the tools of an irrelevant society.”
other scientists, examined the relationship between the
act of violence and the conditions of modern society in
32
In London the driving force behind the coalition was
Gustav Metzger, and to some extent his involvement
63 Mapping the City
an attempt to link theoretical issues of destruction with
Fig. 3.6 A Date with Fate at the Tate, or Tate Bait, 1970 (from left to right, Stuart Brisley, Felipe Ehrenberg, Sigi Krauss, and John Plant).
actual destruction taking part in society, science, and
noted; “the poor custodian was exasperated. He finally
art. Ehrenberg was particularly attracted to Metzger’s
asked me ‘but WHY do you want to come in like that?’ I
“Auto-Destructive Art Manifesto” (1959), which
said ‘Well, because I’m a work of art.’ And that’s where
proposed a new way of making art, so that it would
he found the perfect answer. He said ‘Well, works of art
dematerialize through its making, the object destroyed
are not allowed in the Tate unless by permission of the
as it was created. The intention was to leave nothing
Board of Trustees.’ He was right, of course, but with that
that could contribute to the marketization of art.
phrase by a Tate employee, I had been acknowledged
as a work of art! At that time, statements were works of
In the morning of October 20, 1970, artists around
the world were urged to “demonstrate their opposition
art.”36 Eventually, Ehrenberg removed the pillow from
to the present systems of art production consump-
his head and was allowed to enter the gallery where
tion and manipulation.” Under the current system of
the curators Ronald Alley and Michael Compton had
production and distribution of art, artists were unable
allocated a room for the coalition to carry out their
to connect with society in a meaningful way. Therefore,
demonstration. In 1971 Ehrenberg donated the sound
the only way out of that situation was the closure of the
recording to the Tate Archive under the title A Date with
hegemonic centers and the consequent abolition of the
Fate at the Tate, and a photograph of him standing at
concept of art that was heralded by them.
the entrance of the Tate Gallery with Brisley, Krauss,
and Plant was published with the title Tate Bait in the
33
“I suddenly became very interested in the idea,”
Ehrenberg has recalled; “they were going to hold a
catalogue of the exhibition Fluxshoe organized by David
meeting at the Tate and I thought, well, if I’m going to
Mayor in 1972 (fig. 3.6).
the Tate, I’ll perform the way people look at art, which
is with one eye . . . a one-eyed look at art!”34 He took
Brussels, Paris, and New York. In the latter city a number
a pillowcase and cut out a couple of holes, one for the
of American radical groups such as the Art Workers’
eye and one for the mouth. At the Tate Gallery—“the
Coalition, the New York Art Strike, Women Artists in
headquarters of the British Modern Art system”—he
Revolution, the SoHo Artists Association, and Citizens
joined Metzger, Brisley, Sigi Krauss, and John Plant with
for Artists Association occupied the Metropolitan
the intention of engaging staff and visitors in a debate
Museum Great Hall, demanding “a new and greater role
to demonstrate their opposition to “the commercial-
for the artist in society.”37 They condemned the insti-
isation of art, and other evils of society.”35 However,
tutional mechanisms of exclusion and the institutions’
Ehrenberg, who was wearing the pillowcase over his
complicity in racism, sexism, repression, and war, as
head, was refused entrance to Tate. He was carrying a
well as their political and economic dependence, which
tape recorder and engaged in a lengthy argument with
was disguised under an apparent status of autonomy,
the guard who would not allow him to go in. “A crowd
and made a number of demands: “equal representation
gathered around us and the cops were called in,” he has
for women, more opportunities for ethnic minorities,
65 Mapping the City
Demonstrations also took place in Amsterdam,
and the reduction in the elitism and power of major
complexities. I am the product of my place and time,”
museums in order to decentralize culture and resources
he has noted, and “I have felt it possible to affect my
to local communities.”
historic moment.”40 In this respect, the industrial unrest
that unraveled in Britain at the turn of the decade was to
38
In contrast, Ehrenberg’s action appears to follow in
the steps of the Situationists’ strategies to disrupt the
add another dimension to the direction that Ehrenberg’s
public order and behavior and to subvert the uses and
work was adopting in London.
constrictions of public space. However, his “one-eyed
look at art” was not intended to cause such disruption;
artists engaged more readily in the production of
it was aimed at exposing the Eurocentric universalist
collaborative work, community arts, participatory art,
gaze held by hegemonic institutions, such as the Tate
or art activism. The social and political turmoil that the
Gallery, that excluded non-Western art from their
country was undergoing, specifically in London, created
collections. Furthermore, the fact that he was refused
“a space for experimental art, particularly, art that could
entry on the grounds of being a “work of art” pointed to
utilize the detritus (both ideological and actual) of the
the connections between the dominant cultural centers
city.”41 For Andrew Wilson, the turn of the decade wit-
and an elite class that determined what art was. The
nessed the radicalization of many artists, who became
call for the destruction of the museum and the gallery
self-consciously politically minded, “reflecting a move
ultimately acknowledged that the arena where the
from an art that questioned the condition of art to one
encounter between the viewer and the aesthetic object
that questioned the role of art within society.”42 The
took place could never be considered a neutral space.
political panorama was difficult to ignore. The misman-
agement of the economy by Harold Wilson’s Labour
On a personal level, the repercussion that the work
According to Courtney J. Martin, from 1968 on,
had, both in the media and as the events were unfolding
government, as well as the increasing number of unof-
outside Tate, determined the direction his practice was
ficial strikes, resulted in the Conservative Party’s rise to
taking in London, abandoning traditional media in favor of
power in the 1970 general election. The Conservatives
experimental and unmediated art forms that could have a
inherited a weak economy and the same sense of social
direct impact on the reality that surrounded him.
unrest that had characterized the final years of Wilson’s
39
government: rising unemployment, labor riots, inflation, and the disruption of basic services such as sanitation The Context of Art
were commonplace throughout the decade.
In October 1970 Ehrenberg founded the Polygonal
Ehrenberg often regards his work as consequent to the
Workshop with the Austrian artist Richard Kriesche
context that surrounds him. His art is indelibly branded
and “Laus” Alcaraz, both living in London. They were
by his reality “in a multitudinous and imperfect soci-
later joined by the French film photographer Serge
ety, which is, nonetheless, fresh and powerful in its
Halsdorf, the Paris-based American film student Peter
66 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
Conn, the London-based American artist Roy Lekus, and
debate. Throughout the film the role of art is discussed.
the Austrian artist Rudolfine Well. “A short-lived but
“Art,” Ehrenberg states, “is anything that breaks with
very intense experience in group art,” the Polygonal
your programmations, anything that jolts you, pushes
Workshop defined itself as “an international group of
you, catalyzes you, out of a set mode of behavior.”
artists who work in coordination with each other.”44
For him, the accumulation of garbage in the streets
Kriesche and Ehrenberg were the driving force behind
proved that any creation achieves its own autonomy,
the group. They had met at the Slade, where Kriesche
and allowed him to introduce the difference between
was studying with a scholarship.
creation and art, which he regarded as opposites.
“Creation,” he states, “is organic, it is internal matter.
43
The Polygonal Workshop was initiated as a reaction
to a series of huge strikes by waste collectors that,
Art is a historic definition—a solidifying element. The
between 1968 and 1970, left the city’s streets piled high
trash should point to a way out of this ossification.”47
with decaying rubbish. In October 1970 Ehrenberg and
Kriesche started to record the rubbish-strewn streets of
than art, a concept that incorporated nonartistic ele-
North London in what became their first work together,
ments, such as the coordination of a complex system
the Garbage Walk, which is documented in the film It’s a
of activities that were occurring in a social reality and
Sort of Disease Part ii. In the film, Ehrenberg follows and
that encompassed people, places, objects, time, or
details the growth and accumulation of twelve piles of
detritus. The distinction between “creativity,” denoting
rubbish left in the streets. Edited by Peter Conn and Roy
the energy that drives action, and “art,” a term that had
Lekus at François Reichenbach’s studios in Paris with a
too many historical connotations to produce anything
soundtrack specially composed by Cesare Massarenti,
new, was further explored by Ehrenberg in 1973, when
the film was labeled “la poubelle.”45 Ehrenberg has
he wrote: “What allows creativity to transcend immedi-
recalled how the film was made: “We began to measure
ate communication is the conscience that everyone is a
the increase in trash, marking with white spray paint
mirror that reflects the demands of society, of their own
each pile of rubbish [fig. 3.7], and after using many rolls
context. One’s creativity concentrates these demands
of film and lots of spray paint, the strike was settled.
like a laser ray and turns them into symbols. And these
Then we were able to freely discuss matters, like the
symbols, re-ordered by intuition, by perception, sharpen
necessity to defining a relation between the artist and
the reactions of society and catalyse them.”48 Thus the
society, which inevitably influences the work. Everything
role of the artist becomes that of the catalyst between
was discussed in-depth, as our action was the result of
the individual and society and the tool to implement this
a social crisis: the strike.” The inclusion of a nonartistic
relationship is creativity. In November 1970, a month
situation in a clearly artistic context, in order to prompt
after beginning the garbage project, the Polygonal
a primarily social and political discussion, pointed to
Workshop organized a walk to follow the route marked
the very real possibility that art could engage in social
by the piles of garbage and observe the changes that
46
67 Mapping the City
For Ehrenberg, creativity was a broader concept
Fig. 3.7 Polygonal Workshop, Garbage Walk, 1970.
had occurred since they first marked their contours
in making public all the group’s notes, photographs,
on the streets. The tour started at Sigi Krauss’s frame
tapes, and transcriptions collected during the research
shop–cum–art gallery in Covent Garden, where maps
into the strike, what Ehrenberg later described as the
indicating the locations of the piles of garbage were
“vestiges of urban archaeology” (fig. 3.8).50
provided to the participants.
and the yellow room. In the latter, twelve packaged per-
In February 1971 the Polygonal Workshop presented
The gallery was split into two spaces: the workshop
to the public their first collaboration, under the title The
ishable goods were displayed throughout the duration
Seventh Day Chicken: Polygonal Workshop Investigates
of their decomposition, or, as the group explained, “as
Garbage, at Sigi Krauss Gallery. Ehrenberg referred to
they fulfil[led] their potential as rubbish.” The group
the exhibition as a non–art show, “an activity, an act of
recorded the transformation from goods to garbage, a
creation, but not an artwork.” It included a situation,
process that was intended to act as a “triggering device,
films, and other catalysts, and once again it required the
a catalyst, for dialogue between the public and the
audience to participate actively. The situation consisted
Polygonal Workshop.” In the adjacent room, they set up
49
68 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
Fig. 3.8 Polygonal Workshop, Garbage Walk, 1970.
an office, adopting an aesthetic of administrative and
art object had been transformed into an event, and any
legal organization. They produced an unlimited edition
sense of distance that had previously been maintained
of miniature rubbish bags, which were sold to help
between it and the audience collapsed into a form of
recoup their expenses, the intention being to demon-
exchange between the viewer and the artist that, in the
strate that if any art objects were to exist, they should
context of the strike, held the possibility for a critical
not be produced as commodities; instead, they should
reexamination of the self and society.
fulfill real and immediate needs. Accordingly, they
During the situation at Sigi Krauss, Ehrenberg met
performed an official transference-and-sale act under
David Mayor, then a student at Exeter University who
the slogan “You can buy your collaboration with us.”
was working on the organization of a Fluxus exhibition.52
People had to queue up and fill out a form and have it
He immediately identified similarities between the
stamped by Kriesche and later certified by Ehrenberg.
Polygonal Workshop’s activities and those of Fluxus,
The situation provided a way to fulfill the negation of
particularly the way the “situation” responded to and
any artistic or other form of prior categorization. The
questioned the prevailing social, cultural, and artistic
51
69 Mapping the City
climate, creating works that were ephemeral, interac-
circuits of distribution meant that artists could more
tive, and, to some extent, humorous. Soon thereafter,
easily establish their careers from the periphery. In 1970
in June 1971, Mayor invited the Polygonal Workshop
Kynaston McShine acknowledged this new situation
to organize a situation in Exeter, which was presented
in the catalogue of the exhibition Information, held at
at the city’s library under the title A Sightseeing Tour in
the Museum of Modern Art in New York. He wrote:
Exeter. It consisted of a series of oral and visual rec-
“Exchange with their peers is now comparatively simple.
ollections of the artists’ walks in and around the city.
. . . Increasingly artists use the mail, telegrams, telex
This was the first in a series of collaborations between
machines, etc., for transmission of works themselves—
Mayor and Ehrenberg; it was through Mayor that
photographs, films, documents, etc.—or of information
Ehrenberg first heard about Fluxus.
about their activity. For both artists and their public, it is a stimulating and open situation, and certainly less parochial than even five years ago. It is no longer imper-
Networks and Beyond
ative for an artist to be in Paris or New York. Those far from the ‘art centres’ contribute more easily, without
By the end of 1971 Ehrenberg had radicalized his position
the often artificial protocol that at one time seemed
against the mainstream even further, and pointing a way
essential for recognition.”54 Ehrenberg was aware of
toward regionalism and localism, he embarked on an
the new international networks of exchange that were
attack against London—and, more specifically, “against
being set up around the world through mail art. In 1970
London’s impositions (read New York, Mexico City,
he contributed to the iii Salón Independiente in Mexico
Cologne, Milan, etc)”—in the search for what he defined
City a work that made use of the postal service, Obra
as “little centres of activity that spring up outside and
secretamente titulada Arriba y Adelante . . . y si no, pos
beyond the borders of the enemy camp, using it rather
también (Work secretly titled upward and forward . . .
than being used by it.” “What actually ties artists to
whether you like it or not).55 It consisted of two hundred
the city?” he wondered; “high rents put a ridiculous
postcards that, when arranged together, made up the
premium on much-needed space, if it’s found. Privacy
image of a naked woman holding one breast with one
turns out to be loneliness, and the high costs of living
hand and a football with the other (in allusion to the
further psyches the artist into unnecessary—and what’s
football World Cup that was held in Mexico that year).
worse—distracting worries (neurosis is seldom the
The image was taken from an English soft-porn mag-
mother of creation).”53
azine printed on the occasion of the World Cup, and
the title made reference to Luis Echevarría’s presiden-
Decentralization and internationalism were major
aspects of the prevailing theories on the distribution of
tial campaign, in which the politician finished each
art. Increasing circulation of new formats and alterna-
speech with the phrase: “With the constitution of 1917,
tive networks of exchange that bypassed the hegemonic
upward and forward.”56 The phrase came to symbolize
70 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
Echevarría’s call for equality, better jobs, education for
acknowledged, became crucial amid the political prose-
all, housing for workers, universal health care, and land
cution and the oppression employed by the increasingly
distribution, all of which were lacking or nonexistent
repressive regimes in Latin America.59
in rural Mexico at the time.57 Ehrenberg’s coupling of
Echevarría’s words with an image of a naked woman to
exchange proved crucial when, in 1971, Hellion and
promote the World Cup was not only a provocative ges-
Ehrenberg finally decided to leave London after their
ture but also a firm repudiation of Echevarría’s populist
children suffered an episode of racial abuse. Encouraged
rhetoric, which could not conceal his involvement in the
by Mayor and the poet Christopher Gibbs, they moved
massacre of Tlatelolco. The inclusion of a reference to
to Cullompton, Devon. There they envisioned setting up
the World Cup ultimately pointed at the Olympics and
a community of artists and craftsmen who would live
at the PRI’s responsibility for the events at Tlatelolco,
together, working both independently and as a group—a
and it was also intended to expose the shortfalls of the
community that would stand against the institutional-
Mexican postal system. The artist expected the work
ization of art that, according to Ehrenberg, was to blame
to be censored (therefore the second half of the title,
for the limitations of artistic autonomy. Together with
“whether you like or not”). He instructed that the work
Mayor, the cartoonist Chris Welch, and his partner,
be assembled on a red board; therefore, for every miss-
Madeleine Gallard, they founded Beau Geste Press, an
ing postcard, a red space would disrupt the image. The
alternative press for artists’ books and other collabo-
art critic and Marxist theorist Alberto Híjar assembled
rations.60 “A Community of Duplicators, Printers, And
the work in Mexico, and Ehrenberg specifically asked for
Artisans,” he wrote, “Our Press is not a Business, It’s
the public to take part in this action.
a way of life.”61 The press used mimeograph to pro-
duce concept booklets and pamphlets, magazines,
Ehrenberg’s involvement in networks of exchange
These experiences of building networks of
preceded his arrival in London. While still in Mexico, he
and artists’ books in limited editions. They worked in
was a regular collaborator with the magazine El Corno
collaboration with artists who would come and stay in
Emplumado / The Plumed Horn, directed by the North
Langford Court South, the old farmhouse where they
American author Margaret Randall and the poet Sergio
lived. For Ehrenberg, collaboration was crucial, and the
Mondragón, a poetry magazine edited in both English
final product was always the result of a shared experi-
and Spanish and distributed throughout the Americas
ence: living together in Langford Court South.
and Spain, thus establishing a network of distribution
and collaboration between poets and writers that,
Carrión and Pepe Maya from Mexico, Claudio Bertoni
according to Cuauhtémoc Medina, can be seen as a
and Cecilia Vicuña from Chile, Riyoo & Hiroko Koike and
precedent for the constitution of international networks
Yukio Tsuchiya from Japan, and Kristjan Gudmundsson
of artistic exchange promoted by mail art and artists’
from Iceland, to name just a few. There were also col-
books. These were networks that, as Hellion later
laborations with British artists, such as Opal L. Nations,
58
71 Mapping the City
The press published books by artists such as Ulises
filmmaker Michael Leggett, music critic and composer
the periphery, near the university town of Xalapa, and
Michael Nyman, and the poets Allen Fisher and Michael
set up the press Libro Acción Libre and continued his
Gibbs. They published books by Ehrenberg and his
collaborations with Beau Geste Press until Mayor, who
children, Yael and Matthias, as well as seven issues of
was struggling financially to keep it running, moved to
the magazine Schmuck; collective anthologies dedi-
London in August 1976 and closed the press. In Mexico
cated to countries including Czechoslovakia, France,
all the ideas and experiences that he had developed
Germany, Iceland, and Hungary; and an unfinished one
in England took on radically different meanings and
dedicated to Latin America. Schmuck was compiled
applications. The experience with the small press, for
through mail-art networks and as such was regarded as
instance, turned into a social and educational project
a place for art itself, rather than merely for reproduction,
that led him to set up more than eight hundred collec-
commentary, and promotion.
tive community printing presses all over the country,
The independent press was a response to the
in particular in schools in rural areas, where he taught
uniformity in taste and the cultural monopoly held by
students to produce and distribute their own publica-
publishers, galleries, and curators. In a letter to Paul
tions. His experience of collaborative work with the
Brown at Transgravity magazine, Ehrenberg explained:
Polygonal Workshop paved the way to his involve-
“the main reason we (anybody) set up our press was to
ment, in 1973, in the founding of the Grupo Proceso
cut out all the grievous bullshit about submitting work
Pentágono—along with Victor Muñoz, Carlos Finck, and
‘for consideration’ . . . the act of submitting work of any
José Antonio Hernández Amezcua, an openly political
sort for the approval of any editor carries implicitly a
group whose members chose to call themselves “cul-
series of concessionary attitudes, detrimental to the
tural workers” instead of artists and whose works often
work.”62 According to him, art could influence society
denounced the political situation in Mexico—which in
only after the links with the market were severed, and
turn led to the development of los Grupos, and in 1978
the only way to achieve this goal was for artists to
he was a contributor to the Frente Mexicano de Grupos
regain control over the production and distribution of
Trabajadores de la Cultura Mexicana.64 Through these
their own work. “We work within the satisfying bound-
initiatives, Ehrenberg supported a variety of popular
aries of an operation sponsored by no one,” he wrote,
movements to address issues such as urban property,
“and thus not committed to any pressure but that of
repression, corruption, environmental destruction, and
meaningful survival.” Ultimately, the press provided
U.S. imperialism. In a letter to David Mayor, Ehrenberg
a space where artists could free themselves from the
explained his position: “Outside the art market is diffi-
expectations of the art market and immerse themselves
cult to make a living, but I am making the point, little by
in the making of their work.
little: recuperating control of one’s own production is a
key step in de-mediatizing our professional presence in
63
Ehrenberg remained in England until the spring of
1974, when he returned to Mexico. There he settled in
72 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
these dependent countries like Mexico.”65
Ehrenberg’s activities in London challenged the
with Fate at the Tate—a collection of encounters that
commercial approach to art as a commodity and
ultimately draw a portrait of the artist as a marginal
aroused many questions on single authorship, col-
figure trying to come to terms with his condition as a
laboration, and audience participation. His works
migrant and that led him to reassess his position as an
were characterized by a desire to remain outside the
artist. “I was working under duress,” he has recalled;
mainstream and to surpass the constraints of dom-
“nothing had prepared me to question the one thing I
inant culture. They remain inextricably linked to his
had never expected to doubt: my chosen profession, my
experience of London, which was materialized in an
role as an artist.”66
obsession with collecting, from the random annotations and objects he encountered in A Stroll in July to the recordings of his encounters with passersby in the Tube-O-Nauts’ Travels or with the authorities in A Date
Notes
1. McCaughan, “Signs of the Times.” 2. Ehrenberg, “1960 and a Bit More,” 162. 3. Students from the Escuela Nacional de Pintura, Escultura y Grabado, known as La Esmeralda, and from the Escuela Nacional de Pintura of the Universidad Nacional Autónoma de México were particularly involved in the production of posters and flyers that were distributed by the Consejo Nacional de Huelga (National Strike Council). They produced linotypes that were pasted in different locations throughout the city, and adopted a visual language drawn from the social-realist style developed during the 1930s by the Taller de Gráfica Popular, combined with the hard edges and plain colors characteristic of pop style, which allowed for a clear and direct message. 4. Asbury, Fraser, Iñigo Clavo, and Whitelegg, “Interview with Felipe Ehrenberg,” 3–4. 5. Gilbert, “Eclectic World of Felipe Ehrenberg.” 6. The i Salón Independiente originated in opposition to the government’s initiative to organize an exhibition (Exposición Solar) that, coinciding with the Olympics, would showcase the achievements of Mexican visual culture. The exhibition found strong opposition from artists such as Rufino Tamayo, Carlos Mérida, Jesús Reyes Ferreira, Gunther Gerzso, Leonora Carrington, José Luís Cuevas, Albero Gironella, Rafael Coronel, Enrique Echeverría, Francisco Corzas, and Rodolfo Nieto, among others. They found the criteria to select the work problematic, as it called for artists working only with traditional media and formats. The first salón opened to the public on October 15, only two weeks after the massacre
73 Mapping the City
of Tlatelolco, at the Centro Cultural Isidro Fabela, or Casa del Risco. Despite the student uprising, most artists participating in the salón did not align themselves explicitly with the movement, nor were they intending to boycott the Olympic Games. They were reacting against the government control over the criteria to define what art was. For more information, see García de Germenos, “Salón Independiente: Una relectura.” 7. White, e-interview with Felipe Ehrenberg, Stuart Reid, and Barry McCallion on Fluxshoe. 8. Ehrenberg, “East and West—the Twain Do Meet.” 9. Felipe Ehrenberg, Beau Geste Press leaflet, undated, Tate Gallery Archive. 10. White, e-interview with Felipe Ehrenberg, Stuart Reid, and Barry McCallion on Fluxshoe. 11. Brett, “Internationalism Among Artists in the 60s and 70s,” 112. 12. Walker, Left Shift, 7. 13. Ehrenberg, “East and West—the Twain Do Meet,” and Brett, “Internationalism Among Artists in the 60s and 70s,” 111. 14. Felipe Ehrenberg in conversation with the author, December 10, 2014. 15. In July 1969 David Lamelas, then a student at the St. Martin’s School of Art, was invited to take part in the exhibition Environments Reversal alongside artists such as Stuart Brisley, Marc Camille Chaimowicz, and Ed Herring. He presented his work A Study of the Relationship Between Inner and Outer Space (1969). In 1971, Leopoldo Maler organized the exhibition Silence,
which included works by other artists, among them Felipe Ehrenberg. In 1969 the Whitechapel Art Gallery presented Eden and Whitechapel Experiment, an exhibition by Hélio Oiticica, organized by Guy Brett. In 1976 Jasia Reichardt curated Mortal Issues, an exhibition of the work of Leopoldo Maler. In 1973 Cecilia Vicuña was invited to show a selection of paintings at the ICA in a solo exhibition entitled Pain Things and Explanations. 16. In 1971 Leopoldo Maler presented his work Crane Ballet at the Camden Arts Festival, the same year Ehrenberg presented his participatory work Chromoproject and Diego Barboza performed his work Centipede at Alexandra Park. 17. In September 1973 Chile witnessed the overthrow of Salvador Allende’s democratically elected government by a military junta led by Army Commander-in-Chief Augusto Pinochet and supported by the United States. 18. Felipe Ehrenberg, Documento Trimestral 1 (1971). 19. Felipe Ehrenberg in conversation with the author, December 10, 2014. 20. Ehrenberg, “East and West—the Twain Do Meet.” 21. Manuscript text of Felipe Ehrenberg’s talk at the Royal College of Art to coincide with their exhibition go away, London, April 22, 1999. 22. Felipe Ehrenberg, A Stroll in July, addendum, London 1970. 23. Ibid. 24. Medina, “Publishing Circuits,” 156. 25. Lucy R. Lippard, “Location/Dislocation,” paper presented at the Creative Time Summit, New York City, November 13, 2013. 26. Lippard, “Being in Place,” 34. 27. Ehrenberg, “East and West—the Twain Do Meet.” 28. Asbury, Fraser, Iñigo Clavo, and Whitelegg, “Interview with Felipe Ehrenberg,” 18, and Ehrenberg, “East and West—the Twain Do Meet.” 29. This conviction was further put into play when Ehrenberg ran for election as a member of parliament for the 36 Distrito Electoral in Mexico City in 1982 for the Partido Socialista Unificado (Unified Socialist Party). 30. International Coalition for the Liquidation of Art, manifesto, London, October 10, 1970. 31. The quotation is from ibid. Earth Day i was held on April 22, 1970, in the United States, where millions took to the streets to demonstrate for a healthy, sustainable environment. The event was followed by the passage of the Clean Air Act of 1970, the formation of the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) in December 1970, and the passage of the Federal Water Pollution Control Act of 1972. 32. Ibid. 33. Ibid. 34. Asbury, Fraser, Iñigo Clavo, and Whitelegg, “Interview with Felipe Ehrenberg,” 6. 35. International Coalition for the Liquidation of Art, manifesto.
74 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
36. Asbury, Fraser, Iñigo Clavo, and Whitelegg, “Interview with Felipe Ehrenberg,” 6. 37. Glueck, “Artists Vote for Union.” 38. Walker, Left Shift, 30–31. 39. A review of the event appeared in the Daily Mirror, November 1, 1970, 13, and a transcript of the conversation with the guard was published in Studio International 181, no. 931 (March 1971): 92–93 (i.e., Ehrenberg, “Date with Fate at Tate”). 40. Ehrenberg, “East and West—the Twain Do Meet.” 41. Martin, “Rasheed Araeen,” 111. 42. A. Wilson, “Art:Politics / Theory:Practice,” 129–30. 43. White, e-interview with Felipe Ehrenberg, Stuart Reid, and Barry McCallion on Fluxshoe. 44. Quotation from a card displayed at the exhibition The Seventh Day Chicken: A Situation by Polygonal Workshop, Sigi Krauss Gallery, February 4–20, 1971. 45. Gilbert, “Eclectic World of Felipe Ehrenberg,” 44. 46. Benítez Dueñas, “Restructuring Emptiness and Recovering Space,” 25. 47. Felipe Ehrenberg, introduction to Generación Ehrenberg, xvii. 48. Quotes from It’s a Sort of Disease Part ii (1970), 16 mm. 49. Benítez Dueñas, “Restructuring Emptiness and Recovering Space,” 25. 50. Asbury, Fraser, Iñigo Clavo, and Whitelegg, “Interview with Felipe Ehrenberg,” 9. 51. Quotation from cards displayed at the exhibition The Seventh Day Chicken: A Situation by Polygonal Workshop. 52. Fluxshoe was a traveling Fluxus exhibition conceived by Ken Friedman (Fluxus West, California) and Mike Weaver of the American Arts Documentation Centre at the University of Exeter. The exhibition was realized and coordinated by David Mayor. Marta Hellion designed the exhibition, and Felipe Ehrenberg designed the catalogue. It was held at various venues in Falmouth, including Falmouth School of Art (October 23–31, 1972) and the Arts Theatre (October 28, 1972), at Exeter (November 13–December 2, 1972), Croydon (January 15–26, 1973), Oxford (February 10–25, 1973), Nottingham (June 6–19, 1973), Blackburn (July 6–12, 1973), and Hastings (August 17–24, 1973). Fluxshoe became a platform for performances and events by artists with similar attitudes, whether they were allied to “official” Fluxus or not. In total, nearly one hundred artists took part in the exhibition. For more information, see Glew and Hendricks, Fluxbritannica. 53. Felipe Ehrenberg, Beau Geste Press sheet, ca. 1971, Tate Gallery Archive. 54. McShine, “Information and Culture,” in Information, 140. 55. The iii Salón Independiente was held at the Museo Universitario Arte Contemporáneo (MUAC) and was characterized by a lack of funds, which meant that all works had to be made in situ. The only materials used were paper and cardboard, highlighting the experimental and ephemeral nature of the works exhibited.
Exchange with international artists and openness to experimentation were the prevailing goals of the salón. In 1971 the salón was dissolved due to disagreement between its members as to how artists should manage their participation in biennials and other established circuits as well as the distribution and exposure of their works. 56. Luis Echevarría, of the Partido Revolucionario Institucional, was “secretario de Gobernación” (secretary of the interior) during the massacre of Tlatelolco, and his loyalty to President Díaz Ordaz secured him the presidency of the country in the 1970 general elections. 57. Soto Laveaga, “Searching for Molecules, Fueling Rebellion,” 90. 58. Medina, “Publishing Circuits,” 156. 59. Hellion, “Nineteen Sixty.” 60. For more information on Beau Geste Press, see Gilbert, “‘Something Unnameable in Common.’” 61. Felipe Ehrenberg, Beau Geste Press, undated document, Tate Gallery Archive. 62. Felipe Ehrenberg to Paul Brown, July 5, 1972, Tate Gallery Archive.
75 Mapping the City
63. Felipe Ehrenberg, Beau Geste Press, undated document, Tate Gallery Archive. 64. Constituted between 1973 and 1982 in opposition to the leading figures of muralism, los Grupos was an artistic initiative to question the role of the artist as a sole creator. It was promoted by a generation of artists influenced by the massacre of Tlatelolco who considered art as a catalyst to social change. However, their focus was not only on social and political issues; they saw the initiative as an opportunity to renew the state of the arts in Mexico, to reach new audiences, and to create new spaces for the production and distribution of art. Some of the groups formed during this period were Tepito Arte Acá, Proceso Pentágono, Mira, Suma, Germinal, Taller de Arte e Ideología, El Colectivo, Tetraedro, Março, Peyote y la Compañía, No Grupo, Taller de Investigación Plástica, and Fotógrafos Independientes. For more information, see Vázquez Mantecón, “Los Grupos: A Reconsideration,” 197–99. 65. Felipe Ehrenberg to David Mayor, 1978, Tate Gallery Archive. 66. Ehrenberg, “East and West—the Twain Do Meet.”
Restoring Some Period Color to Roelof Louw’s Pyramid of Oranges (1967) Joy Sleeman
Soul City (Pyramid of Oranges), 1967 (hereafter Pyramid
London art worlds of the late 1960s and also explores
of Oranges), is a sculpture by Roelof Louw (b. 1934).
how the multiple re-creations of the work in the
It is probably the work for which this artist is best
twenty-first century have both realized latent potential
known, though not the only kind of sculpture that he
in the work and led to misinterpretations of its original
was making, even in 1967. According to the artist, it
specificity.
is a work that could not have become manifest in any
city other than London, and yet it is a work that has
Lab, Covent Garden, in November 1967. The Arts Lab
been shown widely across Europe, the United States,
was a short-lived but influential art space located at
and beyond since the beginning of the twenty-first
182 Drury Lane, near Covent Garden market, a historic
century. It is simultaneously a work that is quintes-
location with market buildings dating from the nine-
sentially of its moment, enmeshed in the London art
teenth and twentieth centuries (it was London’s main
worlds of the late 1960s, and a work that has tran-
fruit-and-vegetable market until 1974). The original
scended that context to become an icon of conceptual
installation was described thus by the artist:
Pyramid of Oranges was first made at the Arts
art. Investigating its origins in London in 1967, its survival through documentation, and its apotheosis in the
The pyramid (5ft 6in sq × 5ft high) was built from
flesh (of around six thousand oranges) at the turn of
about 5,800 oranges. Everyone who entered the
the twenty-first century, this chapter resituates Louw’s
gallery was invited to help himself to the oranges.
Pyramid of Oranges in relation to the specificities of the
The sculpture lasted for two weeks.
4. 4. 4. 4. 4. 4. 4. 4. 4. 4.
Fig. 4.1 Roelof Louw, Soul City (Pyramid of Oranges), 1967. Tate Gallery, London, presented by Tate Patrons 2013, T13881. Installation shot from the Tate Britain exhibition Conceptual Art in Britain, 1964–1979, 2016. © Roelof Louw.
One aspect of the sculpture was the use of
context in which it emerged in London in 1967. Louw’s
material “on its own terms” to create an “affective”
other works from this period look very different in terms
situation. Another, was that it should relate to a
of formal means and materials. Their unifying rationale
specific place and the people that go there.
is sculptural, but it is neither materially specific nor tied
1
to a particular recognized theme or movement. This
Today the work is in the permanent collection of
has made Louw elusive in art-historical accounts of the
Tate, acquired in 2013, where it is catalogued as Soul City
period, but it also gives his work the potential to disrupt
(Pyramid of Oranges), 1967 (fig. 4.1). The work’s visibility
and reconfigure those overfamiliar narratives.
in the present obscures the diversity of Louw’s practice
when it was first made, and its designation as a work
Louw was a part-time tutor in the sculpture department
of conceptual art has the potential to misrepresent the
at St. Martin’s School of Art, on Charing Cross Road,
78 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
At the time he made the Pyramid of Oranges in 1967,
Fig. 4.2 Arts Lab, London, membership form and proposal by Roelof Louw, 1967. Collection of Biddy Peppin.
approximately half a mile from the Arts Lab. Louw had
West of London, not far from Maida Vale, was close to
come to London in 1961 from South Africa to study at
the Notting Hill area, where many artists lived in the
St. Martin’s and had been teaching there since 1966.
early 1960s.3 Just over a year after Pyramid of Oranges
Just before the Arts Lab exhibition, Louw had also
was exhibited, a short description (cited above) and
begun working in a new studio situation in Stockwell,
four images of the work in situ at the Arts Lab were
South London, a disused brewery building of seven-
published in Studio International, whose offices at 37
teen thousand square feet that doubled as exhibition
Museum Street, close to the British Museum, were less
and working space. On the application form for his
than half a mile from St. Martin’s and just a few hundred
“sculpture proposal for the entrance of Arts Lab”—a
yards from the Arts Lab (fig. 4.3).
pyramid of oranges—he gave his home address as 1A
Randolph Avenue W9 (fig. 4.2). This address, in the
and descriptions situate the Pyramid of Oranges and
2
79 Restoring Some Period Color
This set of coordinates, locations, dimensions,
Fig. 4.3 Roelof Louw, sculpture for the Arts Laboratory, October 1967, from Studio International 177, no. 907 (January 1969): 35. © Roelof Louw.
Louw in their originating contexts in London in the late
Nine Elms, Vauxhall, in 1974. Although the area around
1960s. However, they do little to articulate the complex
Covent Garden had always changed with the times,
network of interrelations and connections, national and
some kind of a market for fresh produce had been here
international, intersecting in this small area of central
since at least the seventeenth century, and produce had
London.
been sold from a garden on the site as far back as the fourteenth century.4 The Arts Lab was itself a new kind of space, a hybrid form under the artistic direction of Jim
Drury Lane WC1 to Stockwell Depot SW9 via 37 Museum
Haynes, who had also been involved in the establish-
Street WC1
ment of the Traverse Theatre in Edinburgh. Though its lifespan in Covent Garden was very short, its influence
In 1967 the Covent Garden area of London was slated
was significant. Arts Labs sprang up in other parts of
for change. In 1966 plans had been initiated that would
London and across the United Kingdom and Europe. At
result in the removal of the fruit-and-vegetable market to
its demise, in late 1969, Nicholas de Jongh, writing in the
80 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
Guardian, claimed it had inspired “forty similar creations
are often labeled the “New Generation” after the exhi-
all over Britain and Europe.” A young David Bowie
bition of sculpture of that title held at the Whitechapel
visited and rehearsed at the Drury Lane venue and was
Gallery, London, in 1965.9 Second, Louw features in the
inspired by its example to play a role in the creation of
survey of Stockwell Depot already mentioned, where his
an Arts Lab in Beckenham.6 It is not altogether fanciful
Pyramid of Oranges does indeed appear slightly incon-
to speculate that Louw’s Pyramid of Oranges, included as
gruous alongside the industrial-scale abstract work in
a contextual work in the David Bowie Is exhibition at the
wood, metal, concrete, slate, and plastic by Alan Barkley,
V&A in 2013 (and touring), might have been experienced
Roland Brener, Roger Fagin, Gerard Hemsworth, Peter
firsthand by Bowie in 1967.
Hide, and David Evison. Third, Louw plays a crucial
role in Harrison’s account of “some recent sculpture in
5
7
“Not much attention was given to this work at
the time,” recalled Louw, “except for Charles Harrison
Britain,” where his work is considered alongside that
prompting me, quite oddly, to include it in a photo-
of a group of younger artists, notably Barry Flanagan
graphic survey of Stockwell Depot sculptors in Studio
(b. 1939), Bruce McLean (b. 1944), and Richard Long
International in 1969.” It is arguable that the Pyramid
(b. 1945), all of whom would, during the following year
of Oranges survived beyond its two-week existence in
(1969–70), be included in seminal international exhibi-
the entrance to the Arts Lab thanks to Harrison and his
tions that would come to define the new process and
inclusion of this documentation in what has come to be
conceptually oriented work, including Live in Your Head:
regarded as one of the most important art magazines
When Attitudes Become Form (Bern, Krefeld, and London)
of the period. Harrison, critic and art historian and
and Op Losse Schroeven (Amsterdam), both 1969. Louw
assistant editor of the magazine, articulated Louw’s
was also in these exhibitions. In his article Harrison sums
centrality in London’s emergent sculpture scene in the
up Louw’s St. Martin’s connections thus: “Roelof Louw
special section “Some Aspects of Contemporary British
is another member of the group working at Stockwell
Sculpture,” which he put together for the January 1969
who belongs in age to the New Generation but who left
issue of the magazine. From this issue one gets a sense
St. Martin’s at the same time as Brener and whose work
of the artist’s multiple artistic identities at that moment.
relates more to that of the younger group.”10
Three guises are evident in its pages, and all three have
a St. Martin’s connection.
interrelated in the 1960s than is often assumed. Louw
may have been, even by his own admission, something
8
First, Louw appears as one of the sculptors contrib-
Those contexts were far more permeable and
uting to “Anthony Caro’s Work: A Symposium by Four
of a loner, but that did not preclude his participation
Sculptors,” considering abstract sculpture and theoret-
in a whole range of situations, including exhibitions at
ical debate around sculptural problems in the work of
public, commercial, and independently run galleries;
Caro. The other sculptors were David Annesley (b. 1936),
working in educational establishments and artist-run
Tim Scott (b. 1937), and William Tucker (b. 1935), who
spaces; and belonging to diverse artistic groupings that
81 Restoring Some Period Color
Fig. 4.4 Roelof Louw, Holland Park, 1967. © Roelof Louw. Courtesy of Richard Saltoun Gallery.
seem, from the purview of today’s established historical
the “dematerialization” of the art object with a work,
account, perplexing, if not contradictory. How could he
Holland Park, 1967 (fig. 4.4), made at the same time
be included in both British Sculpture out of the Sixties, an
that he was making and showing work alongside some
exhibition of work by established sculptors (curated by
of the most materially substantial sculpture produced
Gene Baro) at the ICA in August–September 1970, lam-
at the time at Stockwell Depot?12 These contexts seem
pooned by McLean in the pages of Studio International
somewhat antithetical. The fact that Louw inhabited
as “not even crimble crumble,” and, alongside McLean
them all simultaneously might suggest that the received
(quite literally in the alphabetically arranged catalogue
narrative of the development of sculpture in the era
that accompanied the exhibition), in When Attitudes
(that runs, roughly, modernist, Minimalist, conceptual)
Become Form, now considered a landmark exhibition
is either wrong or else inadequate to the complexity of
in the emergence of conceptual art? How could his
the situation that existed in this particular city, London,
work appear in the pages of Lucy Lippard’s account of
in the 1960s. Is the common view of the era “wrong? Or
11
82 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
not suitably nuanced? Or shaped by how subsequent
their work was visible, but they lacked the means to
histories played out? I think all three.
sustain a viable practice.
Many of the sculptors first associated with
Stockwell had studied at St. Martin’s in the mid-1960s St. Martin’s WC1 to Stockwell Depot SW9
and were slightly younger than King, Tucker, and Caro (most were born in the 1940s rather than the 1930s),
When acquired by Tate in 2013, Pyramid of Oranges
including Alan Barkeley, Brener, David Evison, Roger
joined another work by Louw, Untitled 1968, purchased
Fagin, John Fowler, Gerard Hemsworth, and Peter Hide.14
from the artist in 1970 after it was shown in British
Their work was often large-scale and abstract, using
Sculpture out of the Sixties. It was one of a series of
industrial-type materials. The attendant limitations
sculptures that Louw referred to as “space-frame”
imposed by the expense of fabricating, storing, and
works and was made—and photographed—at Stockwell
exhibiting sculpture had tended to make the slightly
Depot (fig. 4.5 shows another of these works). The
older successful sculptors dependent on a very limited
St. Martin’s–Stockwell axis was important to the
elite of collectors, a few art dealers, and the selectors of
development of Louw’s work, but it was also of wider
exhibitions in public galleries and museums. Brener felt
significance to the situation of sculptors in London.
that emerging artists needed to reject these precedents
Brener, one of the sculptors instrumental in setting up
and find their own ways of working. Stockwell was one
Stockwell Depot, was, like Louw, from South Africa and
way out of this impasse. Crucially, it gave sculptors
a tutor and former student at St. Martin’s. In his article
control over the means of their work’s exposition as well
“The Concerns of Emerging Sculptors” (also published
as space for experimentation in making. Stockwell was
in the January 1969 issue of Studio International) he set
an attempt at a practical and pragmatic way forward,
out the aims and aspirations for the new space as well
and at this early stage, despite positive responses to its
as the provocations for its formation. For Brener, the
first exhibition, Brener was hesitant to make bold claims
choices for emerging sculptors were stark and paradox-
for its potential to produce work of actual importance.15
ical. They were working “as contributors to a theoretical
In retrospect, we can see it as an early example of an
continuum dealing with accepted sculptural problems”
artist-run space, a situation that has fostered the work
while “forced into a radical position in their quest for
of many important artists in Britain. Stockwell gave
recognition and security.” The visibility of sculpture
sculptors the scope to experiment with scale and the
had been secured by the public success of established
relationships between sculpture and its surroundings.
sculptors associated with St. Martin’s such as King,
Tucker and the so-called “New Generation,” and, per-
experienced in terms of action, were factors that Louw
haps most widely known, Caro. Developing sculptors
felt sculptors associated with the “New Generation” had
such as Brener found themselves in a situation where
failed to come to terms with. When he first arrived at
13
83 Restoring Some Period Color
Scale and the articulation of space, particularly as
Fig. 4.5 Roelof Louw, Square 4 (Red / Light Green), ca. 1969. © Roelof Louw.
St. Martin’s in 1961, his work had marked affinities with
without any attempt at disguise or transformation—and
that of Annesley, Caro, King, and Tucker, whose new
in its invitation to viewer participation. The spectator of
abstract sculpture was in the making at that moment.
Louw’s sculpture “is invited to step over the low bar on
In its abstract formal means, the brightly painted metal
one side of the sculpture and experience the work from
sculpture by Louw, Untitled 1968, still shares certain
inside as well as outside.”16 This invitation was evoked
characteristics with work by this group of sculptors.
optically in some of Tucker’s slightly later work but
But it also has marked differences, particularly in its
never actively encouraged, as art critic Andrew Forge
direct use of materials—scaffolding poles used “as is”
observed in relation to Tucker’s Cat’s Cradle sculptures
84 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
(1971): “One of them—it is the one with a ‘Brass’ finish—
accounts argumentative) aspects, but his work featured
looks from a certain viewpoint like the framework of
prominently in the first two annual exhibitions at the
a small tent. From here the space is enclosing and
depot, in 1968 and 1969.
sheltering. You could crawl in. But this view is fragile: a
pace or two nearer or to the left or right and you realize
outset, much of it generated through “Brener’s flair for
that what you had seen was in fact a kind of drawing in
networking, combined with the prestige of St. Martin’s
space of this tent shape, an image which depended on
and the novelty of the venue.” One early visitor, invited
your exact position.” Tucker’s work is, as Forge notes,
in 1968 to the first in the series of annual exhibitions
“something like a highly condensed analogue for expe-
at the depot, was American critic Clement Greenberg.
rience” rather than an actual experience, as in Louw’s
“Greenberg praised Evison’s work, but confessed that
space-frame works.
Brener’s lay outside his critical faculties. Hide’s Sculpture
17
Stockwell attracted critical attention from the
Number 2 (1968) was condemned with the line: ‘Too Caro, rigorous geometry does not make rigorous art!,’ Louw’s Genius Loci, or Finding a Place to Work
while Louw’s Ring II (1968) [a work made from corrugated metal] was afforded a kick, and a mumbled, ‘Fuck
Toward the end of the 1960s Louw’s work had begun
American symmetry.’”19
articulating the physical limits of the space and of the
artist’s body, as well as the viewer’s relationship to the
of place beyond the walls, such as they were, of his
space and to other gallery viewers. Louw has spoken
open, draughty space at Stockwell Depot and making
of how he had no choice about his working space at
works that responded to the materiality and ambi-
Stockwell Depot—it was assigned to him—and it was
ence of place. When at Stockwell, he made extensive
far from congenial. He has described it thus: “The only
use of the availability of a large expanse of space, as
space available was huge and raw with exposed brick
evidenced in installation photographs of his contribu-
walls and an open steel roof structure. It was also open
tions to the group exhibitions held there in 1968 and
on one side. When it rained, there were always large
1969.20 He made variations of works using cast metal
pools of water. It couldn’t be called a studio, more a
and concrete, scaffolding poles, and objects he found
space where you placed things. I could just as well
lying around at the depot. He filled its vast spaces with
Louw was also quite literally taking his exploration
have been working out in the street.” The site’s liminal
festoons of rope and works made from large sheets of
nature, positioned on the edge of inside and outside,
corrugated sheet metal. But he was also developing a
seems appropriate both conceptually and actually for
practice on the outer edges in a more literal way, as his
the artist and the development of his work at this point.
work was taking him out of the studio and exhibition
Louw did not spend a great deal of time at Stockwell or
space altogether to make works in urban parkland and
involve himself extensively in its more social (and by all
directly in the streets. For example, in 1968 Louw made
18
85 Restoring Some Period Color
a piece with cast-iron wedges arranged around two
Depot—a rope piece—which would be attached to the
blocks of buildings in London’s Park Lane, photographs
roof ties in the upper space at Oxford’s Museum of
of which were shown in the exhibition When Attitudes
Modern Art. But not long before the exhibition was due
Become Form at Bern in 1969. Photography was one way
to open, he changed his proposal to a work using vari-
of providing information about a work, but there was
ously tensioned industrial-scale rubber bands attached
also considerable ambiguity (and debate) about the
around the gallery walls. The installation, which Louw
status of photographs as original works in their own
called Location, had a palpable effect on viewers, with
right or as documentation. In the first showing of When
one reviewer noting that, “like a massive tourniquet
Attitudes Become Form, in Bern, large-scale photo-
round your eyes, this stark black ribbon is inescapable.
graphic prints of Louw’s Park Lane work were shown in
Some visitors, they say, have been terrified.”23 The affec-
the gallery space; in subsequent showings in Krefeld
tive quality of the work, with a direct use of materials
and London they were included as “information” in the
“as is” (in this case rubber bands attached to the walls),
exhibition catalogue. The work thus existed simultane-
seems very close to, and indeed a direct development
ously as a photographic piece and as documentation of
of, the situation Louw aimed to create with Pyramid of
a work executed in situ in a London street. Louw wrote
Oranges at the Arts Lab.
to the curator of the show, Harald Szeemann, about
this piece as “a work I would in particular like you to
sought actively to engage viewers in articulating the
consider for inclusion in the exhibition in either actual,
work in the space. For example, in the Wall Show at the
documentation [large photographic enlargements]
Lisson Gallery in 1970–71, Louw pasted instructions,
or a combination of both forms (there are various
Exercises 3, on the wall, directing the movements of
possibilities).”21
viewers.24 At the same time, he began developing a
series of “Tape Recorder Scripts,” first realized at the
In a 1974 interview Louw made more explicit
Other works had less of a material presence and
the connection between his activities and an older,
Whitechapel Art Gallery in February–March 1971.25
eighteenth-century notion of “genius loci”—or the
Scripts were recorded and played back in the space
genius of the place—by which he attempted to make
where they had been recorded. In what came to be
a work that both reflected and articulated, or perhaps
known as the “Sound Recorder Works,” viewers in the
emphasized, the unique character of a given location.
space had become not only participants in an exhibition
22
It was a small step from there to include the material
situation but also Louw’s sculptural material. These
components of the place directly in the work—the street
works too had an origin at Stockwell, where Louw first
furniture and pavements of city roads, the grassy knolls
experimented with a reel-to-reel tape recorder. He
and trees of urban parkland, or the walls, floor, and
recorded himself and others moving around the space,
viewers in a gallery situation. In 1969 Louw proposed
making simple statements such as “I’m here” or “I’m
a version of a work that he had first made at Stockwell
moving to the other side of the room,” noting the way
86 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
that the sounds were picked up by the microphone on
rather than the crafting of a signature “style” or the use
the recording device.
of a particular material. Importantly, it also complicates
26
Louw’s idea of “genius loci” is not a place-bound
narratives of stylistic or generational succession, a
reverie (as the term is sometimes used in relation to
model that persists in the history of British sculpture
earlier twentieth-century British art) but a more active
even though these sculptural stories were active simul-
engagement with the contingencies of lived locations.
taneously, even in the work of one artist. No doubt the
He has described it as “a kind of ‘poetic’ or ‘aphoristic’
different scenes were combative, often defining them-
response to commonplace places that were around,
selves negatively in relation to one another, but they did
that could be experienced almost anywhere.” Louw’s
not negate one another in chronological succession. As
notion refers both to the affective qualities of a site and
noted, Louw’s Untitled 1968, made from brightly painted
to the activities of people, whether they are workers,
scaffolding poles in a frame-like configuration, had
gallery-goers, passersby, or Mayfair club-goers on their
seemingly close affinities to the constructed abstract
way home from a night out in the West End of London.
sculpture of the “New Generation” but was made the
It can be seen largely to have developed through the
year after Pyramid of Oranges and Holland Park, and even
artist’s movements around London locations in and
taken together, these works are far from representative
between his home, St. Martin’s School of Art, where he
of the full range of work made by the artist during the
taught, Stockwell Depot, and the Arts Lab in 1967.
short time he was working at Stockwell Depot, or even
during the year that he began working at Stockwell,
27
How did his work’s passage through that time and
place reconfigure those locales, leaving a traceable
1967. But Pyramid of Oranges has transcended its original
resonance that could continue to act long after the
moment in a way that, as yet, the metal “space-frame”
artist’s trajectory had had taken him elsewhere? Can
works have not. Pyramid of Oranges has become a
we reconnect to that milieu via his work as present to
work of significance in the twenty-first century, shown
us now? If Louw’s work was successful in capturing the
repeatedly throughout the United Kingdom and world-
spirit of place, as it set out to do, can we intuit that spirit
wide, as well as referenced and imitated by younger
in re-creating and reviewing the work in the present? And
artists.28
how does a specific place impact upon and redirect the career path of an individual artist in a way that exceeds its geographic limits? These questions seem especially rele-
Arts Lab WC1 to Whitechapel Art Gallery E1: “Live in Your Head”
vant to an artist who acknowledges a commitment in his work to responding to the spirit of place (or genius loci).
The current visibility of Pyramid of Oranges owes much
to a significant re-creation of the work at London’s
That Louw was making such different kinds of
sculpture at the same time attests to his own manner
Whitechapel Art Gallery in 2000, as part of the exhibi-
of working, a responsiveness to place and situation
tion Live in Your Head: Concept and Experiment in Britain,
87 Restoring Some Period Color
1965–75. This installation of the work realized aspects
that were latent in its original conception. Long pre-
Louw (the artist) in a way that was more in keeping
served in the pages of Studio International, its material
with current understandings of the global contexts of
repeatability was possible because of the published
modern and contemporary British art. In the twenty-first
set of precise specifications. Remade, the work was
century Louw is a South African artist who worked
transubstantiated from dry, black-and-white concep-
in London during the 1960s and early 1970s. Back in
tual documentation into a lucid, colorful, and sensual
the 1960s he was a sculptor teaching at St. Martin’s
experience.
and working at Stockwell Depot. This difference—his
By re-creating the work “live” rather than showing
the photographic images that documented its 1967 exhibition, the Whitechapel’s Live in Your Head exhibition insisted on the sculptural quality of the work. It was not only a conceptual work. It was this repetition of the Pyramid of Oranges that established the “original” work as capable of being repeated in other-than-documentary form. The 2000 Soul City (Pyramid of Oranges) was the 1967 Pyramid of Oranges, but the 2000 Pyramid of Oranges was also different, or perhaps made by an artist who was now perceived differently.
The Whitechapel re-creation somewhat paradox-
ically liberated the work from being a one-off original made in a particular place, in London during 1967, and enabled it to become one that could be repeated in different locations around the world. But it also retrospectively reconfigured that “origin” into some-
The accompanying catalogue also differentiated
difference—is important in the current context, just as his assimilation was important in the first instance. As Michael Archer wrote in his catalogue essay for Live in Your Head: “The idea that geographical boundaries were not relevant to an analysis of the various artistic forms, approaches and tendencies of the period, was by that time (1972) a given. Whichever country an artist came from, his or her work was, in the main, understood as a contribution to a wider investigation into the possibilities of art.”29
In an interview with Jon Wood in August 2010,
Wood attempted to attribute a particular South African relevance to Pyramid of Oranges, which was immediately rebuffed by the artist: jw: Given everything you’ve said about site specificity up to this point and you make a nice connection between Covent Garden and then the arts labora-
thing that incorporated reproducibility into its very
tory in Covent Garden, the oranges, I also can’t help
conception. Each subsequent repetition now repeats
thinking about South Africa with oranges and I think
the origin of the work in London’s Arts Lab in Covent
once you talked about the food for hippies, there
Garden in 1967 but also incorporates the fact of its
seem to be lots of other levels on which this work
re-creation in 2000, the gesture that freed the work
operates.
from being a one-off original made in a particular place and time.
88 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
rl: Well the sunshine reference is built into the work. But I don’t think I consciously had South Africa
in mind when I chose oranges. In 1961 I became a
After all, the work proposed its own destruction. This
British subject, and by this time even a bit English.
may seem dissonant with the narrative of Pyramid of
Let me just push this point. All my thinking about
Oranges as a vibrant image of Swinging London, but
sculpture was embedded in what was going on at St.
the possibility of there being a darker shade to Oranges
Martin’s and the London art scene. In formal terms,
seems more plausible when taken together with a
I can’t imagine this work having become manifest in
number of fragments of contemporary documentation
any other city.
and the artist’s own more recent commentary.
30
The first hint is contained in Louw’s initial pro-
The multiple presences of Pyramid of Oranges in the
posal to the Arts Lab, where he asserts that his orange
twenty-first century have tended to sever the work
pyramid is “not a joke.” This might be construed as the
(or to liberate it) from the specific context of London,
artist’s insistence that his proposal was genuine and
from the experience of London at a particular moment
that he did intend to make the work as described, with-
in time, and from the work’s contribution to a theoret-
out expense to the Arts Lab, the artist paying for the
ical continuum dealing with sculptural problems, all of
purchase of the oranges that formed the work. But was
which were crucial to its original making. A closer look
it also “not a joke” in that it had a more serious aspect?
at both the original installation of Pyramid of Oranges
An exchange about the Pyramid of Oranges in his inter-
at the Arts Lab in 1967 and its more recent apotheosis
view with Wood in 2010 speaks of Louw’s interest in the
at the Whitechapel Art Gallery in 2000 reveals that
serious import of humor:
Pyramid of Oranges was far from being the only sculpture of significance made by Louw in 1967 and that its recent visibility has obscured other important aspects
jw: And the food for hippies line, and wanting to give people vitamin C?
of Louw’s work, as well as more ambivalent or openly
rl: That was a journalistic jibe, meant as a light-hearted
destructive relationships between artwork, artist, and
put down. But I like jibes they often carry a certain
art world.
truth. The hippie ethos is not to be scorned, and the
reference is something to be considered. After all I
Louw has acknowledged the importance of the
Destruction in Art Symposium as one of the events that
had made a work, apart from its formal ramifications,
strongly impressed him and “proposed new options
that presents itself as a gift, is given away.33
for making sculpture.”31 Gustav Metzger organized the three-day symposium in September 1966, at which
In the event, the rate of destruction of the pyramid
Louw was present (indeed his presence at the sym-
surprised even its maker. Getting word of “free fruit”
posium is the only mention of Louw in David Mellor’s
in Covent Garden, some arrived with shopping bags
catalogue The Sixties Art Scene in London). Did the
and helped themselves generously. The work’s gift
Pyramid of Oranges have a destructive connotation?
might be read not as an act of generosity but as a
32
89 Restoring Some Period Color
demonstration of exchange, excessive expenditure, or
“everyone who went into the gallery was invited to take
wanton destruction of value. Pyramid of Oranges, then,
an orange” but also that, in addition to the pyramid
could be conceived of as a kind of artistic “potlatch.”
of 5,800 oranges, there was another sculpture in the
This term, originating in the Pacific Northwest and pop-
show: a “cone of 9½ tons of black granite chippings.”35
ularized by Marcel Mauss’s book The Gift (1925), first
When asked about this work, Louw explained that the
published in English in 1954, was in wide circulation and
black-granite work did exist for a short time before
discussion in art schools in the 1960s—including the
being removed (apparently there was rather too much
sculpture department at St. Martin’s, where “potlatch”
interaction with the piece in the space) but that there
was the name of a student publication, edited by Glyn
are no photographs. In 2014, however, he drew up a
Foulkes and Roger Bates in 1968. A cartoon by Foulkes
specification for it to be remade in the context of an
excerpted from Potlatch was reproduced in the January
exhibition of work by artists at Stockwell Depot, curated
1969 issue of Studio International.
by Sam Cornish.36 In the event, remaking the work for
this exhibition proved impractical, but the fact that
34
Although less a critical and theoretical engage-
ment with the ideas of Mauss’s book than the citing of
Louw drew up specifications for it suggests that the
a current theoretical term “in the air,” the St. Martin’s
artist considers this work, made of more-inert material
publication spoke to contemporary concerns with
than its contemporary Pyramid of Oranges, one that can
alternative notions of exchange and distribution, the
be repeated.
free circulation of ideas and property, and excessive
expenditure as resistance to models of capitalist
together, it would make possible a dialogue that was
accumulation. Likewise, Louw’s work was not conceived
manifest in the original Arts Lab exhibition, through
as a demonstration of Mauss’s ideas but in the unfold-
a relationship between two geometric solids: one
ing narrative of its exhibition at the Arts Lab came to
that was brightly colored, edible, and intended to be
embody the contradictions of free distribution versus
destroyed through human interaction; another, pre-
individual greed and the conception of the gift in con-
sumably more stable, that was inadvertently destroyed
temporary society.
or perhaps, through inappropriate human interaction,
threatened to overly distress its environment. What is
Another documentary fragment that might reorient
Moreover, if both works were to be re-created
thinking about the original installation at the Arts Lab is
the relationship between black granite chippings and
an early account published in the catalogue to a group
oranges? Or between the cone and pyramid forms?
exhibition, Survey ’68, at Camden Arts Centre in June–
When Pyramid of Oranges shares an exhibition with
July 1968. In the catalogue, the “Orange Pyramid Show,
another sculpture, its meaning becomes less centered
Arts Laboratory, 1967” is listed as Louw’s only one-man
on its internal relations or relations between it and its
exhibition to date, and a short text about his work gives
viewers and expands to include its relation to this other
a description of the show. This explains not only that
form in the space.
90 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
The evidence of this other work in the show—as
in the changing form of the sculpture as the pyramid
well as Louw’s application for membership in the Arts
is depleted. But I think it would be wrong to consider
Lab, which included his original proposal for the Pyramid
Louw’s work as a work of participatory art in the manner
of Oranges work—was presented in Sandy Nairne’s
in which that term is currently understood—for exam-
essay “The Institutionalization of Dissent” in the volume
ple, in Claire Bishop’s Artificial Hells: Participatory Art and
Thinking About Exhibitions, published in 1996. Nairne’s
the Politics of Spectatorship (2012)—not least because
essay gives Louw’s work prominent place in significant
it does not “primarily involve people as the medium
emergent discourses of the 1990s, histories of exhibition
or material of the work.”40 People are not primarily the
making and curatorial practice that presage the Pyramid
medium or material of Pyramid of Oranges: oranges are.
of Oranges’ actual reemergence at the Whitechapel Art
But there are certainly works by Louw that could—and
Gallery at the end of that decade.
should—be discussed in the context of participatory art,
namely, the Sound Recorder Works that he developed
37
Louw’s work was rediscovered in these new con-
texts, but these emergent discourses also reconsidered
from the beginning of the 1970s and that, as discussed
the original object such that it could now be seen as a
above, also had their origins in Louw’s working environ-
precedent for a range of newer works and practices, and
ment at Stockwell Depot. Louw has variously proposed
particularly for interactive and participatory artworks.
remaking these works to the curators of conceptual-art
Nairne discusses how “a particular moment in London
exhibitions. Ph.D. researchers taking an interest in them
illustrates the wider questions of participation and
and contacting him was an important factor in prompt-
multi-disciplinarity.” His example is the Arts Lab in
ing Louw out of his self-imposed exile from art worlds in
Drury Lane and Louw’s Pyramid of Oranges, described
the 1990s. But that’s another story.
by Nairne as “the pick-up piece (of which the recent
The Pyramid of Oranges made for Live in Your Head
pieces of Félix González-Torres are reminiscent).” It is
in 2000 was the major repetition that rearticulated this
easy to see how Louw’s work lends itself to an interpre-
work in the world. It began the process of revealing
tation as an anticipation of the piles of candies made
the work’s—and the artist’s—complex, mobile, and
by González-Torres such as Untitled (Portrait of Ross in
contingent relations. No doubt it helped that the artist
L.A.) of 1991. By the time that Louw’s Pyramid of Oranges
had almost completely disappeared in the interim and
rematerialized in the Live in Your Head exhibition in
that he and his work could thus be rediscovered as
2000, work by González-Torres was widely known and
instances of pure difference, from their original context
familiar, and Louw’s work could be seen to anticipate its
as well as from the current situation, rather than appear
form and manner of viewer interaction. Louw has also
indelibly marked by an incremental or continual passage
remarked on the perfect fit of the fruit with the human
through the institutions and histories of British art in
hand. Taking an orange is a tangible physical inter-
the intervening years. Pyramid of Oranges had not had a
action with the material of the work and is registered
long history of exhibition or inclusion in books on art of
38
39
91 Restoring Some Period Color
the 1960s or in accounts of conceptual art, as arguably
remarkable that someone who taught in the sculpture
had been the case with such familiar works as Art &
department at St. Martin’s during the era of its greatest
Language’s Index 02, 1972, or Richard Long’s formative
fame, showed in some of the most important exhi-
piece A Line Made by Walking, 1967, which were also
bitions of new art, was written about and published
included in the Live in Your Head exhibition. Louw and
articles in the leading art magazines on both sides of the
the Pyramid of Oranges could appear almost as time
Atlantic—Artforum and Studio International—could dis-
travelers from an earlier moment. Where Louw’s dif-
appear. That his relations in this highly visible moment
ference in 1967 had been all but ignored in an art world
seemed slightly tangential at the time accounts for
that absorbed and assimilated difference, he landed
part of our interest now—an interest in the overlooked
in one where difference was valued and affirmed. Up
figures in history rather than the mainstream. His ability
until the end of the 1990s Louw was a marginal figure in
to move between groupings and contexts that seemed
histories of the art of the 1960s and 1970s in Britain, as
totally antithetical—to be in both constructed and con-
he arguably still is today. He was, for example, a name
ceptual sculpture “camps” at St. Martin’s, for example;
check (with his first name misspelled) in the catalogue
to show at the ICA in both When Attitudes Become Form
to The Sixties Art Scene in London exhibition at the
(1969) and British Sculpture out of the Sixties (1970); to
Barbican Gallery in 1993 and was recorded with “current
be part of the Arts Lab alternative space and to show
address unknown” in a project undertaken between
at a commercial gallery in Bond Street in the same
1990 and 1996 to trace participants in three seminal
year (in 1967 at Kasmin, as the artist’s choice of his St.
exhibitions of conceptual art. This continued in the
Martin’s colleague William Tucker)—seems almost
catalogue to the 2013 exhibition When Attitudes Become
inconceivable, unless one considers that his ties to all of
Form: Bern 1969 / Venice 2013, where Louw is the only
these institutions were rather loosely binding or, more
person listed as “unknown” in the caption to a photo-
to the point, that these scenes were not as mutually
graph taken outside the Kunsthalle Bern at the opening
exclusive as they have been presented in the domi-
of When Attitudes Become Form in 1969.
nant art-historical accounts. Situating the work more
securely back in its original context in the London art
41
42
The position of Louw in such histories owes
something to his own desire to disappear from, to move
worlds of the 1960s can be transformative of our under-
within, or even completely to abandon the art world.
standing of that complex historical situation. It also
He was itinerant in the London scene, and it is perhaps
adds some period color to the grainy black-and-white
precisely because his connections to London art-world
documentation that has survived from that moment.
networks were mobile and contingent at the time of Pyramid of Oranges’ first making that it has been possible for his work to be rearticulated in a second moment at the beginning of the twenty-first century. It seems
92 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
Notes I should like to thank the following for their help in writing this chapter: Mark Blignaut, Sam Cornish, David Curtis, Phoebe Greenwood, David Lillington, Alida Louw, Roelof Louw, Jo Melvin, Richard Saltoun, and Jon Wood. 1. “Sculptors at Stockwell Depot,” 35. 2. Stockwell Depot was converted into studio space by a group of young artists in the summer of 1967; see Cornish, Stockwell Depot, 1967–79. 3. See the map illustrated in Mellor, Sixties Art Scene in London, 46. 4. For a history of the area, see the website of the Covent Garden Trust, http://www.coventgardentrust.org.uk. 5. De Jongh, “Lights Out for the Arts Lab.” 6. A listing of regional Arts Labs gives David Bowie as the contact for the Beckenham Arts Lab. International Times 66 (October 10–23, 1969): 16. 7. David Bowie Is, V&A, London, 23 March–11 August 2013. 8. Louw cited in J. Wood, United Enemies, 18. 9. See The New Generation, 1965. The exhibition also included Michael Bolus, Phillip King, Roland Piché, Christopher Sanderson, Isaac Witkin, and Derrick Woodham. 10. C. Harrison, “Some Recent Sculpture in Britain,” 29. 11. See McLean, “Not Even Crimble Crumble” (review of British Sculpture out of the Sixties). 12. Lippard, Six Years, 34. 13. Brener, “Concerns of Emerging Sculptors.” 14. These sculptors, plus Louw, showed in the second Stockwell Depot exhibition, in 1969. 15. For a recent account and reappraisal of Stockwell Depot, see Cornish, Stockwell Depot, 1967–79. 16. Catalogue entry for Roelof Louw’s Untitled 1968 (T01250), based on a conversation with the artist in August 1971, published in The Tate Gallery Report, 1970–1972 (London, 1972), http://www.tate .org.uk/art/artworks/louw-untitled-t01250/text-catalogue-entry, accessed April 1, 2015. 17. Andrew Forge, introduction to British Pavilion, xxxvi Venice Biennale (1972), reprinted in William Tucker: Sculpture, 1970–73, 16, 17. 18. Roelof Louw, “Place Sculpture: The Language Connection Part 1,” 2010, unpublished typescript, courtesy of the artist, n.p. 19. Cornish, Stockwell Depot, 1967–79, 16, 17. 20. See illustrations of the 1968 Stockwell Depot exhibition in Survey ’68: Abstract Sculpture, 19, and Richardson, “8 Young Sculptors at Stockwell Depot,” and of the 1969 exhibition in C. Harrison, “Roelof Louw’s Sculpture.” 21. Louw to Szeemann, January 18, 1969, courtesy of Richard Saltoun (a scan of the original letter was sent to Louw by the organizers of the exhibition at the Fondazione Prada, Venice, April 9, 2013). 22. Zacharea, “Roelof Louw: An Interview with Chryssa Zacharea.”
93 Restoring Some Period Color
23. Oxford Mail, October 11, 1969, in the archive of Modern Art Oxford and included in the exhibition display Roelof Louw: Project Space, Modern Art Oxford, February 15–April 6, 2014. 24. The first of the directions reads: “Stand 3ft from a wall. Place feet astride, arms forward from shoulders, palms flat against the wall. Press against the wall for any period. Proceed to the next position.” Wall Show, n.p. 25. Tape Recorder Project by Roelof Louw, Whitechapel Art Gallery, London, February 26–March 12, 1971. The actual recording was made in the gallery on Friday, February 25, 1971. 26. Louw, Skype conversations with the author, various dates, including April 2, 2016. 27. Louw, notes written in response to questions from Joelle Le Saux, Ph.D. candidate at Rennes University, France, 2005, courtesy of the artist. 28. For example, Peter Coffin’s Untitled (Pyramid of Oranges), United States, 2007, http://www.mots.org.il/eng/exhibitions/ WorkItem.asp?ContentID=361, accessed January 5, 2015 (my thanks to Sam Cornish for drawing my attention to this work). Doug Fishbone’s sculpture 30,000 Bananas in Trafalgar Square, London, on October 5, 2004, has also been compared to Louw’s work, though Fishbone himself claims to have been unaware of Louw’s Pyramid of Oranges at the time he made this work. Conversation with the author, March 19, 2014. 29. Michael Archer, “Out of the Studio,” in Phillpot and Tarsia, Live in Your Head, 27–28. 30. Wood, interview with Roelof Louw at the Henry Moore Institute, Leeds, August 19, 2011, transcript courtesy of the artist. 31. Louw, “Place Sculpture: The Language Connection Part 1,” n.p. 32. Mellor, Sixties Art Scene in London, 220. The entry also notes that Barry Flanagan was at the Destruction in Art Symposium. 33. Wood, interview with Louw. 34. Studio International 177, no. 907 (January 1969), 8. Both Charles Harrison, assistant editor of Studio International, and James Faure Walker, a contributor to Studio International and one of the founder editors of Artscribe in 1976, were contributors to Potlatch. 35. Survey ’68: Abstract Sculpture, 18. 36. The exhibition, Stockwell Depot, 1967–79, was held at the University of Greenwich Galleries, University of Greenwich, London, July 24–September 12, 2015. 37. Sandy Nairne, “The Institutionalization of Dissent,” in Greenberg, Ferguson, and Nairne, Thinking About Exhibitions, 387–410. 38. Ibid., 391. 39. See, for example, the press release for Louw’s exhibition at Modern Art Oxford, February 15–April 6, 2014. 40. Bishop, Artificial Hells, 5. 41. The project was organized by Seth Siegelaub and published as Fricke and Fricke, The Context of Art: The Art of Context. 42. Celant et al., When Attitudes Become Form, 270.
Collectivity, Temporality, and Festival Culture in John Dugger’s Quasi-Architecture, 1970–74 Courtney J. Martin
In 1972 John Dugger, a young American artist then
others. For Dugger, this was a chance to be shown on
living and working in London, was asked to participate
a larger scale and with an international roster of artists
in documenta 5. Curated by the Swiss phenomenon
with some renown. Moreover, the exhibition offered
Harald Szeemann, the fifth edition of the international
him the opportunity to import the type of collabora-
exhibition, entitled documenta 5: Befragung der Realität—
tive, temporal, craft-oriented, participatory event that
Bildwelten heute, has been heralded both for introducing
defined his nascent practice in London. In keeping with
conceptual art and Minimalism to a broader public
the ambition of the exhibition’s title, Dugger’s proposal
and for its innovative approaches to the display of art.
for the People’s Participation Pavilion was for something
Dugger’s inclusion in the fifth documenta seemed to
larger, more technically involved, and far more logisti-
forecast a place for him in what would become concep-
cally complicated than anything he had ever completed.
tual art’s canon.
entrance, both actual and conceptual, required full and
1
Dugger’s proposal for a freestanding red structure,
Described by Dugger as “an environment,” its
the People’s Participation Pavilion (1972), surrounded
engaged immersion in the activity of and conditions
by a trough of water took seriously Szeemann’s titular
within the space. The experiential nature of the struc-
invocation of an “inquiry into reality” (fig. 5.1). Even
ture was built into its multiple floors and pool of water.
before the curator’s intentions were announced, in the
Though temporary, it was architecturally sound, as it
months and weeks leading up to the June 1972 opening,
was designed to exhibit some of his smaller works,
it was clear that this documenta would be different from
creating an exhibition within an exhibition in Kassel.
5. 5. 5. 5. 5. 5. 5. 5. 5. 5.
Fig. 5.1 John Dugger, Pavilion Dugger (a.k.a. People’s Participation Pavilion), 1972. Installation at the exhibition documenta 5: Befragung der Realität—Bildwelten heute, Museum Fridericianum, Kassel, Germany, 1972. © John Dugger.
The pavilion also incorporated the work of two other
widely dismissed by contemporary reviewers, whose
London-based artists, David Medalla and Graham
characterization of Szeemann’s choice of art and
Stevens. The former showed kinetic objects inside the
artists and exhibition design ranged between poorly
pavilion, and the latter placed a monumentally sized
conceived and badly executed all the way to vulgar
inflatable on the roof of the building. Frequently, the
and monstrous. Artforum critic Lawrence Alloway’s
People’s Participation Pavilion has been described as a
account of the exhibition as “something between
collaboration between Medalla and Dugger, not unlike
a supermarket and a wunderkammer” reflected the
the participatory projects that they jointly staged in
sense that the show’s overall organization tended
London. But the pavilion as an event-structure was a
toward disorder. 2
signal feature of Dugger’s practice, with antecedents in
his first solo exhibition, entitled Microcosm, at the Sigi
People’s Participation Pavilion insisted upon became
Krauss Gallery in London, 1971. For this show, Dugger
the model for Artists for Democracy’s invitation to
staged many of the experimental elements that would
international artists to join them in their support of
be carried forward into documenta. Moreover, the
Chilean resistance following the 1973 coup. That this
documenta piece was a model for the installation infra-
happened in London follows from the “biomass” con-
structure that Dugger would later construct for the Arts
cept, whereby any place can be fitted to function for
Festival for Democracy in Chile, held in the fall of 1974 at
political art.
the Royal College of Art in London (RCA).
temporality, and festival culture of sculpture by Dugger
As both an object and an exhibition space within
The emphasis on social engagement that the
This essay examines the collective practices,
documenta 5, the pavilion was a microclimate where
as a specific strategy for occupying physical space for
other artists gathered as it was being built. Modeled
political means. Starting from Dugger’s installation
on a Burmese monsoon refuge, Dugger envisioned
at the Museum of Modern Art Oxford and his solo
the pavilion as an organic sanctuary—calling it a
show at the Sigi Krauss Gallery and ending at the Arts
biomass—from the immediate to-and-fro of a large
Festival at the RCA, I argue for Dugger’s authorship
international exhibition, whose activity was especially
of the People’s Participation Pavilion as separate from
pronounced during the well-attended opening days,
Medalla’s, and also for the recognition of the pavilion
with an onslaught of press, collectors, and museum
as an art object, two key aspects of the work that have
and commercial gallery staff. In turn, many used it as
been overlooked in the longer view of this art history.
a meeting place to which they returned to regroup
The pavilion was an example of the ways in which
while moving around the large, disorienting exhibi-
experimental art at mid-twentieth century was often
tion. Despite documenta 5’s later recuperation as a
embattled over both meaning and proprietary rights
groundbreaking experiment in curatorial strategies,
as the new art forms negotiated their way into public
conceptual art, and audience engagement, it was
visibility and institutional agendas.
97 Collectivity, Temporality, Festival Culture
when paired with her understanding of the artist’s
Collectivity
need to complete the object with the participation of Dugger arrived in London from the United States in
the spectator.6 Clark prioritized the “act of making the
1967. A recent dropout from the Art Institute of Chicago,
proposition,” as the work of art, which was a primary
by way of Berkeley, New York, and San Francisco,
pedagogical point that she, as elder avant-garde
Dugger, like many American men of his generation, was
statesperson, expressed frequently to artists within
presumed to be using London to dodge America’s draft
her circle.7 For example, in a letter to Hélio Oiticica she
for the Vietnam War.3 In London, he quickly became
wrote convincingly of artists as proposers and art as a
attached to the Exploding Galaxy (1967–68), a collective
proposition:
of actors, artists, dancers, and musicians that staged freewheeling performances throughout the city and
But it isn’t participation for the sake of partici-
lived communally in North London. The Galaxy was
pation and it is not saying, as [the Julio] Le Parc
instrumental in introducing Dugger to many loosely
group do, that art is a bourgeois problem. That
interconnected art scenes, notably Medalla (a Galaxy
would be too simple and straightforward. Nothing
founder), Stevens, who made inflatables that often
profound has that simplicity and nothing true is
accompanied Galaxy performances, and the art critic
straightforward. What they deny is the import-
Guy Brett. After the Galaxy ceased to exist as either an
ant thing: it is thought. I think that now we are
art or housing collective, Dugger traveled to Asia and to
the proposers and by means of the proposition
Europe. By 1970 he had settled in Paris, where he would
there must be a thought, and when the spectator
remain for a year.
expresses this proposition he is in fact joining the
age-old characteristic of a work of art: thought and
4
In Paris he interacted with an international group
of artists, many of them working in the area of kinetics,
expression.8
such as the Greek Takis (Panagiotis Vassilakis), the American Liliane Lijn, and, most importantly, for his
Clark’s sentiments reflected previous strongly worded
transition from art student and untrained performer
eschewals of dogma, such as those that guided the
to object maker, the Brazilian Lygia Clark. Clark intro-
Neoconcrete Manifesto’s situation of the art object’s
duced Dugger to the Brazilian avant-garde movement,
transcendent properties.9 Her words also dug deeper
Neoconcretismo, of which she was one of the leading
into the sometimes inarticulate definitions of con-
proponents. Through Clark, he also honed his interest
ceptual art in the sixties. Here and elsewhere in her
in the interactivity of artists and audiences that he
writing and work, Clark argued for art untethered
experienced in Galaxy performances. Clark’s articu-
from an audience that also sought to break down the
lation of participation as a refusal of myth, duration,
superficial binary of art and audience into the purely
and the unconscious made sense to Dugger, especially
experiential.
5
98 L O ND O N ART WOR LDS
Temporality
pairs, these clear tubes were known as Body Conductors. They could be used singly by a participant’s placing the
After Dugger’s return to London in 1971, he was invited
ends of one to the ears and the middle of the tube to
to contribute to Pioneers of Part-Art, a group show held
another body part for the aural experience of the inner
at the Museum of Modern Art, Oxford (now Modern
workings of the body. Ideally, the conductors would be
Art Oxford) that brought together his London Exploding
used by two people for a temporary sensory exchange.
Galaxy associates with the artists he had met in Paris:
One participant would hold the ends of a plastic tube to
Medalla, Stevens, Clark, Oiticica, and Li Yuan-Chia.
his or her ears as the other took the middle of the tube
Nicknamed PoPA at MoMA, the show was to explain
and ran it across another surface, preferably a body
part-art as “part as in participation and art as in articu-
part, hair, or breath. The ambient sound and vibration
lation,” through a range of art objects and actions that
sent through the tubing was experienced as a concep-
included Yuan-Chia’s installation of draped plastic, paper,
tual conduction of one body to another or an intimate
and poems; one of Stevens’s inflatables on which visitors
performance between the two people. Alongside the
could jump; and Dugger’s Biomass Installation (1971).10 In
conductors hung similar devices called Curved Space
name “part-art” also acknowledged the work’s tenuous
Tubes, distinguishable from the conductors only by their
relationship to fine art that excluded tactile interaction.
opacity and intention for single use to “produce a soft
jet-like roaring” sound when put to each ear.11
Biomass Installation was installed within a square
defined by four large, equally placed columns. A former
brewery, the museum’s rough aesthetic was visible in its
associate Oiticica’s 1969 exhibition at the Whitechapel
massive structural pillars, high ceilings, and untreated
Gallery, in which he defined the sand-covered instal-
floors (fig. 5.2). Inside the squared-off space, Dugger
lation area as an “environment” that required full
laid a “floor” of artificial grass on which he placed lightly
immersion.12 Though Biomass visitors were not sup-
inflated sheets of plastic. In the center of the space,
plied with directions for use, the logic of Dugger’s later
he hung an open-weave gridded structure from which
aesthetic directives suggests that an ideal entrance into
dangled several Perennials, each a flaccid, plastic fabric–
the installation would have been preceded by removing
like mesh construction that, when held, uncoiled as if
one’s shoes (as Oiticica instructed), after which one
blossoming or flowering. As the name suggests, the
walked onto the plastic to feel the inflation and see the
Perennials flowered repeatedly when activated by par-
field of green grass visible through it. In the center of
ticipants. Dugger frequently referred to the Perennials
the space, participants could stand within a vertical
as “Ergonic” sculptures, a portmanteau that invoked the
field of Perennials folding and unfolding around them.
meanings of earth and organic.
Alternatively, one might sit and look above as others
agitated the flowers to produce a cascade of blossoms.
On two sides of the installation’s quadrant, Dugger
suspended semicircular tubes from the ceiling. Hung in
99 Collectivity, Temporality, Festival Culture
Dugger’s project borrowed heavily from Clark’s
On the periphery of the installation, one might get in
Fig. 5.2 John Dugger, Biomass Installation, 1971. Shown at the exhibition Pioneers of Part-Art, Museum of Modern Art, Oxford. © John Dugger.
touch with his or her own body before inviting a partner
Rupert Legge and Mark Powell-Jones for MoMA. It
to join in the body conduction. The resulting human
was slated to be on view (or to be interacted with, by
and (pseudo) plant interaction, or Biomass, defined
the terms of part-art) continuously from February 14
the ambitious part-art concept. If, in scientific terms,
to February 28, 1971, but during the opening, on the
a biomass is biological matter harnessed as an energy
evening of February 13, the raucous “participation” of
source, then Dugger’s simulation of the biological and
the attendees with the works caused Medalla, followed
invitation to human participants were to create art
by Dugger and Stevens, to remove their work from the
from the energy of their interaction. So too did it reflect
show, effectively closing it.13 Hilary Floe situates PoPA,
Clark’s total investment in audience.
as well as other contemporary participatory exhibitions,
as an example of “over-participation,” an apt character-
Billed as the first survey of participation art, PoPA
was loosely curated by Oxford University students
100 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
ization of the “interactions that were deemed to exceed
acceptable limits.”14 The press coverage of the opening
visitors had to take off their shoes and walk through
night laid blame for the failure of the show on a number
a trough filled with water. Stepping out of the water,
of factors, from the inexperience of the curators and
visitors dried their feet on a woven mat that was strewn
hypersensitivity of the artists to the problematic conceit
with towels. From there, they walked barefoot onto
of art that should be touched. In all cases, however,
artificial grass to reach the rest of the show. The effect
it was uncertain whether the art was to serve as an
of the “crossing stream,” as Dugger described it, was a
excuse for entertainment and play or as debris—what
breach between the street and the exhibition, forcing
has previously been called nonart when applied to other
visitors to attend to the physical experience of entering
examples of conceptual art, such as Arte Povera. The
into another space.17 Removing shoes and walking in
proposition that Dugger offered with this installation
water was the experiential induction into participatory
was accepted by the public that came to the open-
art that his previous work Biomass Installation lacked.
ing, but he was displeased with the way in which that
It was easier to direct visitors without shoes and with
acceptance was enacted. This misrecognition of the art
clean feet into the other interactive art on offer that
object is a recurring issue in the reception of his work
required as much immersion as the “crossing stream.” It
and particularly its distinction within a space of enter-
was also easier to curtail the kind of irreverent attitude
tainment and other art.
that plagued PoPA’s opening night.
The water feature was one of a few new elements
added to what was otherwise an early career retrospective. Microcosm contained Body Conductors, Curved Space
Participation
Tubes, Perennials and other experimental sculptures that Despite its premature closure, PoPA was Dugger’s
Dugger had made and shown over the last few years.
rehearsal for his first solo exhibition, Microcosm
In the basement of the gallery, he installed another
(subtitled Exhibition of Environmental Art), at Sigi
new object, an architectural model of a temple used as
Krauss Gallery in London’s Covent Garden. Planned
a rain retreat. During Vassa, the months-long mon-
in conjunction with the London music, film, and art
soon season in Burma, Cambodia, Laos, Sri Lanka, and
event Camden Festival ’71, Dugger’s exhibition was a
Thailand, Theravada Buddhist monks sequester them-
satellite of the group show (also named Microcosm)
selves annually, consciously removing themselves from
held at the Camden Arts Centre, which included works
secular life and avoiding the rain. Dugger intended for
by John Hilliard, Medalla, Marc Morrel, and Carolee
visitors to perform similar acts of connection with the
Schneemann. On view in Krauss’s frame shop and
model in order to experience the ascetic associations
gallery, Microcosm rearranged the small retail space as
of the Buddhist ritual. The profound interiority of the
a sensorial environment, complete with water, multi-
exhibition’s orientation inside the gallery (objects inside
ple textures, and living elements. To enter the space,
other objects, the unorthodox use of the basement, the
15
16
101 Collectivity, Temporality, Festival Culture
water division between inside and outside) reflected
Biennale. The young Swiss curator’s selection as the
Rudolph Steiner’s view of the microcosm as the human
artistic director was also viewed as an inspired choice,
body’s inner physical and spiritual life versus that of the
one that seemed to promise the kind of experimental
macrocosm, or the world in which the body lived.
art that had been on view in his previously critically
acclaimed exhibition, Live in Your Head: When Attitudes
18
In the Krauss show, the Rains Retreat also doubled
as The Snake Pit for Art Critics, replete with a full-size
Become Form (Works—Concepts—Processes—Situations—
python living inside it. Throughout the run of the show,
Information) at the Kunsthalle Bern in 1969. Szeemann’s
Dugger and Krauss fed the snake daily with live mice.
attempt to show art that resisted exhibition resulted in
Harald Szeemann saw Microcosm during his visit to
several spaces of distinct action. One of these spaces
London in 1971 in preparation for documenta 5 and
was Joseph Beuys’s Bureau for Direct Democracy, an
invited Dugger to construct a similar environment for
installation in which Beuys distributed information and
the garden of the museum. Krauss’s German nationality
debated political, art, and social issues with visitors
may have been the initial draw for Szeemann, as they
for the hundred days of documenta. On the final day,
had Swiss friends and acquaintances in common, but
in October, Beuys staged a Boxing Match for Direct
it was Dugger’s expansive approach to sculpture that
Democracy. His closing event capped a summer and
engaged him. As a testament to his enthusiasm for
early fall of temporal, demonstrative actions throughout
Dugger’s proposal, Szeemann handwrote the following
the confines of the exhibition that spilled into the city.
on the bottom of his typed letter of invitation to par-
ticipate in documenta: “There is unfortunately no snake
included in documenta 5. The fusion of architecture,
dealer in Kassel. The next one who would take care of
installation, and performance proved sculpture to be a
the Boas lives in Aachen, which is a six hour train ride.”20
dynamic medium. In the case of Haus-Rucker-Co’s Oasis
While Dugger’s snake may be one of the more extreme
#7, installed in and out of the museum, sculpture was
examples of Szeemann’s full commitment to conceptual
shown to be awesome and impossible. The Viennese
art at documenta 5, it goes a long way in explaining the
architecture collective devised a steel-pipe structure
disconnect between the curator’s willingness to realize
that was cantilevered out of the window of the museum.
the artist’s ideals and the critics’ reception of his actions
A platform, two palm trees, and a hammock were
as willfully bizarre.
enclosed inside an eight-meter translucent vinyl bubble.
19
Spectacle also defined the spirit of the sculpture
From the outside, it looked like a small patch of the tropics incubated in a greenhouse and suspended off the Festival Culture
ground was breaking out of the museum. Technically complicated and conceptually rich works such as this
The lead-up to the fifth edition of documenta was auspi-
exceeded Szeemann’s notion that the show be as rigor-
cious. It fell during a year that coincided with the Venice
ous as it was elastic in its conception of art.
102 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Alongside the overtly demonstrative art such as
indicted as the perpetuators of wrongs against the ten
that by Beuys, there were several examples of static,
undersigned artists and their work. The artists asked
performative sculpture, including Edward Kienholz’s Five
that their art not be exhibited “in a classification without
Car Stud (1969–72). Installed inside an inflated dome on
the artist’s consent” and that they receive autonomy
the museum’s grounds, Five Car Stud was a tableau of
“without censorship” in the exhibition catalogue, tenets
nine life-sized figures, five automobiles, trees, dirt, and
that suggested their disinterest in Szeemann’s anthro-
debris lit by a car’s headlights. Viewers walked through
pological curating and belief in the catalogue as an
the dirt and sparsely lit environment in between the
extension of gallery space.21
cars and figures as if happening on the gruesome, if
ambiguous, scene of standing bodies with guns and a
ate adjunct to an international exhibition of art that
dismembered body on the ground. Five Car Stud was
elevated concept over material, and material and
immediately taken up by reviewers as a realistic depic-
form over all else. These were artists making art
tion of American violence, rather than an object with
that might also include written tracts, manifestos,
obvious connections to assemblage, Hollywood film,
performance-lectures, or text not dissimilar to the
and land art.
Artforum letter. Textual, verbal, and audible interface
was their praxis. So public displays of contention were
Szeemann’s curatorial style was not without
In a sense, the manifesto seemed an appropri-
controversy. He allocated whole sections of the show to
simply part of the work. In the end, only four of the
advertising, paintings by mental patients, performance,
ten—Carl Andre, Donald Judd, Robert Morris, and Fred
and science fiction, among other displays of outsider
Sandback—felt the need actually to pull out of the
art. Even before the opening of the exhibition, on June
show. As Jef Cornelis’s archival video of the opening
30, 1972, there was friction between the artists, the
presents, documenta 5 was a freewheeling multiplat-
art, and the curator. In the run-up to the show, several
form event that bore little experiential relationship
American artists were vocal about Szeemann’s curato-
to institutional art exhibitions of its time, despite
rial style, which seemed, from their perspective, to take
its promotion of primarily white male European and
many liberties with artists’ rights, as they ultimately
American artists.
charged him in print. At the rear of the June issue of Artforum, buried within the ads for upcoming exhibitions at commercial galleries, appeared, in the form of a small
Biomass
paid advertisement, a four-point manifesto aimed at documenta 5 specifically and all exhibitions generally.
In the months leading up to documenta, Dugger began
Szeemann and his curatorial team of Jean-Christophe
to design a “part-art” environment where, like his show
Amman, Konrad Fischer, and Arnold Bode, though
at Sigi Krauss, there would be several works spread out
unnamed, were the intended targets of the missive,
over multiple discrete spaces. All of the works would be
103 Collectivity, Temporality, Festival Culture
participatory, so that the pavilion could be constantly
to work for common goals. The goals, once achieved,
in use, night and day. Following his interest in tropical
would then be shared equally by all. To that end, the
architecture, the pavilion would combine the formal
pavilion was named to be inclusive of artists and art
vocabulary of a Southeast Asian longhouse and a rains
viewers at documenta, designating their role as partici-
retreat: open on all sides, with a bonnet roof (fig. 5.3).
pants. Despite the lofty aims of the site-specific project,
Dugger’s object was an appropriation of structures
Dugger obtained building permits from the city, hired
whose design matched their environmental conditions
a construction crew of unionized laborers, and con-
of tropical temperatures, high humidity, and lush veg-
structed the pavilion to Kassel’s architectural and code
etation. His attempt to translate the open-plan design
specifications.
into a new context in order to encourage a collegial
atmosphere was also an act of appropriation that had
toward an area of woven mats. After leaving their
imperial and colonial overtones. The colonial is even sig-
shoes here, participants waded through a meter-wide
naled in the title, through his generalization of a native
trough of water to get into the main exhibition space,
or folk populous (people) in need of representation,
which was, like the Krauss Gallery show, covered
which brings to mind the uneven anthropological hier-
entirely in artificial green grass. Dugger described
archy of the First and Third Worlds, wherein the former
it as a biomass, a term reused from the PoPA show.
would be specifically identified and the latter would be
“Biomass” denoted an area of plant life engaged in
grouped into classifications, such as peoples. Drawing
energy collection and storage, as well as the process
from his own interest in Eastern literature, philosophy,
of the energy collection. Just as the “grass”-covered
and religion, he wanted to use the object’s style to
surface of the pavilion was a biomass, so too were
imbue the interaction of art and the public at documenta
the other artists and participants who gathered in the
with spirituality, specifically one that saw documenta as
space to interface with the work. Once again a snake
a kind of extended retreat for art and its participants in
was installed on the lowest level of the structure. In
the manner of the rains retreat.
this installation, visitors could look down into the pit
that contained the snake.22
Dugger arrived in Kassel in late spring to begin
To enter, one had to ascend a broad staircase
work on the pavilion with architect Lorenz Dombois,
documenta’s technical director. The People’s Participation
days, documenta was also a biomass, in that it was a
Pavilion was located on the grounds of the Museum
gathering, as well as a productive collection of con-
Fridericianum. Dugger’s structure had gray-slate slanted
temporary art that would, after the exhibition closed,
roofs and was painted red inside and out, an ode to
spread out into the world. To make this evident, Dugger
his interest in China, specifically the central role of the
hung several of his cloth banners from the ceiling and
worker in Mao’s Cultural Revolution. Dugger believed
hung or painted numerous red stars onto all of the
that Mao’s socialism mobilized disparate bodies as one
building’s surfaces as symbols of Maoist collectivity. As
104 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Incubated in Kassel every five years for a hundred
Fig. 5.3 John Dugger and Lorenz Dombois, architectural plan for Pavilion Dugger (a.k.a. People’s Participation Pavilion), 1972. Installation at the exhibition documenta 5: Befragung der Realität—Bildwelten heute, Museum Fridericianum, Kassel, Germany, 1972. © John Dugger.
the pavilion began to take shape, Dugger invited other
artists from London to join him, so that the pavilion fully
invited to show his participation craft object, A Stitch
realized his idea of communal art space in the Maoist
in Time, in Dugger’s Pavilion, but by the opening of the
tradition. If at Sigi Krauss’s the separation of Dugger’s
show his long sheets of cotton cloth hung from its
solo exhibit from the works of the other artists showing
ceiling. Resembling a large floating banquet table or a
at the Camden Arts Centre established him as an artist
draping hammock, the fabric was assembled for a com-
capable of developing his own ideas and executing
munal activity. Viewers were given needles and thread
them, documenta both confirmed and complicated his
and invited to become participants by sewing onto the
artistic independence.
cloth, thereby creating both a shared artwork and an
105 Collectivity, Temporality, Festival Culture
It is not clear how David Medalla came to be
Fig. 5.4 Graham Stevens, Inflatable, 1972, atop the People’s Participation Pavilion. Installation at the exhibition documenta 5: Befragung der Realität—Bildwelten heute, Museum Fridericianum, Kassel, Germany, 1972.
atmosphere (people queuing up to sew together) unlike
to “the bourgeois barriers of the gallery system and the
that created when looking at a static art object. As
art world.”25
Claire Bishop has argued, embroidery was a “slower
activity” than either drawing or sculpture, thus allowing
to install one of his large-scale transmobiles, speci-
for greater “social interaction.”24
fying that it must fit the all-red pavilion color scheme
(fig. 5.4). It was a soft barrier, sited on one side of the
23
Medalla also placed one of his cloud machines in
In addition to Medalla, Dugger also invited Stevens
the purpose-built courtyard of the pavilion. This one
pavilion’s otherwise hard structure, that a museumgoer
featured a red star for China. Next to the cloud machine,
could sit, walk, or jump on or move about.26 Related
on the exterior back wall of the pavilion, Medalla
to the history of architectural models and universal
installed a series of posters. Some of the posters
expositions, both Dugger’s Pavilion and Stevens’s pneu-
denounced international atrocities, like the Vietnam
matic environment were early examples of the variety
War, while others carried more-general messages of
of temporary architecture that would be enfolded into
antifascism and antiracism or slogans in support of
conceptual-art practices, large-scale art and archi-
Maoist China. There were also pettier conceits, specific
tectural exhibitions, and commercial enterprises in
to London’s art world, like the enlarged reproduction of
the decades to come.27 What was unique about their
Medalla’s correspondence with Norman Reid, director
objects was their insistence upon the primacy of their
of the Tate Gallery, and Roland Alley, Tate’s keeper of
finality as sculptural objects. Neither the Pavilion nor the
the modern collection, that relayed a dispute he had
inflatable were models for more permanent entities, nor
with the museum over the collection of Medalla’s art.
were they thought experiments in explorations of other
This area of the exhibition was intended as a kind of
concepts.
conversation and information space, where participants
might gather to read the displayed material and discuss
typical of his practice in London. He was a member of
its relevance to the other objects on view. Yet all of the
a few art collectives, worked in a cooperative gallery,
posters reinforced the political slant of Dugger and
and joined in other artist’s performance work. Despite
Medalla, which boiled down to “East is good, West is
its normalcy for him, collaboration ran counter to the
bad,” except for those from the West willing to take
way that most artists in Kassel conceived of their roles
up an Eastern position, as they had. This simplistic
in the exhibition. They saw documenta as an oppor-
equation was one of the ways in which the serious-
tunity to further solo auteurship. The insistence on
ness of the Pavilion as a well-executed architectonic
the single author governed the allocation of physical
sculpture was undermined. A few years later, political
space, to the extent that many artists—like Beuys or
artist and member of Artists for Democracy Su Braden
Kienholz—devised single-room projects for identifi-
dismissed Dugger and Medalla’s use of Lenin and Mao
ably distinct space within the exhibition. This sense of
as “extremely valuable in academic terms” but limited
ownership was neither new nor foreign, but it was a
107 Collectivity, Temporality, Festival Culture
Dugger’s invitation to other artists to join him was
slightly awkward position to take with art that required
public-seeking practice. He needed fellow artists,
a public for interaction and documentation for legibility.
Medalla and Stevens, to widen that space, to broaden
I would argue that this friction between single authority
the population of participants for the immediate
and the exhibition was an important part of the insti-
project but also in the object-form enterprise of his
tutional growth of conceptual art, one that Szeemann’s
participation art. The Pavilion was, in many ways, a
documenta brought into the conversation about con-
satellite of the practices from which he had grown as
temporary art in the early 1970s. This was, after all, the
an artist, specifically those of the Exploding Galaxy
documenta that sought to democratize the reception
and Lygia Clark. But in the manner of the debacle on
of art by showing things that were, at the time, barely
the opening night of the PoPA show, Dugger’s Pavilion
legible as such.
became a hub for artists and visitors to hang out during
the opening events. Its placement on the grounds
Even by Szeemann’s criteria for what constituted
anti-art or nonart, Dugger seemed to be moving in the
of the Fridericianum made it a centerpiece of the
opposite direction, lessening his authorship more and
opening’s spectacle, but it also diminished its object
more as the pavilion was being built. Though attributed
status, for of all those that came, walked through the
to him by Szeemann, it is now often described as a col-
water, forced the artificial flowers to blossom, sewed
laboration with Medalla. In title, the People’s Participation
on strips of cloth suspended in the air, and bounced
Pavilion seemed to imply a collective anonymous entity
up and down on Steven’s transmobile, few seemed to
that sprang into being for an unnamed nation. The
recognize the Pavilion as an object and their role within
name, of course, arose from Dugger’s infatuation with
it as participants. In the same manner that Kienholz’s
China and valorization of the Maoist plan for commu-
“inquiry into reality” was read too literally, Dugger’s
nal work and life. And the pavilion seemed to function
“red house” appeared too much like a lounge for the
that way: people came and went, other artists sought
exhibition rather than art within it. By the same token,
it out, and Dugger’s, Medalla’s, and Stevens’s objects
Dugger’s offering of the exotic was outmatched by the
were largely indistinct from one another, as if they were
atmosphere of documenta, which did not need to rely
representing some utopian nation.
on the appropriation of Asia for spectacle.
Perhaps that utopia was London. Dugger brought
to documenta a sample of the kind of free-form, performance-based practice that was happening in
Proposition
London in the early 1970s, which was a direct result of the social changes brought about by the preced-
Following documenta’s opening in June 1972, Dugger
ing decade’s international civil-rights movements.
made his first trip to China, where he remained for
Dugger’s invocation of a “people’s space” was his
several weeks before returning to London in the late
space in London, a place that welcomed him and his
summer.28 After his return, the Artists Liberation
108 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Front, the political art group to which he belonged
Pavilion in Kassel. According to Vicuña, this was the
with Medalla, began to take a more demonstrative
beginning of Artists for Democracy (AFD). All agreed
role. Medalla declared all acts ones of art and poli-
on the following manifesto:
tics, and Dugger made banners in response to various national and international events. The Chilean coup on
1. To give moral, cultural and financial support to genu-
September 11, 1973, galvanized the group, just as the war in Vietnam, the Cultural Revolution in China, and the events of May 1968 in Paris had similarly done.
ine liberation movements all over the world 2. To propagate[,] in a living and creative way, democratic culture everywhere; to encourage all forms of
29
These were profound moments that provoked their art for political means and drew them into conversations
progressive, experimental art 3. To explore and develop ways of integrating our varied
that seemed to be concerned with issues of greater
artistic theories and practices with the struggle for
civic import than those of the immediate context of the
emancipation of the international working class and
London art world.
all oppressed people.32
Sometime between September 1973 and the spring
of 1974, Medalla, Dugger, and the art critic Guy Brett
met the Chilean artist Cecilia Vicuña, whose 1973 exhi-
described AFD as “an organization of radical artists who
bition at the ICA, Pain Things and Explanations presented
openly supported the anti-imperialist struggle in the
her response to the civic unrest in Chile. In the press
Third World, by organizing art festivals, exhibitions and
release for the show, Vicuña stated: “My painting is
regular discussion meetings.”33 As Araeen suggested,
political in a personal way. My canvases are born as
AFD used its art as a public service, specifically that of
representation of a socialist paradise where everything
social justice. The material composition and forms of
is possible.”
AFD’s art reflected this ideal: Dugger sewed large fabric
30
Their sometime collaborator Rasheed Araeen
Exiled in London, she became one of a few Chileans
banners and made temporary architectonic objects;
in Britain able to give firsthand accounts of the country’s
Vicuña constructed ephemeral body sculptures and
turmoil. In London she was, through the Chile Solidarity
room-sized installations of string; and Medalla printed
Campaign, a surrogate for other South American artists
posters, while Brett delivered lectures. All of the objects
and writers who were unable to leave the region or
and activities fitted physically and ideologically into the
speak openly. During one of the lecture performances
space of Dugger’s structures.
that accompanied her show at the ICA, she joined with
Brett, Dugger, and Medalla to do something for Chile
in the Studio International office. There they planned
in the vein of their work on China and Mao, which
an exhibition and a series of “part-art” events to raise
had been integral to both their more recent Artists
money to support the victims of Chile’s dictatorship.
Liberation Front actions and the People’s Participation
The committee of Brett, Dugger, Medalla, and Vicuña
31
109 Collectivity, Temporality, Festival Culture
Over the summer of 1974 the members of AFD met
Fig. 5.5 Arts Festival for Democracy in Chile, Royal College of Art, London, 1974. © John Dugger.
Chilean workers in various modes of production. Hung outdoors, as it was intended, the strips fluttered in the wind, breaking up the scenes to reveal the banner’s delicacy. Speaking from a podium on September 15, 1974, Señora Allende appeared against the backdrop of Dugger’s banner as the smaller trade-union banners hung below her.36 The fabric banners served as simulations of the Chilean flag, which had been symbolically ruptured by the coup. Dugger’s banner brought to the very center of London that aspect of spectacle which had been so crucial to his work, and others’, on display at documenta. designated themselves secretary, co–festival coordina-
tor, chairman, and co–festival coordinator, respectively,
Democracy in Chile at the Royal College of Art was
of the Arts Festival for Democracy in Chile. Their titles,
the single most visible event/action for AFD.37 Part
like the Maoist worker jacket that Dugger wore, were an
exhibition and part environment, it drew attention from
admission of their shared relationship to this endeavor,
international artists, including Roberto Matta, Claus
and a whiff of Marxism carried over from their previous
Oldenburg, Christo, Meret Oppenheim, Sol Lewitt, Jorg
collectives (Exploding Galaxy and Artists Liberation
Immendorf, Fluxus associate Jon Hendricks, as well
Front) and exhibitions (Vicuña’s ICA show, PoPA, and
as British artists Rasheed Araeen, Su Braden, David
the Peoples Participation Pavilion). Chile was the perfect
Hockney, Tina Keane, and R. B. Kitaj.38 Most artists con-
project-cause for Dugger after China and documenta.
tributed individual objects to be raffled at the close of
Given that Pinochet’s government had overthrown the
the festival, while others attended the events. During its
Marxist Allende, this was a clear fight for Marxism.
run some of these works were displayed inside a space
that Dugger designed.
34
Just before the opening of the festival, AFD
Open on October 14, 1974, the Arts Festival for
cosponsored a march and rally for Chile on Trafalgar
Square featuring Hortensia Bussi Allende (Salvador
this unnamed structure transformed the RCA’s interior
Allende’s widow), trade-union representatives, and the
public area into a cohesive environment that loosely
Swedish ambassador to Chile, Gustav Harald Edelstam.
resembled Dugger’s documenta pavilion (fig. 5.5).39
Dugger’s first large-scale banner, Chile Vencera (1974),
Like the previous biomasses that he conceptualized,
was draped behind Allende on Nelson’s column (see fig.
this one drew on the idea of tropical architecture as
I.4). Constructed of twenty vertical strips, the banner,
a model for art as social justice. The space included
when still, depicted a continuous, unbroken scene of
the now-familiar features of painted wood, multiple
35
110 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Returning to Clark’s proposer/proposition model,
chambers, areas of display interspersed with areas for
other ways, his sculpture’s insistence on radicality fell
congregation and participation, and artificial grass.
flat inside a conceptual art practice that placed a prior-
The banners, posters, and wood scaffolding created, as
ity on making flowers and interpersonal connection via
the other installations had, a kind of imagined “Third
plastic tubes. Moreover, the use and reuse of “tropical
World” stage suggesting that the festival was squatting
architecture” without climatic or environmental neces-
the RCA.
sity seemed also to make light of the real stakes named
in Dugger’s practice. As Jiat-Hwee Chang and Anthony
Unlike the other installations, the RCA version did
not announce itself as sculpture; it was untitled and
D. King demonstrate, tropical architecture is a colonial
undesignated in the list of art donated to the festival.
construction in thought and practice.41 By the time
Instead, it was a kind of armature for the performances
he designed the festival environment for the RCA, its
(dance, live art, music, poetry, puppet theater, and
model’s original purpose as a Buddhist spiritual retreat
Liliane Lijn’s Power Game), lectures (notably by the
in Asia essentialized an already tenuous relationship to
actress Constance Cummings; the writer and recently
postcoup Chile as just another Third World site. By 1974,
deposed cultural adviser to Allende, Ariel Dorfman; and
what, after all, would have been either unique or even
the activist German painter Jörg Immendorff), sym-
aesthetically relevant about the imposition of the exotic
posia, and other smaller, topical discussions that took
onto conceptual art? Furthermore, after Hornsey and its
place within its confines. Likely the last of Dugger’s
teach-ins, art schools in England already expected art to
quasi-architectural objects, it was also the one most
be engaged with the world via the site of the school.
collaboratively executed and purpose-built.
40
And yet, there is something compelling about
One of the chief similarities between the RCA,
the ways in which Dugger’s large-scale temporal
Microcosm, and documenta structures was their reliance
quasi-architecture routinely went unnoticed. The
upon material exoticism. Constructed explicitly on
previous invisibility at Kassel was doubled at the RCA
a “rains retreat” model, all of the quasi-architectural
as his “sculpture” effectively faded into the background
spaces used the idea of a tropical environment as a
while events at the art college commanded attention
ready-made utopia wherein art as participation was
for Chile and attendant concerns about art practice
oversimplified as play and where it overly essentialized
and politics.42 In the former, Dugger’s divestment of his
the normative engagement of undertheorized political
role as artist by inviting other artists into the space had
views, be they Marxism, socialism, or, in the case of
subsumed his individual ideas. Collaboration, in this
the RCA, an evocation of the realities of Chile under a
case, had not been a form of compromise but rather one
dictatorship. In some ways, Dugger’s projection of the
of concealment.
exotic into London and Kassel might be understood as
an extension of the protest concepts of 1968 that often
the theorization of later interactive art under the rubric
incorporated theater, civil disruption, and collectivity. In
of relational aesthetics in which the social experience
111 Collectivity, Temporality, Festival Culture
This part of Dugger’s practice occurred well before
of audience and artist formed the basis of the artwork.
projects on the political nature of food production and
What it does share with relational aesthetics, however,
consumption. Like Dugger’s constructions, the plain
is the way in which he set a stage of variable condi-
wood structures Tiravanija builds to prepare and serve
tions (such as the manipulation of space, provision of
the food are rarely discussed as distinct objects. Seghal,
props, or presentation of directives) that allowed the
by contrast, does not make objects. Instead, he places
art space, be it in a museum or the public realm, to
performers into exhibition spaces to speak to, dance
become a temporary social space for equally imper-
with, make music for, or otherwise engage public audi-
manent and unexpected engagement. For the artist,
ences. The resulting work is, like most live art, focused
the entrance of the participant made it an artwork,
on the experiential interaction between performer and
whether readily acknowledged by the participant or
audience.
not. What the failure of the PoPA show demonstrates
is not so much a failure of the interaction as a disjunc-
his audience was not conditioned to see its success.
ture between the concept and its comprehension. The
One might argue the opposite, that its seamlessness
size, scale, and sheer wealth of resources, both human
within the fabric of documenta’s permanent buildings
and financial, that were used to make Dugger’s struc-
and legible art, together with the audience’s response
tures underscore the multiple ways in which art can be
to the Chilean coup, was more conceptually rich than
perceived and—perhaps should be—misperceived. Later,
a practice that announced itself as art rather than life.
when participants readily recognized art that inherited
If documenta 5 was as groundbreaking as art history
this legacy, like that of Adrian Piper’s cards, Rirkrit
has deemed it to be, it was so because of the modern-
Tiravanija’s meals, or Tino Seghal’s conversationalists, it
ist examples of world’s fairs and universal exhibitions
was not due to its success in communicating itself, but
from which it emerged. Inside documenta 5, the People’s
rather to the ability of the participants (largely art-world
Participation Pavilion retained some of that modernist
cognoscenti) to move knowingly into its realm.
undertone as a small-scale model of the exhibition’s
aims. That Dugger looked toward the exotic, rather than
Social practice has taken many forms, but Piper,
Dugger’s work was no less successful because
Tiravanija, and Seghal represent three notable examples
the exploratory, for currency, is proof that he too was
that have influenced other artists and helped muse-
struggling with a modernist/postmodernist binary in
ums shape their exhibition and collecting practices
the form of the conceptual object. He found himself so
of this form. In the 1970s Piper produced a series of
attached to the form that he could not fully realize his
calling cards that she handed out in social situations
idea. Dugger’s quasi-architecture seems to point toward
to respond to specific moments of racism or sexism.
a postmodernist understanding of space while clinging
Similarly, Tiravanija’s makeshift spaces for communal
to modernism’s evocation of time, situated tenuously in
meals are read variously as felicitous opportunities to
between these realms in his insistence on the recogni-
encourage group interaction or as public-awareness
tion of participation.43
112 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Notes
1. See, for one, Buchloh, “Documenta 7,” 109. 2. Alloway, “‘Reality’: Ideology at D5,” 36. 3. Dugger’s biography is drawn from a number of sources, including interviews with the author and James, John Dugger. 4. For an extended review of the Exploding Galaxy, see Drower, 99 Balls Pond Road, and Keeler, Planted. 5. John Dugger interview with the author, August 11, 2009. 6. Clark, “We Refuse.” 7. Ibid., 106. 8. Clark to Hélio Oiticica, Paris, November 14, 1968, in Butler and Pérez-Oramas, Lygia Clark, 232. 9. Gullar, “Manifesto Neoconcreto.” Clark was one of the signatories of the manifesto. 10. John A. Walker’s account of this installation calls Dugger’s work Canalization of Psychic Energy. Walker, Left Shift, 48. The title that I use, Biomass Installation, was supplied by the artist decades after the close of the event. Based on extant installation images and contemporary descriptions, the differing titles reference the same work of art. 11. John Dugger, “In Paris with Lygia Clark,” unpublished text, 2011, 14. 12. See Hélio Oiticica: Whitechapel Experiment. 13. It is unclear what action Clark, Oiticica, and Li Yuan-Chia might have taken in response to the atmosphere of the opening, as they were not present. See Hutton, “Things to Wear”; “Art Preview Ends in Uproar”; Hutton, “Artists Call Spectators Philistines”; “Over-involved”; Everitt, “PoPA at MoMA”; Tisdall, “Participation in Art”; Brett, “Just a Few Hours of Participation.” 14. Floe, “‘Everything Was Getting Smashed.’” Floe notes that she borrowed Dugger’s term “over-participation” but that she has modified its definition. For a comparison of the two uses of the term, see Dugger, “In Paris with Lygia Clark,” 19, 23, and 25. 15. The Microcosm group exhibition was on view at Camden Arts Centre from April 4 to May 2, 1971, while Dugger’s solo contribution opened two days later, on April 6. The music-and-film event held at the Roundhouse in Chalk Farm, Camden Festival ’71, ran from April 25 to May 1, 1971. 16. Trained in cabinetry and woodworking, Krauss opened his gallery in 1968, which occupied the street-level floor of his shop at 29 Neal Street, Covent Garden, London. The gallery was a small enterprise that shared space with his frame shop, which supplied Marlborough and other West End galleries with frame-making services. Sigi Krauss interviews with the author, August 19, 2008, and October 23, 2010. 17. John Dugger e-mail correspondence with the author, January 3, 2012. 18. Steiner, Macrocosm and Microcosm. 19. Krauss’s first wife was Miriam Tinguely, daughter of Swiss artists Jean Tinguely and Eva Aeppli, through whom he was connected
113 Collectivity, Temporality, Festival Culture
to artists in their orbit. Shortly after Dugger’s show ended, Krauss closed the gallery and founded Gallery House, a nonprofit space that became an important venue for experimental art in London in the 1970s. 20. Harald Szeemann to John Dugger, January 25, 1972, collection of John Dugger. 21. Advertisement, Artforum, June 1972. Despite the artists’ call for a more nuanced understanding of their profession, the repeated use of the male pronoun “he,” despite Dorothea Rockburne’s role as one of the nine signatories to the advertisement, suggests the limits of their radicality. 22. The People’s Participation Pavilion included most of Dugger’s series to date: the sonar body series Singing the Body Electric (1969); the part-art flexible construction Let a Hundred Flowers Blossom (1970); a bio-installation with a live snake, Snake Pit (1971); the part-art events Landscape Hats (1968) and Prismatic Conversation in Silver Space (1970); a portrait of Ho Chi Minh, An Inch of Earth Is an Inch of Gold—U.S. Aggressors Get out of Indo-China; the posters Victory to the Just Struggle of the People’s Movement for the Liberation of Angola—M.P.L.A.! (1972) and The Masses Have Boundless Creative Power—Mao Tsetung (1971); and the Artists Liberation Front banner Socialist Art Through Socialist Revolution (1971). See Szeemann, Documenta 5, 47. 23. A Stitch in Time was included in A Survey of the Avant-Garde in Britain, Part 1, September 12–30, 1972, Gallery House, London. Krauss confirmed this description of A Stitch in Time. Sigi Krauss interview with the author, August 21, 2008. According to Medalla, there were several versions of the installation: Museum of Modern Art, Oxford (1970–71), Camden Arts Centre as part of the Camden Arts Festival (1971), the Toeval exhibition at the University of Utrecht (1972), documenta 5 (1972), Gallery House (1972), and the Architectural Association in London (1973). Cited in Benitez, “David Medalla: The 60s and 70s.” 24. Bishop, Artificial Hells, 185–86. Bishop, like Guy Brett before her, also links Medalla to Clark and Oiticica. 25. Braden, “Politics in Art.” 26. Graham Stevens interview with the author, July 21, 2014. The transmobile included in documenta had previously been shown in Willoughby Sharp’s group show, Air Art, which traveled extensively to venues throughout the United States from March 1968 to March 1969. See Sharp, Air Art. 27. Dan Graham’s series of freestanding steel-and-glass public structures, called pavilions, are but one example of the ways in which Dugger’s early example of quasi-architecture in conceptual art has been built upon. See Colomina, “Beyond Pavilions.” 28. Dugger states that he was invited to China in 1972 as a part of a cultural delegation. Telephone interview with John Dugger, August 11, 2009. For a longer discussion of Dugger’s trip to China, see Walker, Left Shift, 87.
29. Backed by the military, Augusto Pinochet led a coup against the elected president Salvador Allende on September 11, 1973. Allende died during the coup, his family went into exile, and Pinochet’s authoritarian rule lasted until 1990. 30. Press release (no. 182, dated 18.4.73) for Pain Things and Explanations, which was on view from May 8 to May 27, 1973, at the ICA. 31. Cecilia Vicuña interview with the author, February 5, 2008. 32. “News and Notes,” 226. May 6 marks the anniversary of protests against the police raid on the Sorbonne that led to rioting by students, teachers, and others in Paris in 1968. A copy of the original handwritten manifesto (from Vicuña’s archive) is reproduced in Artists for Democracy: El Archivo de Cecilia Vicuña, n.p. 33. Rasheed Araeen, “Black Umbrella” organization proposal (January 1984), Panchayat Archive, University of Westminster, Harrow. 34. The Chile Working Committee also included Su Braden, RoseLee Goldberg, Steve Pusey, Conrad Atkinson, and Hugh Cowe. Chile Working Committee notes, May 6, 1974, Cecilia Vicuña Archive. In a CV from 1977, Brett listed himself as the co-organizer of the festival and cofounder of AFD. Correspondence between Guy Brett and N. Wadley, March 17, 1977, Jasia Reichardt Letters, Getty Research Institute, Los Angeles. 35. See Leggett and Hopkins, Chile Lucha. 36. The march and rally were organized by the British Joint Labour Movement and the Chile Solidarity Campaign, of which Vicuña was a leader. 37. The Arts Festival for Democracy in Chile was on view at the Royal College of Art from October 14 to October 30, 1974. The London-based artists were not the only ones to take on the issue of Chile following the coup. In October 1974 the Venice Biennale hosted theater and cinema under the title Libertà per il Cile. Dorfman came to London directly from the events in Venice. In New York, the Chile Emergency Exhibition took place March 2–16, 1974. The committee of organizing artists included Carl Andre, Dore Ashton, Rudolph Baranik, Arnold Belkin, Hortense Carpentier, Enrique Castro-Cid, Karen Clahassey, Gonzalo Fonseca, Juan Gomez-Quiroz, Judie Hand de Gomez, Edys Hunter, Li-lan, Lucy Lippard, and Irving Penn. Chile Emergency Exhibition to Sylvia Sleigh, March 27, 1974, Sylvia Sleigh Papers, Getty Research Institute, Los Angeles, Accession no. 2004.M.4, Box 30, Folder 9.
114 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
38. According to the exhibition checklist, 326 artworks were donated to the event. Untitled document, Cecilia Vicuña Archive. 39. My description of the RCA event is compiled from several sources, including interviews with Araeen, Brett, Dugger, Tina Keane, Krauss, Lynn MacRitchie, Medalla, Jonathan Miles, John Phillips, Jun Terra, Stevens, and Vicuña, and MacRitchie’s film, Festival for Democracy in Chile, 1974. Save for Dugger, none of those interviewed gave conclusive descriptions of his structure at the show. MacRitchie, Phillips, and Vicuña have, however, identified some sort of structure within the RCA space that may have been spearheaded by Dugger. MacRitchie went so far as to describe the structure as either a “favela” or a “shantytown,” descriptions that support a contemporary comprehension of Dugger’s Pavilion refitted for use as a stand-in for Chile postcoup. 40. The festival’s schedule details a wide-ranging program, from discussions on Chile and its art movements to performances of Indian classical music and the Chicago ballet. Importantly, the festival united disparate avant-garde art groups in the following subject-specific symposia: Latin American Art and Culture (October 15), Asian and Middle East Art and Culture (October 18), African and Caribbean Art and Culture (October 25), and Experimental Forms of Art (October 29). See “International Arts Festival for the Chilean Resistance at the RCA and AMP,” Lynn MacRitchie Archive. 41. Chang and King, “Towards a Genealogy of Tropical Architecture.” 42. Dugger’s sculpture aside, the festival, including exhibition and auction, was wildly successful as an art enterprise though less so as a fundraiser for Chile. The festival solidified the group’s relationship to British art during this period, confirmed their widespread international art networks, and set the stage for the politically motivated events that AFD would support for the remainder of its short existence. Though AFD splintered almost immediately after the festival ended, several of the artists involved formed their own groups. Jonathan Miles and others left to form the Poster-Film Collective. John Phillips and Pippa Smith founded Paddington Printshop (now London Print Studio) in west London. By 1977 Medalla had re-formed AFD in Fitzrovia as a physical space for exhibitions, performances, live art, and film, modeled on the multidimensional documenta exhibition. 43. For a longer discussion of postmodernism as space and modernism as time, see Lee, New Games, 26–28.
6. 6. 6. 6. 6. 6. 6. 6. 6. 6.
Taking the Trouble to Sound It Mediating Conflict in the Work of Rita Donagh Catherine Spencer
Between 1973 and 1974 Rita Donagh worked on a paint-
and 1980s after the reemergence of sectarian violence
ing that, although influenced by “the events taking place
between Loyalist Unionists and Nationalist Republicans,
in Northern Ireland,” remained for the majority of its
who wanted to break away from Britain. While the
maturation “a more generalized expression of conflict.”1
Loyalist Ulster Volunteer Force claimed responsibility
In May 1974, however, the temporal and spatial poli-
for the 1974 irruption of violence in the Irish Republic’s
tics of what ultimately became Evening Papers (Ulster
capital, it was later alleged that British intelligence had
1972–74) (1973–74) crystallized decisively when Donagh
been involved, demonstrating the web of agency and
encountered a photograph in the Sunday Times showing
responsibility in which Donagh’s oeuvre is imbricated.4
the aftermath of a car bomb in Dublin (fig. 6.1).2 The
The critic Paul Overy noted in 1977 that Donagh had
documentary photograph of a body lying prone in the
produced “some of the few paintings to have dealt
street, covered with newspapers from a nearby vendor
with the troubles in Ireland.”5 Her work attends to a
in an attempt to grant the dead a degree of decency
context that has tended to recede into the background
after “three separate car bombs went off without
of discussions about art in Britain during the late 1960s
warning . . . causing carnage during the evening rush
and 1970s.6
hour,” triggered multiple studies and sketches, providing
a visual and conceptual anchor for Evening Papers. This
Union made Ireland part of Britain. By the early twenti-
painting marked the beginning of Donagh’s sustained
eth century, however, support for home rule had gained
investigation into Northern Ireland during the 1970s
traction, and following the Government of Ireland Act
3
After centuries of colonization, in 1800 the Acts of
Fig. 6.1 Rita Donagh, Evening Papers (Ulster 1972–74), 1973–74. Oil, pencil, and collage on canvas, 140 × 200 cm. British Council Collection. © Rita Donagh.
of 1920 and the Anglo-Irish Treaty of 1921, Ireland was
engagement with Northern Ireland. Donagh’s family
partitioned, with the “Six Counties” of Northern Ireland
had roots in Ireland, but she herself was born in
remaining part of Britain, separated from the Irish Free
Staffordshire.10 As Donagh has reflected, “during the
State (later the Republic of Ireland) in the south. By the
’70s I spent a long time trying to make an image, a
late 1960s tensions within Northern Ireland between
painting, of a victim of a car bomb, a young woman
the predominantly Catholic Republicans and Protestant
who was killed, whose photograph I saw in a newspa-
Unionists had again reached a crisis point. The inter-
per. Living in England, it was necessarily a very distant
secting influences fomenting this restlessness spanned
view of the event, and most of my information at that
religion, politics, class, and economics: the historian
time came obviously from the media.” Donagh’s work
Andy Beckett recounts that “by the late sixties,”
of the 1970s searches for critical purchase on this
despite attempts by Northern Ireland’s prime minis-
“persistent separation,” testing out the paradoxical
ter Terence O’Neill to modernize the country’s ailing
state of detached proximity offered by the mass media
industrial sector, “the empire and the boom were over,
of newspaper, radio, and television via the record-
and Belfast’s empty factories and patchy government
ing and transmission technologies of photography,
regeneration projects were a bleak vision in lumpy con-
sound, film, and video.11 Considering Evening Papers
crete and orphaned brick of what might await the rest
(Ulster 1972–74), Overy noted “the horrible irony of the
of the UK.” Many members of the Catholic minority
picture of a body covered in newspapers appearing
felt particularly disadvantaged by unemployment and
itself in a newspaper,” encapsulating the ramifica-
uneven housing allocation, leading to the formation of
tions of Donagh’s chosen image, which combined the
the Northern Ireland Civil Rights Association in 1967
affective qualities of visceral trauma with the dis-
and mounting civil unrest, protest, and violence, focused
tortions and disjunctions of press reportage viewed
on Belfast and Derry. On August 14, 1969, after days of
from the remove of England.12 Indeed, Donagh initially
confrontation between Catholic citizens and the Royal
believed from contemporary press reports that the
Ulster Constabulary in the Bogside area of Derry (also
body under the newspapers was that of the vendor: in
known as Londonderry), and the spread of severe fight-
1976 she made a “pilgrimage” to the site, where she
ing to Belfast, the British Army was sent in to restore
was told that the victim was a male bystander, before
order; although supposedly a temporary measure, these
eventually discovering it was a teenage girl.13 The
events “initiated over thirty years of violence, murder
newspaper’s veiling effect also correlates with govern-
and mayhem.”9 In response, during the 1970s Donagh
ment and internal censorship of the British mainstream
started to address these conditions of conflict and
media’s reportage on Northern Ireland throughout
mediation in her work.
the 1970s and into the 1980s. As Liz Curtis and other
historians have demonstrated, this had its roots in the
7
8
It is significant that a newspaper photograph
printed on the British mainland prompted Donagh’s
117 Taking the Trouble to Sound It
decades after partition, when, “coupled with the veto
Fig. 6.2 Rita Donagh, Reflection on Three Weeks in May 1970, 1971. Oil and graphite on canvas, 152.4 × 152.4 cm. © Rita Donagh.
on parliamentary discussion and the absence of ‘the
late 1970s and 1980s she spent increasing amounts
Irish question’ from school and university curricula, the
of time in Belfast, where she was a visiting lecturer
media silence meant that British people were scarcely
and external examiner at the art school, this chap-
aware of the existence of the Six Counties, let alone of
ter concentrates on her exploration of information
the perverse and abusive system that was being oper-
transmission over distance.15 Contemporary critical
ated in their name.”14
responses underscored the differences between
Donagh’s work, then, is concerned with both the
Donagh’s paintings and the experimental forms of
mediatization and the mediation of conflict from the
artistic production that were perhaps more readily
vantage point of mainland Britain. Although in the
associated with the art worlds of London and Britain
118 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
during the 1970s. Marina Vaizey argued that Donagh’s
Soundings: Mapping the Studio
painting “demonstrates, in a way . . . conceptual art does not, that thought into art can work; that what
For the writer Cherry Smyth, Donagh acquired with
appears a tracery of lines, some delicate odd shapes
Evening Papers (Ulster 1972–74) “a signature that was
can [be] . . . meaningful and far from cold-blooded.”16
to endure for over a decade,” which involved “placing
Yet Donagh did have links with conceptual art, and
components of a tragedy on the canvas like exhibits
she developed an expanded painterly practice that
in a murder trial and letting the multiple subjectivi-
not only holds abstraction and figuration in tension
ties interrelate.”18 Donagh’s account of how the image
but incorporates collaged elements such as photo-
showing the Dublin car-bomb victim “was not intro-
graphs, tracing paper, graph paper, and newsprint
duced” into Evening Papers (Ulster 1972–74) “until it was
fragments, and has expanded into installation. Equally,
well advanced” intimates that the painting developed in
although Donagh’s work did not engage directly with
the manner of a diagram or map, onto which she could
the women’s liberation movement of the 1970s, it was
plot distinct events over time, enabling later additions
shaped by the debates that movement sparked in the
and evolving relationships.19 This approach was forged
art world. Ultimately, her paintings are concerned with
through Donagh’s large-scale early work Reflection on
the politics and ethics of communication and reception,
Three Weeks in May 1970 (1971), where cartography
addressed through abstraction.
emerges not simply as an organizing device for visual
material but as a conceptual strategy that mediates
17
In order to understand the particular perspec-
tive that Donagh’s work brought to bear on Britain’s
between image and experience (fig. 6.2).
geopolitical situation in the 1970s, this chapter begins
by establishing her development of abstract painting
in “a specific period in a specific studio.” Donagh
as a mode of mediation, grounding this in her experi-
set herself the “challenge” of translating events and
ence of teaching. It then demonstrates how this led to
activities conducted with her students at the School of
her formal and conceptual engagement with the act of
Fine Art, University of Reading, in the south of England
mediation, arguing that while Donagh’s works deliver
near London, where she taught between 1964 and 1972,
the viewer into conditions of distance and indetermi-
onto “the flat surface of a painting” and into a network
nacy, they nonetheless remain invested in the politics
of geometric, predominantly abstract pencil marks and
of particular times, places, and bodies. The resulting
passages of paint.20 Donagh recalled how “on the first
images test the slippery, elusive quality of national
day a room was painted white throughout, including the
identity, exposing the elisions between constructs such
floor. A student devised a grid as a means of regulating
as “England” and “Britain,” and the pressure brought
movement within the space. Crosses were put on the
to bear on such terms by decolonization, protest, and
grid to mark squares where movement was prohib-
conflict in the postwar period.
ited.” As a result, “the studio became a stage—action/
119 Taking the Trouble to Sound It
Reflection on Three Weeks in May 1970 was grounded
performance being a natural expression of group
side a thin wavering ribbon of red runs from the top
creativity.” This new environment of the studio/
to the bottom of the picture plane. These derive from
stage provided a forum for undertakings that “included
drawings made by the American transcendentalist
drawing and writing, and lots of discussion in reac-
writer Henry David Thoreau in his 1854 book Walden,
tion to circumstances inside and beyond the studio.”22
which recorded his attempt to “live deliberately,” by
During the three weeks, Donagh and the group “took
a pond in Massachusetts, for a year.25 In one section
many photographs,” which record the students explor-
Thoreau recounts how he surveyed the pond’s previously
ing the interactive zone they had established, moving
unmeasured depths: “As I was desirous to recover the
around the crosses marked on the white floor. One
long lost bottom of Walden Pond, I surveyed it carefully,
image shows a student preparing to make a life study of
before the ice broke up, early in ’46, with compass and
another standing several feet away, the first holding up
chain and sounding line. There have been many stories
the nub of a pencil (or a thumb) in order to gauge the
told about the bottom, or rather no bottom, of this pond,
scale. In another photograph, a figure moves off to one
which certainly had no foundation for themselves. It is
side of the frame, leaving behind scattered detritus—
remarkable how long men will believe in the bottomless-
reminiscent of rags left over from cleaning paintbrushes.
ness of a pond without taking the trouble to sound it.”26
The camera tracks the students as they move away
Donagh’s imagination snagged on the “sensitive plot-
from traditional learning activities and toward a more
ting” that Thoreau undertook.27 She had already traced
collaborative and experimental approach.
and retraced the contours of the maps that Thoreau
made of the pond’s circumference and depth, subjecting
21
23
The final canvas shows the studio grid and its
crosses transposed onto the surface both diagrammat-
them to sustained investigation in a painting entitled
ically and in three-dimensional perspective, but the
“taking the trouble to sound it” (1970). Donagh pushes the
actions and bodies of the students are implied rather
contours of Thoreau’s map through a series of mirror
than represented. The modulation between flatness
reflections, refractions, and reversals to create a restless
and depth across a series of tessellating creamy-white
overlay of rippling lines (fig. 6.3). As in Reflection on Three
squares and triangles has a disorienting effect. Tim
Weeks in May 1970, planar flatness oscillates almost
Hilton concludes that Donagh often uses perspective
queasily with perspective, while shading suggests both
“not to pin things down and locate them in space—its
the undulation of indeterminate landscapes and a series
traditional function—but to veil or obfuscate their
of overlapping watermarks. Thoreau’s account of “taking
position.”24 Yet this constant fluctuation also conveys an
the trouble to sound” Walden Pond offers empirical
active sense of process and translation. This is under-
measurements, but Donagh’s citation of his charts and
scored by Donagh’s incorporation of motifs that allude
maps undermines the notion of a sure terrain.
to mapping and charting: to the right Donagh placed
an outline shaped like a sliver of glass, while on the left
using abstract signs and the convention of perspective,
120 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Donagh herself described how she hoped, “by
Fig. 6.3 Rita Donagh, “taking the trouble to sound it,” 1970. Oil, pencil, and colored pencil on hardboard, 91 × 122 cm. Arts Council Collection, Southbank Centre, London. © Rita Donagh.
to find equivalents for experience and feeling while at
from perceptual experience and from the specificities
the same time conveying precise information about
of locality and named spaces, her treatment of abstrac-
a particular time and place.” Yet as Sarat Maharaj
tion allows room for the body.30 Reflection on Three
notes, Donagh also “teases out and plays upon a
Weeks in May 1970 contains the traces of performance
particular feature of the map: the fact that, if it gives
and movement and reveals Donagh mediating between
us what we tend to take for granted as an accurate
haptic experience and the formal grid. As Briony Fer
account of the ‘world out there,’ it also looks radically
has written of the American artist Agnes Martin,
unlike what it represents.” The act of mapping enables
Donagh’s grids are “repetitive but never mechanical.”31
Donagh to acknowledge the abstraction and distortion
Equally, Donagh’s work manifests what Sven Lütticken
that might occur during knowledge transmission, but
describes as the aim “not so much to oppose abstrac-
rather than present abstract mark making as divorced
tion with ‘concrete facts’” as “to make concrete the
28
29
121 Taking the Trouble to Sound It
omnipresence of abstraction.” Although Lütticken is
regarded as post facto: discussion groups, political
talking specifically about the “concrete abstraction” of
treaties and philosophical tracts became required read-
finance and technology, Donagh would become partic-
ing.”37 The collaborative, discursive structure Donagh
ularly concerned with the abstracting processes of the
established also reverberates with the widespread
mass media.32
student unrest of 1968, which in Britain achieved its
most prominent manifestation at the Hornsey College
This expansive attitude toward abstraction can be
traced to Donagh’s Basic Design training, developed by
of Art occupations in London. Lisa Tickner records that
the artists Richard Hamilton and Victor Pasmore in the
student demands at Hornsey included “the freedom
Fine Art Department of Durham University, Newcastle
to formulate and develop a more flexible ‘network’
upon Tyne, in the North East of England, where she
structure of education; and an atmosphere in which
studied between 1956 and 1962. Hilton attributes
grievances could be freely vented and changes intro-
the difficulty of categorizing Donagh’s practice to the
duced.”38 The three weeks of experimental activity that
fact that she “is not the product of any real school of
Donagh meditated on during the construction of her
painting but of the ‘Basic Design’ courses of provincial
painting, whereby students occupied and sounded out
art schools in the early Sixties.” Basic Design exercises
their studio space at Reading, resonates with con-
sought to refocus students’ attention on mark making
temporaneous debates about the nature and purpose
and were concerned with “relating [the] introspective
of education, particularly in the art-school context,
consideration of abstract elements through analytical
resulting in an attempt to diagrammatize the politically
drawings of objects to the visual world surrounding
charged state of collectivity.
33
34
the student.” Reflection on Three Weeks in May 1970 35
expands this experiential process to incorporate the entirety of the studio. The pedagogic context, involving
Disruptions: Kent State and Civil Disobedience
the construction of creative environments conducive to information exchange, can be seen as a formative
Reflection on Three Weeks in May 1970 moreover
influence on Donagh’s handling of mediation, as her
explicitly registers student antiwar protest. Among
“sounding” of interactive processes demonstrates.
the painting’s vectors and shaded squares, positioned
36
There are affinities between the experiment
just to the center left of a hairline divide bisecting the
Donagh undertook with her Reading students and those
composition, a faint pinkish spill in the shape of an
at other art-education institutions in this period, notably
island can be discerned, which “perturbs” the geomet-
Peter Kardia’s teaching and his 1969 “Locked Room”
ric grids.39 While its contour echoes the topographical
initiative at St. Martin’s School of Art. Kardia’s studio
marks on the right, derived from Thoreau, it also
space became “a quasi-seminar room” where students
references the occasion on which students protesting
were encouraged “to draw upon sources previously
against U.S. military intervention in the Vietnam War
122 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Fig. 6.4 Rita Donagh, Bloodstains, 1971. Pencil, gouache, and collage on paper, 51 × 76.5 cm. Private collection. © Rita Donagh.
were shot by Ohio National Guardsmen at Kent State
placing this reproduction at the intersection of a hor-
University on May 4, 1970, news of which entered the
izontal and vertical line (fig. 6.4). This has the effect
studio in Reading via the radio.
of fusing the “crossed-out” areas of the studio floor
with a reference to the crosshairs that fix a target in
One of the many studies that Donagh made in
connection with Reflection on Three Weeks in May
the sights of a gun. A smear of blue gouache paint
1970—which include First Perspective (1970), White
pools like blood over the figure in the lower right-hand
Room (1971), and White Studio (1971)—is entitled
corner of the photograph, while the standing student
Bloodstains (1971). Like other works in this series,
has been erased completely, reduced to a bright white
Bloodstains draws on the photographs made of
vacuum, bearing out Hilton’s observation that “often it
Donagh’s students during their studio experimenta-
seems that the impulse of Donagh’s brush is to obliter-
tion. Here she has transposed the photograph of one
ate.”40 Donagh’s return to the images of events in the
student preparing to make a life drawing of another,
studio conveys a sense of the photographs themselves
123 Taking the Trouble to Sound It
as performative, functioning as reminder, prompt, and
media theorist Marshall McLuhan’s assertion in
provocation. Equally, Donagh’s treatment of mediated
Understanding Media (1964) that media technologies
images—her combination of photographs with pencil
had “extended our central nervous system . . . in a global
drawings and her exclusion of them entirely from the
embrace, abolishing both space and time. . . . action
final painting—reiterates the interpolation of distance
and the reaction occur almost at the same time.”43 In
and difference, both geographic and temporal. To the
Reflection on Three Weeks in May 1970 the space of dis-
left of the composition, the bloodstain shape from
course is similarly widened and dissolved by the mass
Reflection on Three Weeks in May 1970 appears four
media. The irruption of blood registers not just the
times in black, crimson, and white silhouette, and
blurring of public and private effected by communica-
twice as a pencil outline against a grid. This back-
tion technologies but also the burden of responsibility
ground emulates the graph paper that Donagh used in
that accompanies interconnection.
other preparatory studies, emphasizing the obsessive
quality of this attempt to plot and rationalize the stains
bloodstain” used by Donagh as a photograph taken
and the impossibility of containing their traumatic
by her partner, the artist Richard Hamilton, of the
implications.
TV screen during a live newscast of Kent State.44 Yet
In Reflections on Three Weeks in May 1970 the
the difference between Donagh’s and Hamilton’s
bloodstain is all the more troubling because of its
responses to Kent State is instructive. Hamilton
singularity, which contrasts with the surrounding
recounts how, in the early months of 1970, “it had been
geometric forms, but also because it contaminates
on my mind that there might be a subject staring me
the series of red guide dots that underpin the grid
in the face from the TV screen. I set up a camera in
with a shared implication of bodily fluids. Drawing on
front of the TV for a week. Every night I sat watching
blood’s status as an index for a specific body, Donagh
with a shutter release in my hand.” Although among
establishes a link between paint and flesh, connecting
the images flickering over the screen there were “many
the students in the studio with their peers on another
possibilities” that Hamilton avidly “snapped,” the Kent
continent. Donagh recalled: “Of course we talked about
State shootings produced “the most powerful images
it and everybody felt acutely that we were in such a
that emerged from the camera,” although he felt “a
privileged position. We were all having a really marvel-
reluctance to use any of them.”45 When commissioned
lous time, working away in the studio thinking about
to make a print later that year, however, it was to
art, while students in America were being shot on
the Kent State images that he turned, homing in on
campus.” The stain signals the collapse of geographic
footage of the student Dean Kahler, who, although
distance through mass-media technologies, and the
not killed in the attack, was left paralyzed. Kent State
resultant bond of solidarity, but also of unavoidable
(1970) was a complex print because of the multiple
implication, transmitted across borders. This echoes
different colors involved; Mark Godfrey describes how
41
42
124 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Suzi Gablik cites the source for the “contour of a
a large amount of time and labor was “devoted to
Transmissions: Northern Ireland in and out of the News
crafting and disseminating a picture that would keep alive an image of an atrocity that television producers
Although Donagh’s change in focus from the space
were content to flash before their audiences and then
of the studio to the theater of war in Northern Ireland
replace with the next news item.”46 Both Hamilton’s
might seem unexpected, Reflection on Three Weeks
print and Donagh’s painting attempt to slow down the
in May 1970 and her later works share a consistent
rapidity of media dissemination and in so doing create
engagement with civil resistance. As Caroline Tisdall
opportunities for thought, remembrance, and memo-
observes, Donagh’s reference to Thoreau in the 1971
rialization. Through their interventions, both artists
painting might invoke his 1849 essay Resistance to Civil
arrived at degrees of abstraction—Hamilton’s decom-
Government as much as Walden.49 Together with the
posing, ragged blur and Donagh’s subtle stain—which
crumpled mass of newspaper derived from reportage
simultaneously relay information and convey a sense
of the Dublin bombs in 1974, Evening Papers (Ulster
of loss, underscoring the potentially deadening experi-
1972–74) contains two other elements that relate to the
ence of daily media inundation even as they mine it for
emergence of the civil-rights movement in Northern
residual meaning.
Ireland and to the events that ensued in the Bogside
area of Derry between 1968 and 1972. These two
Their responses diverge, however, in that Hamilton
suspends the televised broadcast through the silk-
elements are the dark-blue trapezoid just below the
screen’s alternate mode of reproduction, while Donagh
center left of the image, marked by a black cross in one
situates her reference to Kent State within a painting
corner, and the upper left-hand rectangle containing the
that maps a shared zone, however ephemeral or tran-
blinding flash of an explosion surrounded by a shimmer-
sient the communal space of the Reading studio might
ing penumbra of cloud.
have been. In this respect John Russell’s analysis of the
final image as “not so much a portrait of the scene as
and tinged with bruised purples and blues, is one that
a portrait of its nervous system” is perceptive, regis-
Donagh returned to elsewhere. A year after she finished
tering the image’s implicit demand that it be conceived
Evening Papers, Donagh used it as the basis for an
of in relation not only to McLuhan’s vision of global
experimental display at The Gallery in London. Founded
interchange but to an embodied network of individual
by Nicholas Wegner in 1972 and directed collabora-
The image of the explosion, rendered in dark brown
actors. The disruption of relational space Donagh
tively with other artists, including the sculptor Vaughan
charted in Reflection on Three Weeks in May 1970, using a
Grylls, The Gallery promoted ironic conceptual gestures
process that Michael Bracewell has eloquently iden-
and, after the autumn of 1973, adopted photography
tified as “socio-analytical cartography,” provided the
as the format for all its shows. They also began dis-
foundation for her turn toward the political situation in
playing, within aluminium frames, photographs and
Northern Ireland in the mid-1970s.
photographic reproductions of works in other media,
47
48
125 Taking the Trouble to Sound It
resulting in what Tisdall has described as an “enterpris-
display this work in London venues such as The Gallery
ing programme of processing and packaging,” which by
demonstrates a subtle but nonetheless powerfully felt
the time of Donagh’s exhibit in 1975 had “become the
commitment to bearing witness, despite—and even
closest to a house style that any London gallery” had.
in an attempt to correct—the perceptual gulf between
The curator and critic Catherine Lampert observes that
mainland Britain and Northern Ireland.54
these strategies allowed each of the exhibitions “to be
treated with the same professional detachment and
Sun and the Daily Sketch and offered a visceral account
emphasis on the non-exclusive.” Donagh’s decision,
of the violence that engulfed the Bogside area of Derry
however, to use a drawing of an explosion entitled Car
after the civil-rights marches of 1968 and 1969, empha-
Bomb (1973) as the basis of her display disturbed this
sizing the adverse living conditions of many Catholics
detachment. Car Bomb was photographed and enlarged,
in Northern Ireland and presenting the conflict as “a
then printed in reverse so that it could be mounted on
colonial war, fought between the Protestant settlers,
the back as well as the front of a freestanding display
planted by the English conquerors centuries ago, and
panel. The source image came from the photojournalist
the native Catholics.”55 Limpkin’s tone chimes with the
Clive Limpkin’s book The Battle of Bogside, published in
initial support of the media, inspired by the civil-rights
1972. By taking a piece of photojournalism republished
movement, particularly after a march from Belfast to
in a book and subjecting it to further reproductions
Derry on October 5, 1968, was met with violence by
through pencil and then rephotography, Donagh seems
the Royal Ulster Constabulary.56 The civil-rights activist
to have tried to bring these gradations of distance to the
Eamonn McCann has described how, on arrival in Derry,
surface of the image.
“two police cordons moved simultaneously on the
crowd. Men, women and children were clubbed to the
50
51
52
Yet despite this percolation, it evidently retained a
Limpkin’s photobook grew out of his work for the
charge: Lampert recounts that the sharpened contrast
ground. People were fleeing down the street from the
endowed by black-and-white photography, when com-
front cordon . . . crashing into one another, stumbling
bined with the “provocative subject matter,” achieved
over one another, huddling in doorways, some scream-
“the starkness and brevity of an underground political
ing.”57 Television transmission of this violence forced
poster.” Lampert was not wholly convinced by this shift
Northern Ireland back into British consciousness. The
from what she considered the “broader visual language”
historian Robert J. Savage describes how the event was
of Evening Papers (Ulster 1972–74), but the comparison
captured on film as it unfolded in all its brutality, and
between Donagh’s photographed drawing and a polit-
the “sensational footage made its way into the BBC
ical poster conveys the residual disturbance that her
programme Twenty-Four Hours, causing uproar. . . . [It]
imagery often seems intended to cause, despite the var-
was picked up by international news organizations and
ious filters it is subjected to, from hesitant mark making
broadcast around the world.”58 There was a certain irony
to blotting out with white paint.53 Donagh’s decision to
to this sudden media efflorescence of Northern Irish
126 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
concerns, for, as Dominic Sandbrook writes, although
discrimination against Catholics was long-standing,
1978 a furor erupted over the exhibition Art for Society:
“until the mid-sixties, Northern Ireland virtually never
Contemporary British Art with a Social or Political Purpose,
made it into the British newspapers or news bulle-
which traveled from the Whitechapel Art Gallery in
tins, usually being mentioned only in the context of a
London to the Ulster Museum in Belfast, where art
royal visit.” The appearance of images documenting
handlers refused to hang certain works by Conrad
these clashes thus paradoxically underscored the prior
Atkinson, Margaret Harrison, and Alexis Hunter,
absence of commentary, revealing attempts to repress
including Atkinson’s Silver Liberties: A Souvenir of a
and elide divergent politics.
Wonderful Anniversary Year (1978), which reproduced
graffiti from a wall in Belfast of a British soldier with a
59
The heavy-handed response of the Royal Ulster
Such censorship extended to art exhibitions: in
Constabulary led to escalating fighting in the Bogside,
nose like a pig and featured photographs of the victims
which included the gelignite bomb that provided
of Bloody Sunday. This triggered a decision on the part
Donagh with her image of an explosion. The “before”
of the trustees to cancel the exhibition, because they
image in Limpkin’s book shows a small van parked
deemed that “in the present violent times in Ulster
innocuously on a suburban street; moments later all
. . . the whole of the exhibition . . . could have suffered
identifying features apart from the trail of double-yellow
damage or destruction.”61 Their act prompted wide-
lines have been engulfed in a haze of dust and debris.
spread condemnation and extensive discussion in the
Donagh’s chosen imagery is rooted in the civilian
Northern Irish press.62 Donagh’s work featured in the
sufferings on the Bogside but offers a much less secure
show, but in contrast to the overt critique mounted
vantage point than that claimed by photojournalism.
by Atkinson’s engagement with Northern Ireland, and
The deliberate obfuscations and obliterations of her
his incorporation of documentary photography, her
mark making are significant in this respect, in that they
paintings consistently took a deliberately distanced
register the extent to which the British media, particu-
and abstracted view. While her works document the
larly BBC Television, was, by the time the imagery had
process of “taking the trouble to sound” the Northern
cohered for Evening Papers Ulster (1972–74), increasingly
Ireland situation, they acknowledge what Robert
subject to both self-censorship from within and explicit
Hewison has described as the “psychological barrier
governmental control whereby reporting considered
of the Irish Sea” and its insulating force.63 In particular,
sympathetic to the civil-rights or Nationalist cause was
Donagh’s paintings register the delays and interfer-
excised.60 This was especially so after the arrival of
ence that fragment the transmission of media imagery,
British troops in 1969, the introduction of internment
especially with regard to Northern Ireland in mainland
without trial in 1971, and the suspension of the Stormont
Britain. Yet they also contain the power to surprise with
government in 1972, which resulted in the introduction
an immediate affective, even physical relation, while
of direct rule from Westminster.
implying that discontinuities in transmission might in
127 Taking the Trouble to Sound It
and of themselves be traumatic because of their disori-
of 1972 and the Dublin bombings of 1974, but the work
enting effects.
offers equivalents for multiple experiences.
This double valence of mediation as simultaneously
This is emphasized by the right-hand side of the
marking and bridging distance informs the third incident
canvas, edged with a vertical strip of marbled purple,
plotted in Evening Papers (Ulster 1972–74). The cross
blue, and green, the abstracted lines and shapes of
relates to one of the worst atrocities in the Bogside
which suggest the modulations of an Ordnance Survey
during January 1972, when British army paratroopers
map. The brooding coloration evokes landscape and
shot dead thirteen unarmed Catholic civilians (a four-
environmental conditions; the diagonal slashes that
teenth victim died later of his wounds). The difference
cover the whole canvas like daggers of rain continue
between Donagh’s handling of the massacre and
these implications of foreboding weather. Placed in rela-
Atkinson’s in Silver Liberties is striking. Again, Donagh’s
tion to the three fragments of imagery relating to key
imagery can be linked back to Limpkin’s book. The pho-
moments of violence in Northern Ireland, the abstract-
tojournalist captured the temporary memorials created
ing processes of mapping and cartography become
to mark these deaths: small wooden crosses, each held
linked to colonizing processes. For many commenta-
together with a lash of rubber binding, which formed a
tors on the left, and for the Irish Republican Army, the
secondary cross. Donagh’s oblique reference to what
situation in Northern Ireland represented a colonial war,
became known as Bloody Sunday quietly but firmly asks
and they “could not help identifying the Londonderry
the viewer to consider “the fact of the British presence
Bogsiders with the Vietcong and the British army with
in Ulster.” At the same time, Donagh’s formal abstrac-
the U.S. in Vietnam.”66 Even though this represents
tion of the cross-shaped marker in Evening Papers
a huge simplification of the complex identifications
also connects the painting to the networked “nervous
at stake, Paul Dixon outlines how the British govern-
system” encompassed by Reflection on Three Weeks in
ment and military after 1969 undeniably approached
May 1970. Sarah Kent notes that the cross in Evening
Northern Ireland as a colonial problem: “when violence
Papers marks the deaths during Bloody Sunday but also
failed to subside the conflict was increasingly seen in
invokes “the crosses in the earlier work and by impli-
‘colonial’ terms and the use of repression was justified
cation . . . the ‘Kent State Massacre.’” Although the
to subdue ‘sinister forces.’”67 This approach increased
maplike surfaces of Donagh’s paintings often suggest
after the Conservative election victory in 1970 and
barriers or encodings that reflect the distortions and
under Margaret Thatcher’s government, from 1979. Even
distancing of the mass media, the cross in Evening
before Thatcher, the attitude of the British government
Papers also acts as a holding point or memorial marker
and establishment to the political situation in Northern
that establishes correlations between transnational
Ireland was informed by their experience of decoloni-
and transtemporal events and conflicts. The painting’s
zation, notably the Rhodesian crisis of 1965.68 Although
title ties it to a temporal span between Bloody Sunday
Donagh would subsequently use the map of the “Six
64
65
128 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Counties” in her work, in Evening Papers (Ulster 1972–74)
often reacting by throwing themselves into geometry, or
the fragment of landscape remains nonspecific. While
a theory or system. The risk was ‘losing the part of your-
it evokes Northern Ireland’s contested geography, the
self that has to do with feeling.’”71 This is attested by the
marbled and misted terrain situates this land within
feminist performance artist Anne Bean, who attended
the wider process of revision and renegotiation that
the University of Reading in the early 1970s and recalled
accompanied the decolonization of the British Empire,
that Donagh’s development of performative actions
as countries previously subject to British rule achieved
from life-drawing classes, of the kind photographed
independence and postcolonial diaspora movements
for Reflection on Three Weeks in May 1970, provided “an
pushed for reconceptualizations of “national” identity.
incredibly fertile ground for exploration with people and
It also gestures toward the intractability of the situation
within one’s own practice.”72
in Northern Ireland due to its longstanding history, and
the competing claims and atrocities on both sides.
ment was far from clear-cut.73 In 1977 Tisdall chose
69
Donagh’s relationship with the women’s move-
to write about Donagh for a special issue of Studio International on “women artists in the United Kingdom.” Diagramming a Conclusion: The Politics of Distance
Tisdall confessed that she was “struggling to think of Rita Donagh’s work within the context of this women’s
The experience of painting Evening Papers (Ulster
issue”—an identification the artist herself also report-
1972–74) was crucial for the development of Donagh’s
edly “finds difficult.” Rather than directly align Donagh
work, with the result that from the mid-1970s “the
with feminist politics, Tisdall alighted on “the resolution
question of Civil Rights in the North of Ireland took
of opposites” as central to Donagh’s work.74 This might
precedence” over other concerns, including the issue
sound like a compromise, but Tisdall makes a signifi-
of “women’s rights.” Yet the politics of Donagh’s
cant point about the license provided by the feminist
work nonetheless encompasses feminism alongside
reprioritization of lived, subjective experience as valid
civil rights and student protest. Sacha Craddock, a
material for art making—for “the externalization of inner
participant in the squatting communities that housed
feeling.”75 Donagh’s response to the conflict in Northern
many radical and feminist artists in London during
Ireland is indebted to, albeit elliptically, the fusion of
this period, has argued that the women’s movement
personal with political fostered by the women’s liber-
facilitated Donagh’s experiments in figuration and
ation movement in the context of artistic production.
abstraction: “students and younger artists encouraged
Both Donagh’s and Tisdall’s references to “feeling” and
her to incorporate both public and private, decorative
the experience of identification are resonant in this
and expressive, geometric and descriptive, verbal and
respect.76 While Donagh uses abstraction to register
silent, serious and playful into her work. Previously, she
distances and elisions, her paintings reverberate with
says, women worked under a sort of ‘counter-pressure,’
both bodily sensation and psychological charge: in her
70
129 Taking the Trouble to Sound It
work not only is the personal political, but the political is
that Donagh’s works ultimately convey “art’s obstinate
always deeply, irrevocably personal.
amorality.”80
With regard to both the women’s liberation move-
Yet each of these statements ignores the impor-
ment and Northern Ireland, however, it is Donagh’s
tance of location, site specificity, and sounding in
commitment to abstraction that is revealing and sig-
Donagh’s work, which has been present from her
nificant. Although Donagh has reflected that “perhaps
earliest paintings and drawings. In a later painting like
I am torn between the two poles of representation and
Shadow of Six Counties (a) (1979), as Maharaj observes,
abstraction,” abstraction functions in her work as an
“‘the map’ remains too much of a blunt reminder that
important conduit for mediation, since abstract forms
some ‘data’ needs to be communicated.”81 Mediation
can hold multiple meanings in play simultaneously
must of necessity occur within a liminal, in-between
while prompting reflection on the impact of social
zone, but it is concerned with exchange rather than
and technological abstractions on shared space and
disinterest, with showing how distance is always subject
politics.77 This adherence to abstraction—albeit within
to negotiation through communication, and constructed
a practice that has consistently incorporated figuration,
in relation to the specific localities of any given envi-
mixed media, and photographic reproduction—perhaps
ronment. This duality informs Donagh’s relationship
goes some way toward explaining the criticism leveled
with different political contexts, from the violence in
at Donagh over the years. Distance, rather than enable
Northern Ireland and the need to “bear witness” to
objectivity, itself becomes politicized, with some com-
British involvement in centuries of colonial oppres-
mentators distrusting the formal qualities of Donagh’s
sion, to the interconnectivity of mass-media networks
paintings and associating them with either a lack of
through which students in the United Kingdom experi-
commitment or self-delusion.78 For Edward Lucie-Smith,
enced repression as it happened in the United States, to
“the refinement of the design, the almost metaphysical
the women’s liberation movement and its demand that
concern with measurements and proportions, tend to
various art worlds recognize their gendered imbalances
remove what she does from the political arena. The
and restrictions.82 Ultimately, it informs her understand-
starting-point is political, but the work itself is very
ing of media communication itself, which in Donagh’s
little if at all concerned with commenting on the Irish
images carries the simultaneous capacity to place
situation specifically.” Others understand Donagh’s
people in relation as well as to mark the distances and
political statement as starting and ending with distance
differences between them.
79
alone: Ursula Szulakowska, for example, concludes
130 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Notes
1. Rita Donagh, in Rita Donagh: Paintings and Drawings, n.p. 2. The image caption read: “After the Talbot Street blast: a body is covered by the evening newspapers.” David Blundy and Chris Ryder, “How Death Was Driven to Dublin,” Sunday Times (London), May 19, 1974, reprinted in Rita Donagh: Paintings and Drawings, n.p. 3. McKittrick and McVea, Making Sense of the Troubles, 120–21. 4. Ibid., 121. 5. Overy, “Pale Images.” Another significant work from the 1970s to engage with the Northern Ireland conflict, also by an artist working from the perspective of mainland Britain, is Conrad Atkinson’s Northern Ireland 1968—May Day 1975 (1975–76), which combines photographs of protests, confrontations, and graffiti on walls in Derry and Belfast with text panels. 6. In the majority of surveys, references to artistic engagements with the political situation in Northern Ireland are brief: Neil Mulholland, for example, discusses the exhibitions of 1975 and 1976 that evolved from Atkinson’s invitation “by the Arts Council of Northern Ireland to present an exhibition relating to life in the province.” The Irish context is touched on by John A. Walker and Robert Hewison in their analyses of art in Britain during the 1970s but is absent from the edited volume Visual Culture and Decolonisation in Britain. Mulholland, Cultural Devolution, 24–25; Walker, Left Shift, 128–30 and 147–50; Hewison, Too Much, 163–64; Faulkner and Ramamurthy, Visual Culture and Decolonisation in Britain. 7. Beckett, When the Lights Went Out, 99. 8. For a firsthand account, see McCann, War and an Irish Town. 9. Savage, BBC’s “Irish Troubles,” 45. 10. Watkins, “Back to the Black Country,” 7–8. Donagh’s paternal grandfather was Irish, and her mother was born in county Leitrim in the Republic of Ireland, but her parents met in England and lived in South Staffordshire, where her father had been born. Rita Donagh, e-mail correspondence with the author, April 7, 2016. 11. Rita Donagh, in “Discussion of A Cellular Maze,” Institute of Contemporary Arts Talks, May 3, 1984, moderated by Caroline Tisdall, British Library Sound Archive, C95/110. 12. Overy, “Pale Images.” 13. Tisdall, “Rita Donagh,” 194. 14. L. Curtis, Ireland: The Propaganda War, 23. See also Miller, Don’t Mention the War, and Savage, BBC’s “Irish Troubles.” 15. Watkins, “Back to the Black Country,” 13. 16. Marina Vaizey, “Nigel Greenwood: Rita Donagh,” Financial Times, January 17, 1972, page number unknown, Tate Library press cuttings. 17. One of Donagh’s first exhibitions, in 1972, was at the Nigel Greenwood Gallery, which showed artists such as Gilbert &
131 Taking the Trouble to Sound It
George and produced conceptual ventures including David Lamelas’s Publication (1970). 18. Smyth, “Rita Donagh.” 19. Donagh, in Rita Donagh: Drawings and Paintings, n.p. Donagh subsequently repeated elements of Evening Papers in another painting, “. . . morning workers pass . . .” (1978). 20. Tisdall, “Calm and Precision.” 21. Donagh, in Rita Donagh: Drawings and Paintings, n.p. 22. Watkins, “Back to the Black Country,” 12. 23. Many of the photographs Donagh used for the preparatory studies and drawings for Reflection on Three Weeks in May 1970 were her own. Rita Donagh, e-mail correspondence with the author, April 7, 2016. 24. Hilton, “Absence Makes the Heart Grow Fonder,” 16. 25. Thoreau, Walden, and Resistance to Civil Government, 61. 26. Ibid., 190. 27. Donagh, in Rita Donagh: Drawings and Paintings, n.p. 28. Ibid. 29. Maharaj, “Rita Donagh,” 9. 30. Temporal and physical sites were important for Donagh, as her decision to exhibit her work in 1972 at the Nigel Greenwood Gallery in London under the title Locations demonstrates. The image on the private view card shows bands of regular horizontal lines like wavelengths interrupted by vectors taken from Thoreau’s “sounding” of Walden Pond. 31. Fer, Infinite Line, 51. 32. Lütticken, “Living with Abstraction,” 148. 33. The Fine Art Department was part of King’s College, Durham University; in 1963 it joined the University of Newcastle upon Tyne (now Newcastle University). For the development of Basic Design courses, see Thistlewood, Continuing Process. 34. Hilton, “Absence Makes the Heart Grow Fonder,” 16. 35. Hamilton, “First Year Studies at Newcastle,” 174. 36. Donagh taught consistently alongside her own practice: the painter Tess Jaray, who worked with Donagh at the Slade School of Fine Art in London between 1973 and 1981, described her as “a wonderful teacher.” Tess Jaray, interview by Judith Bumpus, London, June 16, 1996, British Library National Life Stories Collection, Artists’ Lives, Tape 16, F5384, Side A. 37. Westley, “Traditions and Transitions,” 134. Kardia ran the “Locked Room” as part of the undergraduate sculpture course. Students were locked in the studio for the day and allowed to select one tool to work with on their given material. They were not told when they would get new material, and tutors spoke only when necessary. 38. Tickner, Hornsey 1968, 34–35. 39. Tisdall, “Calm and Precision.” 40. Hilton, “Absence Makes the Heart Grow Fonder,” 16.
41. See, for example, Auslander, “Performativity of Performance Documentation.” 42. Rita Donagh, unpublished interview with Jonathan Watkins, July 21, 2005, quoted in Watkins, “Back to the Black Country,” 12. 43. McLuhan, Understanding Media, 3–4. 44. Gablik, “Oxford: Rita Donagh.” Hamilton has described how his own engagement with Northern Ireland politics in his three diptych paintings The Citizen (1981–83), The Subject (1988–90), and The State (1993) was indebted to Donagh’s investment in the situation. Richard Hamilton, in “Discussion of A Cellular Maze.” 45. Hamilton, “Printmaking,” 94. 46. Godfrey, “Television Delivers People,” 239. 47. John Russell, untitled, Sunday Times (London), October 22, 1972, page number unknown, Tate Library press cuttings. 48. Bracewell, “Joint Declaration,” 9. 49. Partly inspired by Thoreau’s anger against the slave trade, Resistance to Civil Government (also known as Civil Disobedience) argues for the importance of individuals’ maintaining the ability to critique state structures. Tisdall, “Rita Donagh,” 194. 50. Caroline Tisdall, “London Galleries: Mixed Shows,” March 1975, publication unknown, Tate Library press cuttings. 51. Lampert, “Rita Donagh,” 240. 52. Rita Donagh, “Press Release for Rita Donagh at The Gallery London, 11 March–5 April 1975,” reprinted in James, Depart from Zero, 75. 53. Lampert, “Rita Donagh,” 241. 54. Donagh also exhibited in Northern Ireland; in 1983 a show of her and Hamilton’s work traveled from the Orchard Gallery in Derry to the Institute of Contemporary Arts. See Donagh and Hamilton, An Inquiry Through the Medium of Art (also known as A Cellular Maze). 55. Limpkin, Battle of Bogside, n.p. 56. Miller notes that the “widespread sympathy for the civil rights protestors among the British media was to change after the IRA campaign began in earnest in 1971.” Miller, Don’t Mention the War, 77. 57. McCann, War and an Irish Town, 42. 58. Savage, BBC’s “Irish Troubles,” 31. 59. Sandbrook, White Heat, 348. 60. Miller argues: “This is partly because of the perceived national role of the BBC, but also because the government has more cards in its hand when dealing with a publicly regulated
132 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
system than it does with the press.” Miller, Don’t Mention the War, 28. 61. W. A. McCutcheon, director, Ulster Museum, “Belfast Museum Exhibition,” Irish News, November 28, 1978, page number unknown, Whitechapel Gallery Archives, WAG/EXH/2/280. 62. The exhibition did eventually go on show, with the offending works displayed in the Arts Council Gallery nearby. Ray Rosenfield, “Art for Society in Belfast,” Irish Times, January 5, 1979, page number unknown, Whitechapel Gallery Archives, WAG/ EXH/2/280. 63. Hewison, Too Much, 164. 64. Donagh, in Donagh and Hamilton, An Inquiry Through the Medium of Art, n.p. 65. Kent, “Rita Donagh,” 78. 66. Nairn, Break-Up of Britain, 247. 67. Dixon, Northern Ireland, 98. 68. Ibid., 104. 69. See, for example, Dawson, Mongrel Nation, and, for the artistic context, Araeen, Other Story. 70. Rita Donagh, quoted in Elizabeth Hamilton, “Rita Donagh,” in Mark, Wack! Art and the Feminist Revolution, 229. 71. Craddock, “No Clear Dividing Line.” 72. Anne Bean, quoted in Battista, Renegotiating the Body, 96. 73. Donagh’s ambivalent relation to the women’s art movement is exemplified by her role as a selector for the 1978 Hayward Annual. The exhibition was one of the first in a major U.K. institution where women outnumbered male artists, prompting a storm of derogatory press. Equally, members of the women’s art movement expressed disappointment that the selection did not go far enough. See Pollock, “Feminism, Femininity.” 74. Tisdall, “Rita Donagh,” 193. In 1980 Donagh herself contributed an article on Georgia O’Keeffe to another special issue, of the Oxford Art Journal. See Donagh, “Georgia O’Keeffe in Context.” 75. Tisdall, “Rita Donagh,” 193. 76. For more on this negotiation, see S. Wilson, “Structures of Feeling,” and S. Wilson, Art Labor, Sex Politics. 77. Donagh, in “Discussion of A Cellular Maze.” 78. See Irvine, “Rita Donagh.” 79. Lucie-Smith, Art in the Seventies, 97. 80. Szulakowska, “Rita Donagh,” 31. 81. Maharaj, “Rita Donagh,” 11. 82. Gablik, “Oxford: Rita Donagh.”
7. 7. 7. 7. 7. 7. 7. 7. 7. 7.
Circulations and Cooperations Art, Feminism, and Film in 1960s and 1970s London Lucy Reynolds
A Question of Collectivity The early 1970s marked the articulation and organiza-
their argument that the imperative of collective
tion of a united voice of protest and a call for women’s
feminist practice was a “double-edged assault . . .
rights in all areas of culture and the arts, through
against the myth of individual creativity which, in
networks of emerging women’s campaign groups and
practical terms, results in isolation and exploitation for
events. The collective emphasis of these activities is
artists, and against the particular experience of women,
articulated in the 1974 statement for the Women’s
cut off from each other and from public acknowledg-
Workshop of the Artists’ Union, which laid out its
ment as artists.”1
twofold mission to be a means of mutual support and
to counter the individualized modes of authorship
burgeoned in the early days of the British women’s
common to art: “We formed as a collective of women
liberation movement register the experience of commu-
artists because of our common situation/condition. We
nity initiated by consciousness-raising groups and the
share similar, if not identical problems of isolation; both
recognition that collective organization was required for
from other women artists and the general isolation of
change, a factor already apparent in the strategies of the
artists in a society which is alien to collective creative
civil-rights movement. Spearheaded by the formation
activity.” Rozsika Parker and Griselda Pollock cite this
of the London Women’s Liberation Art Group in 1970,
text in the opening chapter of their anthology on fem-
the Women’s Workshop began operating from 1972 as
inist art practice in Britain, Framing Feminism: Art and
a powerful pressure group for female parity within the
the Women’s Movement, 1970–85. It provides support for
Artists’ Union, as well as providing an active meeting
Certainly the different interest groups that
point for debate and discourse around women and art,
examining Freudian, and later Lacanian, psychoanalytic
both theoretically and practically. Organizations such
frameworks in relation to questions of feminism and the
as the Women’s Free Arts Alliance and the Women’s
patriarchal condition. As Mulvey recalled: “It was then
Liberation Workshop later played important roles in
that we started reading Freud and thinking about psy-
advocating equality, visibility, and active support for
choanalysis. . . . As part of a group, one suddenly found
their practices through the organization of exhibitions
the confidence to ask questions from a political point of
and workshops, in response to the lack of endorsement
view. . . . The first thing I wrote, in fact, was in the Shrew
from major art institutions.
on the ‘Miss World Demonstration.’. . . reading Freud, for
all of us, was the most fundamental event of the whole
In parallel to this culture of burgeoning feminist
voices in the visual arts, there were also signs that
group experience.”3 For Kelly this early influence would
women working in film culture were addressing lost
later surface in works such as Post-Partum Document
histories and identifying the patriarchal structures
(1973–79), and for Mulvey, in her seminal text for Screen
at work within film’s modes of production, as well as
in 1975, “Visual Pleasure and Narrative Cinema.”4
its on-screen representations. Initiatives such as the
Although Kelly did produce a short film of her naked
London Women’s Film Group, founded in 1972, formed
belly while pregnant, Antepartum (1973), Post-Partum
to address inequality in the film industry. The Women’s
Document, the record of her son’s development from
Event, organized by Claire Johnston and Laura Mulvey
baby to child, functions as an installation of text and
at the Edinburgh Film Festival in 1972 as part of the
sculptural forms. Likewise Women and Work (1974),
Society for Education in Film and Television’s annual lec-
made collaboratively with Margaret Harrison and Kay
ture series, sought to write women back into history by
Hunt, uses video as a mode of documentation within
screening the films of directors such as Dorothy Arzner,
the exhibition, rather than as an art form in itself.
a respected and successful director in 1930s Hollywood
who had been sidelined, with related discussions and
choosing to work with film as a creative medium at this
essays.
early moment in the British feminist movement? Can
their works be found in the collective circulations of
2
Early feminist meeting points between the two
Where then might we locate women artists
spheres of cinema and art activity were more evident in
the Women’s Workshop and the History Group or the
discourse than in practice. Laura Mulvey and Mary Kelly
discourses of feminist counter-cinema, represented by
met as part of the feminist reading group, entitled the
Mulvey or Claire Johnston? Or do they remain, either
History Group, which had formed in 1970 in response
through choice or necessity, outside these spheres of
to the first National Women’s Liberation Conference
feminist agency, working in other contexts and con-
at Ruskin College. The History Group brought together
ditions? Instances of female filmmaking can be found
artists, film critics, art historians, and writers such as
in the “Directory of U.K. Independent Film-makers”
Sally Alexander and Juliet Mitchell, offering a means of
published in the inaugural 1972 issue of Cinema Rising,
134 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Fig. 7.1 Cinema Rising, “Directory of U.K. Independent Film-makers,” 1972. Courtesy of British Artists Film & Video Study Collection at Central Saint Martins.
a short-lived London-based broadsheet of independent
represented might perceive themselves as engaged in
film (fig. 7.1). A brief paragraph at the beginning of the
an alternative film practice more aligned to the visual
article, written and compiled by Cinema Rising’s editor,
arts. A photographic collage of thirty-seven individual
Tony Rayns, admits that the “definition of independent
artists accompanies the article, spread over two pages,
film making is difficult, since the films differ markedly
together with individual biographies of those agreed
in approach and intent.” Rayns stresses that one of
upon by Rayns and designated experts in the field as
the key criteria for entry to the directory was that the
the most significant independent filmmakers then
filmmakers be funded outside the state television
practicing on the British scene. Cinema Rising’s snap-
and film industry, concomitantly implying that those
shot of alternative filmmaking culture thus provides
5
135 Circulations and Cooperations
rich material for a study of the alliances, ethics, and
considered a double bind of marginalization, working
approaches characteristic of that period: from the
outside the discourses of their feminist contemporaries
radical film agitprop represented by CinemaAction
at the same time that the personal orientations of their
and advocated in an article by Simon Hartog and
subject matter and their fusions of film, performance,
Simon Field, to the London Filmmakers’ Co-operative’s
and installation were dismissed by their male peers in
(Co-op) more fine-arts-aligned axis, delineated by
both film and the arts. Tracing the trajectories of their
David Curtis and Peter Gidal.
film practices, I ask if they experienced the artistic isola-
tion articulated in the Women’s Workshop’s statement
Yet any canon or survey is marked by its omissions.
Searching among the facsimiled faces, I can discern only
and consider what collective strategies they may have
four individually named women: Annabel Nicolson, Sally
turned to in order to counter it.
Potter, Carolee Schneemann, and Barbara Schwartz.
6
Elusive among the sea of male faces, their images arrest me with questions concerning the place of female prac-
The Building
tices in alternative film culture in postwar London. The lack of women in Rayns’s survey might initially seem to
Sally Potter, Barbara Schwartz, and Carolee
be explicable with reference to later feminist studies of
Schneemann all reappear in a 1972 article published in
canon formation and to Pollock’s definition of the veils
Time Out contemporaneously with Cinema Rising.8 The
of naturalization and universality, which seek to validate
piece, entitled “Interviews with Three Filmmakers,” is
what she sees as “the highly select and privileged
devoted to the question of women working in indepen-
membership of the canon that denies any selectivity.”
dent film. According to the opening text, the Time Out
However, Pollock’s critique of the patriarchal canon
feature marks the occasion of a program of films by
within the visual arts cannot provide a complete expla-
“five film makers (who are also women) at the Co-op
nation. For while female membership in Cinema Rising’s
on Saturday. If the situation in which they are being
alternative film canon might appear at first selective
presented is something of a ghetto—and it’s important
and marked by omission, the place of the woman artist
that two at least have been involved in similar shows
filmmaker in the culture of the London art world during
before—it did at least provide an opportunity for a
the early 1970s is further complicated by the lack of
discussion with three of them about their situation as
acceptance afforded to alternative film by film and the
women who make films.”9 The interviews with Potter,
visual arts more generally: neither fully an art form
Schwartz, and Schneemann variously reflect their
nor fulfilling the characteristics of cinema in terms of
conflicted position as women artists working with film
its production and aesthetic systems. This chapter
at an embryonic moment for both feminism and artists’
explores how the four women pictured in Cinema Rising
film in Britain. Their interviews clearly show that they
each negotiated the complex terrain of what might be
were aware of the context of feminism, which they are
7
136 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
asked to discuss for the purposes of the article. Potter,
concept of an arts lab, of a sort of melting pot, of a free
for example, is critical about the potential for feminism
place in the centre of town where you could gather and
to express its political aims aesthetically, speaking of
where you could see an event or a film or a painting
how “women’s lib films I have seen all use such out-
or a talk.”13 At the same time, the rigor of Potter’s and
dated and archaic and also reactionary structures.”
Nicolson’s inquiries into film’s material surfaces and
Schwartz expresses a positive, if tentative, relationship
apparatus, as I discuss below, tempered these counter-
to feminism’s potential to be reflected in her films, refer-
cultural indeterminacies and might also be seen to have
ring to Nell Dunn’s 1965 book of interviews, Talking to
anticipated a more fine-art-oriented engagement with
Women, as a model for what she would like to explore
modernist concerns, which would later develop with the
in her films: “I guess that’s what my films are like—par-
move of the Co-op to North London in 1971.
ticulars rather than generalities—that’s how I can get to
understand the importance for instance of the women’s
and Schneemann, was making use of the rudimentary
movement.”10
film facilities offered at the Arts Lab on Robert Street,
she also pursued an ongoing interest in performance
It could be argued that Potter’s and Schwartz’s
Furthermore, while Potter, like Nicolson, Schwartz,
reluctance was shaped by their alternative engagement
through her association with the performance company
in the pluralistic arts activities of the late 1960s and
Group Events. In this context she developed techniques
early 1970s, circulating around the Arts Lab, a counter-
of improvisation and theater performance as well as
cultural space of convergence for the arts, first at Drury
street theater, happenings, and other live events. Works
Lane and then Robert Street in Camden, where the
such as her double-screen performance The Building
London Filmmakers’ Co-operative was based until 1971.
(1969) as well as her double-screen film Play (1970)
As artists interested in working with film, Nicolson,
and her later three-screen film Combines (1972) could
Potter, Schwartz, and Schneemann bridged a unique
be seen as points of convergence across these different
transitional moment between the Arts Lab imperative of
cultural contexts. Performed at the New Arts Lab and
“mix all the arts!” and the more self-reflexive and artis-
the National Film Theatre in 1969, The Building creates
anal film practices that were nurtured at the Dairy, the
a playful dialogue between film space and live space.
space at Prince of Wales Terrace where the Co-op made
Two performers—fellow Co-op filmmaker Mike Dunford
its base from 1971. Here, film was presented in close
and Leda Papaconstantinou, both of whom Potter had
proximity to experimental theater, music, and visual art.
met through her involvement with Group Events—sit on
The blurred boundaries, spatial proximities, and contin-
chairs before their screen selves, projected in negative
gencies of the Arts Lab are reflected in the distinctive
and involved in a series of actions. The movements end,
mix of performance and multiscreen projection discern-
as Potter puts it, “with the films showing their images
ible in Potter’s early film work and that of peers such as
crossing and re-crossing from screen to screen and
Nicolson. Potter remembers the “vibrancy of the whole
laughing.” At one point the two performers throw off
11
12
137 Circulations and Cooperations
Fig. 7.2 Sally Potter, The Building, New Arts Lab, 1969.
their white overalls to reveal costumes, which Potter
how an experimental intersection of performance and
describes as “red satin skin tight clothing with exag-
double-screen projection might engage with the ques-
gerated padding, so that the woman is exaggeratedly
tioning of gender. Made before the articulations and
female and the man had great padded shoulders” (fig.
activisms of the women’s liberation movement were
7.2). The purpose of this notable caricature of gender
fully established in Britain, Potter’s work uses formal
was, according to Potter in her Time Out interview, “an
experiment to make a playful and implicit examination
attempt to get across the necessity for us to destroy
of gender roles.15
our roles before we can create anything.”14 The Building
not only suggests a nascent interest in the relation-
as a beguiling address to the limitations of gender
ship between film and performance, as well as a
representation and its roles, this was not Potter’s stated
reference to theater, but could also be seen to explore
intent. She describes her primary aim for the piece as
138 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
For while The Building might be read in retrospect
representing “pure presence” through the meeting of
have described as the “positivist science” of North
film with performance in “a sort of synthesizing and
American structural film, where the “set of rules that
reconciling of nonform and expanded form.” But the
govern it . . . delineate and restrict the area of inquiry,”
absence of overt feminist content did not prevent The
providing “no guarantee of freedom from the ideology
Building from being dismissed by her Co-op peers on the
inscribed within the very materials of film. On the
grounds of gender. Potter recalls how she felt “that what
contrary, it reflects the patriarchal ideology from which
I was doing was neither taken seriously nor respected in
it originated, and which it continues to serve.”18 The
any shape or form in that context. And especially when
performative experiments of The Building, therefore,
it started to involve things like dance.”
could be seen to place Potter outside the legitimations
of the more purist modernist practices to which, like
16
Although Potter may have been granted mem-
bership in Cinema Rising’s directory, the dismissal of
their peers in the contemporary arts, filmmakers at the
The Building on the grounds of its theatrical content
Co-op aspired, following its move from the pluralist
demonstrates that experimental forms of cinema were
conditions and countercultural associations of the Arts
engaged in an overlapping system of validation and
Lab.19
exclusion emanating from both the film industry and
the visual arts, harking back to the coded legitimiza-
implicit forms of exclusion, in which discrimination
tions and omissions of artistic practice through which
is disguised within the validations of what is deemed
male canons have traditionally been formulated. In
acceptable as art, posed profound dilemmas for women
the case of The Building, Potter’s theatrically infused
artists at the time, concerning not only the validity of
focus on the body could also be seen to exceed “the
their work but their sense of identity as artists. Potter
modernist logic of formalism,” in which, according to
would seem to confirm Jones’s notion of modernist
Amelia Jones, “the body of the artist—in its impurity—
“disinterestedness” when she recalls that validation was
must be veiled.” In her theorization of the reception
predicated on the premise that “somehow the central
of the body art associated with Potter’s contempo-
work had some kind of neutrality to it, an objectivity,
raries such as Schneemann, Jones argues that the
and then there was this other thing. Called anything
modernist critic’s maintenance of “disinterestedness”
that women made or, you know, was other than that. It
requires “a pure relation between the art object and
seemed to me [this] was inherently a form of marginal-
its supposedly inherent meaning (embedded in its
ization both conceptually and in the body of work. It was
‘form,’ to be excavated by the discerning interpreter),”
a reason to dismiss.”20 Potter, like other women artists,
something that refuses the presence and excesses of
then and now, felt the need to distance herself from an
the mediating subject, such as the performers in The
overt use of feminist discourse, in order to remove her-
Building. This same disinterestedness can also be
self from the negative associations modernism attached
identified in what Lisa Cartwright and Nina Fonoroff
to practices with gender connotations, such as dance,
17
139 Circulations and Cooperations
It could also be observed that these nuanced and
and thereby allow her practice to be taken seriously, and
not be reduced to what Potter had referred to as “this
alist conditions decried in the Women’s Workshop
other thing.”
statement? According to Potter, the 1972 Time Out
grouping of Potter, Schneemann, and Schwartz is
Nicolson also expressed ambivalence about
But is this a return to the isolated and individu-
direct affiliation or association with feminist concerns.
misleading in this respect. For while the Co-op at the
Although a later 1973 film performance, Reel Time, used
Robert Street Arts Lab and the Dairy on Prince of
two machines with gender associations—a sewing
Wales Crescent provided a meeting place for artists
machine and a 16 mm projector in dialogue—she was
interested in working with film, it did not engender
clear about the role of feminism in her art: “I don’t want
a particular collectivity among its female members.
to be making a claim that this is a statement about
It could be argued that, for Potter, an experience of
women, because I don’t think that would be quite right.
collective agency, as well as a space of liberation from
I was saying something about me. Of course I was
the constraints of a prescriptive and discriminating
aware that I’m a woman and I’m female, but it wasn’t
modernism, came from her contact with the collabo-
the political context.” Nicolson’s remarks emphasize
rative energies and ensembles of live theater. After the
individual creativity and subjectivity, which are seen as
positive experience of working with Group Events, she
the central traits of the artist in modernity. The remarks
attended a one-year course in choreography and dance
are consistent with Jan Rosenberg’s account of “a more
at the London School of Contemporary Dance in 1971,
tenuous and ambiguous relationship to the feminist film
initiating fruitful collaborations with contemporary
movement,” in her illuminating 1979 study of feminist
choreographers and dancers such as Richard Alston
film practices: “They [women filmmakers] continue
and Siobhan Davies at its resident theater, The Place.
to make films which explore personal consciousness,
This deeper engagement in performance and dance
sexuality, childhood and other ideas compatible with
continued in dialogue with expanded notions of film,
feminism from a more subjective and psychological
such as her triple-screen film performance Combines
perspective than the documentarists.” She also notes
in 1972. Evoking the temporal and spatial play of The
that, despite the patriarchal inscriptions of avant-garde
Building, Combines mirrored live performance with the
cinema, the primary orientation of these filmmakers
dancer’s on-screen image and gestures. Filmed and
is “toward the world of avant-garde film and art rather
performed within the studios of The Place, the work
than political feminism.” Conflicted by the split mod-
suggests that although film was still an intrinsic factor
ernism required between their identities as artists and
in Potter’s work, more fruitful and less limiting pro-
as women, Nicolson and Potter made a clear separation
cesses, practices, and collaborations were to be found
between their individual practices as artists and their
in the spaces and discourses of contemporary dance
involvement in the women’s movement.
and live art.
21
22
140 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
23
Fig. 7.3 Sally Potter, Annabel Nicolson, and Barbara Schwartz (now Ess) at the London Filmmakers’ Co-operative ca. 1970.
Reel Time: Claiming Subjectivity For Nicolson, however, coming from an art-school background in painting, the Co-op provided a sympathetic space in which to nurture her growing interest in the potential of the film medium. Nicolson has alluded to the sense of “a critical mass” of other like-minded artists who wanted to explore the potential of film, where “we weren’t the first generation, because there had been other people doing it—other artists in history—but in a way we were the first generation that had a number of us” (fig. 7.3).24 Like Potter, she taught herself the fundamentals of filmmaking on the equipment at the New Arts Lab, resulting in works such as Anju (1970) and Slides (1971), whose sewn, painted, and scratched surfaces demonstrated her interest in film’s material qualities. She became fully involved in the Co-op’s organizational activities, later curating its cinema programs as well as engaging in the modernist debates of process and surface that cemented the Co-op’s reputation for a rigorous practice of formal, or so-called structural, filmmaking during the 1970s.25 Unlike Potter, the materialist qualities of Nicolson’s work, which emphasized abstraction rather than drama, enabled a level of acceptance of her work that accounted for its inclusion in programs on structural film at the National Film Theatre and Tate. Returning to Jones’s concept of “disinterestedness,” it could be argued that the containment of her work within this modernist frame of reference was sustained by a narrow mode of interpretation, which was descriptive rather than associative. Allusions to the traditionally gendered activities of stitching or cloth, as
141 Circulations and Cooperations
a fruitful means to offer alternate interpretations of the
(1973), where a paper bird dangles and dances in front
threaded fragments of Slides, for example, were largely
of the projector beam, extend the artisanal focus of
absent from contemporaneous readings of her work.
experimental film practice into a tactility that evoked
26
Furthermore, the narrow frame of reference within which
life outside the studio and the gallery. As Guy Brett
the work was originally received also stresses just how
has noted: “Whereas the typical male attitude has
early in their development the articulations of feminism
stressed professionalism in art as a special realm from
within the sphere of art were in the early 1970s. Potter
which the other parts of life are shut out, women made
is clear in retrospect that, when making films between
no break between their lifestyle and their art practice,
1968 and 1970, “there was not a vocabulary. At that
they often extracted meanings from materials directly
time there wasn’t really a sort of driving sense of pride
associated with their lives, not with art history.”29 Such,
about reclaiming female vocabulary.”27 Although the
it could be argued, was the case with Nicolson’s film
performances, sculptures, and films of artists as diverse
performance Reel Time. For while the projector and
as Yoko Ono, Niki de Saint Phalle, and VALIE EXPORT
the sewing machine that structure the performance
may already have asserted a female perspective during
make compelling allusion to the gendered labor of the
the 1960s, contemporaneous developments drawing on
sweatshop and the projection booth, Nicolson is more
an explicitly feminist discourse did not become preva-
focused on how the apparatus reflects the creative
lent in the United Kingdom until 1971, with the drawings
privacy of her studio. She refers to the way in which
and paintings of artists such as Margaret Harrison and
“so many things happened once I got those [projec-
Monica Sjöo, both members of women’s art groups.
tors]. Because they were in my studio. Even though
28
Furthermore, the extent to which either Potter or
there were projectors upstairs, in the Co-op, because
Nicolson was aware of the 1972 formation of the Women
it was in the same building, once I got my own projec-
Artists Workshop or other related initiatives is unclear,
tors, I just had a relationship.”30 By laying a subjective
suggesting that at this early point, at least, they were
claim, which enfolded her own female identity, to the
not connected to these circles. The National Women’s
gendered territory the cinema apparatus connoted,
Liberation Movement Conference held in London in 1972,
she might be seen to have changed the terms by which
attended by Potter, addressed more explicitly political
this technology was understood, bringing it closer to
agendas to do with equal pay, child care, and domestic
her own experience and creative practice as an artist,
abuse, which could be seen to account for the perception
in which a feminist message was implicit rather than
by both Potter and Nicolson that, while the Women’s
overtly stated (fig. 7.4).
movement might improve women’s living conditions, it
had little impact on their art practices.
during what proved to be a high point of activity for a
version of “expanded cinema” distinct to the British
However, works such as Nicolson’s Slides, Reel
Time (1973), and her film performance Jaded Vision
142 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Reel Time was first presented at Co-op in May 1973,
context. Collective working processes were crucial to
Fig. 7.4 Reel Time film performance by Annabel Nicolson, North East London Polytechnic, 1973.
the convergences of film, performance, and installa-
impromptu feeling to them—they record streets,
tion realized by Nicolson and the close-knit group of
faces, rooms but always without self consciousness
artists connected to the Co-op. In this experimental
and without descending to the uncritical myopia of
climate Nicolson and the other Co-op members sought
home movies. They’ve wit, perception, immediacy.”33
to rethink film spectatorship, opening it up to the
Schwartz’s use of a film gauge, associated more with
temporal/spatial conditions of the gallery through the
the amateur and the domestic, recalls Brett’s observa-
interposition of performance and multiscreen projec-
tions of an art that draws on the sphere of life. It also
tion. Working with peers such as Malcolm le Grice,
suggests an ambivalence toward the Co-op’s empha-
William Raban, David Crosswaite, and Gill Eatherley,
sis—particularly at the Dairy—on 16 mm filmmaking
Nicolson was able to further her examinations of the
and its connotations of an artisanal-artist film practice,
potentials of the projection process and its appara-
rooted in the traditions of experimental film’s post-
tus for a live situation. The results, as one spectator
war practices. However, it was Schwartz’s interest in
remembered, were an evocative interplay of different
experimental film—first kindled in response to the
sensations: “It’s very hard to pin down your things, my
films she saw at the Ann Arbor Film festival while
mind is full of images, colours, light, natural light and
pursuing a degree in English literature at the University
artificial light, beams moving, nothing still, all these
of Michigan, and second nurtured at Ken Jacob’s film
things come to mind.” At this point in the development
workshops at Anthology Film Archives in New York—
of her practice, the dialogues and collaborative events
that encouraged her to come to London to attend the
with which Nicolson was involved through the Co-op
London School of Film Technique in 1971. Finding the
provided a collective support for the development of
school too industry focused, she shifted her attention
her work with film, without recourse to a specifically
to the more sympathetic context of the Co-op and
feminist discourse or its networks.
became involved in the activities and films emerging
31
32
from it. Schwartz found the Co-op a “mutually supportive scene” and a “hotbed of film experimentation,” Home Movies and Roundhouse: London Networks
one that also connected her to experimental music and particularly Cornelius Cardew’s Scratch Orchestra.34
Like Nicolson, the films of Barbara Schwartz (now
Inflected with the Arts Lab culture of contingency and
Barbara Ess) also blur the separation between life
improvisation, her 8 mm films were often projected
and art sanctioned by modernism. Shot on 8 mm,
as expanded film performances and were shown at
their titles are tantalizingly evocative: Home Movies,
relaxed and intimate gatherings in her flat above the
Gina, Everything’s Gonna Be Alright. As Verina Glassner
Co-op. Nicolson recalls an event Schwartz performed
describes them in her article “Interviews with Three
at the New Arts Lab, where she “showed several of
Filmmakers”: “Her films are personal; with a genuine
her films and then handed round jars of bubbles and
144 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
asked people to blow them. You could see the bub-
bles rising in the projector beam and the circles on
rotas and at screening events, Schneemann, records
the screen. Her work always had a beautiful quality
suggest, was not so intimately involved in the film-
of informality. Watching her films in the cinema was
making community at the Co-op as Nicolson and
like watching them upstairs in the flat where she lives,
Potter. Green has contended that Schneemann, when
images of her friends and people she was close to.”
she arrived, was “already formed, joining a scene in
In her Time Out interview Schwartz raises the issue of
formation.”38 Indeed, a generation older, she was well
the lack of women filmmakers in Britain, apparent in
established as an artist in the context of the American
Cinema Rising’s mug shots, and modestly claims this
postwar conceptual movement. Her Kinetic Theater
as the reason for the focus on her work: “I guess it’s
events at the Judson Memorial Church, as well as
just because there’s not many women making films in
large-scale group performances such as Meat Joy
35
Appearing as an occasional name on workshop
this country that I get my films shown.” Certainly she
(1964) and politically charged expanded film perfor-
would have noted a stronger female presence in the
mances such as Snows (1967) and Illinois Central (1968),
more established canon of American experimental film,
had received notoriety, perhaps most infamously in
from founding figures such as Maya Deren to those
the case of Fuses (1964). Her artwork, as well as her
associated with both underground film and structural
writing, clearly articulates her relationship to her
filmmaking such as Chick Strand and Joyce Wieland.
sexuality and gendered corporeality, in contrast to the
Indeed, the American influence in the realm of British
role-playing performances in The Building or Nicolson’s
art and experimental film practice through the influx
orchestrating body—attentive to projector and sewing
of artists from the States proved significant during this
machine—in Reel Time. Rather, Schneemann’s confident
time, and Schwartz was not alone in her migration to
presentation of her own body in the act of perfor-
London. For fellow artist Carolee Schneemann, London
mance elicits what Amelia Jones has described as an
also provided an important, if temporary, place of
“intersubjectivity of the interpretative exchange” with
residence. But while Schwartz perceived London as a
the audience, encouraging a reciprocity that acknowl-
place of new promise, Schneemann, as Alison Green
edges and makes meaning from the contingency of
has suggested, considered the four years she spent in
the moment and the intimacies and particularities of
London, from 1969, a period of rehabilitation, even exile,
this exchange.39 Alongside the innovations of other
from difficulties she had been encountering in America
pioneers such as VALIE EXPORT and Yoko Ono,
across the intertwined strands of her personal life and
Schneemann’s use of performance might be seen as
her practice as a performer and filmmaker. By going first
one of the earlier instances in which a distinct female
to Paris and then London, Schneemann “was escaping
creative agency has been exerted, overturning the
but also joining other friends and entering what she
traditional role assigned to her by painting and sculp-
hoped was a more hospitable cultural climate.”
ture as a figure of representation, to become an active
36
37
145 Circulations and Cooperations
subject of her own art making, unfolding through the
The range of the work that she developed during her
live event.
time in London attested to the opportunities afforded
her through the networks of the city’s art community,
However, as her diaries and recollections show,
Schneemann experienced hostility, sometimes of an
but also indicated that she did not limit her conceptual
aggressive nature, in response to the explicit nature
explorations to works solely on film or in performance
of her happenings and performances in London. A
but also produced series of works on paper. These
harbinger of this negative reaction occurred on an
were sometimes in line with her visceral body-centric
earlier visit to London, in July 1967, when she partic-
practice, such as Blood Work Diary from 1972, which
ipated in the Dialectics of Liberation congress at the
displayed paper documents of her menstrual blood.41
Roundhouse, alongside countercultural luminaries as
diverse as Herbert Marcuse, Allen Ginsberg, and R. D.
and Eatherley found a measure of collective support
Laing. As Schneemann observed of the event: “I was
for their practices, albeit outside the auspices of the
a participant among men who validated each other’s
feminist collectivism that the Women’s Workshop
work—each other’s transgressions of established
espoused, Schneemann remained an isolated figure.
culture and myth—but who at the same time implic-
For Green, her marginalized status can be theorized as
itly mythicized the female as auxiliary, adjacent.”
an exilic condition, within and without her own coun-
40
But it could be argued that, while Potter, Nicolson,
Schneemann’s comments recall the frustrations of
try. I would go further and argue that Schneemann’s
Potter upon the dismissal of The Building for being
experience clearly reflects the divisive conditions under
“other” in relation to accepted modes of modernist
which women artists were expected to practice. Just
validation, and the distrust and misunderstandings
as dismissive reactions to The Building warned Potter,
that Schneemann had already experienced by virtue
the hostility Schneemann courageously endured for her
of the foregrounding in her work of her subjective
transgressive visceral practice was punitive, isolating
gendered experience were by no means dispelled upon
her from her peers in the male-dominated art world.
her residence in London.
The negative reactions of both artists’ male colleagues
also suggest the extent to which content, as well as
However, Schneemann found sympathetic net-
works across London’s creative communities during her
form, that transgressed beyond the codes of modernism
years in London. She worked closely, for example, with
provided the rationale for a gender-based oppression.
the artist John Lifton at the New Arts Lab, orchestrated
As Schneemann wrote in an unsent letter to Allan
the ambitious group performance Thames Crawling at
Kaprow in 1974, “essentially I have stood alone for too
the International Underground Film Festival in 1970.
long, having been methodically repulsed by those with
Michael Kustow, a friend and director of the ICA, also
whom I felt affinity. . . . You see I understand men helping
invited her to present a number of events and screen-
me to sustain what I had but not to enlarge its scope or join
ings, such as Fuses and her Naked Action Lecture of 1968.
them in their world.”42
146 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Three Friends: Collective Possibilities
windows with doves flying round against the light. After a while she gave out some hand wound film viewers
But if Schneemann continued to suffer the divisive
for people to look through privately and pass round.
politics of patriarchy and Potter moved sideways toward
The images were like those of the dovecote projected
more sympathetic communities in dance and live art,
on the walls. She had a transparent box with images
there was also a shift toward collective organization
from the film drawn on it.”43 Alongside Schneemann
among women artists working with film. One outstand-
and Schwartz, Liss also attests to the significant and
ing example involved Barbara Schwartz and her friend
galvanizing American presence in London’s filmmaking
and fellow American Fluxus artist Carla Liss. Liss was
scene during this period, as evidenced by the London
the distribution secretary at the Co-op from 1969 until
Co-op’s foundation by Americans Steven Dwoskin and
the mid-1970s. Her appointment had been strategic
Simon Hartog. There is little written on her ephem-
because the foundation of the Co-op’s distribution
eral and responsive film practice, and yet Liss’s name
collection relied on the donation of prints of American
can be traced through other, more feminist-inflected
underground films from Jonas Mekas at the New York
art networks from 1972 onward. It may be that Co-op
Film-makers’ Co-operative, on the condition that a paid
colleagues would not have been aware that she not only
member of staff would be on staff in London to admin-
guest-edited the October 1973 issue of Art and Artists,
ister and care for them. As a member of Fluxus and
devoted to women’s art, but also engineered with
part of New York’s informal countercultural networks,
Schwartz and fellow American artist Susan Hiller one
Liss was connected to Mekas and the New York Co-op
of the last exhibitions at Gallery House, in June 1973.44
and was invited to take up the role. As the only paid
Notably, the title of their exhibition, Three Friends, could
member of staff in a cooperative structure, she may
be seen to reflect the nonhierarchical forms of collabo-
have been resented by other members giving their time
ration and connection that would become a key strategy
and support without monetary return. What is seldom
in feminist art practices.
mentioned in the records of the London Co-operative or
the screening programs of this period, however, is her
a larger exhibition of women’s work, but the curators
presence as an artist and filmmaker also working with
Rosetta Brookes and Sigi Krauss rejected it. A preview
an expanded practice at the interplay between objects
of the exhibition in Spare Rib lamented this, criticizing
and film projection. Nicolson remembers her “making
the lack of female representation in an earlier Gallery
perspex boxes with things in them, objects from the
House exhibition, The Survey of the Avant-Garde, which
countryside, steam, water.” Other works included a
had included Schneemann but gave “little clue what
four-screen film that evoked a dovecote, which Nicolson
women are doing now.” Spare Rib, along with an editorial
has also described: “Some people were gathered in a
Liss wrote for Art and Artists, gives some detail of the
dark room. High above were images of small circular
exhibition, which featured Dove Cote and screenings
147 Circulations and Cooperations
Hiller, Liss, and Schwartz had originally proposed
of a number of Schwartz’s films, including, according
sound, and expression compelling to feminist film
to Spare Rib, HomeMovie, “a highly personal explora-
theorists such as Teresa de Lauretis, who saw in her
tion of different techniques, and images that caught
work “the elaboration of strategies of address that alter
[Schwartz’s] eye.” Hiller contributed Transformer,
the forms and balances of traditional representation.”48
a wall work constructed of sheets of tissue paper
By the end of the decade, Nicolson—moving away
that, with its craft materials, haptic quality, and glit-
from film and toward a performance and sculpture
tering ephemeral surface, anticipated an emerging
practice that celebrated women’s collectivity, such as
feminist-influenced art, where Brett’s observation of a
the 1981 piece Menstrual Hut—likewise explored the
materiality referencing the sphere of lived experience
possibilities of collaboration and collectivity, as one of
outside the formal hierarchies of the studio might
the founding members of the women artists’ film- and
take root. In Hiller’s Art and Artists interview, however,
video-distribution collective Circles and later as a guest
an ambivalence about how involvement in feminist
editor of the “Women’s Space” issue of Feminist Art
activism might connect to her work remains, qualifying
News in 1982.49 Schwartz, Schneemann, and Liss all
how “the experience [of the women’s movement] is
returned to America during the decade, where Schwartz
valuable, but the issues are stated in dichotomies which
developed her beguiling film and photographic prac-
can’t be resolved except in the abstract language of
tice as Barbara Ess, bringing a feminist dynamic to the
politics. I don’t think in the abstract anymore, I live that
post-punk music scene as part of the band Y Pants, with
far away from words.”
the artists Gail Vachon and Virginia Piersol.50
45
46
However, as Three Friends and Liss’s 1973 issue of
The diverse creative and geographic paths that
Art and Artists indicate, the collective working dynamic
Nicolson, Potter, Schneemann, and Schwartz followed
espoused by the Women’s Movement was soon to
could not thus have been predicted from their pres-
burgeon, bringing with it the discourses of Spare Rib,
ence in the pages of Cinema Rising and Time Out. But,
The Shrew, and the Women’s Workshop and encour-
as I have argued, these images and interviews from
aging a mode of practice where feminist discourses
1972 crystallize the contradictions apparent for artists
were explicit rather than enfolded: as seen in the
working with the moving image at this early juncture in
films, video, and tape-slide works of Tina Keane, Lis
the emergence of feminist art practice. Their scarcity
Rhodes, or Catherine Elwes, for example. Feminist
among the mug shots of Cinema Rising speaks of the
sensibilities can be more overtly traced in Potter’s later
continued marginalization of women within the valida-
performative collaborations with Rose English and her
tions of artists’ independent film, just as the excesses
long working relationship with the musician Lindsay
of performance and theatricality, or depictions of the
Cooper. Her films Thriller (1979) and The Gold Diggers
commonplace in their work—from domestic interiors
(1983) celebrate the centrality of strong female per-
to sewing machines—might bar them under the subtle
formances through a discursive mode of movement,
rules of modernist validation. At the same time, their
47
148 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
reluctance to adhere to the feminist agenda implied
Potter, Nicolson, Schwartz, and Schneemann, Liss and
in Glassner’s Time Out article shows that they did not
Hiller, found in the diverse worlds of London’s creative
see the answer to their vexed position in the collective
community, from dance and live art to film and Fluxus,
causes of the early Women’s Movement.
in order to make room for their practice in lieu of
specifically feminist spaces. This creative negotiation
How to negotiate the space between visibility and
acknowledgment while asserting an artistic practice
manifests in the convergences, conflicts, and dia-
concerned with subject matter more intangible than
logues of their expanded films and performances and
that associated with feminist activism? As Hiller has
installations. Through their excessive and fragmented
recalled: “We wanted to say other things, not neces-
forms—often centered on the body and drawing on
sarily feminist political things, but other kinds of things,
other disciplines from outside the validations of film
and you couldn’t do that without inventing other ways
or visual arts—they address the entwined questions
of going about the whole procedure of making art.”
of identity and creative practice at this moment of an
Like Potter, Nicolson, Schwartz, and Schneemann, Hiller
emergent feminist art practice. Hiller concludes: “All
asserts a subtle opposition to modernism’s patriarchal
that being an artist means is being able to feel and act
validations: one expressed in the realization of creative
at a certain level of intensity and meaning. And this can
potential of the materials deemed “that other thing”—of
be extended to anything, like doing the dishes, sitting in
the body, and of everyday ephemera. This look askance,
a cafe. I think that’s really where it’s at.”52
51
at “other kinds of things” and “other ways of going about,” could be connected to the creative succor that
Notes
1. “Women’s Workshop of the Artists’ Union Collective Statement,” Spare Rib, no. 29 (July 1974): 38, cited by Rozsika Parker and Griselda Pollock, “Fifteen Years of Feminist Action,” in Parker and Pollock, Framing Feminism, 3. 2. Founding members included Esther Ronay, Linda Wood, Susan Shapiro, Francine Winham, Fran MacLean, Barbara Evans, and Midge Mckenzie. They actively campaigned for equal opportunities and made collective films such as The Amazing Equal Pay Show (1974). See Dickinson, Rogue Reels. 3. “Mary Kelly and Laura Mulvey in Conversation,” in Mary Kelly, Imaging Desire (Cambridge: MIT Press, 1996), 30–31, cited in Nixon, “‘Why Freud?’ Asked the Shrew,” 132. 4. Mulvey, “Visual Pleasure and Narrative Cinema.” 5. Rayns, “Directory of U.K. Independent Film-makers.” 6. Yoko Ono is represented with John Lennon. 7. Pollock, Differencing the Canon, 4.
149 Circulations and Cooperations
8. Glassner, “Interviews with Three Filmmakers.” 9. Ibid., 46–47. Annabel Nicolson recalls how she was one of the other filmmakers showing in the program, which was arranged by Peter Gidal, then responsible for the cinema programs at the London Filmmakers’ Co-operative and connected to Time Out through the monthly film column he wrote for them. Although Glassner and Time Out visited the Co-op to interview and photograph the participants in the program, Nicolson was not included in the article. It has not been possible to ascertain the other filmmaker included in the forthcoming screening mentioned in the article. 10. Ibid., 46. 11. For further information on the Arts Lab, see Reynolds, “‘Non-institution.’” 12. D. Curtis, “English Avant-Garde Film,” 112–13. 13. Sally Potter in conversation with Lucy Reynolds, December 2013.
14. Glassner, “Interviews with Three Filmmakers,” 46. 15. The first meeting of the Women’s Movement in London occurred in 1970. 16. Potter in conversation with Reynolds, December 2013. 17. Jones, Body Art, 35. 18. Cartwright and Fonoroff, “Narrative Is Narrative,” 137. 19. For a detailed account of this shift, see Zoller, “Aural History.” See also D. Curtis, History of Artists’ Film and Video. 20. Potter in conversation with Reynolds, December 2013. 21. Annabel Nicolson in conversation with Lucy Reynolds, March 2009. 22. Rosenberg, Women’s Reflections, 41. 23. Potter recalls attending the first Women’s Liberation Conference in London, 1971. 24. Annabel Nicolson interviewed by Lucy Reynolds, March 2009. 25. The term “structural film” was first coined by P. Adams Sitney to discuss tendencies toward a formalist foregrounding of process, material, and film apparatus in late 1960s American artists’ filmmaking. This formalism acquired a different emphasis in Britain, where key spokesmen were Malcolm le Grice and Peter Gidal. However, it should be stressed that practices at the Co-op during this period were varied and did not all adhere strictly to nonnarrative and formal principles. 26. The contemporary exception to this is Laura Mulvey’s 1978 lecture to the Oxford Women’s Studies Committee, “Film, Feminism, and the Avant-Garde,” in which she, citing Reel Time, refers briefly to how Nicolson “has used the old tradition of women’s applied arts to experiment with film as material.” Mulvey, “Film, Feminism, and the Avant-Garde,” 213. For contemporary readings of Nicolson’s films, see Sparrow, “Annabel Nicolson,” and Reynolds, “British Avant-Garde Women Filmmakers.” 27. Potter in conversation with Reynolds, December 2013. 28. For more detailed information about early feminist art initiatives, see Parker and Pollock, “Fifteen Years of Feminist Action,” and Battista, Renegotiating the Body, esp. 17–21, for context and information on Kelly and Schneemann. 29. Brett, Through Our Own Eyes, 149. 30. Nicolson interviewed by Reynolds, March 2009. 31. For a contemporary account of British Expanded Cinema of the period, see Dusinberre, “On Expanding Cinema.” For more recent accounts, see Reynolds, “Filmaktion: New Directions in Film Art,” and Reynolds, “Magic Tricks? The Use of Shadowplay in British Expanded Cinema.”
150 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
32. Annabel Nicolson, “Annabel Nicolson at the Co-op,” in Light Years: A Twenty Year Celebration of the LFMC, leaflet published October/November 1986, 43. 33. Glassner, “Interviews with Three Filmmakers,” 46. 34. Barbara Ess (formerly Schwartz), e-mail correspondence with the author, January 2015. 35. Nicolson, “Annabel Nicolson at the Co-op,” 41. 36. Glassner, “Interviews with Three Filmmakers,” 47. 37. According to Green, what had made New York inhospitable was not only the persecution that Schneemann feared for films and performances critical of U.S. policy in Vietnam, and the hostility and marginality she still experienced within the art community there, but also a need to find a space to recuperate following the painful breakup of her marriage to James Tenney. A. Green, “Intermedia, Exile, and Carolee Schneemann,” 141. 38. Ibid., 147. 39. Jones, Body Art, 34. 40. Schneemann, More Than Meat Joy, 152–57, quote on 155. 41. See Battista, Renegotiating the Body, 38–39. 42. Schneemann, More Than Meat Joy, 195. 43. Nicolson, “Annabel Nicolson at the Co-op,” 42. 44. See Art and Artists 8, no. 7 (October 1973). The issue contains an interview with Joan Jonas and Simone Forti, as well as Hiller, Liss, and Tillman, “Elements of Science Fiction.” 45. Parker, “Arts Editorial,” 19. 46. Hiller, Liss, and Tillman, “Elements of Science Fiction,” 33. 47. See Battista, Renegotiating the Body. 48. De Lauretis, “Rethinking Women’s Cinema,” 158. 49. Nicolson developed a dome-like structure as a space for female reflection and contemplation for her 1981 curatorial residency at the Norwich School of Art, which culminated in the exhibition Concerning Ourselves, including herself alongside other artists. 50. Ess also played and toured with The Static and Daily Life and initiated the multifaceted art-publishing project Just Another Asshole. Schneemann continued her unique and multifaceted practice, engaging questions of identity, gender, and relationships in drawing, installation, film, and video. Liss also returned to New York later in the decade, where she continued her association with Fluxus and a practice engaging with video and performance. 51. Hiller, “3,512 Words,” 130. 52. Hiller, Liss, and Tillman, “Elements of Science Fiction,” 33.
8. 8. 8. 8. 8. 8. 8. 8. 8. 8.
Project sigma An Interpersonal Logbook Andrew Wilson
The question of how to introduce an account of project
Lettrist International (LI) between 1955 and 1956.6 It
sigma1—variously described by its orchestrator, the
was also in Paris that Trocchi started on his lifelong use
novelist Alexander Trocchi, as a “Meta-Categorical
of heroin and other narcotics; this had partially framed
Revolution,”2 an “Invisible Insurrection of a Million
his introduction to the LI, which in turn led directly to
Minds,”3 or a “Spontaneous University”4—necessitates
his friendship with Guy Debord. This was a friendship
addressing the manner in which Trocchi moved from
that was mediated by his immersion—signaled through
one environment and situation to another, forming and
Merlin—in an existential worldview.7
reflecting different kinds of networks. His experiences in
Paris, New York, and California in the 1950s determined
the view of a person, an outsider facing an absurd world,
the character and aims of sigma as much as they also
the direct experience of which, unmediated by any
account for its genesis. Trocchi left Scotland for Europe
external orientation from any kind of belief structure,
in 1950, having just gained a master’s in philosophy
provides (and undermines) the only hope for meaning.
from the University of Glasgow and a Kelmsley traveling
As he stated in an exchange with Hugh MacDiarmid at
scholarship, settling for the main part in Paris between
the 1962 Edinburgh International Writers’ Conference, “I
1952 and 1956. In Paris Trocchi’s changing outlook can
think the question of human identity is the only central
be tracked through the founding and editorship of the
question and it is a question of a man alone.”8 Trocchi’s
literary magazine Merlin between 1952 and 1955,5 which
sense of engagement was not political but engagé, a
was immediately followed by his association with the
perspective obtained through the life of an outsider: a
It is this existential view that guided Trocchi’s steps:
form of dégagement—from a prevailing understanding of
hypothetical. . . . All sense of objectivity is annihilated.”13
reality or social orthodoxy—that was itself a critical act
For Trocchi, the role of the addict was that of the out-
rather than a passive stance. The overriding message
sider, where the death of reality and the death of the
of Trocchi’s Merlin editorials constituted an attack
word was the reality: both the cultural revolution he was
against the mechanics of the Cold War. For instance,
starting to formulate and his use of drugs were deeply
the editorial for the third issue asked: “In what way
identified with each other.
can a literary magazine most effectively combat the
tendency in the human being to form rigid and uncom-
Merlin was, for Trocchi, losing its raison d’être. Having
promising attitudes? . . . Obviously as was suggested in
been the first magazine to publish Eugene Ionesco in
Merlin Number Two, it must proceed by hitting at fixed
English and regularly print work by Samuel Beckett, Jean
categories, by persuading men to analyse their own
Genet, Jean-Paul Sartre, and Corneille, Merlin become
attitudes, to suspend their responses, to think critically,
more widely accepted. The LI reinforced Trocchi’s sense
and then, in the historical context, to act.”10 Whereas the
of both refusal and engagement. He regularly received
final editorial, published in the sixth and penultimate
the group’s magazine, Potlatch, between July 1954 and
issue, was an extended attack on the moral, linguistic,
the spring of 1956, and the twenty-third issue of Potlatch,
and scientific absolutism that Trocchi believed fed Cold
for October 13, 1955, carried a note informing the reader
War politics and as a result had to be resisted to renew
of Trocchi’s resignation from the editorship of Merlin
culture and social relations. To be engagé in such a
and his subsequent membership in the LI. However,
situation was to go beyond politics, beyond categories
only a few months later, in April 1956, he left Paris for
and categorization, beyond tradition, beyond language
America, an act that itself signified a decisive break. He
as it had been and was generally manifested.
wrote: “The fact that I had to commit a criminal act in
One indication of this was his early drug use,
failing to notify the American authorities on my applica-
whereby he could, as he described it, become “an alien
tion for a visa that I had knowledge of narcotics seemed
in a society of conformers.” Through his use of narcot-
to set the key for the whole journey. (Had I admitted to
ics he felt able to evade or renounce one self-identity
that knowledge, there is every reason to believe the visa
(that which is a part of the social structure he rejected)
would have been refused.) I came and went a criminal,
in search for that other identity freed of alienation,
or more exactly, a member of a new underground.”14
which could undertake to build a new society. As he
described this state at the time: “I was the invisible
found work with the Trap Rock Corporation as a captain
catalyst of a complex process of experience. [. . .] I find
for a scow on the Hudson River, a situation in which he
heroin useful to give myself over to thought. Then I am
could write undisturbed. In the late summer of 1957,
able to sustain a flow . . . the hashish carries one like a
with an advance for his novel, he moved to Taos in New
sleepwalker into many postures, all experimental, all
Mexico, where he experimented with LSD with the
9
11
12
152 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
His introduction to the Lettrists came at a time that
Trocchi’s first move was to New York, where he
psychotherapist Oscar Janiger. In Tijuana he married his
play. The notion of play and leisure became a strong
second wife, Lyn, and then moved to Venice Beach and
associative thread throughout sigma, particularly in
into the orbit of Wallace Berman. A habitué of the scene
relation to constructing a basis for a new social order, as
that existed around Stone Brothers Printing and the
it had also been for the Lettrists and would become for
Ferus Gallery,15 Trocchi published his first excerpt from
the Situationists. Such a standpoint rejected not just the
his novel Cain’s Book in the second issue of Berman’s
work ethic but also state structures that were bolstered
magazine, Semina, before moving back to New York in
by an instrumental attitude toward life.
the spring of 1958 in search of more support from his
publishers. Cain’s Book is largely autobiographical: the
with events when the Situationist International (SI) was
narrator is captain of a scow on the Hudson River, a job
formed in 1957 by the amalgamation of the International
on the margins of society that came to provide the main
Movement for an Imaginist Bauhaus with the Lettrist
locus for the book. The eight sentences from the book
International. However, Guy Debord recognized him as
published in Semina, however, give a direct impression
a founder-member of the SI, just as he had also added
of the heroin experience and the dissolution both of
Trocchi’s name to a Lettrist tract—Toutes ces dames au
identity and of language that this entailed when carried
salon!—that had been issued in 1956, some months after
forward as a systematic way of life. For Trocchi, the use
he had left Paris. So when Trocchi and his wife were
of heroin led to what he termed an “evasion of percep-
stranded in the grasp of the federal police for contraven-
tion,” which could be part of a “curative ambience” both
ing American drug laws, the SI took up his case during
personally and for society—this would later come to
their fourth congress, held in London in 1960. Its resolu-
be an important aspect of sigma. As he wrote in Cain’s
tion identified him as “a new type of artist, the pioneer
Book, being an addict “is born of a respect for the whole
of a new culture”;19 it was printed in the fifth issue
chemistry of alienation.”
of Internationale Situationniste that December,20 two
months after the circulation of the “Hands off Alexander
16
17
Trocchi’s time in America, like his last year in Paris,
Trocchi was in America and so was out of touch
was spent searching for life on the margins. Whether
Trocchi” proclamation (figs. 8.1 and 8.2). Bailed before
he was living in the Venice, California, apartment he
his trial in April 1961, Trocchi fled America for Canada,
named Musée Imaginaire (described in chilling detail by
before getting a boat for Aberdeen and then arriving
Irving Rosenthal as “Trocchi’s Pad” in his novel Sheeper,
in London via a short stay in Edinburgh, where he was
a crash-pad staging post for beatniks, decorated with
sheltered by his friend the editor Alex Neish.21
heroin) or on the scow on the Hudson, he occupied the
same field of survival as the mad and the diseased. The
garnered more public attention after participating with
ritual of the heroin fix might have related to alienation,
William Burroughs at the writers conference organized
but in another sense it created the conditions for an act
by John Calder for the 1962 Edinburgh Festival. At a
of sedition through Trocchi’s participation in unearned
press conference he admitted to being a heroin addict,
18
153 Project sigma
Not long after his arrival back in Britain, Trocchi
Fig. 8.1 “Hands Off Alexander Trocchi,” declaration signed by Guy Debord, Jacqueline de Jong, and Asger Jorn, October 7, 1960.
Fig. 8.2 “Resolution Concerning the Imprisonment of Alexander Trocchi,” published in Internationale Situationniste 5 (December 1960).
“a cosmonaut of inner space,” as he put it.22 Trocchi
he continued in this vein, stating that artists should be
acted never as an apologist for drugs, and specifically
involved in a “tentative, intuitive and creative passivity.
heroin, but as a prophet for substances that he saw as
A spontaneity leading to what André Breton called the
agents of creative change. During the conference he
found object. A found object is at the other end of the
elaborated on Burroughs’s statement that the future
scale from the conventional object. To free themselves
of the novel lay in a manipulation of space rather than
from the conventional object and thus pass freely
time, asserting that a new language of experience could
beyond non-categories, the twentieth-century artist
be found in the fragmentation and dematerialization
finally destroyed the object entirely.”24
of narrative. Trocchi argued that “modern art begins
with the destruction of the object. All vital creation is at
was then back in touch with Debord and by 1962
the other side of nihilism. It begins after Nietzsche and
was listed on the editorial board of the magazine
after Dada.” Categories were no longer relevant, and
associated with the SI—a group that subverted and
23
154 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
The reference to Breton was not arbitrary; Trocchi
extended surrealist tenets of surprise, play, and desire
being like victims burnt at the stake, signalling through
toward a cultural revolution that superseded art.
the flames.”28 It is a tract born of the times of possible
25
In parallel Trocchi began to work on his belief in a
nuclear holocaust, and so, in a logical development
“meta-categorical revolution” that he would later call
of his standpoint since Merlin, he rejected the whole
sigma, which was largely suggested by his heroin expe-
political and social structure that had contributed to this
rience. He recounted this in a particularly lucid passage
state of affairs. His cultural revolution was to be “the
in Cain’s Book: “For centuries we in the west have been
necessary underpinning, the passionate substructure
dominated by the Aristotelian impulse to classify. It is
of a new order of things.”29 Artaud’s significance for
no doubt because conventional classifications become
Trocchi was his call not only for the death of the object
part of prevailing economic structure that all real revolt
and what that signified but also for a new experiential
is hastily fixed like a bright butterfly on a classificatory
language of the theater that went beyond represen-
pin. . . . Question the noun; the present participles of the
tation and turned toward life and living itself. Trocchi,
verb will look after themselves.”26
following Artaud, was not nihilistically contemplating a
symbol of an absent void but instead offering a positive
One of the key issues that sigma grappled with and
illustrates (as does the SI) was the question of how to
declaration for a new cultural and social way of living.
escape recuperation by the forces of dominant culture—
how a countercultural force could remain and evolve on
here he was producing a tract not so much for revolu-
its own terms. For Trocchi, the answer was to be found
tion as for evolution; what he called for was “(r)evolt,”
in a structure he defined as the interpersonal logbook;
which he characterized as “a transition of necessity
this relied upon a personal network that would elude
more complex, more diffuse than [the coup d’état] and
identification by the wider society and would in turn
so more gradual, less spectacular. . . . What is to be
shape the course of an invisible insurrection.
seized is ourselves.” This was a cultural shift achieved
by “seizing the grids of expression and the powerhouses
In issue number 8 of Internationale Situationniste
Trocchi liked to play on words in his writing, and
(January 1963) Trocchi published “Technique du coup
of the mind . . . the cultural revolt is the necessary
du monde,” which was essentially the founding text
underpinning, the passionate substructure of a new
for project sigma. It was slightly amended and retitled
order of things. . . . There is in fact no such permanence
Invisible Insurrection of a Million Minds when it was dis-
anywhere. There is only becoming.”30 In a similar way he
tributed as item 2 of the sigma portfolio that autumn.27
described the early formation of sigma as necessarily
The text commences with reference to Antonin Artaud’s
“imperfect, fragmentary and inarticulate . . . it is now
essay collection The Theatre and Its Double, a reference
in the process of becoming conscious itself.”31 It was
that illuminates the core of Trocchi’s proposal: “And
this impermanent, imperfect nature that might have
if there is still one hellish, truly accursed thing in our
prevented sigma’s ossification and recuperation by the
time, it is our artistic dallying with forms, instead of
dominant culture to which it was opposed.
155 Project sigma
Toward the end of Invisible Insurrection of a Million
described in sigma: A Tactical Blueprint, to be pasted up
Minds Trocchi sets out his stall, beginning with the
on advertising hoardings on the London Underground
construction of a prototype “spontaneous university”
as well as distributed in coffee bars. It contains texts
as a “cultural jam session” that owes much to Black
by Trocchi, Burroughs, Artaud, and Kenneth White.
Mountain College in North Carolina—an institution
Although unsuccessful—London Transport refused to
Trocchi then describes in terms of its nurturing of a
allow them to be pasted up, although no reason was
“free play of creativity.” He unsuccessfully sought a
ever given—one indication of how the portfolio worked
brick-and-mortar base of this type into the early 1970s,
as a way of connecting up the growing community of a
and his description of what such a building might entail
million minds is the effect sigma had on a young New
was immediately suggestive of Black Mountain. In his
York psychiatrist, Dr. Joseph Berke.36
view, this “‘experimental laboratory’ will locate itself,
our community-as-art and begin exploring the possible
in production for a few months, circulating not just
functions of a society in which leisure is the dominant
Trocchi’s founding texts but also texts submitted by
fact, and universal community, in which the conven-
R. D. Laing, poet Michael McClure, and filmmaker Stan
tional assumptions about reality and the constraints
Brakhage.37 The circumstances surrounding the contact
they imply are no longer operative, in which art and life
between Trocchi and Berke are both coincidental and
are no longer divided.” And such a stance also recalls
complex, cutting to the heart of how sigma operated on
Debord’s unitary urbanism built from psychogeographic
an interpersonal level. Trocchi understood that the first
analysis of the dérive, or even the Fun Palace envisaged
essential, if project sigma was to flourish, was the need
by architects Joan Littlewood and Cedric Price that was
to underpin already-existing networks of cultural dis-
never built.34
sent and to link with and enlarge them. So, in sigma: A
Tactical Blueprint, he stated: “The first essential for those
32
33
From one perspective the building he was looking
By October 1964 the sigma portfolio had been
for to house and nurture the spontaneous univer-
whose purpose it is to link mind with mind in a supra-
sity can be identified as the sigma portfolio, both the
national (transcategorical) process, is some kind of
content and the way it could be received and acted on
efficient expanding index, an international ‘who’s who.’
performed his notion of no permanence, only “becom-
It is a question of taking stock, of surveying the variety
ing.” The first item in the portfolio is not a theoretical
of talent and goodwill at our disposal.”38 This purpose
statement of aims, which is contained in the second
for sigma he soon identified as an “interpersonal log” in
and third items (Technique du coup du monde / Invisible
the Subscription Form: “In subscribing to the sigma port-
Insurrection of a Million Minds and sigma: A Tactical
folio, you are stimulating the growth of an interpersonal
Blueprint); instead, it is a calling card of, for, and to
log constructing itself to alert, sustain, inform, inspire,
the margins that the SI admired but avoided associ-
and make vividly conscious of itself all intelligence from
ation with. Moving Times was a poster intended, as
now on.”39 Trocchi’s introduction to Potlatch additionally
35
156 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
explains: “I append a list of people to whom I am sending
was for Nuttall “a paper exhibition in words, pages,
this first statement. If you respond, we shall have your
spaces, holes, edges and images which drew people in
contribution roneod and distribute it to those people on
and forced a violent involvement with the unalterable
the list. If you wish to add names to the list, do so. We
facts. The message was: if you want to exist you must
shall extend the chain. The thing should develop into an
accept the flesh and the moment. . . . The magazine . . .
interesting interpersonal work-in-progress.” Joseph
used nausea and flagrant scatology as a violent means
Berke appears on both of the lists, of participants and of
of presentation. I wanted to make the fundamental con-
“people interested,” that Trocchi circulated in October
dition of living unavoidable by nausea. You can’t pretend
and then in December 1964 (figs. 8.3 and 8.4). In June
it’s not there if you’re throwing up as a result.”44
1964 Trocchi had made contact with the psychiatrists
Aaron Esterson, R. D. Laing, and David Cooper, who the
revisited Currell-Brown’s letter and then reaffirmed his
following year instituted the Philadelphia Association
support of sigma in its aim to bring together those who
to support centers for the treatment and research that
held to the “simple premise—that people must now
Trocchi recognized was close to his idea of spontaneous
change or become extinct.” The editorial ends with a
university. Sigma’s creative ambience was a reflection
list of the names of the like-minded people and orga-
of what became the curative environment of the first of
nizations identified by Nuttall as furthering “an actual
these centers (Kingsley Hall) with regard especially to
evolutionary change within the cells of the human mind.
schizophrenia, for which the identity and categories of
To be sigma is not to await guidance or acknowledg-
psychiatrist and patient were dissolved.
ment from 6 St Stephens Gardens (chez Trocchi). It is,
for each of these people/groups, simply to continue as
40
41
42
Trocchi had also been receiving Jeff Nuttall’s
In 1965, in an editorial for My Own Mag, Nuttall
magazine My Own Mag, intended as a “project to found
they are doing.”45 The following year the editorial of My
a committed art group that would confront the prob-
Own Mag comprised a longer list of names (figs. 8.5 and
lem of living in the shadow of imminent destruction.”
8.6), which was, because it also included addresses,
The magazine was a direct result of a letter published
closer in function to sigma’s “interpersonal log.” Nuttall
in Peace News in 1962; written by Peter Currell-Brown,
explains: “subversion is revolution by infiltration rather
it called on artists to be “committed” both in life
than confrontation. I give here a list of individuals,
and as artists. This led to the formulation of a group
organizations, institutions, magazines which seem to me
exhibition for the Crypt at St. Martin’s that, if it had
to be concerned with subversion rather than literature,
ever taken place, would have expressed “the shriek
art, pornography, underground movies, heroin or other
[Nuttall] wanted to smear across the public face.”
quaint rural handicrafts.”46 Many of the names intersect
Failure to mount the exhibition (Nuttall also contacted
with those associated with sigma, and Trocchi’s address
the Whitechapel Art Gallery to no avail) led Nuttall to
is listed as c/o St. Martins School of Art, where he was
remake it as a mimeographed magazine. My Own Mag
by this time an occasional tutor.
43
157 Project sigma
Fig. 8.3 Project sigma—Public Relations—List of People Interested, sigma portfolio 17 (London: project sigma, December 1964).
Fig. 8.4 Project sigma—Public Relations—List of People Interested, sigma portfolio 17 (London: project sigma, December 1964).
Fig. 8.5 Jeff Nuttall, ed., My Own Mag 15 (April 1966), showing list of addresses.
Fig. 8.6 Jeff Nuttall, ed., My Own Mag 15 (April 1966), showing list of addresses.
Earlier, in July 1964, Nuttall had organized a
and assemble the portfolio items with Trocchi; and the
weekend meeting to bring Trocchi and the nascent
following year Nuttall constructed the sTigma environ-
Philadelphia Association together with the artist
ment in the basement of Better Books as a sign of his
John Latham, the poet and organizer of Group H Bob
allegiance.50
Cobbing, and the theater producer Beba Lavrin, who
sTigma was more than just a sign of Nuttall’s alle-
worked with Arnold Wesker’s Centre 42. Nuttall’s
giance to sigma, as its genesis lay in Nuttall’s exchange
recollection of the event, in his book Bomb Culture,
with Peter Currell-Brown in 1962—their exhibition
as a drug-and-alcohol-drenched shambles has both
may not have happened, but sTigma was considered
the air of truth and the ring of fiction in equal mea-
by Nuttall to be the result of a congruence with the
sure. Trocchi’s own unpublished account, written the
ideals of sigma. It was not an “exhibition,” for the group
following week as “Junkie Jottings,” underlines the
behind it (predominantly Keith and Heather Musgrove,
deep-seated difference between him and Nuttall about
Criton Tomazos, John Latham, Bruce Lacey, Islwyn
the latter’s need for a defined position akin to that of the
Watkins, and Dave Trace) had come together to make
Committee of 100. Trocchi writes:
an “experience . . . a labyrinth designed to make people
47
48
feel more.”51 Once in the labyrinth there was no immeThere were nearly 30 people waiting for me in the
diate way out, and the viewer was immediately put face
conference room—“they,” Jeff had called them, not
to face with images of war atrocities, pornography, and
“we.” . . . The kind of community I have described
abortion, after which the corridor narrowed to darkness.
in the Invisible I [Invisible Insurrection of a Million
The walls were lined with tin, glass, wet bread, plastic,
Minds] and sigma a t-b [sigma: A Tactical Blueprint]
and sponges. Before emerging, via a zigzag corridor of
is one in which normal limits and constraints are
polyethylene, the visitor encountered a group of figures
not operative. Leisure and relative plenty a struc-
“gathered around a dentist chair which had itself been
tural fact. All the competitive gestures deriving
turned into a figure, with sponge rubber breasts and
from a world in want are no longer operative. The
a shaven head. On the seat of the chair was a cunt
“pilot” group should have spent less time pretend-
made out of a bed-pan lined with hair and cod’s roe.
ing to ask “what are we here for?” and should have
Detergent bubbles spluttered from between the slabs
concentrated on discussing possible actions and
of roe, which remained spluttering and stinking for four
reactions to the “play situation.” The question was
weeks.”52 This led on via a bank of TV screens to a café
not “Why are we together?” (together we must
with food left moldering and a replica living room from
be!) but “how are we together?”
which visitors had to exit by crawling through a “vaginal
49
tunnel of inner tubes scented with Dettol” and then out Perhaps not a success, as such, but Laing contributed
via a womb room in which was nailed a plastic model
to sigma; Nuttall and Cobbing continued to print up
of an aborted fetus. Recordings of the voices of Trocchi
161 Project sigma
and William Burroughs (who contributed regularly to
Philadelphia Association’s Kingsley Hall.56 When Berke
My Own Mag),53 along with BBC Radio, could be heard
finally moved to London in the summer of 1965 to work
from concealed speakers. There was no relief from
at Kingsley Hall, this vision led first to his assistance in
the oppressive obscenity and bleak misogyny of the
the establishment of the London Free School and then in
environment that Nuttall saw as little different from the
1968 to the formation of the Antiuniversity.57
atrocity of the H-bomb that conventional society had
embraced.
through inner space toward the formation of a new soci-
ety provided a corollary to the position of the mad in an
A few months after the meeting at Brazier’s Park,
Trocchi’s alienated drug addict on a journey
Laing went to America furnished with, among other
institutional culture that banished them to the margins.
things, an introduction from Trocchi to Timothy Leary
It is understandable, given these circumstances, that
(a flyer for Alpert, Leary, and Metzner’s Castalia
the study of madness—and specifically schizophrenia—
Foundation at Millbrook was portfolio item no. 28).
should hold a significant position in the identification for
Laing also made contact with Berke, who the previous
cultural revolution.58 Just as sigma was understood by
year had worked with him in London for some months.
Trocchi as an interpersonal logbook, the basis of Laing’s
Laing introduced Berke to sigma by passing on to him
study of schizophrenia in The Politics of Experience
the portfolio items in print at that time. Berke imme-
(1967) was the mapping of a field of interaction that he
diately wrote to Trocchi, informing him that sigma
termed “inter-experience,”59 as that which cannot be
“reiterates and develops ideas which I and others here
seen but must be felt and which informs the reappraisal
have been on to for some time, I really dig the project.
of the relationship between doctor and patient. The
. . . I showed the folio to Allen Ginsberg which really
resemblance to Trocchi’s “Invisible Insurrection” is no
turned him on as he dug your letter in the first place.”54
coincidence. Again it was not to be sigma, but Berke
Later in the month Berke attended a demonstration
and the Institute for Phenomenological Studies—part
against the seizure of the Living Theatre’s assets: “At
of the Philadelphia Association—that in 1968 set up
1am we stopped and I read excerpts from the Moving
another approximation of the spontaneous university as
Times and some other people read poetry. This must
the Antiuniversity, described by the poet Harold Norse
have been the first public oration of project sigma in the
as a “spontaneous experiment.”60 Its prospectus echoes
U.S. so it was without a doubt a historical moment.”55
Trocchi: “many of the original and radical artists, activ-
For the next ten months or so Berke became one of
ists and intellectuals of London and Europe, America
sigma’s most vocal advocates in New York. Most impor-
and the Third World have a place to meet among them-
tantly, he, along with Allen Krebs, in 1965 cofounded the
selves and discuss their ideas and work. The emphasis
Free University of New York, a countercultural school
is on diversity of approach, but we shall work to unify
built on principles that Trocchi had elaborated and that
disparate perspectives. Above all we must do away with
Berke encouraged Trocchi to duplicate in London at the
artificial splits and divisions between disciplines and art
162 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
forms and between theory and action.”61 Indeed, part of
Horovitz, and Pablo Fernandez) wrote out in Trocchi’s
their purpose was the creation of interactive teaching,
flat as a list naming some of the intersection points
“‘spontaneous universities’ . . . where people will have
of an international underground moving between
the opportunity to listen to, discuss, challenge and turn
London, New York, San Francisco, Athens, Paris, and
on to a multifaceted analysis of what is going on.”62
Amsterdam. It was read out as an invocation at a press
conference a week before the event: “World declaration
Project sigma—read especially through the course
of the sigma portfolio—provides an identification of
hot peace shower! Earth’s grass is free! . . . Skullbody
the concerns of the underground in the mid-1960s
love-congress Annunciation, duende concordium,
and the strategies it adopted in its attempt to find
effendi tovarisch Illumination, Now! Sigmatic New
and evolve a new language of expression and action.
Departures Residu of Better Books & Moving Times in
Trocchi typified this as the destruction of “language to
obscenely New Directions! Soul revolution City Lights
see all the limitations of language, to see how language
Olympian lamb-blast! Castalia centrum new conscious-
limits experience—to break through language” in a
ness hungry generation Movement roundhouse 42
way that operates as a refusal to categorization. The
beat apocalypse energy-triumph! You are not alone!”64
distribution of the sigma portfolio shines a light on the
Trocchi’s conception of project sigma as both a sponta-
wide and international arc of linkages making up the
neous university and an interpersonal logbook proposed
countercultural community, which the International
that each individual could come to an understanding of
Poetry Incarnation at the Royal Albert Hall in June 1965
his or her own reality and that of the wider society. This
publicly emphasized. This event was organized by a
would be achieved by enacting a personal critical dis-
coalition of sigma, Michael Horovitz’s poetry forum,
course within networks of impermanent communities
New Departures, and John Esam, with help from Jill
that were in a perpetual state of “(r)evolt”; discourse
and Dan Richter of Residu magazine. Trocchi was the
would be self-generative: “becoming.”
compere, but it was not so much the poetry or the poets
but the audience of seventy-five hundred that held
International Poetry Incarnation was, for Trocchi, an
significance for him. This exemplified a shared com-
example of the “Invisible Insurrection” in action: “the
munity of purpose, a new cultural network, that could
(r)evolt is taking place at the level of symbols: there is
operate beyond barriers of language and nationality.
no question of us ever meeting the forces of reaction
It showed that the Invisible Insurrection was perhaps
head on in a war on their terms. But it is happening.”65
not so invisible and could be named. For the Poetry
The Poetry Incarnation provided a direct impetus to the
Incarnation, this was mapped by cultural coordinates
founding of the underground newspaper International
that ten of the participants (Trocchi, John Esam, Allen
Times the following year. In its fourth issue, the link with
Ginsberg, Paolo Leonni, Harry Fainlight, Lawrence
sigma was made explicit; on its masthead the newspa-
Ferlinghetti, Dan Richter, Simon Vinkenoog, Michael
per declared itself to be “A Sigmatic Newspaper,” and
63
163 Project sigma
The visualization of the communities at the
opposite this Trocchi announced the establishment of a
hitherto sustained it. This is vitally important,
sigma box office at 102 Southampton Row (also at this
that the project should not be associated with
address were the Indica Bookshop and the offices of the
this or that individual or group. There is a sense
International Times). However, this was not conceived
in which “sigma” is merely a word, a tactical
to give sigma more visibility. The project should not be
symbol, a dialectical instrument. . . . We are all
seen as a building or a set of documents held together
individuals and for each of us the first problem is
in a folder. Sigma’s identity could only be realized
himself-in-the-present. It is not so much a question
through the forces of personal self-discovery and action
of choosing to co-operate as of discovering oneself
that the interpersonal logbook encouraged, and as such
in and of the invisible insurrection by virtue of one’s
it was an identity that was not fixed but evolving. As
practical posture.66
Trocchi asserted: Now, at last, sigma can develop here in London more independently of the personalities that have
Notes
1. In Trocchi, sigma: A Tactical Blueprint, sigma portfolio 2 (London: project sigma, 1964), 2 (later editions, 1), Trocchi states, “In general, we prefer to use the word ‘sigma’ with a small letter, as an adjective rather than as a noun.” 2. In ibid., 5 (later editions, 3), Trocchi uses the word “transcategorical”: “our strength lies not so much in what has so far been done purposively in our name as in the availability of other intelligences to our transcategorical inspiration.” However, in sigma: General Informations, sigma portfolio 5 (London: project sigma, 1964), 3, this term—indicating a range across categories—was exchanged for “metacategorical.” If the boundaries between categories and actions were held as nonexistent, then sigma for Trocchi embodied a view of culture and society that could be arrived at by ignoring boundaries and moving beyond existing categorizations. In his preface to an unpublished collection of his writing to be titled The Invisible Insurrection of a Million Minds, Trocchi writes that “every creative act, whatever its end-product . . . is a tactical particle in what I think of as a continuous global, and metacategorical process of (r)evolt.” Two typescripts with holograph alterations, dated 1966 and 1966 altered to 1971, Trocchi Papers. The papers of Alexander Trocchi are held at Washington University, St. Louis, as MSS116. These papers are made up of a number of purchases between 1967 and 2013; the final purchase, from the estate, contains most of the organizational and administrative records of project sigma,
164 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
manuscripts for unpublished or unfinished texts, translations, collaboration with Michael X, as well as Trocchi’s correspondence with Guy Debord and others. This essay is based on research into these papers carried out in 1990, when I catalogued them for the estate. The catalogue of the Trocchi holdings at St. Louis can be consulted at http://archon.wulib.wustl.edu/index .php?p=collections/controlcard&id=567. 3. Alexander Trocchi, Invisible Insurrection of a Million Minds, sigma portfolio 2 (London: sigma project, 1964). 4. Ibid., 5; Trocchi, sigma: A Tactical Blueprint, 3, 6–11 (later editions, 2, 4–6). 5. Merlin was edited by Trocchi and published by the American Jane Lougee (the final issue was published by Olympia Press) with a close-knit group of contributors comprising Patrick Brangwyn, Patrick Bowles, Charles Hatcher, Christopher Logue, Richard Seaver, and Austryn Wainhouse. In Merlin 1, no. 3, Seaver is listed as “Advisory Editor and Director”; in 2, no. 3, he is listed as an “Associate” alongside Wainhouse, Bowles, and W. Baird Bryant; and for the final issue, 2, no. 7, Seaver is listed as part of a “Committee,” also including Bowles, Baird Bryant, Corneille, Robert Creeley, Ben Johnson, and Shinkichi Tajiri—while Wainhouse is listed alongside Trocchi as “Editor.” Apart from publishing the magazine (seven issues between May 1952 and Spring 1955), the Merlin group also published books in collaboration with the Olympia Press, notably Watt (1953) and
Molloy (1955) by Samuel Beckett; Wand and Quadrant (1953) by Christopher Logue; The Thief’s Journal (1954) by Jean Genet; and Hedyphagetica (1954) by Austryn Wainhouse. The Merlin writers also wrote for Olympia Press, with Trocchi contributing a sequence of pornography under the pseudonyms Frances Lengel and Carmencita de las Lunas between 1953 and 1956, including the first version of Young Adam, in 1953. For more on the scene around Merlin, see J. Campbell, Paris Interzone; de St. Jorre, Good Ship Venus; Kearney, Paris Olympia Press; and Logue, Prince Charming. 6. Potlatch 23 (October 13, 1955): 2, carries the note “Vite Fait” on Alexander Trocchi’s membership in the Lettrist International (LI), which followed the cessation of publication of Merlin. Potlatch, the duplicated magazine of the LI, could only be given and passed between friends, rather than bought, and was a direct model for the papers issued within the sigma portfolio. 7. The single-page typescript note “Trocchi: Tactics: Lettrisme, No. 1” states, “Existentialisme became Lettrisme became Situationnisme became sigma. . . . Existentialisme expressed man being alone, a phenomenologist trapped in his own skull. Lettrisme found him trying to communicate beyond a necessary nihilism.” N.d. [ca. 1964/66], Trocchi Papers. The importance of Trocchi’s friendship with Debord should not be understated. In his founding “Administrative Notes (Practical)” for project sigma, dated January 10, 1962, Trocchi lists Debord as one of seven main “contacts” for the “University” that he saw at the heart of the project (the others were Robert Creeley, William Burroughs, Tony Landrau, Norman Mailer, Bill Heine, and Trocchi himself). Two handwritten sheets, Trocchi Papers. That the founding text of project sigma was first published in French translation in Internationale Situationniste, that Trocchi recast Debord’s statement “Nous ne voulons pas travailler au spectacle de la fin d’un monde, mais à la fin du monde du spectacle” (from Internationale Situationniste 3 [December 1959]: 8) as “Si nous ne voulons pas assister au spectacle de la fin de monde, il nous faut travailler à la fin du monde du spectacle” in Trocchi, Invisible Insurrection of a Million Minds, 3, and, especially, that he made free reference to the Situationists and their embrace of leisure and play within their theories in both this text and also sigma: A Tactical Blueprint should also make clear the debt Trocchi owed to Debord and the Situationist International (SI) in his formulation of project sigma. Furthermore, one of the key productions of project sigma was a new translation of the Manifeste Situationniste—sigma portfolio 18 (London: project sigma, 1964)—translated and updated by Trocchi and Phillip Green. It had originally been published as “Manifeste,” Internationale Situationniste 4 (June 1960): 36–38. Significantly, Trocchi understood his use of heroin in Situationist terms, so that he wrote in the late 1950s, while in America, recalling words from Potlatch: “The fix: a purposive spoon in the broth of experience. (Il vous faut construire les situations.)” Trocchi, Cain’s Book, 236.
165 Project sigma
8. International Writers’ Conference, 1962 (transcript, August 21, 1962), 12. This transcript was mimeographed and distributed in very small numbers; the publisher is unknown, British Library (11881.g.1.). 9. Dégagement was a term much used by Trocchi—for instance, in writing about his experiences in Paris in the early 1950s: “In that city, at that time, for better or for worse, de Gaulle was thrusting himself to power for the second time, I began to realize for myself the only valid commitment was beyond an extreme form of dégagement.” Alexander Trocchi, “Drugs of the Mind, an experiential investigation and general and historical survey” (unpublished typescript, ca. 1970), 22, Trocchi Papers. 10. Alexander Trocchi, “Editorial,” Merlin 1, no. 3 (Winter 1952–53): 117. 11. Alexander Trocchi, “Editorial: Words and War,” Merlin 2, no. 3 (Summer–Autumn 1954): 141–43 and 209–27. 12. Alexander Trocchi in Jamie Wadhawan, dir., Cain’s Film, 1969: “The identity of the junkie (not only a figure of the underground, but the social leper of the 1950s in New York) was consciously chosen. The resulting experience is by definition that of an alien in a society of conformers.” 13. Trocchi, five-page typescript and holograph fragment for “Drugs of the Mind” (ca. 1970), 2–3. (There are a number of different versions and states for this unpublished work.) Trocchi Papers. 14. Trocchi, “Drugs of the Mind” (unpublished typescript, ca. 1970), 24, Trocchi Papers. 15. Trocchi took part in readings at Stone Brothers on Sawtelle Boulevard in West Los Angeles in September 1957, shortly before the space opened, initially as a place for Robert Alexander to print exhibition announcements for Ferus; the poster for one such reading—listing Trocchi with many of the contributors to the second issue of Semina (published in December)—is reproduced in Duncan and McKenna, Semina Culture, 1. 16. Guy Debord sent Trocchi a driver’s license from Paris so that he could drive back from California to New York and, it was hoped by Debord, return to Europe and participate in the newly founded SI; as described in a letter from Debord to Mohamed Dahou, November 18, 1957, translation available at http://www.notbored .org/debord-18November1957.html. 17. Trocchi, Cain’s Book, 33. 18. The apartment was at 81 Brooks Avenue, at the junction of Main Street and Brooks; the building no longer exists. Rosenthal, Sheeper, 217–37. 19. Guy Debord, Jacqueline de Jong, and Asger Jorn, “Hands off Alexander Trocchi!” (October 7, 1960). This tract explicitly states his allegiance with the SI, describing him as “the former director of the revue Merlin, and now he participates in experimental art research in collaboration with artists from several countries, who were regrouped on 28 September in London in the Institute of Contemporary Arts (17 Dover Street). On that occasion, they unanimously expressed in public their solidarity with
Alexander Trocchi, and their absolute certainty of the value of his comportment.” 20. “Resolution Concerning the Imprisonment of Alexander Trocchi” (September 27, 1960), Internationale Situationniste 5 (December 1960): 14. “The conference . . . calls in particular upon the cultural authorities of Britain and on all British intellectuals who value liberty to demand the setting free of Alexander Trocchi, who is beyond all doubt England’s most intelligent creative artist today.” 21. Graham Rae, “Jabberwock Talk: The Scottish Drug (Literature) Connection,” gives a useful account of Trocchi’s arrival in Aberdeen and the short period he spent with Neish in Edinburgh. http://realitystudio.org/interviews/interview-with-alex-neis h-editor-of-jabberwock-and-sidewalk. 22. Trocchi coined this phrase at a press conference (August 22) during the International Writers’ Conference organized by John Calder and Jim Haynes for the 1962 Edinburgh Festival. The audio recording of the conference is held by the British Library, London, under the catalogue reference NP550-NP561. He reiterated the main points of the press conference later in the day, saying that “the important exploration is the exploration of the self. I rather sensationally described myself as a cosmonaut of inner space.” International Writers’ Conference, 1962 (transcript, August 22, 1962), 22. 23. Alexander Trocchi, “The Destruction of the Object,” one-page typescript note, 1962, Trocchi Papers. The transcript of the writers’ conference records this statement incorrectly. 24. International Writers’ Conference, 1962 (transcript, August 24, 1962), 11. 25. In September 1961 Trocchi had been a signatory, with Guy Debord and Raoul Vaneigem, to the “Hamburg Theses,” which, though unpublished, defined the second phase of SI activity. A few months later Trocchi was elected to the SI central council and the editorial board, alongside Michele Bernstein, Debord, Attila Kotanyi, Uwe Lausen, J. V. Martin, Jan Strijbosch, and Vaneigem. 26. Trocchi, Cain’s Book, 59–60. 27. This text was first published in English in New Saltire Review 8 (June 1963); it was also reprinted in America in City Lights Journal 2 (1964). 28. Trocchi, Invisible Insurrection of a Million Minds, 1. This short indicative quotation is also printed in The Moving Times—project sigma, sigma portfolio 1 (London: project sigma, 1964). This first issue of the portfolio was produced as a poster broadsheet. The distribution of its second edition—printed double foolscap both verso and recto—coincided with the 1965 Poetry Incarnation at the Albert Hall, London. 29. Trocchi, Invisible Insurrection of a Million Minds, 1. 30. Ibid. 31. Trocchi, sigma: A Tactical Blueprint, 2 (later editions, 1).
166 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
32. Trocchi, Invisible Insurrection of a Million Minds, 6. For more on Black Mountain College, see Harris, Arts of Black Mountain College, and Katz, Black Mountain College. 33. Trocchi, sigma: A Tactical Blueprint, 10 (later editions, 5). Although Trocchi was unsuccessful in setting up such a center in London, the sigma centrum in Amsterdam operated between November 1966 and July 1967; organized by Simon Vinkenoog, it received a grant from the Amsterdam city council. For more on Vinkenoog and sigma centrum, see Pas, “In Pursuit of the Invisible Revolution.” 34. Joan Littlewood and Cedric Price, Joan Littlewood presents . . . , sigma portfolio 11 (London: project sigma, 1964). Trocchi and Price met a number of times in 1964 to discuss the Fun Palace project. An offprint of Joan Littlewood, “A Laboratory of Fun,” New Scientist, May 14, 1964, 452–53, can be found within the Trocchi Papers along with correspondence with both Price and Littlewood and a group of Price’s architectural drawings. In many respects, the plans for the Fun Palace—especially its informality, lack of permanent structures, and capacity for evolution and flexibility—echo much of Trocchi’s conception of a spontaneous university. For more on the Fun Palace, see Cedric Price: Works ii, 56–61, and Mathews, From Agit-Prop to Free Space, 82–176. 35. A note published in “Sur des publications de l’I.S.,” Internationale Situationniste 10 (March 1966): 83, regarding the division between Trocchi and the SI since his circulation of sigma portfolio from the autumn of 1964, states: “Upon the appearance in London in autumn 1964 of the first publications of the ‘project sigma’ initiated by Alexander Trocchi, it was mutually agreed that the SI could not involve itself in such a loose cultural enterprise. . . . It is no longer as a member of the SI that our friend Alexander Trocchi has since developed an activity of which we fully approve of several aspects.” On October 12, 1964, in a letter to Trocchi, Debord had informed him that he had been ousted from the SI; however, this was rescinded in a letter of December 1, 1964, in which he describes Trocchi as “our friend, someone who shares our fundamental goals,” and they remained in correspondence until at least 1967. Letters to Trocchi translated at http://www.notbored .org/debord-12October1964.html and http://www.notbored.org/ debord-1December1964.html. 36. Application to paste up Moving Times on London Underground advertising boards was made on September 3, 1964, by Beba Lavrin for “Sigma Associates.” A letter to Lavrin from London Transport Advertising dated December 16, 1964, rejected the application. Trocchi Papers. 37. R. D. Laing, The Present Situation, sigma portfolio 6 (London: project sigma, 1964). This is a paper that Laing delivered to the 6th International Congress for Psychotherapy in London in August 1964; in the introduction for the portfolio it was explained how “Dr Laing’s statement that ‘we are all implicated in this state of affairs of alienation’ calls for a therapeutic situation closely resembling the experimental ambience of Trocchi’s ‘spontaneous
university.’” Letter from Stan Brakhage to Robert Kelly, sigma portfolio 10 (London: project sigma, 1964). Letter from Stan Brakhage to Alexander Trocchi, sigma portfolio 19 (London: project sigma, 1964). Michael McClure, Essay: Revolt, sigma portfolio 21 (London: project sigma, 1964)—reprinting this work from McClure’s Meat Science Essays was preferred over the initial idea of distributing his Dream Table (Poems) as sigma portfolio 9, which in the event did not take place, though one poem from this sequence was published the following year in Jeff Nuttall, ed., My Own Mag 11 (February 1965). 38. Trocchi, sigma: A Tactical Blueprint, sigma portfolio 2 (London: project sigma, 1964), 5 (later editions, 3). 39. Subscription Form, sigma portfolio 12 (London: project sigma, 1964), 1. 40. Potlatch, sigma portfolio 4 (London: project sigma, 1964). 41. Project sigma—Public Relations—Selective List of Individual Participants appears to be an early version of Trocchi, Project sigma—Public Relations—List of People Interested, sigma portfolio 17 (London: project sigma, 1964). 42. Kingsley Hall was a community center in Bow lent to the Philadelphia Association in June 1965. The Philadelphia Association had been set up as a charity that April by the psychiatrists R. D. Laing, David Cooper, and Aaron Esterson, and at Kingsley Hall they were joined by Joseph Berke, Leon Redler, Morton Schatzman, and Jerome Liss to create an “anti-psychiatry unit” to treat schizophrenia in an environment where the categories of sane/insane or counselor/patient were dismantled in favor of an inner journey toward rebirth. In 1969 a fundraising brochure stated: “If one thinks of oneself primarily as a patient, doctor, social worker or nurse, one will find it difficult to meet across the subtle ambiguities and pressures that exist in families and mental hospitals. To explore the contradictions in communication that at times may lead any of us to act, or to be seen, as mad, we needed a community with a flexible structure, where people did not have to be forced into such roles as doctor, social worker, nurse or patient. . . . Kingsley Hall has been a melting pot, a crucible in which many, if not all, of our initial assumptions about normal-abnormal, conformist-deviant, sane-crazy experience and behaviour have been dissolved.” Philadelphia Association Report, 1965–1969 (London: Philadelphia Association, 1969), 6–7. The Philadelphia Association occupied the building from June 1965 until August 1970, and for a short time John Latham had a studio in the building. In 1967 the Institute of Phenomenological Studies (set up by a number of those involved with the Philadelphia Association) organized the Dialectics of Liberation conference. Berke’s earlier agitation for a London version of the Free University of New York would eventually lead to the foundation of the Antiuniversity in 1968 at Rivington Street in London (although he had hoped this could also have been located at Kingsley Hall), for which the institute was the main sponsor. 43. Hewison, Too Much, 106.
167 Project sigma
44. Nuttall, Bomb Culture, 151. 45. Jeff Nuttall, “Editorial,” My Own Mag 12 (May 1965), n.p. 46. Jeff Nuttall, “Editorial,” My Own Mag 15 (April 1966), n.p. 47. Launched in 1961, Centre 42 was an attempt to make the best in the arts available to everyone without the need for class-based patronage or subservience to the forces of the market. It described itself in its launch brochure as “a cultural hub which, by its approach and work, will destroy the mystique and snobbery associated with the arts. A place where artists are in control of their own means of expression and their own channels of distribution . . . where the artist is brought into closer contact with his audience enabling the public to see that artistic activity is a natural part of their daily lives.” Centre 42 launch brochure as cited in Hewison, Too Much, 19. After organizing festivals throughout Britain in 1961 and 1962, Wesker worked to secure a base for its activities and in 1964 took the sixteen years remaining on the lease for the Roundhouse in Camden. For more on Centre 42, see Hewison, Too Much, 17–24, and Wesker, Fears of Fragmentation. In Invisible Insurrection of a Million Minds, 4–5, Trocchi identified with Centre 42’s aims in attacking divisions between art and life but criticized what he felt to be a lack of ambition in realizing those aims. 48. For contrasting descriptions of this meeting, see Nuttall, Bomb Culture, 221–27; Walker, John Latham, 71–73; and Alexander Trocchi, “Junkie Jottings,” unpublished manuscript, 1964, Trocchi Papers. 49. Trocchi, “Junkie Jottings.” 50. Better Books was opened in the autumn of 1947 by the bookseller, later publisher, Tony Godwin and the actor John Clarke (later better known as Bryan Forbes) in premises at 92–94 Charing Cross Road. In 1964 Godwin opened a paperback bookshop—betterbookz—next door at 1, 3, and 5 New Compton Street, designed by Germano Facetti and managed successively by Bill Butler, Barry Miles, and Bob Cobbing as a multidisciplinary space offering readings, talks, lectures, exhibitions, film screenings, and performances in addition to its broad selection of avant-garde writing and publishing. This range of activities suited its location near St. Martin’s School of Art. Collins publishers bought the bookshop in 1966, and the following year Cobbing left after the new owner curtailed the range of activities. For more information, see A. Wilson, “This Is Not an Advertisement.” 51. Nuttall, “Editorial,” My Own Mag 12 (May 1965), n.p. Alongside this editorial are printed two photographs of the environment as well as a cut-up description of it. 52. Nuttall, Bomb Culture, 236. Another account is Dick Wilcocks, “sTigma—a Kick at Soporifics,” Peace News, March 12, 1965, 10. 53. Nuttall, Bomb Culture, 154. Cut-up contributions by Burroughs appeared in the following issues of My Own Mag, often as a magazine within a magazine, variously titled The Burrough or The Moving Times: 2 (December 1963/January 1964?); 4 (April 1964?); 5 (“Tangier Special Issue”), as Moving Times (May
1964?); 6, as The Burrough (July 1964?); 7, as The Moving Times (July 1964?); 8, as The Burrough (August 1964?); 9, as The Moving Times (November 1, 1964); 11, as The Moving Times (February 1965); 12, as The Apomorphine Times (May 1965); 13 (“The Dutch Schultz Special,” August 1965); 15, as The Moving Times (April 1966). 54. Joseph Berke to Alexander Trocchi, typescript letter, October 5, 1964, Trocchi Papers. 55. Joseph Berke to Alexander Trocchi, autograph letter, October 26, 1964, Trocchi Papers. 56. The influence of sigma on the founding of the Free University of New York is made clear by Berke in a handwritten letter to Trocchi from the spring of 1965, a typewritten copy of which is held with the Trocchi Papers. In this letter Berke writes, “the beginning of the Free University of N.Y. is a key sigma project. It incorporates the concept of University of which you speak in Invisible Insurrection. . . . The Sigma Brotherhood will begin to manifest itself. . . . Free University of London has existed in the persons of you, Ronnie, etc. Now is the time for it to achieve an even more tangible expression.” 57. The London Free School was set up by Hopkins in March 1966 with Michael de Freitas, John Michell, Graham Keen, Dave Tomlin, Joe Boyd, Harry Fainlight, Berke, and others. For more on this, see A. Wilson, “Spontaneous Underground,” 77–79. For Berke’s part in the Antiuniversity and the Free University of New York, see Berke, Counter-Culture, 12–34 and 212–81. 58. If Trocchi’s thought was largely determined by his prioritization of an alienated view on the world, this was also one starting point for R. D. Laing as it defined the detachment of humanity “from its authentic possibilities.” For Laing, as for Trocchi, “[n]o one can begin to think, feel or act now except from the starting-point of his or her own alienation.” Laing, Politics of Experience, 11. 59. “The task of social phenomenology is to relate my experience of the other’s behaviour to the other’s experience of my behaviour. Its study is the relation between experience and experience: its true field is inter-experience.” Ibid., 15.
168 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
60. Norse, Trocchi, and Tasher, “Three views on the Anti-University”; Norse here also suggested, in a way that chimes with sigma, that the Antiuniversity should be a “Free School, founded on the principle that a revolution in the mind itself as a necessary condition for a changed value system is the only possible hope for the moribund human race, [which] could really provide a focus for research into the self.” 61. Antiuniversity of London: Catalogue, n.p. This was produced for the first semester (February 1968). The catalogue for the second semester (July 1968) was produced and printed by Bob Cobbing. 62. Ibid. Among those who participated in sigma’s “interpersonal log” and were listed also on the faculty or visiting faculty of the Antiuniversity for its first and second semesters were Joseph Berke, William Burroughs, David Cooper, Jim Haynes, Allen Ginsberg, R. D. Laing, John Latham, Jeff Nuttall, and Cedric Price. 63. Alexander Trocchi response in typescript transcript of Something to Say 4: Daniel Farson Interviewing William Burroughs and Alexander Trocchi, Slate 1 / Take 1, Telerecording, January 6, 1964, 9–10, Trocchi Papers. 64. This was printed in the program for the International Poetry Incarnation, Royal Albert Hall, London, June 11, 1965 [folded card], and also reprinted in “International Poetry Incarnation,” Wholly Communion (London: Lorrimer Films, 1965), 9, and “Poetry Internationale,” ICA Bulletin 150 (August–September 1965): 12–13. 65. Alexander Trocchi, “International Poetry at the Royal Albert Hall, London: What Happened at the Royal Albert Hall?” Topolski’s Chronicle 13, nos. 5–6 (1965), n.p. 66. Trocchi, “sigma.” A report of the opening of Sigma Centrum in Amsterdam appears on page 3 of the same periodical.
The Artist as a Speaker-Performer The London Art School in the 1960s–70s Elena Crippa
Artists have been standing up and speaking about art
delivered a lecture titled “Authentic Paranoiac Phantom”
for centuries. In the tradition of the art academy, artists
while wearing a deep-sea diving suit and using a
would teach, lecture, and give speeches about their
decorated billiard cue as a pointer for the accompany-
work, as well as theories of perspective and anatomy
ing slides.2 In 1952 Eduardo Paolozzi, on the occasion
and issues of style and technique. It was with the
of the first, intimate gathering of the Independent
historical avant-garde that artists started mixing tech-
Group, delivered his lecture, titled “BUNK,” using an
niques akin to those of academic presentations with
epidiascope to project images, in random order and
elements of performance. The London art world has,
with no verbal commentary, from his large collection of
since the early twentieth century, hosted any number
American color magazines.3
of avant-garde artist presentations. Filippo Tommaso
Marinetti used his favorite medium, the public lecture,
speaker-performer. In London the figure of the intel-
or conferenza, to deliver a number of performances.
lectual who stands up and gives an aesthetic and
These included his “Futurist Speech to the English”
often highly performative embodiment of his or her
at the Lyceum Club in 1910 and the recitation of his
ideas through public presentations became increas-
poem “Zang Tumb Tuuum,” with drum accompani-
ingly common in the 1960s and early 1970s. By 1974
ment by Christopher Nevinson, at the Doré Gallery in
this trend was so apparent and distinctive that the
1914. Salvador Dalí, as part of the program of events
art critic Richard Cork, standing in the auditorium of
planned for the International Surrealist Exhibition, of 1936,
the Royal College of Art, began his lecture “Sculpture
1
These are early examples of the artist as a
9. 9. 9. 9. 9. 9. 9. 9. 9. 9.
Now: Dissolution or Redefinition” by stating: “Consider,
1960s and 1970s and, to a large degree, fostered by the
for a moment, the possibility that the event you are
teaching imparted within the art school. I also investi-
attending this evening is a lecture-sculpture—not a
gate the conditions and constraints that inspired artists
straightforward talk, given by a writer, who has been
to give form to such hybrid interventions, exploring
invited to prepare and deliver it in the ordinary way, but
alternative ways of articulating language and commu-
a carefully dramatized enactment, which takes its place
nication in order to reject the increasingly common
among other, related works by a sculptor, who sees his
figure of the artist as a defiantly confident and articulate
expressive potential within the format of a conventional
being, and also as a figure who was, invariably, male.
lecture.” With this potent introduction, Cork translated
back into the practice of the critic what had become
higher education are particularly relevant to this history.
a prominent, if not clearly defined, practice among
In 1960 a national reform aiming to raise academic
contemporary artists: that of performing knowledge
standards established the study of art history and other
through the staging of hybrid forms of lectures and per-
theoretical subjects as compulsory and fundamental
formances, as sites of convergence between academic
aspects of the training of artists in all art schools.5
and artistic modes of expression.
Through those curricular changes, art schools played
a decisive role in shaping the figure of the artist as
4
This history of the artist as a public speaker-
Two important transitions in the teaching of art in
performer is difficult to narrate, because of the art’s
an intellectual, in charge of the theoretical develop-
ephemeral nature, the scarcity of documentation, and
ment underpinning his or her work. Even earlier, since
the work’s lack of commercial currency or a place
the 1950s, Bauhaus-inspired formats of teaching and
within art history at the time of its delivery. At times it
exercises adopted across Britain played a key role in
may even seem dubious whether specific instances of
initiating the training of the artist as a thinker. Teaching,
such public events should be considered artworks at all
rather than focusing mostly on training the eye and the
rather than ludic interventions with little art-historical
hand, ultimately consisted in training the mind toward
relevance. Despite such legitimate reservations, this
a thinking process that would underpin the making of
chapter is motivated by the belief that this history is
works. Artists were not to draw or paint forms as they
indeed important. It attempts to recognize the vitality
saw them, but as they thought them. Students were no
and cultural relevance of this type of live manifestation
longer asked to copy from the cast and the figure, but
and understand its coeval as well as later influence on
to establish their own principles and develop their ideas
the development of practices that merged academic
in the making of artworks, following a continuous and
and theatrical types of delivery. Looking back at this his-
rational process.6
tory, this essay proposes that, if the figure of the artist
as a speaker-performer first emerged as part of the his-
the artist was learned and practiced were the sessions
torical avant-garde, it was more widely promoted in the
of group criticism, or “crits.” Group discussions have
170 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
The most important arenas in which the new role of
been a common feature of art academies since the
According to Caro, ongoing discussion among tutors
sixteenth century. Nevertheless, the history of group
and students was the major instrument through which
criticism, as a more clearly formulated and regularly
they questioned conventional assumptions on what
conducted pedagogical format responding to new and
sculpture was and how it should be made.10
specific needs in the training of artists, can be traced
back to the teaching of the Bauhaus, where it played
tutors and students started as a continuous and
a central role, and later to Britain, initially through
informal activity, it was soon to be formalized into the
courses of the Basic Design type. Group criticism was
weekly group “crits,” or “forums,” which were to become
to constitute a vital component of teaching. The format
strongly identified with the St. Martin’s Sculpture
was linked to a more systematic scrutiny of the relation-
Department. In this context, group criticism did not
ship between the work, the artist’s intention, and the
just constitute a pedagogical model among others—it
work’s sensorial, psychological, and intellectual impact.
became a forum that acted as a rite of passage for stu-
It trained students to articulate their visual concerns
dents seeking public recognition as fully formed artists,
verbally. It also helped develop a collective exchange
and proved a highly influential model for many other
on personal experiences and fostered an agreement
art schools. Around half a dozen finished works would
on principles of form and on the solutions that hold
be displayed in the main hall of the college building.
most interest. As a result, it also inevitably started
Much of the work presented was rejected by the other
functioning as a regulating and prescriptive tool, which
participants. Yet it was precisely the artists’ need to face
would sanction what type of work was to be considered
such disparagement and to defend their own work that
successful and why.
was considered essential for them in forming their voice
and learning how to “forge and sharpen their views.”11
7
8
In Britain, the teaching paradigm changed from the
If the conversation between Caro and his fellow
traditional easel visit to the group tutorial, or “crit,” in
the mid-1960s. For Stephen Chaplin, former archivist at
progressively embraced a formalist idiom derived from
the Slade School of Art, such a move meant a clear shift
Greenbergian criticism. This was the result not only of
in the relationship between the verbal and the visual
the influence of American Abstract Expressionism on
and played a major role in the discursive turn of higher
the tutors and students but also of the phenomenal
art education. In 1960s London, nowhere else was
endorsement offered by Clement Greenberg and the
group criticism as central to the teaching of art as in the
rapid success of St. Martin’s sculptors. The specific
Sculpture Department at St. Martin’s School of Art. The
idiom of “high modernism” was a matter not just of con-
artist Anthony Caro was a part-time tutor who, in the
tent but also of style. It set up camps of opposing forces,
1950s–60s, contributed significantly to the transforma-
discerning between good and bad, and established a
tion of St. Martin’s modest Sculpture Department into
condition of probity whereby success was linked to the
a powerhouse of sculpture on an international level.
forcefulness and directedness of the assertion. In the
9
171 The Artist as a Speaker-Performer
In the discussion of work during the forums, tutors
context of the forums, such style was described, in the
ingrained assumptions of what constituted the sculp-
words of the head of the Sculpture Department, Frank
tural medium, implicitly criticizing sculptors of his
Martin, as an “adversarial sort of situation.”
tutors’ generation for failing to take into account the
modalities of presentation and experience of their work.
12
Sculpture provided the occasion for a ritualistic
type of performance, with a number of artists staging
It was also a performance—a staged intervention that
a routine with relatively fixed formats of discussion
played with conventions of how artists were expected
and styles of presentations. Some of the students
to make and discuss their work. The critic Mel Gooding
were quick to identify and condemn the prescriptive
convincingly defined it as “a proto-performance, an
character of these public sessions of discussion and
exercise in pose, a lecture-sculpture precisely devised
the posturing of their teachers. Commenting on the
for its context.”18
“crits,” Bruce McLean, who studied in the department
between 1963 and 1966, famously stated: “Twelve adult
formulaic and authoritarian way of presenting and dis-
men with pipes would walk for hours around sculpture
cussing art may have instigated the development of the
and mumble.” Yet while being critical of this postur-
performances that marked the beginning of Gilbert &
ing, some of the students—including McLean—did not
George’s joint career, launching them into the interna-
reject but took on and started playing with formats of
tional art arena as “living sculptures.” Gilbert & George
presentation and public discussion. Key is that these
first performed their famous piece Singing Sculpture,
students, while taking on the performance of public
with the original title Our New Sculpture, at St. Martin’s
deliveries, counteracted them through speech acts that
on January 23, 1969, in their final year at the school.
made visible and disrupted the reproductive power of
the “texts” performed with the art school, and proposed
a few brief remarks from the artists about the nature
alternative ways of posing, articulating views, and relat-
of sculpture, in which Gilbert & George suggested that
ing to one another.
the work originated in response to the way in which
In October 1968, two years after having completed
sculpture was discussed in the department.19 Although
his studies in the Sculpture Department, McLean went
no audio documentation or transcript of the preface to
back to St. Martin’s to deliver a lecture. The slides he
the performance exists, it is possible that it did not differ
showed were not of existing works. Instead, he shot
greatly from their “Laws of Sculpture,” which featured in
several rolls of slides of objects from the urban environ-
“A Magazine Sculpture,” a text dedicated to the pre-
ment, such as brick walls, garden edges, park benches,
sentation of Underneath the Arches, published in Studio
and curbstones. McLean explained to his audience
International in May 1970.20 The laws of sculpture read:
13
14
15
16
A similar contempt for and desire to reject a highly
This first incarnation of the piece was prefaced by
that the work consisted in observing these different elements and recognizing them as sculpture.17 This intervention was a lecture that radically questioned
172 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
1. [Always] be smartly dressed, well groomed relaxed friendly polite and in complete control.
2. Make the world to believe in you and to pay heavily for this privilege.
title Impresarios of the Art World. For the piece, Gilbert & George would inquire about particular works by
3. Never worry assess discuss or criticize but remain quiet respectful and calm.
established artists, many of whom were teachers at St. Martin’s, from Anthony Caro to William Tucker, and
4. The lord [chisels] still, so [don’t] leave your bench for long.
McLean would respond by physically mimicking the characteristics of the work in question. While McLean acted out the different works, Gilbert & George sat
These laws seem to refer to and parody the way in
down on a stage applauding or took photographs of
which students presenting their work in the forums
the works being performed, showing a clear awareness
were expected to perform the confidence, rigor, and
of the role of documentation in the currency of per-
assertiveness associated with the figure of the artist.
formance art.23 Although this work has conventionally
Although it is debatable whether Gilbert & George
been defined simply as a performance, it undoubtedly
are here accomplishing an act of more or less overt
represented a form of critical presentation and artic-
criticism of the art establishment, their use of language,
ulation of knowledge, albeit in a satirical and mostly
rhetorical style, and attitude strongly contrasts with
plastic, rather than verbal, way.
those experienced in the school. The following sardonic
statement expresses the duo’s concerns about group
artists who, while students at St. Martin’s School of
criticism: “We were not in favour of groups of people
Art in the 1960s, started playing with the format of the
standing around talking about sculpture.” What they
lecture. They realized artworks that mimicked lectures
resisted in the teaching of the “New Generation” group
while at the same time criticizing established forms
was the elitism of their work and discourse: “We real-
of knowledge that tended to perpetuate themselves
ized that with all the discussions around sculpture at the
through repetition in conversations and public discus-
time, they were building up a language that was outside
sions. The absence or limited use of a poetic or informal
life and which the minute you got onto the Charing
discourse, in favor of academic language, is one of the
Cross Road would not mean a damn thing. It was only
elements that defined these early examples, which
within that club. It was too elitist.” In this respect
engaged in critical debate by subverting the traditional
their criticism had roots very similar to McLean’s, and
oratory strategies and presentation techniques expe-
it is not a coincidence that the three artists developed
rienced in lectures and public presentations, while
collaborative projects.
mediating broader observations on artistic production
and the rules governing art making. Those presentations
21
22
In April 1969 they realized Interview Sculpture, also
McLean and Gilbert & George are among the first
referred to as Sculpture in the 60s, first presented at
also had rhetorical and choreographic qualities. They
the Royal College of Art, then at St. Martin’s School of
relied on paying great attention to the setting and decor.
Art, and finally at the Hanover Grand, under the new
The artists often decided to stage their performances in
173 The Artist as a Speaker-Performer
lecture theaters, making use of the furniture, decorative
had recently completed their studies started being
elements, and technologies typical of an academic set-
invited to speak to students only a few years their junior.
ting, such as desks, blackboards, and slide projectors.
Artists were not expected to deliver formal lectures on
24
In the years after leaving art school, McLean
objective issues. Rather, they represented important
continued to develop his practice, taking as his major
models of being artists, in their public stance and in their
subject the posing and the language of the art world. In
nonacademic or antiacademic styles of delivery.
the Shadow of Your Smile, Bob (1970), a 16 mm black-and-
white film with sound, is a playful and irreverent take
created the position of student adviser, the only position
on the dominant tenets dictating the way in which
co-elected by staff and student representatives, with
artists appear and behave. McLean sits in front of the
the task of organizing events and lectures in consulta-
camera, taking on thoughtful poses and speaking in
tion with the student body. The artist Stuart Brisley was
front of microphones while also insistently rubbing his
the first person to hold this post, from 1968 to 1970.28
nose. He also adopts an iron and a tape recorder as
Brisley invited a relatively wide range of people to speak
working tools, as if mocking the increasingly fashion-
to his students, including established artists and others
able apparatus of conceptual art practices. The film
who were less known, as well as curators or critics. It
relates to and is exhibited alongside a reproduction of
was Brisley who invited Gilbert & George to perform
a photograph of the artist Robert Morris. In the photo-
Underneath the Arches in 1969. Among the other artists
graph, the American Minimalist artist—who McLean
he invited to give lectures on their work was also Gustav
otherwise admired—poses against a heavy metal
Metzger, a practiced speaker who had given his first
structure, playing the self-assured, assertive artist.
25
During the late 1960s the Slade School of Art
public presentation on Auto-Destructive Art as early as
Having parodied the work and attitude of his teachers
1959.29
at St. Martin’s School of Art, McLean made a mockery
of the dominant figure of the confident macho artist,
lecture on his work. Before starting his presentation,
promoted by first-generation New York School artists
Hockney asked if any student would help him put his
and pursued by Minimalist artists in their style of posing
slides into the carousel. No one volunteered—possibly
for the camera.
because they felt intimidated by the artist’s fame or did
26
McLean and Gilbert & George’s Interview Sculpture
Brisley also invited David Hockney to deliver a
not dare intervene in what they felt was a staged affair.
was staged not only at St. Martin’s School of Art but
As a result, Hockney proceeded to set up the carou-
also at other art schools, including the Royal College
sel on his own. Once presenting slides of his work, he
of Art and the Slade School of Fine Art. Young artists
introduced each with a statement such as “That is an
were bringing back to the art school a mode of making
upside-down drawing of a tree” or “That’s a sideways
that bridged performance and the educational model
version of . . . [a different work]”.30 Such a performance
of the lecture. It is at this point in time that artists who
shows the artist capitulating to the growing demand
27
174 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
to discuss his work. Such a performance ultimately
RoseLee Goldberg, at the time a recent graduate
testifies to the convergence of artistic and academic
from the Courtauld Institute, worked for two years as
formats, and the widening of art practice to include
exhibition organizer at the Royal College of Art. In this
new modes of discussion and oral presentation.
capacity Goldberg organized a wide range of events,
Nevertheless, Hockney resisted taking on the role of the
lectures, and performances to coincide with a rich
assertive and confident artist who articulates his inten-
program of exhibitions. Goldberg’s ongoing concern, in
tion in a convincing narrative of the making of his work,
the program of activities planned for the Royal College
playing instead with the stereotype of the eccentric and
of Art, was to ensure that seminars and lectures
technologically inept artist.
accompanied each exhibition. Every Tuesday night she
would organize an event in the lecture theater, with
In 1975, after Paul Harris, David Medalla, and
Conrad Atkinson had briefly held the post of student
the artists David Tremlett, John Stezaker, Susan Hiller,
adviser at the Slade School of Art, the role was taken
McLean, and the art historian Barbara Reise as regular
on for two years by Lynda Morris, a recent graduate
attendants.33
from the Royal College of Art who had been working
at the Nigel Greenwood gallery and in the bookshop
records, selected by the critic Germano Celant, on
of the Institute of Contemporary Art, gaining a direct
which artists had used their voices to produce sound
knowledge of the contemporary art scene. Between
works, following the example of Futurists and Dadaists.
1975 and 1976, Morris organized a vast range of activ-
The oldest record played was Yves Klein’s Conférence
ities and events. She invited Mark Boyle and John
à la Sorbonne, from 1959, an example of audio poetry
Stezaker, among other artists, to lecture on their work,
that used one of the artist’s own lectures as material for
while Gerard Hemsworth was asked to discuss a solo
the recording.34 The exhibition demonstrated an early
exhibition he had recently opened in London. Morris
awareness of the historical development of art forms
also invited Tim Head to give a seminar on architecture,
mixing oratory and performance, using the spoken word
Gilbert & George to present a martial-arts film, Daniel
as their primary medium.
Buren to give a lecture on art and politics, David Dye
Goldberg’s Structure & Codes, 1975, represents
to show one of his film works and give a seminar, Art
an important example of an exhibition structured as
& Language to organize a conference, Marc Camille
a series of overlapping events involving artists’ par-
Chaimowicz to give a performance and seminar, and
ticipation and discussion. The display focused on the
André Cadere to devise a project for a short series of
work of British artists who had been engaging with
seminars.
contemporary culture through an analysis and syn-
31
32
Similarly, between 1973 and 1975—a few years
The exhibition Record as Artwork, in 1973, presented
thesis of its codes and structures. It included works by
before publishing the first edition of her seminal
John Blake, John Latham, Peter Smith, John Stezaker,
research on performance art—the critic and curator
and Stephen Willats. The exhibition was an attempt
175 The Artist as a Speaker-Performer
to develop a dialogue between, on one side, predomi-
major issue in the art world. Nevertheless, it was at this
nantly structuralist theories that focused on the ways
very time that female artists started seeking alterna-
in which meaning constructs social and cultural reality
tive spaces of discussion and presentation, where they
and, on the other side, artistic practice that did not aim
felt able to shape their own activities and articulate an
to transcend culture but was concerned with the type
alternative voice and style of delivery.
of cultural meanings that should be given form. Given
this objective of working between theory and artistic
opened in December 1975, was the last one that
practice and of drawing relationships between the
Goldberg organized at the Royal College of Art, working
different ways each operated, it seems apt that a series
with the architect Bernard Tschumi, a teacher at the
of lectures and seminars were organized “as an integral
Architectural Association in London. For the exhibi-
part of the exhibition.” The program of events included
tion, a number of artists and architects had each been
lectures by the artists Toni del Renzio and John Stezaker,
invited to submit an image and a text, no longer than
alongside those by the anthropologist Mary Douglas
a thousand words, addressing the notion of space, to
and the writer and Royal College of Art professor of film
be displayed on gallery panels as well as published in
and television Stuart Hood.
the exhibition catalogue.38 The exhibition itself was the
35
36
37
These examples point to the fact that the rise of
The exhibition A Space: A Thousand Words, which
result of a year of discussions and activities relating to
the contemporary artist as a public figure and spokes-
teaching and published texts on the notion of space,
person—nearly always a man—who would engage in
and was followed in January 1976 by a one-day con-
the discursive framing of his practice coincided with
ference at the Architectural Association.39 Titled Real
the ascent of the figure of the young curator and event
Space, the conference aimed to tackle the two very
organizer, such as the important women Goldberg and
different aspects of space that had emerged during
Morris. What is more, they illustrate that, in London in
the previous activities: one that deals “with concepts,
the 1970s, the art school became an important center
theory, semantics, archetypes and abstraction,” and
for the display, production, and discussion of artists’
“one that deals with experience, performance, praxis,
work through exhibitions, lectures, seminars, and
etc. . . . [that is,] with real space.”40 Those two aspects
project-based activities. The artists who, during their
of space mirror the two facets of the otherwise varied
time as students, had developed a discursive approach
format of public presentation that bridges lecture and
to their practice, would return to the art school to pres-
performance: the simultaneous engagements with the
ent, perform, and share their ideas on the development
articulation of an intellectual position and with the more
of their work with other artists, tutors, and critics. That
experiential and often less rational stance inherent in
male artists were by far the dominant voice in teaching
performance-based activities.
and performing, while women would at best take on the
role of organizers and enablers, was and has remained a
tudes toward the use of space included Paul Richards
176 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Artists invited to present and discuss different atti-
and McLean from the recently dissolved collective Nice
showed slides from three carousels: of her paintings
Style, Daniel Buren, COUM, John Stezaker, and Brian
and constructions, of Kinetic Theater works, and of
Eno. One can imagine the contributions of such diverse
collages alternating with performances, to demonstrate
speakers and performers, as concept based and yet
formal, textural, and haptic relations with the work of a
concerned with embodied and sensorial experience, to
number of artists, from Velasquez and Cézanne to de
have bridged the two seemingly irreducible approaches
Kooning.43 At the end of the lecture, two male audience
to art making and architecture the conference intended
members volunteered to strip and perform a collage
to tackle. The conceit of such a conference lineup, while
action with the artist. Once the three had left the stage,
demonstrating an early take on the artist as researcher,
Schneemann’s experimental erotic film Fuses, 1965, was
is also symptomatic of a desire to give visibility to the
projected. The artist stated: “Naked Action Lecture asked
different way in which artists, in the 1960s and 1970s,
the questions: can an artist be an art historian? Can an
started engaging with a different type of knowledge
art historian be a naked woman? Does a woman have
production. They began to mix the factual with the
intellectual authority? Can she have public authority
imaginary, adopting loose associations as much as log-
while naked and speaking? Was the content of the
ical argumentations. Ultimately playing with, twisting,
lecture less appreciable when she was naked? What
and questioning the established rules that underpin rig-
multiple levels of uneasiness, pleasure, curiosity, erotic
orously argued and inflexibly defended narratives, they
fascination, acceptance or rejection were activated in
also chose to use their bodies or other props in order to
an audience?”44 Discussing the piece, Schneemann has
express ideas that words would render too reductive or
pointed out that it at least partially emerged from her
monolithic.
experience as an art student: “The inanities that were
The same distrust for the rigid, prescriptive,
acceptable in teaching for maintaining the position of
and reproductive nature of language was also at the
the ‘hapless girl student’ who could never amount to
core of a number of performances that, while taking
anything as an artist, but who could be the life model.
place outside of the art school, directly addressed
Which I did to help pay my tuition.”45
the way in which knowledge is produced and repro-
duced within such institutions. This is, for example,
discouraged, if not alienated, was undoubtedly shared
the case of the American artist Carolee Schneemann
across the Atlantic. At about the same time, the work
who, while in London in the late 1960s, performed
of a number of artists in London started to emerge from
Naked Action Lecture, 1968, at the ICA. From the stage
their engagement with feminism and their realization
Schneemann gave a thirty-minute lecture on her work
that the language of fine art was irremediably shaped
and its relationship to historical antecedents in paint-
by a patriarchal tradition that denied women a voice
ing, while dressing and undressing and walking back
and a capacity for intellectual and artistic expression
and forth with a pointer. As part of the lecture, she
unless they operated within a framework of terms and
41
42
177 The Artist as a Speaker-Performer
The experience, as a female art student, of being
expectations they perceived as “male” and extraneous
times mesmerizing. Her Mistress’s Voice (1977) involved
to them. If, for artists like McLean and Gilbert & George,
different sections, with different objects—including an
the language of art making and art discussion was
electric train on a track, a stuffed magpie, and a dial, or
heavily overdetermined by the attitude, posturing, and
indicator—being manipulated and activated. A section
lexicon of an increasingly reductive, prescriptive, and
of the performance involved the prerecorded sound of a
combative approach to art making, vividly encapsulated
child’s earliest noises being played over the amplifier, an
in the quarrelsome sessions of group criticism, there
attempt to articulate the different magpie sounds, and a
was for female artists a further complication. As the art
screeched-out performance of the witches’ speech from
historian Lisa Tickner has put it: “The additional ambi-
Shakespeare’s Macbeth, using her vocal cords to their
guity for female students was that ‘attitude’—requiring
limits.
the forceful assertion of one’s work and identity as an
artist—was at odds with the commonplace assumption
Elwes has pointed out that, by borrowing and taking
that girls were essentially decorative and compliant.”46
on different voices and styles of delivery, Finn-Kelcey
As there was little chance of developing or expressing
did not shy away from the contradictory nature of live
themselves within the art school, many female artists
experience and created “a sense of femininity in the
found in feminist groups a space where they could
process of its own invention.”48 One could go further
attempt to articulate their own voices and could elect
and say that the artist searched for an alternative
and discuss alternative, and to them more relevant,
language and a voice to articulate it in the process of
reading lists than those handed out in art schools. This
its own invention. Writing in 1980 about her work, Lisa
was the case with Rose Finn-Kelcey, who worked in
Tickner adopted a prose that established a dialogue
performance and installation in the early 1970s and,
with Finn-Kelcey’s work and did not subsume the poly-
through organizations like the Women Artists Collective,
phonic nature of her and the artist’s discussion and their
was a central figure in the emerging community of
many references into a “bland authorial narrative.”49
feminist artists in London. Despite frictions, the group
Tickner saw Finn-Kelcey’s performances as the embod-
provided an important network of support, one that
iment of a way of thinking and adopting language that
female artists rarely, if ever, encountered within the art
also concerned her, in her own work as an art historian
school. In the mid to late 1970s, Finn-Kelcey staged
and writer. This was an understanding of language as
a number of performances that embodied an attempt
malleable, as able “to shift the rigidity of the forms one
to use language and articulate it in a non-clear-cut
inherits,” wanting “to give the unsayable a place not
manner, emphasizing its sensorial qualities—sonorous
officially granted by the structures of our consciousness
and haptic—and inviting the audience to experience
and our prose.”50
it not as a unilateral form of communication but as an
open-ended form of engagement, at times playful, at
ment of performance-based work as the embodiment
47
178 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Discussing the performance, the artist Catherine
Within the history of performance art, the develop-
of a discourse or a critical position has been scarcely
ritual, as events that made visible the power of the texts
researched. It sits between two trajectories: the one
performed within the art school and as speech acts dis-
concerned with the body and physical enactment as
rupting the flow of the dominant art discourse.53 They at
part of the tradition of theater and dance; the other
least partially relate to the generational clash between
relating to the performance of knowledge through lec-
younger artists and their older masters as well as to an
tures, public discussions, and presentations of papers
early awareness of the normative power of performance
or audiovisual material. Its development cannot be
within institutions. On the other side, it was outside
subsumed in either of the two most influential accounts
the art school—mostly through their affiliation with
of performance-art history: an analysis of performance
feminist groups—that many female art students found
in relation to the physical embodiment of space in
the physical and intellectual space to investigate and
theater and dance or an analysis of performance as
experiment with alternative forms of public delivery.
an extension of the painting and sculptural object into
Those female artists’ performances discussed above
the fourth dimension.52 Neither of these two promi-
can be productively analyzed, in relation to established
nent narratives account for what was specific in the
feminist theoretical approaches, as having a relation
performance-based work developed by artists educated
both to Lacanian psychoanalysis, with their emphasis on
in London art schools in the 1960s and 1970s: the artic-
the structural relation between desire and language, and
ulation of knowledge and criticality through playful and
to the transgressive dimension that defines the work of
often irreverent performances that borrowed props and
many other American and European artists, from Adrian
mocked postures typical of the academic environment.
Piper to VALIE EXPORT.54 While it is useful to map out
these distinctions, this essay, in addressing the relation
51
In the 1960 and 1970s, the figure of the artist as a
speaker-performer thrived in London among art stu-
between performance and knowledge, has highlighted
dents and recent graduates who had been influenced by
interesting similarities in the performance-based work
and were quickly ready to question what they learned in
of male and female artists. Paying attention to the intel-
a reformed type of art school: namely, that artists had
lectual pursuit as much as to the physical embodiment
to engage equally with the making of objects as with
of the deliveries of early works by McLean alongside
the articulation, discussion, and public presentation
another by Finn-Kelcey, among others, suggests that the
of the critical issues surrounding the making of their
overcoming of “bland, authorial narrative” was at the
work. Artists used their bodies to give form to ways
time a project that both male and female artists shared,
of moving, interacting, and speaking that parodied
and that the conception of hybrid forms of performance
and subverted accepted ways of discussing art, being
and knowledge production were fundamental to this
artists, and articulating ideas. On one side, male artists’
goal. Moreover, these works represented important
actions bridging lectures and performances can be dis-
examples of a rejection of “high modernism,” in relation
cussed, in relation to traditional notions of theater and
not only to its content or credo but also to the arrogance
179 The Artist as a Speaker-Performer
of its monolithic and prescriptive style. These were the
to inspire change that is not only a matter of counting
defining qualities of those works that spoke to an unfin-
heads but a matter of enabling, fostering, and giving due
ished cultural project aimed at readdressing gender
recognition to types of practices and forms of sociability
inequality, deflating the stature of the macho artist, and
that rely on the cultivation of a medium ground between
exposing the pedagogic model as homosocial and chau-
the individual and the unknown mass.
vinist, and doing so through the forging of polyphonic and less ruthlessly combative forms of expression. Over forty years later, these performance-speeches continue
Notes
1. See Wees, Vorticism and the English Avant-Garde, 93–94, and Kirby, Futurist Performance, 30–32. 2. See International Surrealist Bulletin 4 (1936). 3. See “‘Eduardo Paolozzi, Retrospective Statement’—the Independent Group, 1990,” in Spencer, Eduardo Paolozzi: Writings and Interviews, 71. 4. My transcription of an excerpt from Richard Cork, “Sculpture Now: Dissolution or Redefinition?” recording of the Lethaby Lectures, Audio Arts, 1975, tape 1, side A, Goldsmiths’ College Audiocassette Reserve Collection. The lecture coincided with the exhibition bearing the same title, Sculpture Now: Dissolution or Redefinition? Royal College of Art, London, November 11–22, 1974. 5. The National Advisory Council on Art Education was established to undertake this reform. Its first report, known as the “Coldstream Report,” was published in October 1960. On this history, see Thistlewood, introduction to Histories of Art and Design Education, 8. 6. On the history of the development of Basic Design courses in Britain, see de Sausmarez et al., “A Visual Grammar of Form,” pts. 1 and 2, and de Sausmarez, Basic Design. 7. On the Bauhaus training, see Josef Albers, “Creative Education” (lecture delivered at the Sixth International Congress for Drawing, Art Education, and Applied Art, Prague, 1928), published in Wingler, Bauhaus, 142. For an account of group criticism in the context of British Basic Design, see Yeomans, “Foundation Course,” 207. 8. Albers, “Creative Education,” 143. 9. Stephen Chaplin, “Slade Archive Reader” (unpublished, 1998), Slade Archive, UCL Special Collections. 10. “Antony Caro and Tim Marlow, in Conversation,” January 15, 1992, in Talking Art: Archival Sound Recordings, Institute of Contemporary Arts, London, C95/809.
180 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
11. Introduction to St. Martin’s South Bank Sculpture (London: St. Martin’s School of Art, 1977), Tate Archive, Frank Martin collection, TGA 201014, n.p. 12. Transcript of “Frank Martin Interviewed by Melanie Roberts (1997),” National Life Story Collection: Artists’ Lives, British Library, C466/58, 61. 13. Gooding, Bruce McLean, 68. 14. Bruce McLean, cited in Dimitrijević, Bruce McLean, 7. 15. For a discussion of Mikhail Bakhtin’s analysis of utterances and the formation of speech through performance and speech-act theory, see Carlson, Performance, 58–65. 16. Gooding, Bruce McLean, 47–48, and Bruce McLean, interviewed by the author, October 28, 2010. 17. The slides used in this lecture were lost, while the public presentation was not documented. As is true of most of the works and lectures discussed in this essay, there is no or very limited photographic documentation. That which is extant fails to register the complexity and time-based nature of the events discussed, and so I have decided not to include images to illustrate my essay. 18. Gooding, Bruce McLean, 47. 19. Soon after the first presentation at St. Martin’s School of Art, Gilbert & George omitted the preliminary words and titled the piece Underneath the Arches. See Rorimer, New Art in the 60s and 70s, 142. 20. Gilbert & George, “A Magazine Sculpture.” 21. Seymour, “Gilbert & George,” 92. 22. “Gilbert & George Interviewed by Andrew Wilson” (April 1990), in Bickers and Wilson, Talking Art, 321–22. 23. Stuart Morgan, “A Rhetoric of Silence,” in Nairne and Serota, British Sculpture in the Twentieth Century, 203. 24. For example, when presenting Underneath the Arches at the Slade School of Art in 1979, Gilbert & George decided with the students to stage the piece in a lecture theater of the University College. See the transcript of “Stuart Brisley Interviewed by
Melanie Roberts (1996),” National Life Story Collection: Artists’ Lives, British Library, C466/43/01, F5273A, 178. 25. See Applin, “There’s a Sculpture on My Shoulder,” 108–10. 26. On the “macho” posturing of many artists associated with Minimal art, see James Meyer, “The Case for Truitt: Minimalism and Gender,” in Minimalism, 222–28. 27. See Gilbert & George, 1968 to 1980, 47. 28. For an account of the artist on his role as student adviser, see “Stuart Brisley Interviewed by Melanie Roberts,” 178–81. 29. Gustav Metzger gave his first lecture on Auto-Destructive Art at the Farm in Soho, London, 1959. The same year, he published the first manifesto on Auto-Destructive Art, which was given as a lecture to the Architectural Association in 1964 and was then taken over by students as an artistic “happening.” See A. Wilson, “Poetics of Dissent,” 95. 30. “Stuart Brisley Interviewed by Melanie Roberts,” 179. 31. Lynda Morris interviewed by the author, July 14, 2010. 32. Typed document listing the series of lectures organized by Lynda Morris at the Slade School of Art (1975–76), Lynda Morris’s private archive. 33. RoseLee Goldberg interviewed by the author, July 21, 2010. 34. Yves Klein’s Conférence à la Sorbonne, 1959, was based on the recording of the artist’s lecture “L’évolution de l’art et de l’architecture vers l’immatériel.” See the press release of the exhibition Record as Artwork, Royal College of Art Gallery, London, October 24–November 16, 1973, Tate Archive, LON-ROY 1973 300.81. 35. “Structures & Codes Exhibition,” press release, Royal College of Art Gallery, December 18, 1974, Tate Archive, LON-ROY 1975 300.81. 36. Ibid. 37. Structures & Codes Exhibition, 13 January–31 January 1975, exhibition leaflet, Tate Archive, LON-ROY 1975 300.81. 38. Goldberg, preface to A Space: A Thousand Words, n.p. 39. See, for example, Goldberg, “Space as Praxis,” and Tschumi, “Questions of Space.”
181 The Artist as a Speaker-Performer
40. “Real Time” events list booklet, Architectural Association, spring term, January 12–16, 1976, RoseLee Goldberg’s private archive. 41. This information is derived from the “Event List, Spring Term 1976,” Architectural Association, School of Architecture, RoseLee Goldberg’s private archive. 42. “Naked Action Lecture, June 27, 1968 Institute of Contemporary Art London,” in Schneemann, More Than Meat Joy, 180–81. 43. Ibid., 181. 44. Ibid., 180. 45. Earnest, “Carolee Schneemann in Conversation with Jarrett Earnest.” 46. Tickner, Hornsey 1968, 98–99. 47. See Battista, Renegotiating the Body, 58 and 174–75 n. 32. 48. Catherine Elwes, “In Praise of Older Women: Rose Finn-Kelcey and Kate Meynell,” in Video Loupe, 167 (first published in Make 78 [1997–98]). 49. Tickner, “One for Sorrow, Two for Mirth,” 59. 50. Ibid., 70–71. 51. For an account of performance as a disciplinary formation bridging academic performance and the performing arts in the American context, see Jackson, Professing Performance. 52. See Goldberg, Performance Art, and Schimmel et al., Out of Actions. 53. For an overview of performance theories, from early anthropological and ethnographic approaches relating to rituals and the space of the theater to linguistic approaches, see Carlson, Performance, 13–74. 54. For a discussion of performance in terms of transgression, see McKenzie, Perform or Else, 43. For a reading of female artists’ performances in the 1970s beyond feminist discourse and in relation to a broader “deconstructive intent,” see Forte, “Women’s Performance Art.”
10. 10. 10. 10. 10. 10. 10. 10. 10. 10.
File Under COUM Art on Trial in Genesis P-Orridge’s Mail Action Dominic Johnson
“COUM has changed. That is good.”1 So begins a
court, charged under the Post Office Act, 1953, after
succinct statement of purpose written in 1978, in which
a case was brought for sending indecent materials
Genesis P-Orridge addresses the changes brought
through the mail. The ensuing trial, General Post Office
about in the work of COUM Transmissions over the
v. Genesis P-Orridge (G.P.O. v. G.P-O.) was appropriated
previous two years.2 In 1976, at the age of twenty-six,
by P-Orridge, transformed into a performance event,
P-Orridge had critical run-ins with the law, with institu-
and renamed the Mail Action. This enabled P-Orridge
tions, and with broadcast media, which prompted the
to combine, muddle, and compare the spaces of art
artist’s conceptual and practical withdrawal from art.
and law, art and pornography, and mail art and perfor-
Thus, the positive change announced in the statement
mance art. The performance did not affect the outcome
refers to the abandonment of art as an identifiable cate-
of the trial—nor could it change the law—but the Mail
gory of creative production—a retirement of sorts from
Action allowed P-Orridge to frame, recode, or erode
a conversation into which the artist had been intro-
the purported autonomy of art and theatricalized the
duced—and a compensatory embrace of more esoteric
reach of the law across the freedom to be an artist and,
aesthetic commitments. This involved the deliberate
particularly, to create and disseminate “indecent” or
formal dispersal of art practices that were already
objectionable art. Six months later, in October 1976,
remarkably ephemeral and uncontainable, and a retreat
Genesis P-Orridge and Cosey Fanni Tutti would become
to still more distant conceptual lands.
household names after the scandalized reception of
the COUM Transmissions exhibition Prostitution at the
Two specific controversies led to this renunciation
of the art world. In April 1976 P-Orridge appeared in
ICA. Prostitution prompted a media furor on account
of its provocative, sexualized content, particularly in
suggestion (which he goes on to critique) that artists
the light of COUM’s receipt of public funds at a time of
had been caught in the act of “perpetrating a confidence
economic austerity and heightened political and social
trick” against a gullible public.6 My attempt to recon-
conservatism.
struct the Mail Action entails a historiographical exercise
Indeed, 1976 was a pivotal year for art and contro-
in patching together archival traces and inquiring into
versy in the United Kingdom more broadly. As Richard
the ways in which historical veracity about an event is
Cork noted in December 1976, “[i]t is difficult to recall
both enabled and foreclosed by the stories divulged by
a period in recent history which produced the flurry of
the archive. It supplements or anticipates the (rela-
scandalized attacks we have witnessed over the past 12
tively) greater visibility given to Prostitution in histories
months,” adding that the effect upon the public’s recep-
of art and performance.
tion of modern art had been “undeniably disastrous.”
The controversies of 1976 included media outrage over
scopic; it remains difficult to pin down. It was an alter
the Tate Gallery’s purchase of “120 ordinary firebricks,”
ego for P-Orridge and an art collective of unstable
in the form of Carl Andre’s Equivalent viii (1966); Mary
membership; a pidgin language; a philosophy or make-
Kelly’s Post-Partum Document, containing “a tabulated
shift ethic; as well as a way of life.7 In P-Orridge’s use
row of soiled nappy-liners” at the ICA in London; and
of COUM as an alter ego or alibi of sorts, the question
the aforementioned incidents concerning COUM
of authorship arises as a problem, especially as it tends
Transmissions, which had, Cork writes, made P-Orridge
to subsume the authorship of collaborators—especially
“a national laughing stock.” For historian Alwyn Turner,
that of Cosey Fanni Tutti—under its aegis.8 The politics
references to Kelly and COUM “became a journalistic
of authorship is particularly controversial—and sensi-
shorthand for the monstrosity of modern art.”4 In the
tive—as it is often unclear whether the Magazine Actions
Evening Standard, journalist Maureen Cleave reflected
should be attributed to Cosey (who endured personal
upon the greater implications of the Prostitution scandal
risk and public ignominy) or to COUM, as made vivid
but warned that the cumulative threat of “a stream of
in longstanding disagreements between P-Orridge and
Orridges, bolstered by nappy exhibitions and people
Cosey on this very issue.9
in Nottingham sweeping litter into ‘artistic piles,’ is
another matter.” Her column makes reference to
COUM participated in a series of avant-garde strate-
Kelly’s aforementioned Post-Partum Document and to
gies aimed at critiquing the institutional practices of art
funds received by Ray Richards to make sculptures
and returning art to a more vital relation to the con-
out of sweepings in the streets of Nottingham. Cleave
cerns, sensory experiences, and creative processes of
suggests that in 1976 the best of British art risked being
everyday living. As P-Orridge writes, “We found the art
undermined or supplanted by the work of mediocre
world on every level less satisfying than real life.”10 This
but attention-grabbing artists, complementing Cork’s
dissatisfaction prompted COUM to query and unbind
3
5
184 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
COUM was multiple by its very nature, and kaleido-
The performances and mail art of P-Orridge and
the artificial division between the aesthetic domain and
Yellow Objects (1972), for which Klassnik distributed
its purported outsides, including popular, macabre, or
eight thousand self-addressed envelopes with a call
pornographic cultures, and to privilege the vital margins
for donations of yellow artifacts, which were displayed
of life over the artificial, ineffectual promises of art.
indiscriminately in an expanding window display at
The Mail Action stages P-Orridge’s and/or COUM’s
the ICA in London. Klassnik staged the democratic,
placement both inside and outside the broader narra-
deskilled principles of mail art and harnessed the
tives of British art in the 1970s. In 1975 P-Orridge pitched
performance-oriented nature of audience participa-
a neo-avant-garde conception of COUM’s anti-aesthetic
tion, creating an installation that grew daily according
sensibility in persuasive terms: “Performance art is not
to improvised responses to a predetermined script, or
‘about’ entertainment, nor does it claim to produce an
score. P-Orridge’s appropriation of the indecency trial
art-form which is concerned with beauty, aesthetics
as a performance was a canny response to the ephem-
or a high standard of moral life. It is not [an antidote
erality of performance art and mail art, enshrining the
to] poverty, ignorance, atrocious housing, specula-
democratic values of dematerialization while, in the
tion or politics. Performance art is concerned with
same stroke, harnessing publicity and notoriety to
Experience—direct, first-hand, individual interpretation
ensure greater attention from audiences and the longer
of action. It uses as its base the imaginative interpreta-
reach of cultural and critical memory.
tion of life itself, the raw material being drawn from the everyday.”11 Indeed, such claims for performance art’s immediacy are now common; and similar affirmations
COUMmentary
have been made for the democratic potential of mail art more broadly—as a form or field centrally relevant
Neil Andrew Megson was born in Manchester on
to P-Orridge in the period and to the “indecent” works
February 22, 1950. After attending the University of
that prompted the Mail Action. For John Held, mail art
Hull for one year from 1968, to study economics and
has been consistently unpopular for institutions of
social administration, Megson took up the eccentric
commodity-based art, yet popular among audiences:
gender-neutral name Genesis in 1969 and acquired the
as an artistic form it “democratizes art” (anyone can
full name Genesis P-Orridge by deed poll in January
participate), “decentralizes art” (the “eternal net-
1971. P-Orridge founded COUM Transmissions in
work” renders geographical distance insignificant),
December 1969, and after a series of performances
and “dematerializes art” (skill, technique, and special-
in and around Hull, COUM grew in membership and
ized materials are absented); last, mail art “fulfil[s] a
visibility from 1971. After a local petition to prevent
prophecy of the historic avant-garde in bridging art and
COUM from performing, and a documented campaign
life.” Contemporary examples in COUM’s milieu were
of police harassment, P-Orridge moved to London on a
indicative and influential—for example, Robin Klassnik’s
permanent basis in June 1973 (and remained until forced
12
185 File Under COUM
Fig. 10.1 COUM Transmissions, Omissions (Kleiinie Spielinie), Kiel, West Germany, June 1975. © BREYER P-ORRIDGE. Courtesy the artist and Invisible Exports, New York.
to flee the country in a further clash with police in 1992).
audiences alike—with a deliberately silly, tasteless, or
Relocating COUM to London, P-Orridge secured a lease
prankish sensibility.
on the “Death Factory,” a studio at 10 Martello Street in
East London.
scandal and intrigue. This was not merely promiscuous
or gratuitous. P-Orridge theorized the public nature of
The performances of COUM Transmissions
Throughout, COUM was strategically attracted to
between 1971 and 1976 consisted primarily of provoca-
COUM’s interventions and the active pursuit of media
tive live actions in public, in alternative spaces, and in
coverage as a political necessity. “No social ticket is
art venues, as well as experiments in sound, mail art,
required, no venue,” P-Orridge writes, for the work
and installation. Merging art and life, COUM’s per-
reaches audiences beyond the self-selecting constit-
formances and objects explored the aesthetics of the
uencies comprising the art world. Specifically, COUM
urban industrial wastelands in which P-Orridge, Cosey,
attempted to “use the press to record our activities like
and their collaborators were raised, with allusions to
a diary,” because “it was far more effective propaganda/
and enactments of sex, scandal, crime, wounding, and
information dispersal to be written up [in] the NEWS
esoteric ritual (fig. 10.1 shows an example). Omissions
section of daily papers than in a back page column of a
(1975) was a typical performance in this regard,
specialist Art journal.” The ramifications of this adap-
enacted on a public thoroughfare in Groß-Gerau, West
tation was significant for P-Orridge, as it both exploited
Germany, about which P-Orridge writes, in diary form:
and undermined the purported imperatives of the press
“[COUM] pour petrol into gutters and light it whilst
and exempted COUM from the institutional apparatus
Cosey [. . .] masturbates on lit candles in street, Fizzy
of art. “The threat is biggest for the art world, the art
[Paet] covered in used tampax, milk bottles tied to his
market,” P-Orridge declares. “Solving art problems is
fingers filled with blood and maggots, Cosey fingering
coincidental.”14
her cunt, hits them with hammer and smashes them. They eat raw eggs and puke, then they try to wash in vomit, then piss themselves and fuck, milk syringed up
The Mail Action
their arse.” If COUM’s aesthetic could be unnerving, 13
repellent, indecent, or obscene, it was never exclusively
On January 17, 1976, Genesis P-Orridge was charged
so—it was also eccentric, farcical, and strategically
with two counts of indecency under section 11(1)(c) of
infantile, typified by their first poster artwork: a por-
the Post Office Act, 1953, a piece of legislation governing
trait of P-Orridge as a schoolboy propping up a tuba,
proper use of the postal service. By sending two col-
framed by the slogan “Yes COUM are Fab and Kinky”
laged postcards through the Royal Mail, P-Orridge had
(1971). In performances, writings, and ephemera, COUM
contravened a law that states: “A person shall not send
characteristically mingled acts and images of physical
or attempt to send or procure to be sent a postal packet
extremity—sure to outrage or repel casual and informed
which [. . .] has on the packet, or on the cover thereof,
187 File Under COUM
any words, marks or designs which are grossly offen-
other imagery to the fronts of high-street postcards
sive or of an indecent or obscene character.” Until its
and carry messages, stamps, and clippings on the
repeal in 2001, the act complemented the key obscenity
backs. They were stamped prominently with COUM’s
legislation—namely, the Obscene Publications Act of
studio address, at Martello Road, suggesting P-Orridge
1959—by providing legal means for the state to prose-
had little knowledge (or concern) for the probable
cute formally “indecent” materials.
illegality of the activities in question—or, perhaps,
ensured conscientiously that any ensuing controversy
15
Writing in 1979, P-Orridge’s barrister Geoffrey
Robertson explained the difference between the two
would attach itself to COUM Transmissions, named on
models of legal censorship, namely, “obscene” and
the cards.
“indecent” materials. The proof of obscenity depends on
the offending object’s potential, “taken as a whole,” “to
Goodrich) on October 12, 1975. The front carries a
deprave or corrupt” its consumers and cause objective
relatively inoffensive found image of a woman grasping
social harm.16 However, the criminally indecent artifact
a male lover, collaged against a patterned background
is that which might embarrass or outrage the citizenry’s
of chains, with a patterned sheet pasted across part
perceived sexual modesty. While obscenity is under-
of both images. The back includes a section of text cut
stood to actively harm the individual or social body,
from the porn magazine Club International. “I could hear
indecent materials are illegal because they are “a public
Angelo breathing heavily,” the text begins, “and after
nuisance, an unnecessary affront to people’s sense
a couple of minutes his penis began to harden again,
of aesthetic propriety.” In what seems like a legal
filling my mouth with its rigid flesh.”
anomaly, P-Orridge was committing a crime neither by
producing or owning the postcards nor by purchasing or
lecturer in mathematics at Warwick University and
repurposing pornographic images and writing. Instead,
an erstwhile COUM collaborator—at an address in
it was when the cards entered the postal system that
Geneva on October 11, 1975, and shows appropriated
the artifacts became formally “indecent” and a crime
elements collaged onto a souvenir postcard (fig. 10.2).
had been committed.
The resulting work shows a drawing of a farmer sowing
seeds onto the lawn of Buckingham Palace. Directly
17
18
P-Orridge was initially charged with sending
The first postcard was sent to Biggles (Ian
The second card was sent to Tim Poston—a
two postcards, and new charges were added to the
next to an inset portrait of the Queen, a pornographic
prosecution’s case on February 3, 1976, after investiga-
image shows a hand reaching up between garter-clad
tions uncovered three further, older cards.19 (P-Orridge
legs. The fingers part and probe the cleavage between
estimates that at least a hundred similar cards were
the buttocks. On the back, a handwritten message from
in circulation at the time.) Of the five postcards, two
P-Orridge reads, “The lady on the front has her mouth
were seized and never returned. The postcards typi-
shut because her teeth are filed to points,” in scathing
cally attach commercially available pornography and
reference to the unsmiling Queen (fig. 10.3).
20
188 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Fig. 10.2 Genesis P-Orridge, untitled postcard (front), 1975. Mimeograph of collage on postcard as reproduced in the publication G.P.O. v. G.P-O.: A Chronicle of Mail Art on Trial. © BREYER P-ORRIDGE. Courtesy the artist and Invisible Exports, New York.
Fig. 10.3 Genesis P-Orridge, untitled postcard (back), 1975. Mimeograph of collage on postcard as reproduced in the publication G.P.O. v. G.P-O.: A Chronicle of Mail Art on Trial. © BREYER P-ORRIDGE. Courtesy the artist and Invisible Exports, New York.
The three cards under subsequent legal scrutiny
is loaded with irony, as it was written by a “sham” artist
had been sent between August 1974 and December
(Glass, a.k.a. P-Orridge). The statement was reprinted
1975. The sole surviving work uses a reproduction post-
in edited form in “Scenes of Victory,” the text discussed
card of René Magritte’s Time Transfixed (1938), in which
in the opening part of this chapter, suggesting a playful
a locomotive steams from a fireplace, jutting at full pelt
and serial slippage between P-Orridge’s performance
into an empty painted room. In P-Orridge’s collage, a
of identity and the construction of alter egos—staged
reclining woman is anally penetrated, in front of the
throughout COUM and here, obliquely, in the cracked,
fireplace, as two hands (seemingly the man’s) hold
distorting mirror illustrating Glass’s biography.
open the folds of her vulva. Magritte’s apparent gesture
toward the train as phallic substitute is de-sublimated in
planned to send the most graphic card without incrim-
P-Orridge’s appropriation. The train rams the pene-
inating a correspondent, or hoped to extend the
trated woman in the jugular, nearly perpendicular to the
circulation of the artwork. (Specifically, the address
penis that enters her from below (in its original French,
chosen for the postcard was the last home address of
Magritte’s title La durée poignardé translates literally as
Marcel Duchamp in New York.) Indeed, other cards
Impaled Duration, returning the painting to a suggestion
received by P-Orridge around the same time were
of physical impalement, rather than the cognitive activity
reworked and deliberately reposted “return to sender,”
of transfixion). Like the first card, its reverse carries two
taking advantage of the postal procedures for unde-
paragraphs pasted from a pornographic magazine. It
livered mail to continue the evolution and travel of a
describes an “adulterous fuck” in close detail, adorned
collaborative work. The Magritte card demonstrates
by a signature, and various rubber stamps, including
that P-Orridge privileged the process of transit, or
“FILE UNDER COUM,” suggesting COUM as a category
passage—the administration, carriage, and delivery
of indecent, illicit, and willfully illegitimate activities.
of the postcard, and its accrual of stamps, graffiti, and
other signs of activation as a significant object. Indeed,
The Magritte postcard was sent to “Ted Glass,”
The use of a fictional recipient suggests P-Orridge
a fictional artist P-Orridge surreptitiously included in
other cards bore a rubber-stamp mark—designed
Contemporary Artists (1977), a mammoth encyclopedia
by P-Orridge—with the literal command, “KEEP ME
of thirteen hundred artists’ biographies, co-edited by
POSTED.” Each work is thus transformed into a prop,
P-Orridge and Colin Naylor. The entry is accompanied
a tool in a task, and a trace or document of a series of
by a half-page reproduction of one of Glass’s photo-
performed actions.
graphs (depicting a broken mirror) as well as an artist
statement. The latter reads in part: “My art is some-
February 1976, then postponed for two months to allow
times distrusted and disliked. [. . .] People like sham
P-Orridge to perform at English Art Today (Arte inglese
artists that soothe them with aesthetic platitudes. They
oggi), 1960–76, at Palazzo Reale, Milan. In the inter-
dread having to face reality in any form.” The statement
vening months P-Orridge set about appropriating and
21
190 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
The trial—the Mail Action—was originally set for
recasting the imminent trial as a performance. Sending
Smith; gallerists Angela Flowers, Nigel Greenwood, John
invitations was a crucial step in framing the trial as an
Kasmin, and Nicholas Logsdail; critics Richard Cork,
action, as was the commitment to documenting the
Barbara Reise, and Caroline Tisdall; radio broadcaster
proceedings, from the serving of the original summons
John Peel; solicitor and former chairman of the Arts
(photographed by Cosey) to the sentencing and proba-
Council Lord Goodman; and a broad range of interna-
tion. The transmutation also involved retitling the event
tional VIPs, including curators Jean-Christophe Amman,
Mail Action in the accompanying literature and orches-
Leo Castelli, and Harald Szeemann—and imprisoned
trating a sophisticated publicity campaign, which began
mass murderer Charles Manson. The mailings provoked
with the notification of diverse international press
postal responses from invitees (including a friendly
contacts at Artforum, Studio International, Melody Maker,
endorsement from Manson, at Folsom State Prison,
NME, Time Out, Mayfair, Playboy, Penthouse, and the
who wrote: “Gen—you must be a retarded person—or
Press Association. P-Orridge recalls that the impulse
maybe you’re in another universe”).24 Bruce Lacey and
to appropriate the trial as an action was conditioned by
Jill Bruce replied with a repurposed wedding-invitation
shock at the extremity of the state’s intervention into
acceptance card, with “wedding” crossed out to read
a genuine artistic practice: “To us it was a significant
“trial,” and a handwritten note: “Is Dress Optional?”
event, not because it was us [involved], but because it
was art under siege. It was the establishment trying to
for the Mail Action wearing an appropriately theatrical
22
censor and intimidate the artist into self-censorship.”
costume, described by journalist Duncan Campbell
Refusing to be fully subjected to the law, P-Orridge laid
as “resplendent” and consisting of a “lurex suit, red
claim to some agency in the framing, populating, and
socks, silver finger nails, and with his hair just growing
recording of the trial.
back on the crown of his head [actually, the forehead]
from where he had recently shaved it.”25 The Mail
The wedding-style invitations were made from
On the afternoon of April 5, 1976, P-Orridge arrived
embossed white card printed in silver cursive script.23
Action lasted an hour and a half and involved readings
Each reads: “Coum Transmissions request the presence
from defense and prosecution and testimonies from
of ______ at thee trial of Genesis P-Orridge. G.P.O. v
an impressive celebrity roll call, amassed and cast by
G.P-O. ‘Mail Action’ at Highbury Corner Magistrates
P-Orridge and the artist’s legal team. The audience
Court, 51 Holloway Road N.7, April 5th 1976 at 2 pm.”
consisted, furthermore, of “a battalion of London’s
P-Orridge sent invitations to a broad range of contacts
avant-gardesmen,” in the words of the reporter for
on April 1, 1976—a “who’s who” of the London art
Time Out.26 Specifically, the audience included Cosey,
worlds (as well as broader worlds)—including artists
Reise, Naylor, Smith, Lacey, Bruce, and performance
Shirley Cameron, Marc Chaimowitz, Brian Eno, Brion
artist Ian Breakwell, all of whom are recorded in extant
Gysin, Bruce Lacey, John Latham, Jeff Nuttall, and
photographs of the event. Their presence suggested
Roland Miller; mail artists Robin Klassnik and Pauline
the importance of the occasion to the London art-world
191 File Under COUM
calendar, as well as a resistant show of force by friends
element in an art which is designed to stimulate and
and peers (fig. 10.4).
to call into question many of our accepted attitudes.”29
A friend and mentor of sorts, Burroughs wrote that
At the trial, P-Orridge admitted sending the five
cards but pleaded “not guilty” on account of believing
he considered P-Orridge “a devoted and serious artist
that the cards were not indecent. The defense consisted
in the Dada tradition. The postcards in question were
of a notable legal team, namely, barrister Geoffrey
certainly not intended to titillate nor to offend, but
Robertson and solicitor David Offenbach; Robertson
to instruct by pointing up banality through startling
was renowned for defending the editors of the British
juxtapositions.”30 Burroughs was well placed to under-
countercultural magazine Oz, convicted under the
stand P-Orridge’s investment in déclassé subject matter
Obscene Publications Act in 1971, and for successfully
and likely sympathized with the artist’s victimization
defending Johannes Hanau, the distributor of Inside
as a subject of censorship, because of trials against the
Linda Lovelace (1974) in early 1976. Robertson had
publishers of excerpts of his novel Naked Lunch (1959)
warned P-Orridge of the realistic risk of a fine of £500
in 1965. Despite their presumably differing cultural
and the lesser risk of up to twelve months in prison.
values and perspectives, Forty and Burroughs signal
27
P-Orridge was tried by three magistrates rather than by
the seriousness or earnestness of P-Orridge’s creative
jury. The prosecutor showed the offending cards and
endeavors. The testimonies mobilized the historically
read salacious quotations from the collaged messages,
legitimate foundations of P-Orridge’s anti-aesthetic
like “to my delight I felt his tongue running up and
and the value of (pornographic) appropriation as a
down my slit,” to prove P-Orridge’s transgression of the
technique, to frame the postcards and their mode of
“objective” criterion of indecency.
dissemination as a carefully conceived aesthetic strat-
28
P-Orridge’s legal team attempted to counter the
egy—namely, to épater la bourgeoisie.
prosecution’s case with a demonstration of the legit-
imacy of the artist, the works, and mail art as a form
quate against charges of indecency, for “in determining
by reading affidavits by Sir Norman Reid (director, Tate
whether an article sent by post is ‘indecent,’ the courts
Gallery); countercultural icon William S. Burroughs;
have imposed an objective criterion, so that the charac-
artists Mark Boyle, Allen Jones, and Bridget Riley; critics
ter of the [sender] and the purpose of the mailing are
Reise and Naylor; and Gerald Forty (director of fine arts,
irrelevant.”31 Richard Cork and the ICA’s Ted Little were
British Council). Each attested to P-Orridge’s merits
both called to speak at the trial, as experts in contempo-
as an artist and argued the status of the postcards as
rary art, though their testimonies were dismissed when
works of art. For example, Forty testified that “P-Orridge
the magistrates claimed the defense of artistic merit to
is a professional and wholly committed artist with a
be beside the point.32 P-Orridge’s defense was under
serious approach to his work, and if at times it has a
collapse. At the close of proceedings, after a ten-minute
mischievous and provoking quality, this is an essential
recess for deliberation, the three presiding magistrates
192 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
Yet as Robertson notes, such rebuttals were inade-
Fig. 10.4 Photo taken in foyer of the Highbury Corner Magistrates’ Court, London, April 5, 1976. Left to right: Richard Cork, Colin Naylor, Genesis P-Orridge, David Offenbach, Pauline Smith, Peter (Sleazy) Christopherson. Mimeograph of photograph
as reproduced in the publication G.P.O. v. G.P-O.: A Chronicle of Mail Art on Trial. © BREYER P-ORRIDGE. Courtesy the artist and Invisible Exports, New York.
returned their verdict. P-Orridge was found guilty on all
proceedings is thrown into question in Robertson’s
five counts and ordered to pay a fine of £100 plus £20 in
suggestive placement of the word “trial” in scare
legal costs. (The legal team cost a further £150.)
quotes (this appears consistently in our longer corre-
spondence). Writing elsewhere, Robertson notes the
33
Geoffrey Robertson QC recalled the event to me:
“Of course I remember this ‘trial’ [. . .]—the utterly
inadequacy of legal definitions of “indecency” and their
humourless bench of elderly lay justices, the bumptious
usage in court, arguing that by lacking the detailed crite-
and outraged fat clerk, the baby-faced provocateur of
ria that qualify prosecutions for obscenity, charges of
a defendant and his sweet and supportive-in-mischief
indecency rely on the working definition of “something
girlfriend. Oh for a jury trial! Conviction was a foregone
that offends the ordinary modesty of the average man,”
conclusion.” Robertson is affectionate in his portrayal
which is too “vague and arbitrary” for objective usage in
of “baby-faced” P-Orridge and sweetly mischievous
criminal proceedings.35 Robertson suggests that inde-
Cosey and his recollection of the dreary magistrates
cency and obscenity charges, alike, depend substantially
and their “bumptious” routines. The status of the
on the vagaries of social acceptability: “Criminal trials
34
193 File Under COUM
are mechanisms for deciding who is telling the truth,
performance event, however, the Mail Action was inno-
but in obscenity trials there is no truth to tell—only a
vative, appropriating the existing space of the court and the existing structure of the judiciary process to frame
clash of opinions, as a captive audience is invited to score a polite debate between bewigged protagonists.”
and recast a series of contested themes in contem-
In indecency cases, without juries, the situation can be
porary aesthetics: morality, sexuality, the body, and
more specious, as the judges are not required to evaluate
obscenity. It commented upon the status of art versus
the work as a whole (in contrast to the test of obscen-
that of pornography and the contemporary redefinition
ity), and there can be no defense of the work as having
and revision of the historical avant-garde attempt to
particular merits, or appeals to community standards;
activate the blurring of art and life.
moreover, Robertson notes that the defense against
indecency involves a losing battle, namely, “to convince
of textual proceedings, G.P.O. v. G.P-O.: A Chronicle of
a bench of lay justices that anything pertaining to sex
Mail Art on Trial, first published as a limited edition by
is not ‘indecent,’” when “[w]hat ‘offends the ordinary
John Armleder’s imprint, Galerie Ecart, Geneva, in 1976.
modesty of the average man’ is decided in most cases
Serving to document the legal proceedings, it was put
by what offends the extraordinarily prudish modesty of
together partly to raise funds to pay for P-Orridge’s
the average magistrate.”
fine. As a historical document—and as an exhibition
36
37
A key document from the Mail Action is a book
Barbara Reise recorded her impressions of the
catalogue for the Mail Action—it provides factual and
court proceedings from the audience. A staff writer
contextual information about the event and the social
for Studio International and a close friend of P-Orridge
and cultural milieu in which P-Orridge was active.
from 1975 until her untimely death in 1978, Reise states
Letters of support, notes, affidavits, legal documents,
that the legal team’s defense was “[t]oo wordy, too
invoices, receipts, and other artifacts are collected
abstract, too redundant,” and overstressed P-Orridge’s
in facsimile alongside mimeographs of the extant
“international reputation.” The contention of the work’s
cards. The book reproduces a number of documen-
purported indecency, Reise observed, remained intact.
38
tary photographs taken by Reise and Cosey, which
Ian Breakwell concurred with Reise, writing to P-Orridge
show the audience gathered in groups outside the
that he “feared the worst as soon as your lawyer opened
courthouse, posing, and larking about with P-Orridge
his mouth.”
after the astonishing conclusion to the trial. In a letter,
39
As a legal event, G.P.O. v. G.P-O. was “precedent
P-Orridge describes the book project as “a complete
setting,” writes Duncan Campbell, in that “it established
moment in time, prese[r]ved as information . . . [i]n a
that a person can now be prosecuted for sending ‘dirty’
sense a work by a collection of people in a non-chosen
postcards even though they have offended no-one, and
context,” additionally stressing the logic of appropria-
traditional in that the arguments really came down to
tion that conditioned both the postcards and the trial/
one person’s art being another person’s porn.” As a
performance.41
40
194 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
In Wreckers of Civilisation, an encyclopedic survey of
prompted tampering by postal workers and several raids
COUM and Throbbing Gristle (a wildly influential band
on her Ealing flat by Special Branch officers, including
consisting of the core members of COUM, 1975–81),
a raid on April 5, 1976, the morning of the Mail Action.
Simon Ford gives an overview of the trial and notes the
Smith’s papers in the Tate Archive hold a substantial
adaptation of the proceedings into a performance. Yet
collection of correspondence from P-Orridge. The fullest
Ford stops short of theorizing the Mail Action, except for
statement of P-Orridge’s theory of mail art was com-
a useful observation that it ended P-Orridge’s primary
posed to Smith in January 1974, after she took offense
investment in mail art and drew to a close the intense
at P-Orridge’s creative recycling of her cards as new
central period of COUM’s productivity. However,
works and complained about their apparently disre-
the many documents show that the trial prompted
spectful treatment. “Thee reason E have bin sending em
P-Orridge to theorize COUM’s work, particularly in writ-
all back to yoo is cos E find hoarding boring,” P-Orridge
ings to friends and testimonies to the court. In a formal
explained. “Yoo sed to moi that [your postcards were]
instruction to solicitor David Offenbach, P-Orridge
meant as circulars & yoo’d er hoped that people would
writes, “I want to be part of popular culture, involved
either sling em, or send em back altered, or triggered.
with everyday life and responses, not an intellectual
Well E went hom sweat hom and E did it”—that is,
artist, in an ivory tower, thinking I am special, revered
dutifully cannibalized, digested, and repurposed
and monumental. [. . .] I don’t want to be separate
Smith’s original works, as recalibrations or unbidden
from anything.” To the question “Why use postcards?”
collaborations. The letters to Smith—instances of mail
P-Orridge replies: “I want my art to circulate and be
art—demonstrate P-Orridge’s conviction that art should
acces[s]ible in structure, to be popular and amusing as
be anticommercial, intimate, and disposable. P-Orridge
well as significant and aesthetic. [. . .] Thee person in
valorizes “[p]ersonal coumunication” over artistic
thee street has some marvellous, ready-made, medi-
production. “Everything else is a luxury. [. . .] and E dont
ums at his [or her] disposal and I want to remind them
care if they get slung in bins, E really dont.”44 P-Orridge
they are there for everyone to use and explore.”43 These
suggests a key avant-gardist principle for COUM,
insights were crucially taken up and cemented after
namely, to bridge art and life: or, more precisely, the
1976, toward elaborating further the DIY, samizdat qual-
relation between art and life might be transformed such
ity of P-Orridge’s performances, mail art, music, and,
that life might absorb—or wishfully destroy—art.
subsequently, other forms.
ing mailed screeds, P-Orridge articulated a coherent
42
In unpublished correspondence with other art-
In contemporary writings and statements, includ-
ists, especially with fellow mail artist Pauline Smith,
strategy toward becoming—and remaining—categor-
P-Orridge had earlier been prompted to theorize the
ically marginal to the institutions of contemporary art,
politics of mail art. Smith found notoriety on account
including the gallery circuit and its attendant market.
of her “Adolf Hitler Fan Club,” a mail-art project that
However, through the Mail Action P-Orridge also leaned
195 File Under COUM
quite confidently upon support from the upper ech-
broader implications of the trial, P-Orridge in the same
elons of power in the art world, suggesting a nuance,
letter writes, “Lets hope E am free and art is rescued on
ambivalence, or contradiction in the artist’s stated or
Monday night.” P-Orridge tends both to support and to
staged relationship to the politics of artistic legitimacy.
interrupt the archival impulse in art and performance,
In a short preface to the documentation of the Mail
by enabling and organizing extensive traces of COUM’s
Action, P-Orridge writes, “often E work in a way coum-
work while also trafficking strangeness, informality,
what disparaging of the Art World. Yet, when E went to
sincerity, and beaurocratic irregularity into formal and
all my friends in that world [. . .] not one person refused
institutional archives. There is a pervading sense that to
to help me.” For example, P-Orridge called upon Sir
“File under COUM”—to categorize an action, object, or
Norman Reid in a series of amusingly candid letters,
effect as relevant to or subservient to COUM’s desires—
and their affectionate correspondence is held in Reid’s
both subscribes to an archival logic and disrupts it.
papers. P-Orridge’s first letter was written in COUM’s
P-Orridge’s interest consists, at least in part, in anticipat-
signature style, on letterhead paper topped with a phal-
ing these tensions and keeping them in play.
45
lic, spunk-dripping logo. Primarily requesting support in the form of a written affidavit, P-Orridge includes anecdotes and commentaries, noting, for example,
COUMclusion
Tate’s own recent embroilment in scandal. “E realise this is a bit boring,” P-Orridge writes of the imminent
The appropriation of new or unfamiliar spaces and
trial, adding that support from Reid is “possibly after
practices is a constant thread through the works
the Andre thing a bit difficult tactically for you” (with
and approaches taken up by COUM Transmissions,
reference to Tate’s purchase of Andre’s Equivalent viii);
from P-Orridge’s earliest performances, in 1968, to
in closing, P-Orridge mentions a limited-edition print of
the signature interventions of the mid-1970s and the
the Magritte postcard and encloses six copies, adding:
appropriation of a court of law in 1976. The Mail Action
“Maybe if E win thee case you can sell them in your
exposes the reductive impositions of clear bound-
shop (I doubt it).”
aries and categories—art, pornography, indecency,
46
Unguarded in tone, P-Orridge’s lobbying techniques
and obscenity—categories P-Orridge had already
were persistent, ambitious, and conscientious: the letter
been eager to upset or displace, not least through the
to Reid included a pack of sample affidavits (includ-
choice of content in the postcards that precipitated the
ing Burroughs’s), copies of the three extant cards,
artist’s criminal status. The court’s gallery of visitors
legal documents (including summonses), the relevant
becomes an audience, and the three magistrates,
passage from the Post Office Act, and information on
unwitting performers in P-Orridge’s luridly costumed
fundraising—namely, the attempted sale of one of the
spectacle. While persisting as a legal procedure, the
original postcards. Signing off by calling into play the
trial also becomes a conceptual space, continuous or
196 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
coterminous with the enabling appropriation of the
year COUM had appropriated the abstract space of the
postal service and its avenues of transit and travel,
trial and the concrete space of the courtroom as venues
which had been so artfully remade by the formally inde-
for performance, the critical purchase of the Prostitution
cent procedures of P-Orridge’s mail art.
exhibition depended on an analogous act of appropria-
If the action was critically effective and politically
tion, namely, Cosey’s recasting of her own experiences
nuanced, it was also personally debilitating. In a letter
of modeling as surreptitious interventions into the porn
to Reid of August 1976, P-Orridge explains the emo-
industry, and her concrete appropriation of pages from
tional toll of the trial: “E am beginning to feel more
magazines—snipped out and framed—as individual
like my old self.” The letter continues, “Since thee trial
works of art. The photographs were placed under lock
E was very depressed, paralysed as far as keeping
and key and made available for private viewing upon
up coumunication with people went & even now E
request, theatricalizing the “pornographic” function
get severe depressions, feelings of hopelessness, like
of the source materials as the essential aspect of the
anti-matter negating all my energy. Butter E have not
finished works.49
stopped COUM activity, its just slow.” P-Orridge notes
COUM was “bankrupted” by the trial, explaining that
in the pages of newspapers. Indeed, the Mail Action
this had slowed and curtailed their ongoing projects.
provided what P-Orridge calls “the map for Prostitution.”
Two months later, the Prostitution controversy would
In preparation for COUM’s retrospective at the ICA,
embroil P-Orridge in much deeper trouble than the
P-Orridge remembers, “We [. . .] were planning to delib-
“anti-matter” of the Mail Action.
erately trigger another furor. With G.P.O. v. G.P-O. we
didn’t do it on purpose. It was a surprise. [. . .] We were
47
Prostitution was on show at the ICA from October
The bulk of the ensuing controversy took place
19 to October 26, 1976, and included the Magazine
happy to have escaped [a prison term] by the skin of
Actions—a series of assisted self-portraits by Cosey
our teeth. But we were also disgusted and outraged that
Fanni Tutti appropriated from pornographic maga-
it even happened.”50 P-Orridge was particularly mobi-
zines—alongside sadomasochistic paraphernalia,
lized by the charge that an artist’s usage or signature
sculptures made from used tampons and other mate-
might convert commercially and legally available mate-
rials, and a growing self-reflexive “media wall” of press
rials (pornography and postcards) into proof of criminal
cuttings, as well as live performances at the opening
acts: “My touching it and reassembling it makes it
and several planned interventions that were preemp-
criminal.” In the months after the trial, during the prepa-
tively canceled by the institution. Two officers from
ration of Prostitution, P-Orridge recalls thinking, “[I]f I’m
Scotland Yard’s Obscene Publications Squad visited
a criminal, fuck it—let’s enjoy it. Let’s expose the media
the opening and sent a report to the Director of Public
and how they misinterpret and lie and cheat. That’s why
Prosecutions. No action was decided, but the ICA called
we have always said the wall of press cuttings was the
off COUM’s planned live performances. If earlier in the
most important part.”51
48
197 File Under COUM
This occupation of newspaper print space would
there alone. Your card was very welcome and helped me
imperil the ICA when the (now-disgraced) Tory MP
survive.”55
Nicholas Fairbairn vilified COUM as “the wreckers of
The Mail Action—and in its wake, Prostitution—can
civilisation” and demanded that Education Minister
be read as a pivotal project for London art worlds in the
Shirley Williams investigate the ICA’s receipt of public
1970s, not least through the imaginative attempts at
funds—including £200 from a public disbursement from
world building—at community organization and public
the Arts Council. The Sun began a daily campaign
intervention—that the activities warranted or licensed.
against Prostitution, writing that “even a stripper” was
The stories of COUM Transmissions, performance art,
shocked by the “sick” and “disgusting” exhibition. It
mail art, and the Mail Action are stories of ambiva-
indignantly reported “beastly” COUM’s use of public
lence, instability, and intrigue. The Mail Action serves
funds: “Even a penny of public money is too much to
as a snapshot of the margins of a culture and recalls
spend on this squalid rubbish. [. . .] Mr. Orridge is prosti-
unwritten narratives of art in the 1970s that remain to
tuting Britain—and sending us the bill.”54 Articles about
be factored into broader cultural histories. After COUM
Prostitution were often accompanied by graphic images
began to wind down, in the aftermath of the Mail Action
of key performances by COUM, which recalibrated the
and more emphatically after Prostitution, Genesis
exhibition in terms of the democratic goals set out in
P-Orridge and co-conspirators would continue to appro-
P-Orridge’s polemical writings on the democratization
priate existing forms, to destructure institutions, to
of art. The experience was, once again, distressing and
consolidate a new and eccentric aesthetic language, and
isolating for P-Orridge, who wrote to Reise, “It’s all
to destroy art’s already-beleaguered autonomy. To reit-
pretty sick really, everyone running for cover, leaving
erate P-Orridge’s own decisive mock-prophetic words,
us as a target/sacrifice and then blaming us for being
“There is no such thing as art there is only coum.”56
52
53
Notes
1. P-Orridge and Christopherson, “COUM Transmissions: Annihilating Reality,” 65. This includes a one-page artist statement by P-Orridge titled “Scenes of Victory” (1978), followed by found images and quotes compiled with Christopherson in 1976. 2. The artist now identifies as Genesis BREYER P-ORRIDGE, having undergone Breaking Sex (1999–2007), a project of surgical and behavioral modifications to merge identities with the late Lady Jaye BREYER P-ORRIDGE and create a post-transsexual “pandrogyne” identity. I retain the obsolete name Genesis P-Orridge to discuss works undertaken before the advent of “pandrogeny.” Although the artist uses a complex series of invented pronouns, I, for the sake of clarity and historical veracity, avoid the use of gendered pronouns except in quotation.
198 L O ND ON ART WOR LDS
3. Cork, “Message in a Brick.” 4. Turner, Crisis? What Crisis? Britain in the 1970s, 161. 5. Cleave, “Londoner’s Diary: Art and Mr Orridge.” 6. Cork, “Message in a Brick.” 7. P-Orridge devised new spellings for common words as a means of reconditioning language. These include “thee” for “the,” “E” for “I,” “butter” for “but,” “yoo” for “you,” and prolific introductions of “coum” into various words. In my quotations throughout, I preserve P-Orridge’s strategic spellings. 8. On authorship and attribution in COUM, see S. Wilson, Art Labor, Sex Politics, 118–19.
9. After the inclusion of the Magazine Actions in the Tate Triennial in 2006, P-Orridge queried Tate Britain’s attributions to Cosey without reference to COUM. See P-Orridge, “Letters: COUM On.” 10. P-Orridge, “Scenes of Victory.” 11. Cited in Ford, Wreckers of Civilisation, 5.8. Emphasis in original. 12. Held, Mail Art, xii. 13. P-Orridge, cited in Ford, Wreckers of Civilisation, 5.6. 14. P-Orridge, “Scenes of Victory.” 15. Post Office Act, 1953, s. 11(1): “Prohibition on sending by post of certain articles.” National Archives, http://www.legislation.gov .uk/ukpga/Eliz2/1-2/36/section/11/enacted?view=plain, accessed October 23, 2013. Repealed 2001. 16. Robertson, Obscenity, 348. 17. Ibid., 1. 18. Ibid., 174. 19. Unless otherwise stated, details concerning the trial are from P-Orridge, G.P.O. v. G.P-O. 20. Genesis BREYER P-ORRIDGE, interview with the author, New York, March 19, 2016. 21. See Naylor and P-Orridge, Contemporary Artists, 342. 22. BREYER P-ORRIDGE, interview with the author. 23. A card is preserved in the Barbara Reise Papers, Tate Archive, TGA 786/5/2/43: “COUM 1973–1976.” 24. Charles Manson, untitled note, in P-Orridge, Painful but Fabulous, 7. 25. D. Campbell, “‘Dirty’ Porridge,” 9. 26. Ibid., 8. 27. Genesis P-Orridge to Sir Norman Reid, March 30, 1976, Sir Norman Reid Papers, Tate Archive, TGA 15/6/14: London: “Miscellaneous Correspondence 1976–79.” 28. Cited in D. Campbell, “‘Dirty’ Porridge,” 9. 29. Excerpted in P-Orridge, Painful but Fabulous, 6. 30. William S. Burroughs, “Statement by William S. Burroughs in Re: The Art of Genesis P-Orridge (March 22, 1976),” in G.P.O. v. G.P-O., n.p. 31. Robertson, Obscenity, 183.
199 File Under COUM
32. Ian Mather, “The Mischievous Art of Genesis P-Orridge,” Observer, April 11, 1976, reprinted in P-Orridge, G.P.O. v. G.P-O., n.p. 33. D. Campbell, “‘Dirty’ Porridge,” 9. 34. Geoffrey Robertson QC, e-mail to the author, December 3, 2014. 35. Robertson, Obscenity, 176. 36. Ibid., 6. 37. Ibid., 175–77. 38. Barbara Reise, unpublished notes, Barbara Reise Papers. 39. Ian Breakwell to Genesis P-Orridge, April 6, 1976, in G.P.O. v. G.P-O., n.p. 40. D. Campbell, “‘Dirty’ Porridge,” 8. 41. Genesis P-Orridge to Sir Norman Reid, August 9, 1976, Sir Norman Reid Papers. 42. Ford, Wreckers of Civilisation, 6.10–13. 43. Genesis P-Orridge to David Offenbach, in G.P.O. v. G.P-O., n.p. 44. Genesis P-Orridge to Pauline Smith, January 13, 1974, Pauline Smith Papers, Tate Archive, TGA 801/1/12: “Correspondence Filed Under ‘P.’” 45. P-Orridge, acknowledgments in G.P.O. v. G.P-O., n.p. 46. P-Orridge to Reid, March 30, 1976. 47. P-Orridge to Reid, August 9, 1976. 48. Dovkants, “Sex Show Report for DPP.” 49. Blincow, “Cosey’s Sex Romp Pictures are Banned.” 50. BREYER P-ORRIDGE, interview with the author. The artist does not refer to COUM here but rather uses plural as opposed to singular personal pronouns. 51. Ibid. 52. Cited in Ford, Wreckers of Civilisation, 6.22. 53. Wesley, “Show Shocks Even a Stripper.” 54. “The Sun Says: Prostituting Britain.” 55. Genesis P-Orridge to Barbara Reise, October 28, 1976, Barbara Reise Papers. 56. P-Orridge to Pauline Smith, January 13, 1974. Emphasis added.
Alfrey, Nicholas, Joy Sleeman, and Ben Tufnell. Uncommon Ground: Land Art in Britain, 1966–1979. London: Hayward Publishing, 2013. Exh. cat. Alloway, Lawrence. “The Development of British Pop.” In Lippard, Pop Art, 27–66. ———. “The Long Front of Culture.” In Imagining the Present: Context, Content, and the Role of the Critic, edited by Richard Kalina, 61–64. London: Routledge, 2006. First published in Cambridge Opinion, no. 17 (1959): 24–26. ———. “Network: The Art World Described as a System.” Artforum 11, no. 1 (September 1972): 27–31. ———. “‘Reality’: Ideology at D5.” Artforum 11, no. 2 (October 1972): 30–36. Anderson, Fiona, and Amy Tobin. “Collaboration Is Not an Alternative: Artists Working Together in London and New York, 1974– 1981.” In Collaboration and Its (Dis)Contents: Collaborative Practices in Art, Architecture, and Film Since 1910, edited by Meredith A. Brown and Michelle Millar-Fisher. London: Courtauld Books Online, 2017. http://courtauld.ac.uk/research/ courtauld-books-online/collaboration-an d-its-discontents. Anderson, Simon. “Fluxus, Fluxion, Fluxshoe: The 1970s.” In The Fluxus Reader, edited by Ken
Friedman, 22–30. London: Academy Editions, 1998. The Antiuniversity of London: Catalogue. London: Trigram Press, ca. 1968. Applin, Jo. “There’s a Sculpture on My Shoulder: Bruce McLean and the Anxiety of Influence.” Sculpture Journal 17, no. 2 (Winter 2008): 102–15. ———. “When Attitudes Became Formless: Art and Antagonism in the 1960s.” In A Companion to British Art: 1600 to the Present, edited by Dana Arnold and David Peters Corbett, 180–98. Oxford: Wiley-Blackwell, 2013. Araeen, Rasheed, ed. The Other Story: Afro-Asian Artists in Post-War Britain. London: Hayward Gallery, South Bank Centre, 1989. Exh. cat. ———. “Preliminary Notes for a Black Manifesto.” In Making Myself Visible, 73–97. London: Kala Press, 1984. First published in Black Phoenix 1 (January 1978): 3–12. ———. “A Very Special British Issue? Modernity, Art History, and the Crisis of Art Today.” Third Text 22, no. 2 (March 2008): 125–44. ———. “When the Naughty Children of Empire Come Home to Roost.” Third Text 20, no. 2 (March 2006): 233–39. Araeen, Rasheed, Sean Cubitt, and Ziauddin Sardar, eds. The Third Text Reader: On Art, Culture, and Theory. London: Continuum, 2002.
Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography Bibliography
Artists for Democracy: El Archivo de Cecilia Vicuña. Santiago de Chile: Museo de la Memoria y los Derechos Humanos, 2014. Exh. cat. “The Artists’ Union.” Studio International 183, no. 944 (May 1972): 192. “Art Preview Ends in Uproar.” Observer, February 14, 1971, 3. Art Spectrum London. London: Arts Council of Great Britain, 1971. Exh. cat. Asbury, Michael, Valerie Fraser, María Iñigo Clavo, and Isobel Whitelegg. “Interview with Felipe Ehrenberg at the University of Essex on the Eve of ‘Xocoyotzin, the Penultimate.’” arara 8 (2010): 1–25. Accessed September 18, 2014. http://www.essex.ac.uk/arthistory/research/ pdfs/arara_issue_8/ehrenberg.pdf. Ascott, Roy. “Behaviourables and Futuribles.” Control Magazine 5 (1970): n.p. ———. “The Cybernetic Stance: My Process and Purpose.” Leonardo 1, no. 2 (April 1968): 105–12. Auslander, Philip. “The Performativity of Performance Documentation.” PAJ: A Journal of Performance and Art 28, no. 3 (September 2006): 1–10. Bailey, David A., Ian Baucom, and Sonia Boyce, eds. Shades of Black: Assembling Black Arts in 1980s Britain. Durham, N.C.: Duke University Press in collaboration with the Institute of International Visual Arts and the African and Asian Visual Artists’ Archive, 2005. Baro, Gene. British Sculpture out of the Sixties. London: Institute of Contemporary Arts, 1970. Exh. cat. Barson, Tanya, and Taisa Palhares, eds. Mira Schendel. London: Tate Publishing in association with Pinacoteca do Estado de São Paulo, 2013. Exh. cat. Battista, Kathy. Renegotiating the Body: Feminist Art in 1970s London. London: I. B. Tauris, 2013. Beckett, Andy. When the Lights Went Out: Britain in the Seventies. London: Faber & Faber, 2009. Benitez, Purissima Helena. “David Medalla: The 60s and 70s.” Master’s diss., Courtauld Institute of Art, University of London, 1992. Benítez Dueñas, Issa María. “Restructuring Emptiness and Recovering Space: The Conceptual Ehrenberg.” In Llanos, Felipe Ehrenberg, 21–27. Berke, Joseph, ed. Counter-Culture. London: Peter Owen, 1969. Bickers, Patricia, and Andrew Wilson, eds. Talking Art: Interviews with Artists Since 1976. London: Art Monthly and Ridinghouse, 2007.
202 Bibliography
Bihari, Bernard. “Marshall McLuhan and the Behavioral Sciences.” Art-Language 1, no. 3 (June 1970): 11–28. Bishop, Claire. Artificial Hells: Participatory Art and the Politics of Spectatorship. London: Verso, 2012. ———. “Incidental People: APG and Community Arts.” In Artificial Hells, 163–91. Blincow, Neil. “Cosey’s Sex Romp Pictures Are Banned: Another Art Exhibition Row.” Evening Standard (London), October 19, 1976, 6. Bourdieu, Pierre. “The Field of Cultural Production, or: The Economic World Reversed.” Translated by Richard Nice. In The Field of Cultural Production: Essays on Art and Literature, edited by Randal Johnson, 29–73. Cambridge: Polity Press, 1993. First published in Poetics 12, nos. 4–5 (1983): 311–56. Bracewell, Michael. “Joint Declaration.” In Civil Rights etc.: Rita Donagh and Richard Hamilton, exh. cat., edited by Barbara Dawson, 6–12. Dublin: Dublin City Gallery The Hugh Lane, 2011. Braden, Su. “Politics in Art.” Studio International 187, no. 967 (June 1974): 272–74. ———. “Sky Signs: Su Braden Discusses the Message Flags of Rose Finn-Kelcey.” Art and Artists 7, no. 1 (April 1972): 28–31. Breitwieser, Sabine, ed. Gustav Metzger: History History. Vienna: Generali Foundation, 2005. Exh. cat. Brener, Roland. “The Concerns of Emerging Sculptors.” Studio International 177, no. 907 (January 1969): 25. Brett, Guy. Abstract Vaudeville: The Work of Rose English. London: Ridinghouse, 2014. ———. “Artists in Revolt.” Sunday Times (London), August 10, 1970, 5. ———. Exploding Galaxies: The Art of David Medalla. London: Kala Press, 1995. ———. “Hélio Oiticica’s ‘Whitechapel Experiment.’” In The Whitechapel Art Gallery Centenary Review, 76–78. London: Whitechapel Art Gallery, 2001. ———. “Internationalism Among Artists in the 60s and 70s.” In The Other Story: Afro-Asian Artists in Post-war Britain, exh. cat., edited by Rasheed Araeen, 111–14. London: Hayward Gallery, South Bank Centre, 1989. ———. Introduction to Carnival of Perception: Selected Writings on Art, 12–19. London: Institute of International Visual Arts, 2004.
———. “Just a Few Hours of Participation.” Times (London), February 16, 1971, 10. ———. Kinetic Art: The Language of Movement. London: Studio Vista; New York: Rienhold Book Corporation, 1968. ———. “Life Strategies: Overview and Selection, Buenos Aires– London–Rio de Janeiro–Santiago de Chile, 1960–1980.” In Schimmel et al., Out of Actions, 197–225. ———. Rose Finn-Kelcey. London: Ridinghouse, 2012. ———. Through Our Own Eyes: Popular Art and Modern History. London: GMP/Heretic; Philadelphia: New Society Publishers, 1986. ———. “Tissues of Thought: Performance and Some Other Works in London, 1970–1985.” Third Text 22, no. 2 (March 2008): 237–56. ———. “Venezuelan Artists: Midland Group Gallery Nottingham.” Times (London), May 30, 1972, 8. Brett, Guy, and Luciano Figueiredo, eds. Oiticica in London. London: Tate Publishing, 2007. Briers, David. “David Briers Interviews Steve Willats.” Art and Artists 8, no. 3 (June 1973): 21–23. Brooks, Rosetta. “Behavioural Art.” Studio International 185, no. 951 (January 1973): 27–28. ———. “The New Art.” Studio International 184, no. 948 (October 1972): 152–53. ———. “Problem Solving and Question Begging.” Studio International 186, no. 961 (December 1973): 276–78. ———, ed. A Survey of the Avant-Garde in Britain. Vol. 1. London: Gallery House, 1972. Exh. cat. Brown, Paul, Charlie Gere, Nicholas Lambert, and Catherine Mason, eds. White Heat Cold Logic: British Computer Art, 1960–1980. Cambridge: MIT Press, 2008. Bryan-Wilson, Julia. Art Workers: Radical Practice in the Vietnam War Era. Berkeley: University of California Press, 2009. Buchloh, Benjamin H. D. “Conceptual Art, 1962–1969: From the Aesthetic of Administration to the Critique of Institutions.” October 55 (Winter 1990): 105–43. ———. “Documenta 7: A Dictionary of Received Ideas.” October 22 (Autumn 1982): 104–26. Burnham, Jack. Dissolve into Comprehension: Writings and Interviews, 1964–2004. Edited by Melissa Ragain. Cambridge: MIT Press, 2015. Butler, Cornelia H., and Luis Pérez-Oramas, eds. Lygia Clark: The Abandonment of Art, 1948–1988. New York: Museum of Modern Art, 2014. Exh. cat.
203 Bibliography
Butt, Gavin. “The Common Turn in Performance.” Contemporary Theatre Review 22, no. 1 (February 2012): 46–61. Camnitzer, Luis, Jane Farver, and Rachel Weiss, eds. Global Conceptualism: Points of Origin, 1950s–1980s. New York: Queens Museum of Art, 1999. Exh. cat. Campbell, Duncan. “‘Dirty’ Porridge.” Time Out, no. 318 (April 16–22, 1976): 8–9. Campbell, James. Paris Interzone: Richard Wright, Lolita, Boris Vian, and Others on the Left Bank, 1946–60. London: Secker & Warburg, 1994. Carey, Peter, ed. Survey 69: New Space. London: Camden Arts Centre, 1969. Exh. cat. Carlson, Marvin A. Performance: A Critical Introduction. London: Routledge, 1996. Cartwright, Lisa, and Nina Fonoroff. “Narrative Is Narrative: So What Is New?” (1983). In Multiple Voices in Feminist Film Criticism, edited by Diane Carson, Linda Dittmar, and Janice R. Welsch, 124–39. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1994. Casser, Anja, and Phillipp Ziegler, eds. Stephen Willats: Art Society Feedback. Nuremberg: Verlag für moderne Kunst, 2010. Exh. cat. Castells, Manuel. The City and the Grassroots: A Cross-Cultural Theory of Urban Social Movements. London: Edward Arnold, 1983. ———, ed. The Network Society: A Cross-Cultural Perspective. Cheltenham: Edward Elgar, 2004. Cedric Price: Works ii. London: Architectural Association, 1984. Celant, Germano, et al. When Attitudes Become Form: Bern 1969 / Venice 2013. Venice: Fondazione Prada, 2013. Exh. cat. Chambers, Eddie. Black Artists in British Art: A History Since the 1950s. London: I. B. Tauris, 2014. Chang, Jiat-Hwee, and Anthony D. King. “Towards a Genealogy of Tropical Architecture: Historical Fragments of Power-Knowledge, Built Environment, and Climate in the British Colonial Territories.” Singapore Journal of Tropical Geography 32, no. 3 (November 2011): 283–300. Cherix, Christophe, ed. In and Out of Amsterdam: Travels in Conceptual Art, 1960–1976. New York: Museum of Modern Art, 2009. Exh. cat. Clark, Lygia. “We Refuse” (1966). In Lygia Clark and Yve-Alain Bois, “Nostalgia of the Body.” October 69 (Summer 1994): 105–6. Cleave, Maureen. “Londoner’s Diary: Art and Mr Orridge.” Evening Standard (London), October 22, 1976, 19.
Cole, Ian, ed. Gustav Metzger: Retrospectives. Oxford: Museum of Modern Art, 1999. Colomina, Beatriz. “Beyond Pavilions: Architecture as a Machine to See.” In Dan Graham: Beyond, edited by Bennett Simpson and Chrissie Iles, 191–207. Los Angeles: Museum of Contemporary Art; Cambridge: MIT Press, 2009. Conwell, Donna. “Beau Geste Press.” Getty Research Journal, no. 2 (2010): 183–92. Cork, Richard. “The Message in a Brick.” Evening Standard (London), December 30, 1976, 11. Cornish, Sam. Stockwell Depot, 1967–79. London: Ridinghouse in association with the University of Greenwich, 2015. Exh. cat. Craddock, Sacha. “No Clear Dividing Line.” Times (London), March 7, 1995, 37. ———. “Squatters: Tolmers United.” In Proll, Goodbye to London, 32–39. Cross, Peter. “Gays: Revolting Queers; A Memory of South London Gay Liberation.” In Proll, Goodbye to London, 74–83. Curtis, David. “English Avant-Garde Film: An Early Chronology.” In The British Avant-Garde Film, 1926 to 1995: An Anthology of Writings, edited by Michael O’Pray, 101–19. Luton: University of Luton, 1996. First published in Studio International 190, no. 978 (November–December 1975): 176–82, revised in 1978. ———. A History of Artists’ Film and Video in Britain, 1897–2004. London: British Film Institute, 2007. Curtis, Liz. Ireland: The Propaganda War; The British Media and the “Battle for Hearts and Minds.” Rev. ed. Belfast: Sásta, 1998. First ed., London: Pluto, 1984. Dawson, Ashley. Mongrel Nation: Diasporic Culture and the Making of Postcolonial Britain. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press, 2007. Dean, Emma, and Michael Stanley, eds. Stephen Willats: Person to Person, People to People. Milton Keynes: Milton Keynes Gallery, 2007. Exh. cat. de Jongh, Nicholas. “Lights Out for the Arts Lab.” Guardian (Manchester), October 21, 1969, 12. de Lauretis, Teresa. “Rethinking Women’s Cinema: Aesthetics and Feminist Theory.” In Multiple Voices in Feminist Film Criticism, edited by Diane Carson, Linda Dittmar, and Janice R. Welsch, 140–61. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1994. First published in New German Critique, no. 34 (Winter 1985): 154–75.
204 Bibliography
de Sausmarez, Maurice. Basic Design: The Dynamics of Visual Form. London: Studio Vista, 1964. de Sausmarez, Maurice, Richard Hamilton, William Turnbull, and Robert Brazil. “A Visual Grammar of Form, Part 1.” Motif 8 (1961): 3–29. de Sausmarez, Maurice, Kenneth Martin, Oliffe Richmond, and Denis Broodbank. “A Visual Grammar of Form, Part 2.” Motif 9 (1962): 47–67. de St. Jorre, John. The Good Ship Venus: The Erotic Voyage of the Olympia Press. London: Hutchinson, 1994. Dickinson, Margaret, ed. Rogue Reels: Oppositional Film in Britain, 1945–90. London: British Film Institute, 1999. Dimitrijević, Nena. Bruce McLean. Basel: Kunsthalle Basel, 1981. Exh. cat. Dixon, Paul. Northern Ireland: The Politics of War and Peace. Basingstoke: Palgrave, 2001. Donagh, Rita. “Georgia O’Keeffe in Context.” In “Women in Art,” special issue, Oxford Art Journal 3, no. 1 (April 1980): 44–50. Donagh, Rita, and Richard Hamilton. An Inquiry Through the Medium of Art Aided by Film and News Photographs into Dimensions (Height, Depth, Breadth, Length) and Habitation of the Majesty’s Prison Maze Formerly Long Kesh Internment Camp in Antrim, One of the Nine Counties of Ulster, Ancient Northern Province of Ireland (also known as A Cellular Maze). Londonderry: Orchard Gallery, 1983. Exh. cat. Dovkants, Keith. “Sex Show Report for DPP.” Evening Standard (London), October 22, 1976, 1. Drower, Jill. “The Exploding Galaxy.” Third Text 22, no. 2 (March 2008): 229–36. ———. 99 Balls Pond Road: The Story of the Exploding Galaxy. London: Scrudge Books, 2014. Duncan, Michael, and Kristine McKenna, eds. Semina Culture: Wallace Berman and His Circle. Santa Monica: Santa Monica Museum of Art, 2005. Exh. cat. Dusinberre, Deke. “On Expanding Cinema.” Studio International 190, no. 978 (November–December 1975): 220–24. Earnest, Jarrett. “Carolee Schneemann in Conversation with Jarrett Earnest.” In Women in Performance: Rigorous Ecstasy— Language and Performance, Part i (September 2014). Accessed December 14, 2014. https://www.artpractical. com/column/women-in-performance-rigorous-ecstasy-language-performance-part-i/. Ehrenberg, Felipe. “Date with Fate at Tate.” Studio International 181, no. 931 (March 1971): 92–93.
———. “East and West—the Twain Do Meet: A Tale of More Than Two Worlds.” In The Subversive Imagination: Artists, Society, and Social Responsibility, edited by Carol Becker. London: Routledge, 2013. Kindle edition. ———. Generación Ehrenberg. Cullompton, Devon: Beau Geste Press, 1973. ———. “1960 and a Bit More.” In Llanos, Felipe Ehrenberg, 156–62. Ekeberg, Jonas. “Institutional Experiments Between Aesthetics and Activism.” In Self-Organised, edited by Stine Hebert and Anne Szefer Karlsen, 50–61. London: Open Editions; Bergen: Hordaland Art Centre, 2013. Elwes, Catherine. Video Loupe: A Collection of Essays By and About the Videomaker and Critic Catherine Elwes. London: KT Press, 2000. Everitt, Anthony. “PoPA at MoMA: Pioneers of Part-Art.” Birmingham Post, February 15, 1971. Faulkner, Simon, and Anandi Ramamurthy, eds. Visual Culture and Decolonisation in Britain. Aldershot: Ashgate, 2006. Fer, Briony. The Infinite Line: Re-making Art After Modernism. New Haven: Yale University Press, 2004. Floe, Hilary. Are You Afraid of the Light? Spectacular Aesthetics at the Museum of Modern Art, Oxford, 1967–1968. Oxford: Modern Art Oxford, 2013. ———. “‘Everything Was Getting Smashed’: Three Case Studies of Play and Participation, 1965–71.” Tate Papers 22 (Autumn 2014). Accessed 28 February, 2015. http://www.tate.org. uk/research/publications/tate-papers/22/everything-wa s-getting-smashed-three-case-studies-of-playand-participation-1965–71. Ford, Simon. “Technological Kindergarten: Gustav Metzger and Early Computer Art.” In Brown et al., White Heat Cold Logic, 163–74. ———. The Wreckers of Civilisation: The Story of COUM Transmissions and Throbbing Gristle. London: Black Dog, 1999. Forte, Jeanie. “Women’s Performance Art: Feminism and Postmodernism.” Theatre Journal 40, no. 2 (May 1988): 217–35. Fricke, Marion, and Roswitha Fricke, eds. The Context of Art: The Art of Context. Trieste: Navado Press: 2004. Gablik, Suzi. “Oxford: Rita Donagh at the Museum of Modern Art.” Art in America 66, no. 1 (January–February 1978): 121. Gallagher, Ann, ed. Susan Hiller. London: Tate Britain, 2011. Exh. cat. García de Germenos, Pilar. “Salón Independiente: Una relectura.” In La era de la discrepancia: Arte y cultura visual en México
205 Bibliography
1968–1997 / The Age of Discrepancies: Art and Visual Culture in Mexico, 1968–1997, 40–57. México City: Turner / Universidad Nacional Autónoma de México, 2006. Garlake, Margaret. New Art, New World: British Art in Postwar Society. New Haven: Yale University Press, 1998. ———. New Vision 56–66. Jarrow, Tyne and Wear: Bede Gallery, 1984. Exh. cat. Gilbert, Zanna. “‘Something Unnameable in Common’: Translocal Collaboration at the Beau Geste Press.” ARTMargins 1, nos. 2–3 (2012): 45–72. ———. “The Eclectic World of Felipe Ehrenberg.” Essex Student Research Online 2, no. 2 (2009): 43–51. Accessed April 21, 2013. https://www.essex.ac.uk/journals/estro/doc uments/issue3/FullIssue.pdf. Gilbert & George. “A Magazine Sculpture.” Studio International 179, no. 922 (May 1970): 218. Gilbert & George, 1968 to 1980. Eindhoven: Van Abbemuseum, 1980. Exh. cat. Glassner, Verina. “Interviews with Three Filmmakers.” Time Out, March 17–23, 1972, 46–47. Glew, Adrian. “Transmitting Art Triggers: The Early Interactive Work of Stephen Willats.” In Brown et al., White Heat Cold Logic, 19–35. Glew, Adrian, and Jon Hendricks. Fluxbritannica: Aspects of the Fluxus Movement, 1962–73. London: Tate Gallery, 1994. Exh. cat. Glueck, Grace. “Artists Vote for Union and a Big Demonstration.” New York Times, September 23, 1970, 39. Godfrey, Mark. “Television Delivers People.” In Richard Hamilton, exh. cat., edited by Mark Godfrey, Paul Schimmel, and Vicente Todolí, 235–48. London: Tate Publishing, 2014. Goldberg, RoseLee. Performance Art: From Futurism to the Present. London: Thames & Hudson, 1979. ———. “Space as Praxis.” Studio International 190, no. 977 (September–October 1975): 130–35. ———. A Space: A Thousand Words. London: Royal College of Art, 1975. Exh. cat. Gooding, Mel. Bruce McLean. Oxford: Phaidon Press, 1990. Green, Alison. “Intermedia, Exile, and Carolee Schneemann.” In Across the Great Divide: Modernism’s Intermedialities, from Futurism to Fluxus, edited by Christopher Townsend, Alex Trott, and Rhys Davies, 137–57. Newcastle upon Tyne: Cambridge Scholars Publishing, 2014. Green, Jonathon. Days in the Life: Voices from the English Underground, 1961–1971. London: Heinemann, 1988.
Greenberg, Reesa, Bruce W. Ferguson, and Sandy Nairne, eds. Thinking About Exhibitions. London: Routledge, 1996. Grieve, Alastair. Constructed Abstract Art in England After the Second World War: A Neglected Avant-Garde. New Haven: Yale University Press, 2005. Grunenberg, Christoph, ed. Summer of Love: Art of the Psychedelic Era. Liverpool: Tate Liverpool, 2005. Exh. cat. Grunenberg, Christoph, and Jonathan Harris, eds. The Summer of Love: Psychedelic Art, Social Crisis, and Counterculture in the 1960s. Liverpool: Liverpool University Press, 2005. Gullar, Ferreira. “Manifesto Neoconcreto.” Jornal do Brasil, March 22, 1959. Hamilton, Richard. “First Year Studies at Newcastle.” In Collected Words, 1953–1982, 172–75. London: Thames & Hudson, 1982. First published in the Times Educational Supplement, ca. 1960. ———. “Printmaking.” In Collected Words, 1953–1982, 84–110. London: Thames & Hudson, 1982. Harris, Mary Emma. The Arts of Black Mountain College. Cambridge: MIT Press, 1987. Harrison, Charles. “Against Precedents.” In Exhibiting the New Art: “Op Losse Schroeven” and “When Attitudes Become Form” 1969, 194–99. London: Afterall Books, 2010. First published in When Attitudes Become Form, exh. cat. London: Institute of Contemporary Arts, 1969. ———. “Roelof Louw’s Sculpture.” Studio International 178, no. 915 (October 1969): 126–29. ———. “Some Recent Sculpture in Britain.” Studio International 177, no. 907 (January 1969): 26–33. ———, ed. Idea Structures. London: Camden Arts Centre / Central Library; Swiss Cottage, 1970. Exh. cat. Harrison, Margaret. “Notes on Feminist Art in Britain, 1970–77.” Studio International 193, no. 987 (1977): 212–20. Harvey, Jonathan, and Nayia Yiakoumaki. Supporting Artists: Acme’s First Decade, 1972–1982. London: Whitechapel Gallery and Acme Studios, 2013. Exh. cat. Held, John, Jr. Mail Art: An Annotated Bibliography. Metuchen, N.J.: Scarecrow Press, 1991. Hellion, Martha. “Nineteen Sixty.” In Llanos, Felipe Ehrenberg, 97–100. Henri, Adrian. Environments and Happenings. London: Thames & Hudson, 1974. Hélio Oiticica: Whitechapel Experiment. London: Whitechapel Art Gallery, 1969. Exh. cat. Reproduced in Brett and Figueiredo, Oiticica in London, 97–137.
206 Bibliography
Hewison, Robert. In Anger: Culture in the Cold War, 1945–60. Rev. ed. London: Methuen, 1988. First ed., London: Weidenfeld & Nicolson, 1981. ———. Too Much: Art and Society in the Sixties, 1960–75. London: Methuen, 1986. Hiller, Susan. “3,512 Words: Susan Hiller with Jörg Heiser and Jan Verwoert” (2007). In The Provisional Texture of Reality: Selected Talks and Texts, 1977–2007, edited by Alexandra M. Kokoli, 127–38. Zurich: JRP/Ringier, 2008. Hiller, Susan, with Carla Liss and Lynne Tillman. “Elements of Science Fiction.” Art and Artists 8, no. 7 (October 1973): 29–33. Hillings, Valerie, Daniel Birnbaum, and Edouard Derom, eds. Zero: Countdown to Tomorrow, 1950s–60s. New York: Solomon R. Guggenheim Museum, 2014. Exh. cat. Hilton, Tim. “Absence Makes the Heart Grow Fonder.” Independent on Sunday Magazine, February 12, 1994, 16–17. Hoffmann, Beth. “Radicalism and the Theatre in Genealogies of Live Art.” Performance Research: A Journal of the Performing Arts 14, no. 1 (July 2009): 95–105. Holert, Tom. Marc Camille Chaimowicz: Celebration? Realife. London: Afterall Books, 2007. Hudek, Antony. “Meta-Magazine: Control, 1965–68.” In Control: Stephen Willats, Work, 1962–69, exh. cat., 33–40. London: Raven Row, 2014. ———. “Staging Dissonance: Artist Placement Group’s Performative (Non‑)Exhibitions.” Journal of Curatorial Studies 2, no. 3 (October 2013): 302–28. Hudek, Antony, and Alex Sainsbury. The Individual and the Organisation: Artist Placement Group, 1966–79, exh. cat. London: Raven Row, 2012. Huizing, Colin, and Tijs Visser, eds. nul = 0: The Dutch Nul Group in an International Context. Rotterdam: nai010, 2012. Exh. cat. Hutton, Andrew. “Artists Call Spectators Philistines—and Quit.” Oxford Mail, February 15, 1971. ———. “Things to Wear, Jump On, Touch, and Explore.” Oxford Mail, February 13, 1971. International Surrealist Bulletin 4 (1936). Irish, Sharon. “The Performance of Information Flows in the Art of Stephen Willats.” Information and Culture 47, no. 4 (2012): 457–86. Irvine, Jaki. “Rita Donagh.” Third Text 9, no. 31 (1995): 73–76. Jackson, Shannon. Professing Performance: Theatre in the Academy from Philology to Performativity. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2004.
James, N. P. Depart from Zero: The Development of the Gallery London, 1973–1978. London: The Gallery Trust, 1987. ———. Interviews-Artists: Patterns of Experience; Recordings, 1988–2011. London: Cv Publications / VAR Archive & Editions, 2012. ———. John Dugger: Ergonic Sculpture and Other Works. London: Cv Publications, 2011. ———. Scenes from The Gallery. London: Cv Publications, 2006. Johnson, Dominic, ed. Critical Live Art: Contemporary Histories of Performance in the UK. Abingdon, Oxon: Routledge, 2013. Jones, Amelia. Body Art / Performing the Subject. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 1998. Kardia, Peter, et al. From Floor to Sky: The Experience of the Art School Studio. London: A & C Black, 2010. Katz, Vincent, ed. Black Mountain College: Experiment in Art. Cambridge: MIT Press, 2013. Kearney, Patrick J. The Paris Olympia Press. London: Black Spring Press, 1987. Keeler, Paul. Planted: A Report of the Events Leading up to and Surrounding the Arrest and Committal to Be Tried Before a Judge and Jury of Three Members of the Exploding Galaxy Charged with Being in Possession of Dangerous Drugs. London: Exploding Galaxy, 1968. Kennedy, Garry Neill. The Last Art College: Nova Scotia College of Art and Design, 1968–1978. Cambridge: MIT Press, 2012. Kent, Sarah. “Rita Donagh.” In Hayward Annual ’78, exh. cat., 78–79. London: Hayward Gallery, 1978. Kester, Grant H. Conversation Pieces: Community and Communication in Modern Art. Berkeley: University of California Press, 2004. ———. The One and The Many: Contemporary Collaborative Art in a Global Context. Durham: Duke University Press, 2011. Kirby, Michael. Futurist Performance. Translated by Victoria Nes Kirby. New York: E. P. Dutton, 1971. Krauss, Sigi. There Was an Opening, the Carpet Was Squishy. London: MA Culture, Criticism and Curation, Central Saint Martins, 2014. Laing, R. D. The Politics of Experience and The Bird of Paradise. Harmondsworth: Pelican Books, 1967. Lampert, Catherine. “Rita Donagh.” Studio International 189, no. 975 (May–June 1975): 240–41. Larsen, Lars Bang, ed. Networks. Whitechapel Documents of Contemporary Art. Cambridge: MIT Press; London: Whitechapel Gallery, 2014.
207 Bibliography
Lee, Pamela M. Chronophobia: On Time in the Art of the 1960s. Cambridge: MIT Press, 2004. ———. New Games: Postmodernism After Contemporary Art. London: Routledge, 2013. Leggett, Mike, and John Hopkins. Chile Lucha. Video, 17 minutes, 1974. Limpkin, Clive. The Battle of Bogside. Harmondsworth: Penguin, 1972. Lippard, Lucy R. “Being in Place.” In The Lure of the Local: Senses of Place in a Multicentered Society, 32–37. New York: New Press, 1997. ———, ed. Pop Art. London: Thames & Hudson, 1966. ———. Six Years: The Dematerialization of the Art Object from 1966 to 1972. Berkeley: University of California Press, 1997. (Originally published New York: Praeger, 1973.) Llanos, Fernando, ed. Felipe Ehrenberg: Manchuria, visión periférica. México City: Editorial Diamantina, 2008. Logue, Christopher. Prince Charming: A Memoir. London: Faber & Faber, 1999. Lucie-Smith, Edward. Art in the Seventies. Oxford: Phaidon, 1980. Lütticken, Sven. “Living with Abstraction.” In Abstraction, Whitechapel Documents of Contemporary Art, edited by Maria Lind, 142–52. Cambridge: MIT Press; London: Whitechapel Gallery, 2013. Maharaj, Sarat. “Rita Donagh: Towards a Map of Her Artwork.” In Rita Donagh: 197419841994, exh. cat., edited by Stephen Snoddy, 9–16. Manchester: Cornerhouse, 1994. Mallen, George. “Bridging Computing in the Arts and Software Development.” In Brown et al., White Heat Cold Logic, 191–202. Marioni, Tom. Beer, Art, and Philosophy: A Memoir. San Francisco: Crown Point Press, 2003. Mark, Lisa Gabrielle, ed. Wack! Art and the Feminist Revolution. Los Angeles: Museum of Contemporary Art, 2007. Exh. cat. Martin, Courtney J. “Art World, Network, and Other Alloway Keywords.” Tate Papers 16 (Autumn 2011). Accessed January 15, 2015. http://www.tate.org.uk/research/ publications/tate-papers/art-world-network-an d-other-alloway-keywords. ———. “Rasheed Araeen, Live Art, and Radical Politics in Britain.” Getty Research Journal 2 (2010): 107–24. Martin, J. L., Ben Nicholson, and Naum Gabo, eds. Circle: International Survey of Constructive Art. 1937. Reprint, London: Faber & Faber, 1971.
Mason, Catherine. A Computer in the Art Room: The Origins of British Computer Arts, 1950–80. Hindrigham, Norfolk: JJG Publishing, 2008. Mathews, Stanley. From Agit-Prop to Free Space: The Architecture of Cedric Price. London: Black Dog, 2007. McCann, Eamonn. War and an Irish Town. New ed. London: Pluto Press, 1980. First ed., Harmondsworth: Penguin, 1974. McCaughan, Edward J. “Signs of the Times.” In Art and Social Movements: Cultural Politics in Mexico and Aztlán. Durham: Duke University Press, 2012. Kindle edition. McKenzie, Jon. Perform or Else: From Discipline to Performance. London: Routledge, 2001. McKittrick, David, and David McVea. Making Sense of the Troubles: A History of the Northern Ireland Conflict. Rev. ed. London: Viking, 2012. McLean, Bruce. “Not Even Crimble Crumble.” Studio International 180, no. 926 (October 1970): 156–59. McLuhan, Marshall. Understanding Media: The Extensions of Man. Cambridge: MIT Press, 1994. First ed., New York: McGraw-Hill, 1964. McShine, Kynaston L. Information. New York: Museum of Modern Art, 1970. Exh. cat. Medalla, David. “Paris—London: Memories of the Sixties.” AND Journal of Art and Education, no. 17 (1988): 8–17. Medina, Cuauhtémoc. “Publishing Circuits.” In La era de la discrepancia: Arte y cultural visual en México 1968–1997, 155–59. Mexico City: Turner / Universidad Nacional Autónoma de México, 2007. Mellor, David Alan. The Sixties Art Scene in London. London: Barbican Art Gallery, 1993. Exh. cat. Mellor, David Alan, and Laurent Gervereau, eds. The Sixties: Britain and France, 1962–1973, the Utopian Years. London: Philip Wilson, 1997. Exh. cat. Mercer, Kobena. “Black Atlantic Abstraction: Aubrey Williams and Frank Bowling.” In Discrepant Abstraction, edited by Kobena Mercer, 182–205. Cambridge: MIT Press; London: Institute of International Visual Arts, 2006. ———, ed. Cosmopolitan Modernisms. Cambridge: MIT Press; London: Institute of International Visual Arts, 2005. ———, ed. Pop Art and Vernacular Cultures. Cambridge: MIT Press; London: Institute of International Visual Arts, 2007. Meyer, James. Minimalism: Art and Polemics in the Sixties. New Haven: Yale University Press, 2001.
208 Bibliography
Meyers-Kingsley, Dara, and Chris Chang. Reel Work: Artists’ Film and Video of the 1970s. North Miami: Museum of Contemporary Art, 1996. Exh. cat. Miller, David. Don’t Mention the War: Northern Ireland, Propaganda, and the Media. London: Pluto Press, 1994. Morgan, Conway Lloyd. “Cognition and Control Project.” New Scientist 56, no. 817 (October 1972): 234. Morris, Catherine, and Vincent Bonin, eds. Materializing Six Years: Lucy R. Lippard and the Emergence of Conceptual Art. Cambridge: MIT Press; Brooklyn, N.Y.: Brooklyn Museum, 2012. Exh. cat. Morris, Lynda. Genuine Conceptualism. Ghent: Herbert Foundation, 2014. Mulholland, Neil. The Cultural Devolution: Art in Britain in the Late Twentieth Century. Aldershot: Ashgate, 2003. Mulvey, Laura. “Film, Feminism, and the Avant-Garde” (1978). In The British Avant-Garde Film, 1926 to 1995: An Anthology of Writings, edited by Michael O’Pray, 199–216. Luton: University of Luton, 1996. First published as “Feminism, Film, and the Avant-Garde” in Women Writing and Writing About Women, edited by Mary Jacobus. London: Croom Helm, 1979. ———. “Visual Pleasure and Narrative Cinema.” Screen 16, no. 3 (Autumn 1975): 6–18. Nairn, Tom. The Break-Up of Britain: Crisis and Neo-nationalism. 2nd, exp. ed. London: Verso, 1981. First ed., London: NLB, 1977. Nairne, Sandy, and Nicholas Serota, eds. British Sculpture in the Twentieth Century. London: Whitechapel Art Gallery, 1981. Naylor, Colin, and Genesis P-Orridge, eds. Contemporary Artists. London: St. James Press, 1977. Neate, Hannah. “Provinciality and the Art World: The Midland Group, 1961–1977.” Social and Cultural Geography 13, no. 3 (2012): 275–94. The New Art. London: Arts Council of Great Britain, Hayward Gallery, 1972. Exh. cat. The New Generation, 1965. London: Whitechapel Art Gallery, 1965. Exh. cat. “News and Notes.” Studio International 189, no. 975 (May–June 1975): 226–27. Newsheet 1. Gallery House (March 1973), n.p. Newsheet 2. Gallery House (May 1972), n.p. Nixon, Mignon. “‘Why Freud?’ Asked the Shrew: Psychoanalysis and Feminism, Post-partum Document, and the History Group.” Psychoanalysis, Culture, and Society 20, no. 2 (2015): 131–40.
Norse, Harald, Alexander Trocchi, and Robert Tasher. “Three Views on the Anti-university.” International Times 26 (February 16–29, 1968): 6. Nuttall, Jeff. Bomb Culture. London: MacGibbon & Kee, 1968. O’Brien, Sophie, and Melissa Larner, eds. Gustav Metzger: Decades, 1959–2009. London: Serpentine Gallery, 2009. Exh. cat. Osborne, Peter. Anywhere or Not at All: Philosophy of Contemporary Art. London: Verso, 2013. “Over-involved.” Birmingham Post, February 15, 1971. Overy, Paul. “Other Stories.” Art History 20, no. 3 (September 1997): 493–501. ———. “Pale Images.” Times (London), August 13, 1977, 12. Papastergiadis, Nikos. The Turbulence of Migration: Globalization, Deterritorialization, and Hybridity. Cambridge: Polity Press, 2000. Pas, Niek. “In Pursuit of the Invisible Revolution: Sigma in the Netherlands, 1966–1968.” In Between the Avant-Garde and the Everyday: Subversive Politics in Europe from 1957 to the Present, edited by Timothy Brown and Lorena Anton, 31–43. Oxford: Berghahn Books, 2011. Parker, Rozsika. “Arts Editorial.” Spare Rib, June 1973, 19–22. Parker, Rozsika, and Griselda Pollock, eds. Framing Feminism: Art and the Women’s Movement, 1970–85. London: Pandora, 1987. Peabody, Rebecca, ed. Anglo-American Exchange in Postwar Sculpture, 1945–1975. Los Angeles: Getty Publications, 2011. Phillpot, Clive, and Andrea Tarsia. Live in Your Head: Concept and Experiment in Britain, 1965–75. London: Whitechapel Art Gallery, 2000. Exh. cat. Pollock, Griselda. Differencing the Canon: Feminist Desire and the Writing of Art’s Histories. London: Routledge, 1999. ———. “Feminism, Femininity, and the Hayward Annual Exhibition 1978.” Feminist Review 2 (1979): 33–55. P-Orridge, Genesis. G.P.O. v. G.P-O.: A Chronicle of Mail Art on Trial. Toronto: Art Metropole, 2002. First published Geneva: Ecart Publications, 1976. ———. “Letters: COUM On.” Art Monthly, no. 295 (April 2006): 15. ———. Painful but Fabulous: The Lives and Art of Genesis P-Orridge. New York: Soft Skull, 2002. P-Orridge, Genesis, and Peter Christopherson. “COUM Transmissions: Annihilating Reality.” In Performance by Artists, edited by A. A. Bronson and Peggy Gale, 65–71. Toronto: Art Metropole, 1979.
209 Bibliography
Pratt, Mary Louise. “Arts of the Contact Zone.” Profession, 1991, 33–40. Proll, Astrid, ed. Goodbye to London: Radical Art and Politics in the 70’s. Ostfildern: Hatje Cantz, 2010. Exh. cat. “Questionnaire on ‘The Contemporary.’” October 130 (Fall 2009): 3–124. Rayns, Tony. “Directory of U.K. Independent Film-makers.” Cinema Rising, April 1972, 6. Rees, A. L. “Projecting Back: UK Film and Video Installation in the 1970s.” Millennium Film Journal 52 (2010): 57–71. Rees, A. L., Duncan White, Steven Ball, and David Curtis, eds. Expanded Cinema: Art, Performance, Film. London: Tate Publishing, 2011. Reichardt, Jasia, ed. Cybernetics, Art, and Ideas. London: Studio Vista, 1971. ———. Cybernetic Serendipity. London: Institute of Contemporary Arts, 1968. Exh. cat. ———. “‘Cybernetic Serendipity’—Getting Rid of preconceptions.” Studio International 176, no. 905 (November 1968): 176–77. Rewcastle, Martin, and Nicholas Serota. Art for Society: Contemporary British Art with a Social or Political Purpose. London: Whitechapel Art Gallery, 1978. Exh. cat. Reynolds, Lucy. “British Avant-Garde Women Filmmakers and Expanded Cinema of the 1970s.” Ph.D. diss., University of East London, 2009. ———. “Filmaktion: New Directions in Film Art.” In Centre of the Creative Universe: Liverpool and the Avant-Garde, edited by Christoph Grunenberg and Robert Knifton, 157–67. Liverpool: Liverpool University Press, 2007. ———. “Magic Tricks? The Use of Shadowplay in British Expanded Cinema.” In Rees et al., Expanded Cinema, 148–56. ———. “‘Non-institution’: Finding Expanded Cinema in the Terrains Vagues of 1960s London.” In Cinema in the Expanded Field, edited by François Bovier and Adeena Mey, 84–89. Lausanne: JRP Ringier / University of Art and Design Lausanne, 2016. Richardson, Gordon. “8 Young Sculptors at Stockwell Depot.” Studio International 176, no. 902 (July–August 1968): 36. Rita Donagh: Paintings and Drawings. Manchester: Whitworth Art Gallery, 1977. Exh. cat. Roberts, Eleanor. “Restless Images: The Feminist Performances of Rose Finn-Kelcey.” Oxford Art Journal 38, 3 (December 2015): 387–403.
Robertson, Geoffrey. Obscenity: An Account of Censorship Laws and Their Enforcement in England and Wales. London: Weidenfeld & Nicolson, 1979. Robinson, Julia, ed. New Realisms, 1957–1962: Object Strategies Between Readymade and Spectacle. Madrid: Museo Nacional Centro de Arte Reina Sofia; Cambridge: MIT Press, 2010. Exh. cat. Roms, Heike, and Rebecca Edwards. “Towards a Prehistory of Live Art in the UK.” Contemporary Theatre Review 22, no. 1 (February 2012): 17–31. Rorimer, Anne. New Art in the 60s and 70s: Redefining Reality. London: Thames & Hudson, 2001. Rosenberg, Jan. Women’s Reflections: The Feminist Film Movement. Ann Arbor: UMI Research Press, 1983. Rosenthal, Irving. Sheeper. New York: Grove Press, 1967. Rowe, Dorothy C. “Nonsynchronous Cartographies: Frank Bowling’s Map Paintings.” Small Axe 17, no. 2 (July 2013): 255–73. Salvadori, Marcello. “Fundamental Research at the Centre for Advanced Study of Science in Art.” Studio International 173, no. 890 (June 1967): 306–8. Sandbrook, Dominic. White Heat: A History of Britain in the Swinging Sixties, 1964–70. London: Abacus, 2007. Saunders, Graham. “The Freaks’ Roll Call: Live Art and the Arts Council, 1968–73.” Contemporary Theatre Review 22, no. 1 (February 2012): 32–45. Savage, Robert J. The BBC’s “Irish Troubles”: Television, Conflict, and Northern Ireland. Manchester: Manchester University Press, 2015. Schimmel, Paul, et al. Out of Actions: Between Performance and the Object, 1949–1979. Los Angeles: Museum of Contemporary Art; New York: Thames & Hudson, 1998. Exh. cat. Schneemann, Carolee. “Foreword: Live Art Performance Art Body Art.” In Johnson, Critical Live Art, 1–4. ———. More Than Meat Joy: Performance Works and Selected Writings. Edited by Bruce R. McPherson. Kingston, N.Y.: Documentext and McPherson, 1979. “Sculptors at Stockwell Depot.” Studio International 177, no. 907 (January 1969): 34–37. Seago, Alex. Burning the Box of Beautiful Things: The Development of a Postmodern Sensibility. Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1995. Seymour, Anne. “Gilbert & George.” In The New Art, 92–95.
210 Bibliography
Shanken, Edward A. “Art in the Information Age: Technology and Conceptual Art.” Leonardo 35, no. 4 (2002): 433–38. Sharp, Willoughby. Air Art. New York: Kineticism Press, 1968. Signals: Newsbulletin of Signals London 1, no. 5 (December 1964— January 1965). Signalz: Newsbulletin of the Centre for Advanced Creative Study 1, no. 1 (1964). Sleeman, Joy. “The New Art, Hayward Gallery, London, 1972: New as Compromise, or When What Happens Around the Exhibition Is as Interesting as What Happens in the Exhibition.” Sculpture Journal 21, no. 2 (2012): 63–74. Smyth, Cherry. “Rita Donagh.” Art Monthly 291 (November 2005): 24. Some 260 Miles from Here: Art from the Rhein-Ruhr Germany 1973. London: Gallery House, 1973. Exh. cat. Soto Laveaga, Gabriela. “Searching for Molecules, Fueling Rebellion: Echevarría’s ‘Arriba y Adelante’ Populism in Southeastern Mexico.” In Populism in Twentieth Century Mexico: The Presidencies of Lázaro Cárdenas and Luis Echevarría, edited by Amelia Marie Kiddle and María L. O. Muñoz, 87–105. Arizona: University of Arizona Press, 2010. Sparrow, Felicity. “Annabel Nicolson.” Luxonline profile. Accessed May 31, 2016. www.luxonline.org.uk/artists/annabel_nicolson/essay(1).html. Spencer, Robin, ed. Eduardo Paolozzi: Writings and Interviews. Oxford: Oxford University Press, 2000. Steiner, Rudolf. Macrocosm and Microcosm: Eleven Lectures Given in Vienna, 21st to 31st March 1910. Revised translation by D.S.O. and C.D. London: Rudolf Steiner Press, 1968. Stephens, Chris, and Katharine Stout. Art and the 60s: This Was Tomorrow. London: Tate Britain, 2004. Exh. cat. Stimson, Blake, and Gregory Sholette, eds. Collectivism After Modernism: The Art of Social Imagination After 1945. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 2007. “The Sun Says: Prostituting Britain” (editorial). Sun (United Kingdom), October 21, 1976, 2. Survey ’68: Abstract Sculpture. London: Camden Arts Centre, 1968. Exh. cat. Szeemann, Harald. Documenta 5: Befragung der Realität, Bildwelten heute. Kassel: Documenta-GmbH, 1972. Szulakowska, Ursula. “Rita Donagh.” Art Monthly 182 (December 1994–January 1995): 30–31. Thistlewood, David. A Continuing Process: The New Creativity in British Art Education, 1955–65. London: Institute of Contemporary Arts, 1981. Exh. cat.
———. Introduction to Histories of Art and Design Education: Cole to Coldstream, edited by David Thistlewood, 8–13. London: Longman in association with the National Society for Education and Design, 1992. Thoreau, Henry David. Walden, and Resistance to Civil Government. Edited by William Rossi. 2nd ed. New York: W. W. Norton, 1992. Tickner, Lisa. “The Body Politic: Female Sexuality and Women Artists Since 1970.” Art History 1, no. 2 (June 1978): 236–51. ———. “‘Export Britain’: Pop Art, Mass Culture, and the Export Drive.” Art History 35, no. 2 (April 2012): 394–419. ———. Hornsey 1968: The Art School Revolution. London: Frances Lincoln, 2008. ———. “The Kasmin Gallery.” Oxford Art Journal 30, no. 2 (2007): 233–68. ———. “One for Sorrow, Two for Mirth: The Performance Work of Rose Finn-Kelcey.” Oxford Art Journal 3, no. 1 (1980): 58–71. Tisdall, Caroline. “The Calm and Precision Is Interrupted by an Event from the Outside World. . . .” Guardian (Manchester), November 2, 1972, 10. ———. “Participation in Art.” Guardian (Manchester), February 16, 1971. ———. “Rita Donagh.” Studio International 193, no. 987 (1977): 193–94. Tobin, Amy. “I’ll Show You Mine, If You Show Me Yours: Collaboration, Consciousness-Raising, and Feminist-Influenced Art in the 1970s.” Tate Papers 25 (Spring 2016). Accessed June 2016. http://www.tate.org. uk/research/publications/tate-papers/25. Trocchi, Alexander. Cain’s Book. New York: Grove Press, 1960. ———. “sigma.” International Times 4 (November 28–December 11, 1966): 2. Tschumi, Bernard. “Questions of Space: The Pyramid and the Labyrinth (or the Architectural Paradox).” Studio International 190, no. 977 (September–October 1975): 137–42. Tufnell, Ben. “Colin Self and the Bomb.” In Stephens and Stout, Art and the 60s, 64–67. Turner, Alwyn W. Crisis? What Crisis? Britain in the 1970s. London: Aurum Press, 2008. Vázquez Mantecón, Alvaro. “Los Grupos: A Reconsideration.” In La era de la Discrepancia, arte y cultura visual en México 1968–1997, 197–99. México City: Turner / Universidad Nacional Autónoma de México, 2006.
211 Bibliography
Wainwright, Leon. “Frank Bowling and the Appetite for British Pop.” Third Text 22, no. 2 (March 2008): 195–208. ———. “Varieties of Belatedness and Provincialism: Decolonization and British Pop.” Art History 35, no. 2 (April 2012): 442–61. Walker, John A. John Latham: The Incidental Person—His Art and Ideas. London: Middlesex University Press, 1995. ———. Left Shift: Radical Art in 1970s Britain. London: I. B. Tauris, 2002. Wall Show. London: Lisson Publications, 1971. Exh. cat. Walmsley, Anne. The Caribbean Artists Movement, 1966–1972: A Literary and Cultural History. London: New Beacon Books, 1992. Wandor, Michelene, ed. The Body Politic: Writings from the Women’s Liberation Movement in Britain, 1969–1972. London: Stage 1, 1972. Watkins, Jonathan. “Back to the Black Country.” In Rita Donagh, exh. cat., 7–19. Birmingham: Ikon Gallery, 2005. Wees, William C. Vorticism and the English Avant-Garde. Toronto: University of Toronto Press, 1972. Wesker, Arnold. Fears of Fragmentation. London: Jonathan Cape, 1970. Wesley, Brian. “Show Shocks Even a Stripper.” Sun (United Kingdom), October 20, 1976, 20. Westley, Hester Ruth. “Traditions and Transitions: St Martin’s Sculpture Department, 1960–1979.” Ph.D. diss., Courtauld Institute of Art, University of London, 2007. White, Rupert. E-interview with Felipe Ehrenberg, Stuart Reid, and Barry McCallion on Fluxshoe. Artcornwell.org. Accessed September 18, 2014. http://artcornwall.org/interview_ fluxshoe_stuart%20reid_felipe_ehrenberg2.htm. Whitelegg, Isobel. “Signals Echoes Traces.” In Brett and Figueiredo, Oiticica in London, 89–92. Whiteley, Gillian. “Sewing the ‘Subversive Thread of Imagination’: Jeff Nuttall, Bomb Culture, and the Radical Potential of Affect.” The Sixties: A Journal of History, Politics, and Culture 4, no. 2 (2011): 109–33. Whiteley, Nigel. “‘Cultural Imperialism’? British Hard-Edge Painting in the 1960s.” Third Text 22, no. 2 (March 2008): 209–27. Willats, Stephen. The Artist as an Instigator of Changes in Social Cognition and Behaviour. London: Occasional Papers, 2011. First published London: Gallery House Press, 1973. ———. Artwork as Social Model: A Manual of Questions and Propositions. Sheffield: Research Group for Artists, 2012.
———. “Centre for Behavioural Art: Social Study Project No. 1.” Control 7 (1973): 2. ———. “Clothing as Artwork.” In Multiple Clothing: Designs, 1965–1999, 5–8. Cologne: Walther König, 2000. ———. “Cognition and Advertising.” In Casser and Ziegler, Stephen Willats: Art Society Feedback, 286–93. ———. “Edinburgh Project.” Art and Artists 8, no. 10 (January 1974): 6. ———. “It Came by Accident Like Everything Does” (Stephen Willats in conversation with Emily Pethick). In Cognition Control: From the Archive of Stephen Willats, exh. cat., n.p. Cambridge: Institute of Visual Culture, 2002. ———. “‘Stephen Willats: Visual Automatics and Visual Transmitters’ at the Museum of Modern Art, Oxford— to November 16.” Studio International 176, no. 905 (November 1968): 208. ———. “The West London Social Resource Project.” Studio International 185, no. 951 (January 1973): 25–26. ———. West London Social Resource Project Public Monitor. London: Chelsea Space, 2011. Exh. cat. William Tucker: Sculpture, 1970–73. London: Serpentine Gallery, 1973. Exh. cat. Wilson, Andrew. “Art:Politics / Theory:Practice: Radical Art Practices in London in the Seventies.” In Proll, Goodbye to London, 128–38. ———. “The Audience Is the Rationale.” In Casser and Ziegler, Stephen Willats: Art Society Feedback, 23–61. ———, ed. Conceptual Art in Britain, 1964–1979. London: Tate Britain, 2016. Exh. cat. ———. “Gustav Metzger’s Auto-Destructive/Auto-Creative Art.” Third Text 22, no. 2 (March 2008): 177–94. ———. “A Poetics of Dissent: Notes on a Developing Counterculture in London in the Early Sixties.” In Stephens and Stout, Art and the 60s, 92–111. ———. Richard Hamilton: Swingeing London 67 (f). London: Afterall Books; Cambridge: MIT Press, 2011.
212 Bibliography
———. “Spontaneous Underground: An Introduction to London Psychedelic Scenes, 1965–1968.” In Grunenberg and Harris, Summer of Love, 63–98. ———. “This Is Not an Advertisement: Notes on a Bookshop Manager at a Certain Time.” In Boooook: The Life and Work of Bob Cobbing, edited by William Cobbing and Rosie Cooper, 88–102. London: Occasional Papers, 2015. ———. “Towards an Index for Everything: The Events of Mark Boyle and Joan Hills, 1963–71.” In Boyle Family, exh. cat., by Patrick Elliott, Bill Hare, and Andrew Wilson, 45–59. Edinburgh: National Galleries of Scotland, 2003. Wilson, Siona. Art Labor, Sex Politics: Feminist Effects in 1970s British Art and Performance. Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press, 2015. ———. “Structures of Feeling: Yvonne Rainer Circa 1974.” October 152 (Spring 2015): 3–25. Wingler, Hans M. The Bauhaus: Weimar, Dessau, Berlin, Chicago. Translated by Wolfgang Jabs and Basil Gilbert, edited by Joseph Stein. Cambridge: MIT Press, 1969. Wood, Jon, ed. United Enemies: The Problem of Sculpture in Britain in the 1960s and 1970s. Leeds: Henry Moore Institute, 2011. Exh. cat. Wood, William. “Still You Ask for More: Demand, Display, and ‘The New Art.’” In Rewriting Conceptual Art, edited by Michael Newman and Jon Bird, 66–87. London: Reaktion, 1999. Yeomans, Richard. “The Foundation Course of Victor Pasmore and Richard Hamilton, 1954–1966.” Ph.D. diss., University of London, Institute of Education, 1987. Zacharea, Chryssa. “Roelof Louw: An Interview with Chryssa Zacharea.” Art and Artists 8, no. 11 (February 1974): 10–15. Zoller, Maxa. “Aural History: An Audio Documentary of the Early Years of the London Filmmaker’s Co-op, 1966–1968.” British Artists Film and Video Study Collection. Accessed 31 May 2016. www.studycollection.co.uk/auralhistory/ index.htm.
Jo Applin teaches modern and contemporary art at the Courtauld Institute of Art, London. She is the author of Eccentric Objects: Rethinking Sculpture in 1960s America (Yale University Press, 2012) and Yayoi Kusama: Infinity Mirror Room—Phalli’s Field (Afterall and MIT Press, 2012) and is currently completing Not Working: Lee Lozano Versus the Art World, 1961–1971 (Yale University Press), which was awarded the Suzanne and James Mellor Book Prize from the National Museum of Women in the Arts, Washington, D.C., in 2015. She is an editor of Oxford Art Journal. Elena Crippa joined Tate in 2014 as curator of modern and contemporary British art. Her role focuses on the research, display, exhibition, and acquisition of artworks from the period 1940–80. Her recent research has centered on interdisciplinarity and participation in the postwar period, the relationship between sculpture and performance art, and postwar figurative painting. For her doctorate research she participated in the Tate Research project Art School Educated (2009–13), investigating the relationship between new approaches to art teaching and art making as they emerged in the British art school in the 1950s–60s. Recent publications include Exhibition, Design, Participation: “An Exhibit” 1957 and Related Projects (Afterall, 2016); Elena Crippa and Catherine Lampert, London Calling: Bacon, Freud, Kossoff,
Andrews, Auerbach, and Kitaj (J. Paul Getty Museum, 2016); Anne Goodchild, Alastair Grieve, and Elena Crippa, Victor Pasmore: Towards a New Reality (Lund Humphries, 2016); and “1970s: Out of Sculpture,” in British Art Studies, no. 3 (2016). Antony Hudek is a curator and art historian. He is the director of the Curatorial Studies program at KASK School of Arts, Ghent, and a curator at the Museum of Contemporary Art Antwerp (M HKA). His research focuses on histories of art from the late 1950s to the present, particularly histories of exhibitions and exhibition sites in the United Kingdom. Hudek is also a cofounding director of Occasional Papers, a nonprofit press on art and design based in London. Dominic Johnson is a reader in performance and visual culture in the School of English and Drama at Queen Mary University of London. His research focuses on histories and theories of performance art after 1960. He is the author of Glorious Catastrophe: Jack Smith, Performance and Visual Culture (Manchester University Press, 2012), Theatre & the Visual (Palgrave Macmillan, 2012), and The Art of Living: An Oral History of Performance Art (Palgrave Macmillan, 2015). He is the editor of five books, including Pleading in the Blood: The Art and Performances of Ron Athey (Live Art Development
Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors Contributors
Agency and Intellect Books, 2013) and (with Deirdre Heddon) It’s All Allowed: The Performances of Adrian Howells (Live Art Development Agency and Intellect Books, 2016). He is also an editor of the journal Contemporary Theatre Review. Carmen Juliá is a curator at Spike Island, Bristol. She was previously an assistant curator at Tate, London, where she worked on the acquisition of contemporary British art from 1950 to the present. In 2014 she curated the Tate Britain Commission Phyllida Barlow: Dock. At Tate she curated numerous collection displays, including Anwar Shemza (2015) and Gallery One, New Vision Centre, Signals, Indica (2011). In 2013 she co-curated the exhibition Friends of London: Artists from Latin America in London 196X—197X at the David Roberts Foundation, London. She is the author of “Una vanguardia itinerante: Julio Plaza y el arte postal,” in Modernidad y vanguardia: Rutas de intercambio entre España y Latinoamérica (1920–1970) (Museo Nacional Centro de Arte Reina Sofía, 2015). Her research interests include the study of migrations and the challenges they bring to discourses of modernity. Courtney J. Martin is Deputy Director and Chief Curator of the Dia Art Foundation. Prior to Dia, she was an assistant professor in the Department of History of Art and Architecture at Brown University. An art historian of the modern and contemporary fields, her scholarship is concentrated in three areas: twentieth-century British art, sculpture studies, and the history of art criticism. She is co-editor of Lawrence Alloway: Critic and Curator (Getty Publications, 2015) and editor of Four Generations: The Joyner/ Giuffrida Collection of Abstract Art (Gregory R. Miller, 2016). The contemporary artists on whom she has written include Rasheed Araeen, Kader Attia, Asger Jorn, Lara Favaretto, Wangechi Mutu, Ed Ruscha, and Yinka Shonibare. In addition to her scholarship, she is also a curator. In 2012 she curated Drop, Roll, Slide, Drip . . . Frank Bowling’s Poured Paintings 1973–1978 at Tate Britain. In 2014, she co-curated the group exhibition Minimal Baroque: Post-Minimalism and Contemporary Art, at Rønnebæksholm in Denmark. In 2015 she curated Robert Ryman for the Dia Art Foundation. Lucy Reynolds has lectured and published extensively, most particularly focused on questions of the moving image, feminism, political space, and collective practice. She is a senior lecturer in the School of Media, Arts, and Design at Westminster University. Her articles have appeared in a range of journals, such as Afterall, Moving Image Review and Art Journal, Screen, and Screendance.
214 Contributors
Publications include “Controlling Agent: Artist and Spectator in the Film Actions of Gill Eatherley and Annabel Nicolson,” in Exhibiting the Moving Image: History Revisited, ed. François Bovier and Adeena Mey (JRP Ringier, 2015); “A Collective Response: Feminism, Film, Performance, and Greenham Common,” Moving Image Review and Art Journal 4 (March 2016); and “Ballet Black and Borderline: Stephen Dwoskin and the Advocacy of Difference,” in “The Stephen Dwoskin Dossier,” special issue, Screen 57 (April 2016). She writes for Art Agenda and Millennium Film Journal and has curated exhibitions and film programs for a range of institutions from Tate and M HKA, Antwerp, to the ICA and the South London Gallery. Joy Sleeman is a reader in art history and theory at UCL Slade School of Fine Art. Her research is focused on the histories of sculpture and landscape, especially land art in the 1960s and 1970s, and she has published widely on this subject. Together with Nicholas Alfrey and Ben Tufnell, she co-curated the most comprehensive exhibition of British land art to date, Uncommon Ground: Land Art in Britain 1966–1979, for the Arts Council Collection and Hayward Touring. It toured to four U.K. venues in 2013–14. She is the author of a book on the sculpture of Roelof Louw (Ridinghouse) and advisor and contributor to the catalogue of an exhibition on David Lamelas at the University Art Museum at California State University, Long Beach. Catherine Spencer is a lecturer in the School of Art History at the University of St. Andrews. Her research and teaching focus primarily on performance art since 1960, particularly in Europe, North America, and Latin America, but also encompass abstraction. Her writing has appeared in Art History, Tate Papers, and British Art Studies; publications include “A Calendar of Happenings: Allan Kaprow, Counter-Chronologies and Cataloguing Performance, c. 1970,” Art History 41 (June 2016); a chapter on the artist Marta Minujín in Sabotage Art: Politics and Iconoclasm in Contemporary Latin America, ed. Sophie Halart and Mara Polgovsky Ezcurra (I. B. Tauris, 2016); and an essay on the British painter Prunella Clough in British Art in the Nuclear Age, ed. Catherine Jolivette (Ashgate, 2014), which was the winner of the 2016 Historians of British Art Book Award for an Exemplary Multi-authored Book. Amy Tobin is an associate lecturer in the Department of Art at Goldsmiths College, London. Her research is concerned with the intersections between art, feminism, and theory, with a particular
focus on artists working in Britain and America in the 1970s. Publications include 14 Radnor Terrace: A Woman’s Place (Raven Row, 2017); an essay in Jo Spence: The Final Project (Ridinghouse, 2012); a co-authored chapter on feminist artists’ organizing in Collaboration and Its (Dis)Contents: Collaborative Practices in Art, Architecture, and Film Since 1910, ed. Meredith A. Brown and Michelle Millar Fisher (Courtauld Books Online, 2017); and a chapter in Other Cinemas: Politics, Culture, and Experimental Film in the 1970s, ed. Sue Clayton and Laura Mulvey (I. B. Tauris, 2017). Her writing has also appeared in Feminist Review, MIRAJ, British Art Studies, and Tate Papers. She was a co-organizer of the Now You Can Go program on Italian feminisms (2015) and has also advised on the exhibitions Of Other Spaces: When Gesture Becomes Event at Cooper Gallery, Dundee (2016–17) and 56 Artillery Lane at Raven Row, London (2017). Isobel Whitelegg is a lecturer in Art Museum and Gallery Studies at the University of Leicester. Before this she was LJMU Research Curator within the Tate Research Centre: Curatorial Practice and Museology (2014–15) and head of Nottingham Contemporary’s Public Programme (2011–14), a leading platform for the public debate of ideas and practices relevant to contemporary art and its institutions. She specialized in Latin American art at the University of Essex, where she completed a Ph.D. on Mira Schendel and her critical milieu, and has subsequently published widely on the international reception of art from Latin America.
215 Contributors
Andrew Wilson is a senior curator of modern and contemporary British art and archives at Tate. Over the past twenty-five years his research has focused on postwar art and culture, often with a specific emphasis on wider countercultures through the 1960s, 1970s, and 1980s and the development of conceptual art in the 1960s and early 1970s. He is the author of Richard Hamilton: Swingeing London 67 (f) (Afterall, 2011), and his essays have been published widely in books and exhibition catalogues, including “Engaging Thought and Action: Notes on the Work of Ivor Davies,” in Silent Explosion: Ivor Davies and Destruction in Art (Occasional Papers, 2016); “Stephen Willats: Work, 1962–1969,” in Stephen Willats (Raven Row, 2014); and “Art:Politics / Theory:Practice: Radical Art Practices in London in the Seventies,” in Goodbye to London: Radical Art and Politics in the 70’s, ed. Astrid Proll (Hatje Cantz, 2010). In 2016 he curated the major exhibition Conceptual Art in Britain, 1964–1979 at Tate Britain and edited the accompanying catalogue, and has more recently co-curated the retrospective exhibition David Hockney for Tate Britain, touring to the Centre Pompidou, Paris, and the Metropolitan Museum of Art, New York (2017–18).
Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index Index
Page numbers in italics refer to illustrations. Abstract Expressionism, 29, 31, 171 abstraction as art style, 119, 120–22, 125, 129–30 feminism as influence on, 129–30 film-performances emphasizing, 141 gallery specialty, 6 modernism and counterculture symbolism of, 8 Acme, 7 Air Art (exhibition), 113n26 Alcaraz, Rodolfo “Laus” social protest workshops founded by, 66 Tube-O-Nauts’ Travels, a Voyage Under London, photograps for Ehrenberg, 61, 62, 63 Alexander, Sally, 134 Allende, Hortensia Bussi, 110 Allende, Salvador, 10, 74n17, 110, 114n29 Alley, Ronald, 65, 107 Alloway, Lawrence, 2, 9, 18n6, 97 Alston, Richard, 140 The Amazing Equal Pay Show (film), 149n2 Amman, Jean-Christophe, 103, 191 analytical art, 47–48, 122, 125 Analytical Art (journal), 47 Andre, Carl Equivalent VIII museum acquisition, 184, 196 exhibition protests, 103 festivals organized by, 114n37 Anju (Nicolson), 141 Annesley, David, 81
Antepartum (Kelly), 134 Anthology Film Archives, 144 “Anthony Caro’s Work: A Symposium by Four Sculptors,” 81 anti-art movement coalitions for, 9, 13, 63, 65, 163 festivals for, 63, 65 gallery demonstrations supporting, 9, 13, 64, 65, 66 mail art and, 185, 195 purpose, 8 symposiums for, 63, 89 anti-London activism, 70 Antiuniversity, 162, 167n42 antiwar activism, 10, 34, 98, 107, 109, 122 APG (Artist Placement Group), 42 Araeen, Rasheed, 5, 109, 110 Archer, Michael, 88 Architectural Association, 113n23, 176 Argentine art, 58 Art and Artists (journal), 147, 148 Artaud, Antonin, 155, 156 art education, 42, 122, 170–76, 171 Arte Povera, 101 Art for Society (exhibition), 127 Artforum (journal), 92, 97, 103, 191 art history education reform, 170 The Artist as an Instigator of Changes in Social Cognition and Behaviour (exhibition), 45, 46 The Artist as an Instigator of Changes in Social Cognition and Behaviour (publication), 41, 52n4
Artist Placement Group (APG), 42 Artists for Democracy (AFD) demonstrations, 15, 16, 110 founding and mission, 13, 35, 57, 109 fundraising part-art exhibitions and events, 109–10 influence of, 114n42 “Artists in Revolt” (Brett), 1, 8 artists’ rights activism, 13, 15, 56, 65–66, 103, 139–40 Artists’ Union, 5–6, 42, 133–34, 148, 149n2 Art & Language conferences organized by, 175 descriptions, 39, 47, 48, 52n6 exhibitions, 43, 47 founding, 47 Index 02, 92 publications of, 47 Art Meeting Place, 7, 57 Arts Council, 5, 191 Arts Council Gallery, 132n62 Arts Festival for Democracy in Chile, 97, 109–11, 110, 114n40 Arts Lab. See also New Arts Lab as alternative exhibition space, 57 designers of, 80 founding, 7 influence of, 7, 80–81, 137, 144 locations, 80, 81 music rehearsals at, 81 sculptural installations at, 77–78, 79, 88, 89–91 Art Spectrum London (exhibition), 5–6, 6, 8, 15 Art Strike, 9, 65 Art Systems in Latin America (exhibition), 58 Art Workers’ Coalition, 6, 65 Arzner, Dorothy, 134 Ascott, Roy, 42, 50 Ashmolean Museum, 22 Ashton, Dore, 31, 114n37 As Is When series (Paolozzi), 2 Atkinson, Conrad artist-political group memberships, 114n34 artists’ rights and inclusion, 19n20 censorship of artworks of, 127 Northern Ireland 1968–May Day 1975, 131n5 Silver Liberties, 127, 128 student advising at Slade, 175 Atkinson, Terry, 47 “Authentic Paranoiac Phantom” (Dalí lecture), 169 Auto-Destructive Art (Metzger), 9, 63, 65, 174
217 Index
Bainbridge, David, 47 Baldwin, Michael, 47, 53n44 banners, 15, 16, 17, 56, 57, 104, 107, 109–11 Barboza, Diego Centipede, 74n16 diaspora community, 57 influences on, 58 Baro, Gene, 18n1, 82 Basic Design (art education curriculum), 122, 171 Bates, Roger, 90 The Battle of Bogside (Limpkin), 126, 127, 128 Bauhaus, 170–71 Baxter, Iain and Ingrid, 43 Bean, Anne, 129 Beau Geste Press, 4, 12, 13, 71–72 Beckett, Andy, 117 behaviorism, 39, 47, 48, 50. See also Centre for Behavioural Art Behavioural Treasure Hunt (D. Martin and Shotbolt), 53n42 Béjar, Feliciano, 56 Berke, Joseph, 156, 157, 162, 167n42 Berman, Wallace, 153 Better Books, 7, 161, 167n50 Beuys, Joseph Boxing Match for Direct Democracy, 102 Bureau for Direct Democracy, 102 exhibitions featuring, 4, 102 Big Breather (APG/Latham, et al.), 42 Bill, Max, 26 biomasses, 97, 99–100, 104, 110–11 Biomass Installation (Dugger), 99–101, 100 Bishop, Claire, 91, 107 Black Manifesto (Araeen), 19n18 Black Mountain College, 156 Bloodstains (Donagh), 123, 123–24 Blood Work Diary (Schneemann), 146 Bloody Sunday, 1–2, 127–28 Bode, Arnold, 103 body art, 58–61, 85, 99–100, 139, 145–46, 179. See also performance art Bomb Culture (Nuttall), 161 Boty, Pauline, 2 Bourdieu, Pierre, 3 Bowie, David, 81 Boxing Match for Direct Democracy (Beuys), 102 Boyle, Mark, 175, 192 Bracewell, Michael, 125 Braden, Su, 15, 107, 110, 114n34
Brasilia: Photographs and a Model of the New Capital of Brazil (exhibition), 27, 37n17 Brazilian art and artists, 25, 26–29, 35 Breakwell, Ian, 191, 194 Brener, Roland, 81, 83, 85 Breton, André, 154 Brett, Guy artist collective memberships, 98 artist-political group memberships, 13, 35, 109 associates, 109 Brazil visits, 35 on British aversion to North American art, 29 Caracas University City model, 35 exhibition reviews, 1, 8 exhibitions organized by, 73–74n15 gallery-forum memberships, 22, 25 on gender and artist identities, 142 on London art scene, 17, 57 Briers, David, 48 Brisley, Stuart art museum demonstrations at Tate Gallery, 9, 64, 65 associates, 63 exhibitions, 7, 41, 42, 73n15 galleries representing, 7 student advising and speaker-performer invitations, 174 union memberships, 42 British Sculpture out of the Sixties (exhibition), 1, 8, 82, 83, 92 Brooks, Rosetta biographical information, 41 book production and publications, 52n4 exhibitions organized by, 44, 47–48, 147 gallery employment, 41 as Willats’s Super Girl project assistant, 44, 45 Bruce, Jill, 191 Buchloh, Benjamin H.D, 48 The Building (Potter), 137–39, 138 “BUNK” (Paolozzi lecture), 169 Bureau for Direct Democracy (Beuys), 102 Buren, Daniel, 175, 177 Burgin, Victor, 47, 48, 53n52, 54n74 Burnham, Jack, 9 Burroughs, William, 153–54, 156, 162 Burrows, Mick: Mass Media People, 53n42 Butler, Bill, 167n50 CACS (Centre for Advanced Creative Study), 22, 27, 31. See also Signals London
218 Index
Cadere, André, 175 Cain’s Book (Trocchi), 153, 155 Calder, John, 153 Callaghan, James, 9 Camargo, Sergio de, 7, 25–26 Camden Arts Centre, 47, 57, 58, 90, 101 Camden Arts Festival, 57, 74n16, 101, 113n23 Campbell, Duncan, 191, 194 Canalization of Psychic Energy (Biomass Installation) (Dugger), 99–101, 100 Caracas University City, 27, 35 Car Bomb (Donagh), 125, 126–27 Carey, Peter, 47 Caribbean Artists Movement, 5 Caro, Anthony, 18n1, 81, 83, 171 cartography, 120–22, 125, 128–29, 130 Cartwright, Lisa, 139 CASSA (Centre for Advanced Study of Science in Art), 33–34 Castells, Manuel, 8–9 Cat’s Cradle (Tucker), 84–85 CAVS (Center for Advanced Visual Studies, MIT), 31, 33, 34 CBA. See Centre for Behavioural Art Celant, Germano, 175 Celebration? Realife (Chaimowicz), 41 censorship, 41, 117–18, 126–27, 183, 187–97 Center for Advanced Visual Studies (CAVS, MIT), 31, 33, 34 Centipede (Barboza), 74n16 Centre 42, 161, 167n47 Centre for Advanced Creative Study (CACS), 22, 27, 31. See also Signals London Centre for Advanced Study of Science in Art (CASSA), 33–34 Centre for Behavioural Art (CBA/Willats) closure, 50–51 description and function, 12, 15–16, 39–44, 47, 50, 51 founding, 12, 39 lecture series and presentations at, 40, 44–45, 50, 51 location, 39, 40, 42, 51 Lole’s documentation displays at, 47 name selection, 51 philosophies and policies, 42–43 project assistants at, 44, 45 publications associated with, 41 social projects of: Cognition Control, 41, 45–47, 50, 52n39, 53n42; Man from the Twenty-first Century, 50; Oxford Insight Development Project, 44, 52n39; Social Resource Project for Munich Olympics (unrealized), 52–53n40; Social Resource Project for Tennis Clubs, 53n42; Survey of
Distance Models of Art, 48–49, 49; Visual Meta Language Simulation, 52n39; West London Manual, 44; West London Re-Modelling Book, 44; West London Social Resource Project, 44–45, 45 Centro de Arte y Comunicación, Buenos Aires, 58 “Ceremonial Address to the American Academy of Arts & Letters” (Mumford), 34 Chaimowicz, Marc Camille Celebration? Realife, 41 exhibitions, 7, 41, 42, 52n13, 73n15 Mail Action invitation recipient, 191 speaker-performances and seminars of, 175 union membership, 42 Chang, Jiat-Hwee, 111 Chaplin, Stephen, 171 Chile artist exiles from, 10, 57, 109 artist organizations supporting, 35, 97, 109–10, 114n34, 114n36 exhibitions on political unrest in, 15, 109, 114n37 festival fundraising for, 109–10 politics, 10, 57 publishing collaborations with artists from, 71 Chile Solidarity Campaign, 15, 109, 114n36 Chile Vencera Banner (Dugger), 15, 16, 110 Chile Working Committee, 114n34 China, 104, 109 Christopherson, Peter, 193, 198n1 Chromoproject (Ehrenberg), 74n16 Chronophobia: On Time in the Art of the 1960s (Lee), 23–24, 26, 29 CinemaAction, 136 Cinema Rising (journal), 134–36, 135 Circle: International Survey of Contemporary Art (publication), 23 Circles (film-and-video-distribution collective), 148 circulation and distribution. See also mail art; specific titles of periodicals art activism and themes of, 14 periodicals for networking, 12, 13, 14, 25, 39–41, 46, 47, 58, 71 The Citizen (Hamilton), 132n44 Citizens for Artists Association, 65 The City and the Grassroots (Castells), 8 civil disobedience, 123–25. See also Northern Ireland Civil Disobedience (Thoreau), 125 Clark, Lygia art philosophies, 98 associates, 25, 98 Dialogue of Hands, 24 exhibitions, 25, 26
219 Index
Clarke, John, 167n50 Cleave, Maureen, 184 Cluett, Shelagh (Super Girl), 44, 45 Cobbing, Bob, 7, 161, 167n50, 168n61 Cognition Control (CBA/Willats), 41, 45–47, 50, 52n39, 53n42 Combines (Potter), 137, 140 commercialization, 8, 63, 65 Compton, Michael, 65 Computer Arts Society, 50, 53n66 “Conceptual Art, 1962–1969” (Buchloh), 48 “The Concerns of Emerging Sculptors” (Brener), 83 Concrete Art—50 Years of Development (exhibition), 26 Conference à la Sorbonne (Klein lecture), 175 conferenza, 169 conflictedness, 24, 34, 36 Confrontación (exhibition), 56 Conn, Peter, 66–67 Consejo Nacional de Huelga (National Strike Council), 73n3 Conservative Party, 9, 66 Contemporary Artists (P-Orridge and Naylor), 190 The Context of Art: The Art of Context (project), 92, 93n41 Control (magazine), 13, 39–41, 43, 50 controversies exhibition content, 127, 183–84, 184, 197–98 mail art, 15, 183, 187–88, 190–97 museum acquisitions, 184, 196 performance art, 187 Cooper, David, 157, 167n42 Cooper, Lindsay, 148 Cork, Richard, 169–70, 184, 191, 193 Cornish, Sam, 90 Cornock, Stroud: Mind Rover, with Edmonds, 53n42 El Corno Emplumado (magazine), 71 Cosey Fanni Tutti, 183–84, 187, 191, 193, 194, 197 “cosmonaut of inner space,” 154 COUM Transmissions. See also P-Orridge, Genesis, Cosey Fanni Tutti authorship controversies, 184 exhibitions of, controversial, 183–84, 197–98 founding and purpose, 183, 184–85 language style of, 198n7 Magazine Actions, 184 mail art projects of, 188–90, 189 Omissions (Kleiinie Spielinie), 186, 187 performance art of, descriptions and themes, 187 performance art statements, 185 Prostitution, 183–84, 197–98
COUM Transmissions (continued) publicity strategies, 187 relocation and studio space, 184–85 speaker-performer events featuring, 177 Craddock, Sacha, 129 Crane Ballet (Maler), 74n16 criticism, group (“crits”), 170–72, 173 Crosby, Caresse, 31 Cruz-Diez, Carlos, 25–26 Cummings, Constance, 111 Currell-Brown, Peter, 157, 161 Curtis, Liz, 117 cybernetics, 39, 40, 47, 48, 50 Cybernetic Serendipity (exhibition), 50 Dalí, Salvador, 169 dance, 139, 140 A Date with Fate at the Tate, or Tate Bait (artist demonstration), 9, 13, 64, 65, 66 David Bowie Is (exhibition), 81 Davies, Siobhan, 140 Debord, Guy, 151, 153, 154, 156, 165–66n19, 165n16 decentralization, 70 decolonization, 4–5, 119, 128–29. See also Northern Ireland dégagement, 152 dematerialization, 23, 40, 82, 154, 155, 185 dérives theory, 61, 156 Destruction in Art Symposium, 7, 63, 65, 89 Dialectics of Liberation conference, 146, 167n42 Dialogue of Hands (Clark), 24 diaspora antiwar and draft dodging, 10, 98 displacement experiences as artistic influence, 4–5, 10, 55–58, 145 isolation and, 146 space and location themes, 83–87, 88 walking as art form and location immersion, 61 Díaz Ordaz, Gustavo, 55, 75n56 Dipper, Andrew, 42 Directions in Kinetic Sculpture (exhibition), 34 “Directory of U.K. Independent Film-makers” (Cinema Rising), 134–36, 135 “Discussion on Art and Its Social Function” (CBA event), 51 Dixon, Paul, 128 documenta 5 (exhibition) artists’ rights protests against, 103 collective vs. single artist authorship, 107–8
220 Index
curators and curatorial style of, 13, 95, 102, 103 event description and function, 104 garden installation plans, 102 inflatable installations at, 97, 106, 107 inside/outside architectural installations, 102 legacy of, 95 participation architectural installations, 95–96, 96, 103–8, 105, 106 performative sculpture installations, 103 political activist installations, 102 reviews of, 97 Documento Trimestral (DT: Delirium Tremens), 58 Dombois, Lorenz: Pavilion Dugger (a.k.a. People’s Participation Pavilion) architectural plans, with Dugger, 104, 105 Donagh, Rita biographical information, 131n10 Bloodstains, 123, 123–24 Car Bomb, 125, 126–27 Evening Papers (Ulster 1972–1974), 115, 116, 117, 119, 125, 127–29 exhibitions, 125–26, 131n17, 131n30, 132n54 First Perspective, 123 influences and themes, 13, 115, 117–18, 119, 120, 122, 129–30 “...morning workers pass...,” 131n19 Reflection on Three Weeks in May 1970, 118, 119–23, 124 Shadow of Six Counties, 130 “taking the trouble to sound it,” 120–21, 121 teaching positions, 119, 131n36 White Room, 123 White Studio, 123 Doré Gallery, 169 Dorfman, Ariel, 111 Dream Table (Poems) (McClure), 156, 166n37 “Drugs of the Mind” (Trocchi), 165n13 Duchamp, Marcel, 22, 23, 190 Dugger, John artist collective memberships, 98, 107 artist-political group memberships, 13, 35, 57, 108–9, 109 Arts Festival for Democracy in Chile installation, 97, 110, 110–11 associates, 98, 109 biographical information, 98 Biomass Installation (or Canalization of Psychic Energy), 99–101, 100 Chile Vencera Banner, 15, 16, 110 China trip, 108 gallery venues, 52n13 The Great Martial Arts Banner (Wu Shu Kwan), 15, 17 An Inch of Earth is an Inch of Gold—U.S. Aggressors Get out of Indo-China, 113n22
influences on, 98 Landscape Hats, 113n22 Let a Hundred Flowers Blossom, 113n22 The Masses Have Boundless Creative Power–Mao Tsetung, 113n22 Microcosm, 97, 101–2 People’s Participation Pavilion (Pavilion Dugger), 95–96, 96, 103–8, 105, 106 Prismatic Conversation in Silver Space, 113n22 Rains Retreat, 102, 104 Singing in the Body Electric, 113n22 Snake Pit, 113n22 The Snake Pit for Art Critics, 102 Socialist Art Through Socialist Revolution, 113n22 Victory to the Just Struggle of the People’s Movement for the Liberation of Angola–M.P.L.A.!, 113n22 Dunford, Mike, 137 Dunn, Nell, 137 Dwoskin, Steven, 147 Dye, David, 175 Ealing College of Art, 42 Earth Day, 63 Echevarría, Luis, 70–71 Edelstam, Gustav Harald, 110 Eden (Oiticica), 73–74n15 Edinburgh Festival, 4, 153, 166n22 Edinburgh Film Festival, 134 Edinburgh International Writer’s Conference, 151, 153–54 Edinburgh Social Model Construction Project (Willats), 50, 51 Edmonds, Ernest, Mind Rover, with Cornock, 53n42 Ehrenberg, Felipe art demonstrations at Tate Gallery, 9, 13, 64, 65, 66 art education, 56, 63 art philosophies, 61, 63, 67, 72 art themes, 57, 66, 70 associates, 63 Chromoproject, 74n16 diaspora and exile experiences, 55–57, 58, 71, 72 exhibition catalogues designed by, 74n52 exhibitions, 12, 56, 73–74n15 influences on, 61 lecture-performances of, 56 Obra secretamente titulada Arriba y Adelante...y si no, pos también, 70–71 political campaigns of, 74n29 political movement associations, 56, 72 Polygonal Workshop, 66–70, 68, 69
221 Index
publications of, 58 publishing presses founded by, 4, 12, 71 A Stroll in July, or One Thursday Afternoon, or Half Day in London, or (The) Afternoon, or ...Topology of Sculpture, 58–60, 59, 60 Tube-O-Nauts’ Travels, a Voyage Under London, 61, 62, 63 Electric Theatre (exhibition), 53n61 elitism, 65–66, 172, 173 Elizabeth, Queen of England, 188, 189 Elwes, Catherine, 148, 178 English, Rose, 148 Environments Reversal (exhibition), 73n15 Equivalent VIII (Andre), 184, 196 Ergonic sculptures, 99 Escuela Mexicana de Pintura, 56 Escuela Nacional de Pintura, 73n3 Escultura y Grabado, 73n3 Essay: Revolt (McClure), 156, 166–67n37 Esterson, Aaron, 157, 167n42 Evening Papers (Ulster 1972–1974) (Donagh), 115, 116, 117, 119, 125, 127–29 Eventstructure Research Group, 42 Everything’s Gonna Be Alright (Schwartz/Ess), 144 Evison, David, 81, 83, 85 (r)evolt, 155, 163, 164n2 exclusion, 13, 15, 56, 65–66, 139–40 Exercises 3 (Louw), 86 existentialism, 151 exoticism, 108, 111, 112 Experiments in Art and Technology, 33 Exploding Galaxy, 7, 98 Exposición Solar (exhibition), 73n6 Fairbairn, Nicholas, 198 feminism. See also filmmaking, women’s experimental abstraction as concept of, 129 anti-sexism art themes, 112 as artistic influence, 119, 129–30 association avoidance, 139–40, 148, 149, 150 collective practices and purpose, 133–34 early dialogue on art and, 142 equal representation activism, 65 exhibitions influencing women’s art, 5–6 exhibitions with women artist majority and media response, 132n73 speaker-performances and gender roles, 176 speaker-performances of women artists, 177–78, 179 women artist identities, 140, 142, 144, 148, 149, 150
Feminist Art News (journal), 148 Feministo (event), 7 Fer, Briony, 121 Ferus Gallery, 153 Festival of Auto-Destructive Art, 63, 65 Festival of Life (Alexandra Park), 57, 74n16 festivals anti-art, 63, 65 for artistic experimentation and collaboration, 57, 74n16, 101, 113n23 Chilean democracy activism, 97, 109–11, 110, 114n40 Field, Simon, 136 “Film, Feminism, and the Avant-Garde” (Mulvey), 150n26 filmmaking. See also filmmaking, women’s experimental collectives for, 137, 140, 141, 142, 144 directories for independent, 134–36, 135 independent, definition, 135 structural/formal, 141 filmmaking, women’s experimental American influences on, 145, 147 collective and collaborative practices, 134, 137, 140, 141, 142, 144, 146 with dance/performance art, 140 early feminist discourses in, 14, 134 feminism and identity conflicts, 140, 142, 144, 148, 149, 150 in independent filmmaking directories, 134–36, 135 with performance art, 137–38 sexism and critical response, 139–40, 146 women-centered festival events, 134 Finn-Kelcey, Rose collective memberships, 178 Here Is a Gale Warning, 5, 6, 15 speaker-performances of, 178 I Salón Independiente (exhibition), 56 First Perspective (Donagh), 123 Fischer, Konrad, 103 Fishbone, Doug: 30,000 Bananas, 93n28 Five Car Stud (Kienholz), 103 flags, 5, 6, 15 Flanagan, Barry, 47, 81, 93n32 Flat Time House, 19n30 Floe, Hilary, 100–101 Fluxshoe (exhibition), 12, 65 Fluxus Happenings, 56, 69–70 Fonoroff, Nina, 139 Forbes, Bryan, 167n50 Ford, Simon, 195
222 Index
Forge, Andrew, 84 formalism, 48, 139, 141 forums, 171–72 Foulkes, Glyn, 90 Frameworks (journal), 46, 47 Framing Feminism (Parker and Pollock), 133 Free University, 162, 167n42, 168n56 Frente Mexicano de Grupos Trabajadores de la Cultura Mexicana, 72 Freud, Sigmund, 134 Friedman, Ken, 74n52 From Figuration Art to Systems Art in Argentina (exhibition), 58 Fruitmarket, 4 Fun Palace (Littlewood and Price), 156 Fuses (Schneemann), 145, 146, 177 “Futurist Speech to the English” (Marinetti), 169 Gablik, Suzi, 124 Gabo, Naum, 22, 37n5 Galerie Denise René, 22, 25 Galerie Iris Clert, 25 Gallard, Madeleine, 71 The Gallery, 125–26 Gallery House behavioural art centers located at, 39, 40, 41, 42, 51 closure of, 50 description, 41 exhibitions at, 41–42, 44, 45, 47–48, 147–48 exhibition specialties, 7, 48 founding, 7, 41, 113n19 lecturers at, 46, 47 philosophies and policies, 41, 42 publication presses of, 41, 52n4 publications of, 42 Gallery House Press, 41, 52n4 Gallery One, 7, 33 Garbage Walk (Polygonal Workshop), 66–70, 68, 69 gender, 44, 113n21, 176, 179. See also feminism; sexism General Post Office v. Genesis P-Orridge (G.P.O v. G.P-O.), 183, 187–88, 190–97, 193 genius loci, 86–87 “Genuine” Conceptualism, 40 Gidal, Peter, 136, 150n25 The Gift (Mauss), 90 Gilbert & George exhibitions, 47 gallery representation, 131n17
Interview Sculpture (or Sculpture in the 60s, Impresarios of the Art World), 173 “Laws of Sculpture,” 172–73 Singing Sculpture (or Our New Sculpture), 172 Underneath the Arches, 172, 174, 180n24 Gina (Schwartz/Ess), 144 Ginsberg, Allen, 146, 162, 163, 168n62 Glassner, Verina, 144 Glusberg, Jorge, 58 Godfrey, Mark, 124–25 Godwin, Tony, 167n50 Goeritz, Matthias, 25, 56 Goldberg, RoseLee, 114n34, 175–76 Gold Diggers (Potter), 148 González-Torres, Félix: Untitled (Portrait of Ross in L.A.), 91 Gooding, Mel, 172 Goodrich, Ian, 188 Gosford, Charles, 19n20 G.P.O. v. G.P.-O.: A Chronicle of Mail Art on Trial (P-Orridge publication), 189, 193, 194 G.P.O. v. G.P-O. (General Post Office v. Genesis P-Orridge), 183, 187–88, 190–97, 193 Graham, Dan, 113n27 GRAV (Groupe de Recherce d’Art Visuel), 29 The Great Martial Arts Banner (Wu Shu Kwan) (Dugger), 15, 17 Green, Alison, 145 Greenberg, Clement, 48, 85, 171 Greenwood, Nigel, 43, 131n17, 131n30, 175, 191 Grice, Malcolm le, 144, 150n25 Groundcourse (art education curriculum), 42 group criticism, 170–72, 173 Groupe de Recherce d’Art Visuel (GRAV), 29 Group Events, 137, 140 group g, 32 Growth and Form (exhibition), 32 Grupo movement, 56, 72 Grupo Proceso Pentágono, 72 Grupo Ruptura, 56 Gruppo T, 25 Grylls, Vaughan, 125 Guzman, Alberto, 25, 29 Haacke, Hans, Visitors’ Profiles, 48–49 Hackney Flashers, 7 Halsdorf, Serge, 66 Hamilton, Richard artist group membership, 2
223 Index
The Citizen, 132n44 exhibitions, 32, 132n54 Kent State, 124–25 The State, 132n44 students of, 122 The Subject, 132n44 “Hands Off Alexander Trocchi” (declaration), 153, 154 Harrison, Charles, 8, 47, 81, 93n34 Harrison, Margaret Art Spectrum influence, 5 censorship of artworks of, 127 feminist discourse in works of, 142 Women and Work, with Hunt and Kelly, 134 Hartog, Simon, 136, 147 Haus-Rucker-Co: Oasis 7, 102 Hayward Annual (exhibition), 132n73 Hayward Gallery, 47–48 Head, Tim, 175 Held, John, 185 Hellion, Martha, 55–56, 71, 74n52 Helmhaus Zürich, 26 Hemsworth, Gerard, 81, 83, 175 Henri, Adrian, 4 Here Is a Gale Warning (Finn-Kelcey), 5, 6, 15 Her Mistress’s Voice (Finn-Kelcey), 178 heroin, 151, 152, 153–54, 165n7 Herring, Ed, 47, 48, 53n49, 73n15 Hewison, Robert, 127 Hide, Peter magazine articles on sculpture featuring, 81 Sculpture Number 2, 85 Stockwell Depot association, 83 Híjar, Alberto, 71 Hiller, Susan on feminism in art, 148, 149 speaker-performances of, 175 Transformer, 148 women’s art exhibitions organized by, 147 Hilton, Tim, 120, 122, 123 History Group, 134 Hitler Fan Club (Smith, Pauline), 195 Hockney, David, 6, 110, 174–75 Holland Park (Louw), 82, 82, 87 Home Movies (Schwartz/Ess), 144, 148 Hornsey College of Art, 7, 19n30, 45, 122 Hunt, Kay: Women and Work, with Harrison, M. and Kelly, M., 134
Hunter, Alexis, 127 Hurrell, Harold, 47 ICA. See Institute of Contemporary Arts Ikon, 4 Illinois Central (Schneemann), 145 Immendorf, Jörg, 110, 111 imperialism, 5, 13. See also Northern Ireland In and Out of Amsterdam (exhibition), 18n12 In Between Show (exhibition), 42 An Inch of Earth is an Inch of Gold—U.S. Aggressors Get out of Indo-China (Dugger), 113n22 indecency, 183, 187–88, 190–94, 193 Independent Group, 2, 169 Index 02 (Art & Language), 92 Indica gallery and bookstore, 7 Inflatable (Stevens), 97, 106, 107 Information (exhibition), 70 Institute for Phenomenological Studies, 162 Institute of Contemporary Arts (ICA) artist collectives at, 2 exhibitions at, conceptual art, 7–8 exhibitions at, controversial, 183–84, 197–98 exhibitions at, kinetic art, 32, 53n61 exhibitions at, Latin American art, 27, 37n17, 57, 58, 73–74n15, 109 exhibitions at, mail art, 185 exhibitions at, 1960s British sculpture, 1, 8, 82, 83, 92 seminars at, 33 women’s experimental performance films presented at, 146 “The Institutionalization of Dissent” (Nairne), 91 Instituto Poltécnico Nacional, Mexico City, 55 International Coalition for the Liquidation of Art, 9, 13, 63, 65 Internationale Situationniste (journal), 153, 154, 154–55, 165n7 internationalism, 4–5, 8–9, 10, 21, 23. See also diaspora International Poetry Incarnation, 163 International Surrealist Exhibition, 169 International Times (newspaper), 1–2, 2, 163–64 International Underground Film Festival, 146 Interview Sculpture (Gilbert & George), 173 “Interviews with Three Filmmakers” (Glassner, Time Out), 136–37, 138, 140, 144, 145 In the Shadow of Your Smile, Bob (McLean), 174 Inversions (Martin, M.), 32 The Invisible Insurrection of a Million Minds (Trocchi collection), 164n2
224 Index
The Invisible Insurrection of a Million Minds (Trocchi sigma project founding text), 155–56, 165n7 It’s a Sort of Disease Part II (film), 67 Jack Wendler Gallery, 43 Jaded Vision (Nicolson), 142 James, Nicholas Philip, 48 Janiger, Oscar, 153 Jaray, Tess, 131n36 Johnston, Claire, 134 Jones, Amelia, 139 Jong, Jacqueline de, 154, 165–66n19 Jongh, Nicholas de, 80–81 Jorn, Asger, 154, 165–66n19 A Journal of Objects for the Chilean Resistance 1973–4 (Vicuña), 10, 11 Judd, Donald, 103 “Junkie Jottings” (Trocchi), 161 Kahler, Dean, 124 Kaprow, Allan, 4, 146 Kardia, Peter, 122 Kasmin, John, 6, 191 Kasmin Gallery, 6–7, 92 Keeler, Charles, 22, 34 Keeler, Paul art sales and museum acquisitions brokered by, 25–26 Brazil visits, 35 exhibitions organized by, 22 gallery-forums and publications founded by, 7, 13, 22, 23 networking roles, 25 studio visits, 31 Kelly, Mary Antepartum, 134 feminist reading groups of, 134 Post-Partum Document, 134, 184 Women and Work, with Harrison, M. and Hunt, K., 134 Kent, Sarah, 128 Kent State (Hamilton), 124–25 Kent State University shootings, 123–25, 128 Kepes, György, 31, 33, 34 Kester, Grant, 19n44, 44, 52n7 Kienholz, Edward: Five Car Stud, 103 kinetic art British, 32 definitions and descriptions, 23–24, 34, 36 exhibitions of, 13, 22–29, 27, 28, 34, 36 historical vs. modern views of, 24
North American, 29, 31 science and technology relationship, 32–34 Kinetic Theater, 145 King, Anthony D., 111 King, Phillip, 83, 93n9 Kingsley Hall, 157, 162 Klassnik, Robin Mail Action invitation recipient, 191 Yellow Objects, 185 Klein, Yves, 31, 37n16, 175 Klüver, Billy, 33 Kopinski, Jan: Minformation Is Coming, with McKay, 53n42 Kosuth, Joseph, 43, 47 Kozlov, Christine, 43 Krauss, Sigi. See also Gallery House; Sigi Krauss Gallery associates, 102, 113n19 demonstrations at Tate Gallery, 9, 64, 65 Krebs, Allen, 162 Kriesche, Richard: Polygonal Workshop/Garbage Walk, 66–70, 68, 69 Kustow, Michael, 146 Lacey, Bruce, 161, 191 Laing, R. D., 146, 156, 157, 161, 162, 167n42 Lamelas, David diaspora community, 57 exhibitions, 73n15 Publication, 131n17 A Study of the Relationship Between Inner and Outer Space, 73n15 Lampert, Catherine, 126 Landscape Hats (Dugger), 113n22 La Pérgola gallery, 56 Latham, John Big Breather, 42 exhibitions, 42, 48 Mail Action invitation recipient, 191 OHO (OI-IO) Context, 42 publications promoting, 32 speaker-performance exhibitions featuring, 175 sTigma collaborative environment, 161 studio locations of, 167n42 Latin American art. See also specific artists’ names and countries diaspora/exile influences on, 4–5, 6, 10, 55–58, 61 exhibitions of, 21, 25–29, 27, 28, 31, 35, 35, 57, 58, 73–74n15 galleries specializing in, 4, 21, 24–29, 57 museum acquisitions of, 25–26
225 Index
perceptions of, 35–36 Lauretis, Teresa de, 148 Lavrin, Beba, 161 “Laws of Sculpture” (Gilbert & George), 172–73 Leary, Timothy, 162 lecture performances. See speaker-performances Lee, Pamela M., 23–24, 26, 29 Legge, Rupert, 100 Let a Hundred Flowers Blossom (Dugger), 113n22 Letter from Stan Brakhage to Robert Kelly (Brakhage), 156, 166–67n37 Lettrist International (LI), 151, 152, 153, 165n6 Lexus, Roy, 67 Libro Tul Rojo (Vicuña), 10, 11 Lifton, John, 146 Lijn, Liliane associates, 98 Power Game, 111 Limpkin, Clive, 126, 127, 128 A Line Made by Walking (Long), 92 linguistic conceptual art, 47–48, 50 Lippard, Lucy, 40, 61, 82, 114n37 Liss, Carla, 14, 147 Liss, Jerome, 167n42 Lisson Gallery, 43, 86 Littlewood, Joan: Fun Palace, 156 Live in Your Head: Concept and Experiment in Britain (2000 exhibition), 87–88, 91–92 Live in Your Head: When Attitudes Become Form (1969 exhibition), 7–8, 81, 82, 86, 92, 102 Location (Louw), 86 Locations (exhibition), 131n17, 131n30 “Locked Room” (art education curriculum), 122 Lole, Kevin biographical information, 47, 54n78 CBA event participation, 54n74 journals edited by, 47 periodical contributions, 41, 46, 47 London, overview. See also related topics art activism against, 70 art education reforms in, 170–71 art market descriptions in vs. outside, 4 art networks, 4, 6, 8–10, 12 art scene descriptions, 57, 66 city/streets as artistic production sites, 58–61, 66–70, 85–86 exhibitions of influence, 5–6 galleries and alternative exhibition spaces, 7–8 international influences on, 4–5, 6
London Filmmakers’ Co-operative American influences on, 147 collaboration and collectivity of, 7, 14, 140, 141, 142, 144, 145 distribution secretaries and networking through, 147 locations of, 137 programs featuring women filmmakers at, 136 London Free School, 162 London Print Studio, 114n42 London Women’s Film Group, 134 London Women’s Liberation Art Group, 133 Long, Richard exhibitions, 81 A Line Made by Walking, 92 magazine articles on sculpture featuring, 81 Lougee, Jane, 164n5 Louw, Roelof. See also Soul City (Pyramid of Oranges) art scene participation, 81–82, 92 Arts Lab membership form and proposal, 79, 79 biographical information, 79 Exercises 3, 86 exhibitions, 81, 82, 85, 86–87, 92 Holland Park, 82, 82, 87 influences on, 83–84, 85, 89 Location, 86 Park Lane, 86 residences of, 79 Ring II, 85 Sound Recorder Works or Tape Recorder Scripts, 86, 91 Square 4 (Red / Light Green), 83, 84 studio locations, 79, 82, 83 teaching positions, 78–79 Untitled 1968, 83, 84, 87 Lucie-Smith, Edward, 130 Lütticken, Sven, 121–22 Lyceum Club, 169 Magazine Actions (COUM Transmissions), 184. See also Cosey Fanni Tutti “A Magazine Sculpture” (Gilbert & George), 172–73 Magritte, René: Time Transfixed, 190 Maharaj, Sarat, 121, 130 mail art anti-art statements and infrastructure challenges, 185, 188–90, 189, 195 for controversy, 195 indecency arrests and trials, 183, 187–88, 190–97, 193 Latin American political activism collaboration using, 70–71
226 Index
for networking, 10, 12 as walking sculptural documentation, 59–60, 60 yellow artifact donations and display, 185 Maler, Leopoldo Crane Ballet, 74n16 diaspora community, 57 exhibitions, 73–74n15 Mallen, George, 50, 51n3, 52n30, 53n42 Man from the Twenty-first Century (CBA/Willats), 50 Manifeste Situationniste (Trocchi), 165n7 Manson, Charles, 191 Mao Tsetung, 104, 107 mapping, 120–22, 125, 128–29, 130 Marinetti, Filippo Tommaso, 169 Marioni, Tom, 43 Martin, Agnes, 121 Martin, Courtney J., 66 Martin, David: Behavioural Treasure Hunt, with Shotbolt, 53n42 Martin, Frank, 172 Martin, Leslie, 37n5 Martin, Mary exhibitions, 29, 32 Inversions, 32 Marx, Erica, 33, 34 Marxism, 110 Massachusetts Institute of Technology (MIT), 31–32, 34 Massarenti, Cesare, 67 The Masses Have Boundless Creative Power–Mao Tsetung (Dugger), 113n22 Mass Media People (Burrows), 53n42 Mauss, Marcel, 90 Mayor, David, 12, 65, 69–72, 74n52 McCann, Eamonn, 126 McClure, Michael, 156 McKay, Andy: Minformation Is Coming, with Kopinski, 53n42 McLean, Bruce anti-art activism, 8 British art exhibition criticism, 18n1, 82 magazine articles on sculpture featuring, 81 speaker-performances, 172, 173, 174, 175, 177 McLuhan, Marshall, 124, 125 McShine, Kynaston, 70 Meat Joy (Schneemann), 145 Meat Science Essays (McClure), 156, 166n37 Medalla, David artist collective memberships, 98 artist-political group memberships, 13, 35, 57, 108–9, 109
artist spaces founded by, 114n42 art spaces, favorite, 33 biographical information, 25 exhibition installations, 31, 97, 99, 100, 107 exhibitions organized by, 22, 29, 30 forums and publications founded by, 13, 22, 23, 25, 32–33 galleries founded by, 7 protest posters produced by, 109 A Stitch in Time, 105, 107, 113n23 student advising at Slade, 175 media communication ethics themes, 117–18, 122, 124–25, 126–27, 130 for publicity, 187, 191 Medina, Cuauhtémoc, 61, 71 Megson, Neil Andrew. See P-Orridge, Genesis Mekas, Jonas, 147 Mellor, David, 89 Menstrual Hut (Nicolson), 148 The Mental Furniture Industry (exhibition), 19n30 Merlin (journal), 151, 152, 164–65n5 Metzger, Gustav anti-art coalitions founded by, 9, 63, 65, 89 art demonstrations at Tate Gallery, 9, 65 art forum memberships, 22 biographical information, 9 exhibitions, 5, 7, 41–42 Mass-Media-Today, 5 speaker-performances by, 174 Stockholm June: A Project for Stockholm 1–15 June 1972, 42 union membership, 42 Mexico exhibitions featuring artists from, 37–38n27 London-based artists from, 12–13, 25, 55–57, 58, 71, 72 political campaigns as art themes, 70–71 political activism and student protests, 55, 56, 58, 71 publishing collaborations with artists from, 71 Signals Newsbulletin featuring new museums in, 27 Microcosm (Camden Arts Centre exhibition), 101 Microcosm (Dugger solo exhibition), 97, 101–2 Midland Group Gallery art forum collaborations with, 32 exhibitions at, 35, 35, 36, 45–46, 52n39 Mindlin, Henrique E., 27 Mind Rover (Cornock and Edmonds), 53n42 Minformation Is Coming (Kopinski and McKay), 53n42 Minimalism, 48, 174
227 Index
“Miss World Demonstration” (Mulvey), 134 MIT (Massachusetts Institute of Technology), 31–32, 34 Mitchell, Juliet, 134 Mondragón, Sergio, 71 Monotipias (exhibition), 26 “...morning workers pass...” (Donagh), 131n19 Morris, Lynda, 40, 175 Morris, Robert, 103, 174 Mortal Issues (exhibition), 73–74n15 Le Mouvement (exhibition), 22–23 The Moving Times–project sigma, sigma portfolio 1 (poster), 156, 162, 166n28 Mulvey, Laura, 134, 150n26 Mumford, Lewis, 34 Museum of Conceptual Art, San Francisco, 43 Museum of Modern Art Oxford (now Modern Art Oxford) artists and social projects featured at, 43, 45–46 building history, 99 exhibitions at, 33–34, 99–101, 100 founding and influence of, 4 participation art at, 113n23 sculptural installations and genius loci themes, 86 Museum of Modern Art, Rio de Janeiro, 35 Museum of Normal Art, New York, 43 Mutation Phenomena (exhibitions), 36, 37n27 My Own Mag (magazine), 157, 160–61, 162 Nairne, Sandy, 91 Naked Action Lecture (Schneemann), 146, 177 The National Advisory Council on Art Education, 180n5 National Women’s Liberation Conference, 134, 142 Naylor, Colin, 190, 191, 193 N.E. Thing Co. Ltd., 43 Neoconcretismo, 98 “Nest-Cells” (Oiticica), 4 networking. See also mail art; project sigma art centers for, 40 art collaboration through, 70–71 circulation methods for, 10, 12 contact zones for, 4, 9 exhibitions influencing, 6, 8 galleries supporting, 25, 29 internationalism and technology promoting, 8–9 periodical publications for, 12, 25, 46, 47, 58, 71 as social movement for politicized practices, 8 studios as artistic communities for, 85 urban decentralization and, 70
networking (continued) women artists’ collectives for, 178 women’s filmmaking practices for, 134, 137, 140, 141, 142, 144, 146 “The New Art” (Brooks, Studio International), 48 The New Art (exhibition), 47–48 New Arts Lab, 137, 140, 144, 146 “New Generation,” 81, 83 New Generation (exhibition), 81 Newsbulletin (publication) contents and layout descriptions, 24–25 future plans and growth expectations, 29, 34 kinetic art, defined, 23 Latin American art featured in, 27–28 networking function of, 12, 13, 25, 32–33 North American art featured in, 34 purpose of, 32 themes of, 21 New Scientist (magazine), 27 Newsheet (publication), 42 New Vision Centre, 18n16, 25, 33, 37n16 New York Art Strike, 65 New York Film-makers’ Co-operative, 147 Nicholson, Ben, 22, 37n5 Nicolson, Annabel Anju, 141 collective practices, 141, 142, 144 education, 141 as Feminist Art News guest editor, 148 film-and-video-distribution collectives founded by, 148 filmmaking style descriptions, 141–42, 144 in independent filmmaking directories, 135, 136 Jaded Vision, 142 on Liss film performance descriptions, 147 Menstrual Hut, 148 with Potter and Schwartz (Ess) at the Co-op, 141 Reel Time, 140, 142–43, 143 on Schwartz film performance descriptions, 144–45 Slides, 141, 142 Time Out interview, 149n9 on women’s identity conflicts, 140, 142 Nigel Greenwood Gallery, 43, 131n17, 131n30, 175, 191 Nitro Benzol & Black Linoleum (Oiticica), 57 nonart, 67, 68–69, 101, 108. See also anti-art/aesthetics movement Norse, Harold, 162 Northern Ireland art exhibition controversy, 127 civil-rights art themes, 115–19, 116, 125–29, 130, 131n5, 132n44
228 Index
journal cover imagery, 1–2 media coverage, 117–18, 126–27 political conflict descriptions, 9–10, 115, 117, 126–27, 128 Northern Ireland 1968–May Day 1975 (Atkinson, C.), 131n5 Nul, 25 Nuttall, Jeff magazines founded by, 157 Mail Action invitation recipient, 191 project sigma interpersonal logs, 157, 160–61 project sigma weekend meeting organized by, 161 sTigma collaborative environment, 161–62 Oasis 7 (Haus-Rucker-Co), 102 Obra secretamente titulada Arriba y Adelante...y si no, pos también (Ehrenberg), 70–71 obscenity, 188, 193–94 O’Connor, Howard, 43, 51n3 Offenbach, David, 192, 193, 195 OHO (OI-IO) Context (Latham), 42 Oiticica, Hélio as artistic influence, 58, 99 diaspora community, 57 Eden, 73–74n15 exhibitions, 4, 25, 29, 73–74n15 Keeler and Brett meeting with, 35 networking, 25 Nitro Benzol & Black Linoleum, 57 Parangolé, 35 proposition/thought theories, 98 university worships of, 4 Whitechapel Experiment, 58, 73–74n15 Oliver, Felicity (Super Girl), 44, 45 Olympia Press, 164–65n5 Olympics, 52–53n40, 55, 71, 73n6 Omissions (Kleiinie Spielinie) (COUM Transmissions), 186, 187 O’Neill, Terence, 117 Op Losse Schroeven (exhibition), 81 “Orange Pyramid Show, Arts Laboratory, 1967,” 90 Orchard Gallery, 132n54 Otero, Alejandro, 25, 26, 27, 28, 32 Our New Sculpture (Gilbert & George), 172 over-participation, 100–101 Overy, Paul, 115, 117 Oxford Insight Development Project (CBA/Willats), 44, 52n39 Paddington Printshop, 114n42 Pain Things and Explanations (exhibitions), 73–74n15, 109
Paolozzi, Eduardo exhibition protest, 18n1 As Is When series, 2 speaker-performances of, 169 Papaconstantinou, Leda, 137 Parangolé (Oiticica), 35 Parker, Rozsika, 133 Park Lane (Louw), 86 participation art (part-art) architectural installations for social engagement, 95–96, 96, 103–8, 105, 106 exhibitions for, 97, 99, 100–102 over-participation challenges, 100–101 Pask, Gordon, 42, 50 patriarchy, 134, 139, 146, 149 Penrose, Sir Ronald, 33 People’s Participation Pavilion (Pavilion Dugger) (Dugger), 95–96, 96, 103–8, 105, 106, 113n22 performance art. See also participation art; speaker-performances anti-aesthetic philosophies on, 185 controversial, 183–84, 197–98 film, 137–40, 144–46, 148 mail art as, 70–71, 190 sculpture-, 58–61, 66–70, 77–78, 148, 172–73 trials appropriated for, 183, 190–97, 193 Philadelphia Association, 157, 161, 162 Piersol, Virginia, 148 Pilkington, Philip, 47, 53n46 Pilot (CACS exhibitions), 22, 27, 31 Pinochet, Augusto, 10, 15, 57, 74n17, 110, 114n29 Pioneers of Part-Art, 99–101, 100 Piper, Adrian, 112, 179 The Place theater, 140 Plant, John, 64, 65 Play (Potter), 137 The Plumed Horn (magazine), 71 political art and activism. See also diaspora; Northern Ireland anti-imperialism, 5, 13 antiwar, 10, 34, 98, 107, 109, 122 pro-democracy, 15, 70–71, 72, 102, 109, 110–11, 113n22 pro-socialism, 104, 107, 113n22 waste collection strikes, 66–70, 68, 69 The Politics of Experience (Laing), 162 Pollock, Griselda, 133 Polygonal Workshop, 66–70, 68, 69 PoPa at MoMA (exhibition), 99–101, 100 Pop art, 2–3
229 Index
pornography, 164–65n5, 183, 188, 194, 196, 197 P-Orridge, Genesis (Neil Andrew Megson). See also COUM Transmissions alter ego collectives of, 184 artist encyclopedias edited by, 190 art scene withdrawal, 183 biographical information, 185, 198n2 exhibitions of controversy, 183–84, 197–98 Mail Action indecency trial and performance, 183, 187–88, 190–97, 193 performance art statements, 185 postcards and mail projects, 188–90, 189 reconditioned language of, 198n7 relocations, 186–87 positivist science, 139 postal service distribution. See mail art postcard art anti-aesthetic philosophies on, 185, 195 arrest and prosecution for indecency, 183, 187–97, 189, 193 pro-democracy activism and international collaboration, 70–71 walking documentation, 59–60, 60 Poster-Film Collective, 114n42 Postminimalism, 48 Poston, Tim, 188 Post-Partum Document (Kelly), 134, 184 Potlatch (journal), 90, 152, 165n6 potlatches, 90 Potter, Sally The Building, 137–39, 138 collective and collaborative practices, 137, 140, 148 Combines, 137, 140 education, 140 feminist dialogue limitations, 142 filmmaking style descriptions, 137–40 Gold Diggers, 148 in independent filmmaking directories, 136 with Nicolson and Schwartz (Ess) at the Co-op, 141 Play, 137 Thriller, 148 Time Out interview, 136–37, 138, 140 women artists’ identity conflicts, 138, 139–40 women’s liberation conferences attended by, 142, 150n23 Powell-Jones, Mark, 100 Power Game (Lijn), 111 Precarious Objects (or Precarios) (Vicuña), 10 The Present Situation (Laing), 156, 166n37
Price, Cedric: Fun Palace, 156 Prismatic Conversation in Silver Space (Dugger), 113n22 project sigma (Trocchi) box office location, 164 challenges of, 155 creation of, 155 descriptions, 151, 155 distribution models for, 165n6 environment installations as allegiance to, 161–62 founding text of, 155–56, 161, 162, 165n7 influence of, 162–63 influences on, 151 interpersonal logs for, 156–57, 158–59, 160, 163, 165n7, 168n62 poetry events as example of, 163 posters for, 156, 162, 166n28 purpose and theoretical statements, 7, 14, 156, 161, 163–64, 165n7 themes, 152, 153, 155, 163 transatlantic distribution and advocacy, 162 university construction prototypes, 156, 157, 162 weekend meeting events, 161 Project sigma—Public Relations—List of People Interested, 156–57, 158–59 Prostitution (exhibition), 183–84, 197–98 Publication (Lamelas), 131n17 Pyramid of Oranges. See Soul City (Pyramid of Oranges) (Louw) A Quarter of a Century of the Beautiful Art of Alejandro Otero: 1940–1965 (exhibition), 26, 27, 28 Rains Retreat (Dugger), 102, 104, 111 Randall, Margaret, 71 Rayns, Tony, 135 Read, Sir Herbert, 33 Real Space (conference), 176–77 Record as Artwork (exhibition), 175 Reel Time (Nicolson), 140, 142–44, 143 Reflection on Three Weeks in May 1970 (Donagh), 118, 119–23, 124 Reichardt, Jasia, 50, 73–74n15 Reichenbach, Francois, 67 Reid, Norman, 107, 192, 196, 197 Reise, Barbara, 175, 191, 194, 198 relational aesthetics, 111–12 René, Denise, 22–23, 25 Resistance to Civil Government (Thoreau), 125 “Resolution Concerning the Imprisonment of Alexander Trocchi” (Internationale Situationniste), 153, 154
230 Index
Richard Demarco Gallery, 4, 18n10 Ring II (Louw), 85 Robert Fraser Gallery, 33 Robertson, Geoffrey, 188, 193–94 Rockburne, Dorothea, 113n21 Roelof Louw: Project Space (exhibition), 86 Rosenberg, Jan, 140 Rosenthal, Irving, 153 Rothenstein, Sir John, 26, 27 Royal College of Art pro-democracy festivals held at, 97, 109–11, 110, 114n40 speaker-performance exhibitions at, 175–76 speaker-performances at, 169–70, 173, 174, 176 Rushton, David, 47, 53n46 Russell, John, 125 Salvadori, Marcello, 22, 25, 31, 33–34 Sandback, Fred, 103 Sandbrook, Dominic, 127 Sanger, Colston biographical information, 54n78 gallery representation, 46 journals founded by, 46 Signs, Grips and Words, 46–47, 53n42 Santos, Bartolomeu dos, 63 Savage, Robert J., 126 Schatzman, Morton, 167n42 Schendel, Mira, 7, 25, 26, 35 Schmuck (magazine), 72 Schneemann, Carolee Blood Work Diary, 146 collective and collaborative practices, 14, 145, 146 critical response to, 146 diasporic experiences, 145 exhibitions and performances, 4, 101 Fuses, 145, 146, 177 Illinois Central, 145 in independent filmmaking directories, 136 Meat Joy, 145 Naked Action Lecture, 146, 177 political conflict recollections, 10 Snows, 145 Thames Crawling, 146 Time Out interview, 136 Schwartz (Ess), Barbara biographical information, 145, 148 collective and collaboration practices, 144, 147, 148
education, 140, 144 Everything’s Gonna Be Alright, 144 exhibitions organized by, 147 Gina, 144 Home Movies, 144, 148 in independent filmmaking directories, 136 with Potter and Nicolson at the Co-op, 141 Time Out interview, 136, 137, 145 women artists’ identity conflicts, 144 science and technology, 8–9, 33–34 Scott, Tim, 81 sculpture art education courses, 122 Ergonic, 99 museum acquisition controversies, 184, 196 as performance, 58–61, 66–70, 77–78, 148, 172–73 Sculpture in the 60s, Impresarios of the Art World (Gilbert & George), 173 “Sculpture Now” (Cork), 170 Sculpture Number 2 (Hide), 85 Seghal, Tino, 112 Semina (magazine), 153 The Seventh Day Chicken: Polygonal Workshop Investigates Garbage (exhibition), 68–69 sexism as art theme, 112 equal representation issues, 65 exhibitions with women artist, 132n73 filmmaking and gender-based oppression, 14, 134, 136, 139–40, 146, 149, 177 Shadow of Six Counties (Donagh), 130 Sharp, Willoughby, 31, 36 Shaw, Jeffrey, 42 Sheeper (Rosenthal), 153 Shotbolt, Jack: Behavioural Treasure Hunt, with Martin, 53n42 Shrew (journal), 134, 148 Side, 4 Siegelaub, Seth, 40, 93n41 A Sightseeing Tour in Exeter (Polygonal Workshop), 69–70 Sigi Krauss Gallery artists featured at, 7, 42 closure, 113n19 exhibitions at, 57, 97, 101–2, 105 founding and descriptions, 7, 41, 113n16 social protest workshop collaborations, 68 Signals London (formerly Centre for Advanced Creative Study) artists featured at, 24
231 Index
British art and, 32 closure, 7, 25, 34–35 descriptions, 7 exhibitions at, 22, 23, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 32 founding and history, 7, 22, 33 future plans and growth expectations, 23, 29, 31, 34 influence and legacy, 7, 21, 25, 28–34, 35–36 kinetic art and role of, 13, 21, 24 Latin American art, 21, 25–27, 29 location, 22 museum acquisitions through, 25–26 name origins, 22 North American art, 29, 31, 34 patrons of, 26, 31 periodicals published by (see Newsbulletin) Signalz: Newsbulletin of the Centre for Advanced Creative Study, 22, 23 Signs, Grips and Words (Sanger), 46–47, 53n42 Silence (exhibition), 73–74n15 Silver Liberties (Atkinson, C.), 127, 128 Singing in the Body Electric (Dugger), 113n22 Singing Sculpture (Gilbert & George), 172 Site Gallery, 4 Sitney, P. Adams, 150n25 Situationist International (SI), 153, 154–55, 165n16, 166n35. See also Internationale Situationniste Situationists, 61, 66, 165n7 Six Latin American Countries (exhibition), 37–38n27 Sixties Art Scene in London (exhibition), 92 Sixties Art Scene in London (Mellor exhibition catalogue), 89 Sjöo, Monica, 142 Slade School of Art speaker-performances at, 174–75, 180n24 student advisors at, 63, 174–75 students at, 10, 63 teachers at, 131n36 teaching practices at, 171 Slides (Nicolson), 141, 142 Smith, Pauline Hitler Fan Club mail art project, 195 Mail Action invitation recipient, 191 P-Orridge mail art theories and card recycling, 195 P-Orridge trial attendance, 191, 193 Smith, Peter, 54n74, 175 Smith, Pippa, 114n42 Smyth, Cherry, 119 Snake Pit (Dugger), 104, 113n22 The Snake Pit for Art Critics (Dugger), 102
Snow, George: International Times cover design, 1, 2 Snows (Schneemann), 145 socialism, 104, 107, 113n22 Socialist Art Through Socialist Revolution (Dugger), 113n22 Social Resource Project for Munich Olympics (CBA/Willats), 52–53n40 Social Resource Project for Tennis Clubs (CBA/Willats), 53n42 SoHo Artists Association, 65 “Some Aspects of Contemporary British Sculpture” (Harrison), 81 Soto, Jesús Rafael, 23, 25–26, 35 Soul City (Pyramid of Oranges) (Louw) artists influenced by, 93n28 description, 77–78, 91 exhibitions of, 77–78, 81, 82, 87–88, 89–90, 91, 92 installation views, 78 magazine articles featuring, 13, 79, 80, 81, 82 museum acquisitions and displays of, 78 other sculptures exhibited with, 90–91 as signature work, 77, 87, 89, 91–92 site specificity vs. global recreations, 88–89 themes of, 89–90 Soundings One (exhibition), 22 Soundings series (exhibitions), 22 Soundings Three (exhibition), 29, 30, 32 Soundings Two (exhibition), 22, 23 Sound Recorder Works (Louw), 86, 91 South African artists, 79, 83 South Bank Demonstration (Metzger), 9 South London Gay Community Centre, 7 A Space: A Thousand Words (exhibition), 176–77 Spare Rib (journal), 147–48 speaker-performances art schools and early development of, 172–77 art tradition of, 169 descriptions and definitions, 169–70, 172, 179–80 influences on development of, 170–72 legacy of, 180 of Mexican artists, 56 scholarship and legitimacy issues of, 178–79 sculpture and, 172–73 sound recordings of, 175 themes, 173, 174–75, 177–78, 179–80 Square 4 (Red / Light Green) (Louw), 83, 84 St. Martin’s School of Art exchange/distribution concepts, 90 publications of, 90 sculpture performances at, 172
232 Index
speaker-performances at, 173, 174 teachers at, 78–79, 81, 83, 87 teaching styles at, 122, 171 The State (Hamilton), 132n44 Statements (magazine), 53n46 Steiner, Rudolph, 102 Stevens, Graham artist collective memberships, 98 exhibition installations, 97, 99, 100 Inflatable, 97, 106, 107 Stezaker, John biographical information, 41, 54n78 exhibitions, 43, 48, 175, 176 networking practices, 47 periodical contributions, 41, 46, 53n44 speaker-performances, 175, 176, 177 sTigma (Nuttall, et al.), 161–62 A Stitch in Time (Medalla), 105, 107, 113n23 Stockholm June: A Project for Stockholm 1–15 June 1972 (Metzger), 42 Stockwell Depot, 79, 81, 82, 83, 85, 93n2 Stone Brothers Printing, 153 A Stroll in July, or One Thursday Afternoon, or Half Day in London, or (The) Afternoon, or ...Topology of Sculpture (Ehrenberg), 58–60, 60 Structure & Codes (exhibition), 175–76 Studio International (magazine) conceptual sculpture, 13, 79, 80, 81, 82 cybernetic exhibitions, 50 exhibition reviews, 48 kinetic art, 53n61 Laws of Sculpture published in, 172–73 office location, 79 Potlatch cartoons reproduced in, 90 sculptors featured in, 83 women artists, 129 A Study of the Relationship Between Inner and Outer Space (Lamelas), 73n15 The Subject (Hamilton), 132n44 Super Girls, 44, 45 Survey ‘68 (exhibition), 90 Survey ‘69 (exhibition), 47 Survey ‘70 (exhibition), 47 Survey of Distance Models of Art (Willats), 48–49, 49 Survey of the Avant-Garde in Britain (exhibition), 41, 45, 47–48, 113n23, 147 System Research Ltd., 42
Szeemann, Harald Dugger invitation to documenta 5, 102 exhibitions organized by, 7, 13, 95, 102, 103 on Louw’s Park Lane exhibition, 86 Mail Action invitation recipient, 191 Szulakowska, Ursula, 130 A Tactical Blueprint (Trocchi), 156, 161, 164n7 “taking the trouble to sound it” (Donagh), 120–21, 121 Takis (Panagiotis Vassilakis), 22, 25, 31, 34, 98 Talking to Women (Dunn), 137 Taller de Gráfica Popular, 73n3 Tape Recorder Project by Roelof Louw (exhibition), 86–87, 93n25 Tape Recorder Works (Louw), 86, 91 Tate Gallery anti-art demonstrations at, 9, 13, 64, 65, 66 art acquisition controversies, 184 conceptual sculpture exhibitions at, 78 kinetic art acquisitions, 25–26, 32 Medalla correspondence with, as art exhibit, 107 sculpture acquisitions and displays, 78, 83 “Technique du coup du monde” (retitled Invisible Insurrection of a Million Minds) (Trocchi), 155–56, 165n7 Thames Crawling (Schneemann), 146 Thatcher, Margaret, 9, 128 The Theatre and Its Double (Artaud), 155 Thinking About Exhibitions (Greenberg, Ferguson and Nairne), 91 III Salón Independiente (exhibition), 70–71 30,000 Bananas (Fishbone), 93n28 Thoreau, Henry David, 120, 122, 125 Three Friends (exhibition), 147–48 3 Life Situations (exhibition), 41–42 Thriller (Potter), 148 Throbbing Gristle (band), 195 Tickner, Lisa, 2, 6, 122, 178 Time Out (magazine), 136–37, 138, 140, 144, 145, 191 Time Transfixed (Magritte), 190 Tinguely, Miriam, 113n19 Tiravanija, Rirkrit, 112 Tisdall, Caroline, 125, 126, 129, 191 Tlatelolco massacre, 55, 58, 71 Towards the Invisible (exhibition), 23, 29, 31 Transformer (Hiller), 148 Transgravity (magazine), 72 trials, as performance art venues, 183, 190–97, 193 Trocchi, Alexander. See also project sigma arrests and imprisonment, 153, 154, 165–66n19–20
233 Index
autobiographical novels of, 153, 155 collection of writings by, 164n2 drug use as identity, 151, 152–53, 153–54 education, 151 French radical group memberships, 151, 152, 165n6 marriage, 153 papers of, 164n2 periodical contributions, 151, 164–65n5 philosophies of, 151–52, 154, 161 pornography writings and pseudonyms of, 164–65n5 Situationist group memberships, 154–55, 166n35 in US, 152–53 Tschumi, Bernard, 176 Tube-O-Nauts’ Travels, a Voyage Under London (Ehrenberg), 61, 62, 63 Tucker, William Cat’s Cradle, 84–85 Louw comparisons, 84 sculpture visibility due to, 83 symposium participation, 81 Turner, Alwyn, 184 Tutti, Cosey Fanni, 183–84, 187, 191, 193, 194, 197 12 Books for the Chilean Resistance (Vicuña), 10, 11 2B Butler’s Wharf, 7 Ulster Museum, Belfast, 127 Underneath the Arches (Gilbert & George), 172–73, 174, 180n24 Understanding Media (McLuhan), 124 Universidad Nacional Autónoma de México, 55, 73n3 University of California, Berkeley, 34 University of Sussex, 4 Untitled 1968 (Louw), 83, 84, 87 Untitled (Portrait of Ross in L.A.) (González-Torres), 91 Vachon, Gail, 148 Vaizey, Marina, 119 VALIE EXPORT, 142, 145, 179 Vasarely, Victor, 22–23 Vassilakis, Panagiotis (Takis), 22, 25, 31, 34, 98 Venezuela (exhibition), 35 Venezuelan artists, 25, 26–29, 35, 35 Victoria & Albert Museum, 81 Victory to the Just Struggle of the People’s Movement for the Liberation of Angola–M.P.L.A.! (Dugger), 113n22 Vicuña, Cecilia art subjects and themes, 57 diaspora and exile, 10, 57, 109
Vicuña, Cecilia (continued) exhibitions, 73–74n15, 109 A Journal of Objects for the Chilean Resistance 1973–4, 10, 11 Libro Tul Rojo, from 12 Books for the Chilean Resistance, 11 political art groups founded by, 109 Precarious Objects (or Precarios), 10 protest sculpture for Artists for Democracy, 109 publishing collaborations, 71 12 Books for the Chilean Resistance, 10, 11 Vietnam War, 10, 34, 98, 107, 109, 122 Visitors’ Profiles (Haacke), 48–49 Visual Meta Language Simulation (CBA/Willats), 52n39, 53n42 “Visual Pleasure and Narrative Cinema” (Mulvey), 134 Walden (Thoreau), 120 Walker, James Faure, 93n34 Walker, John A., 57 walking, as art form, 58–61 Wall Show (exhibition), 86 waste collection strikes and protests, 66–70, 68, 69 Waterlow, Nick, 54n74 Weaver, Mike, 74n52 Wegner, Nicholas, 125 Welch, Chris, 71 Well, Rudolfine, 67 West London Manual (CBA/Willats), 44 West London Re-Modelling Book (CBA/Willats), 44 West London Social Resource Project (CBA/Willats), 44–45, 45 When Attitudes Become Form. See Live in Your Head: When Attitudes Become Form (1969 exhibition) When Attitudes Become Form: Bern 1969 / Venice 2013 (exhibition), 92 White, Kenneth, 156 Whitechapel Art Gallery exhibitions controversy in Northern Ireland, 127 Latin American art exhibited at, 4, 57, 73–74n15, 99 sculptural installations at, 87–88, 91–92 sculpture exhibitions at, 81 sound exhibition installations at, 86
234 Index
Whitechapel Experiment (Oiticica), 58, 73–74n15 White Room (Donagh), 123 White Studio (Donagh), 123 Why I Paint What I Paint (Ehrenberg lecture), 56 Wieland, Joyce, 145 Willats, Stephen. See also Centre for Behavioural Art CBA event participation, 44–45, 54n74 Edinburgh Social Model Construction Project, 50, 51 employment at System Research Ltd. as assistant, 52n19 exhibitions, 45–46, 46, 48 periodicals of, 13, 39, 41 publications of, 41, 52n4 publications promoting, 32 speaker-performance exhibitions featuring, 175 teaching positions, 45 Wilson, Harold, 9–10, 66 Wittgenstein, Ludwig, 48 Women and Work (Harrison, M., Hunt K. and Kelly, M.), 134 Women Artists Collective, 178 Women Artists in Revolution, 65 The Women’s Event (Edinburgh Film Festival), 134 Women’s Free Arts Alliance, 134 women’s liberation movement. See feminism Women’s Workshop of the Artists’ Union, 133–34, 140, 142, 148, 149n2 Wood, Jon, 88, 89 World Cup, 70–71 Wreckers of Civilisation (Ford), 195 Yellow Objects (Klassnik), 185 Y Pants, 148 “Zang Tumb Tuuum” (Marinetti), 169 Zero, 25, 37n16
rm
REFIGURING MODERNISM
ARTS L I T E R AT U R E S SCIENCES
(A Series Edited By) Jonathan Eburne Refiguring Modernism features cutting-edge interdisciplinary approaches to the study of art, literature, science, and cultural history. With an eye to the different modernisms emerging throughout the world during the twentieth century and beyond, we seek to publish scholarship that engages creatively with canonical and eccentric works alike, bringing fresh concepts and original research to bear on modernist cultural production, whether aesthetic, social, or epistemological. What does it mean to study modernism in a global context characterized at once by decolonization and nation-building; international cooperation and conflict; changing ideas about subjectivity and identity; new understandings of language, religion, poetics, and myth; and new paradigms for science, politics, and religion? What did modernism offer artists, writers, and intellectuals? How do we theorize and historicize modernism? How do we rethink its forms, its past, and its futures?
(Other Books in the Series) David Peters Corbett The World in Paint: Modern Art and Visuality in England, 1848–1914 Jordana Mendelson Documenting Spain: Artists, Exhibition Culture, and the Modern Nation, 1929–1939 Barbara Larson The Dark Side of Nature: Science, Society, and the Fantastic in the Work of Odilon Redon Alejandro Anreus, Diana L. Linden, and Jonathan Weinberg, eds. The Social and the Real: Political Art of the 1930s in the Western Hemisphere Margaret Iversen Beyond Pleasure: Freud, Lacan, Barthes Stephen Bann, ed. The Coral Mind: Adrian Stokes’s Engagement with Architecture, Art History, Criticism, and Psychoanalysis Charles Palermo Fixed Ecstasy: Joan Miró in the 1920s Marius Roux The Substance and the Shadow Aruna D’Souza Cézanne’s Bathers: Biography and the Erotics of Paint Abigail Gillman Viennese Jewish Modernism: Freud, Hofmannsthal, BeerHofmann, and Schnitzler Stephen Petersen Space-Age Aesthetics: Lucio Fontana, Yves Klein, and the Postwar European Avant-Garde Stefanie Harris Mediating Modernity: German Literature and the “New” Media, 1895–1930 Michele Greet Beyond National Identity: Pictorial Indigenism as a Modernist Strategy for Andean Art, 1920–1960 Paul Smith, ed. Seurat Re-viewed David Prochaska and Jordana Mendelson, eds. Postcards: Ephemeral Histories of Modernity David Getsy From Diversion to Subversion: Games, Play, and TwentiethCentury Art Jessica Burstein Cold Modernism: Literature, Fashion, Art Adam Jolles The Curatorial Avant-Garde: Surrealism and the Making of the Modern Exhibition Highfill, Juli Modernism and Its Merchandise: The Spanish Avant-Garde and Material Culture, 1920–1930 Keane, Damien Ireland and the Problem of Information: Irish Writing, Radio, Late Modernist Communication Kalba, Laura, Color in the Age of Impressionism: Commerce, Technology, and Art Morehead, Allison, Nature’s Experiments and the Search for Symbolist Form Walworth, Catherine, Soviet Salvage: Imperial Debris, Revolutionary Reuse, and Russian Constructivism